1 //===--- SemaOverload.cpp - C++ Overloading -------------------------------===//
2 //
3 // Part of the LLVM Project, under the Apache License v2.0 with LLVM Exceptions.
4 // See https://llvm.org/LICENSE.txt for license information.
5 // SPDX-License-Identifier: Apache-2.0 WITH LLVM-exception
6 //
7 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
8 //
9 // This file provides Sema routines for C++ overloading.
10 //
11 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
12 
13 #include "clang/AST/ASTContext.h"
14 #include "clang/AST/CXXInheritance.h"
15 #include "clang/AST/DeclObjC.h"
16 #include "clang/AST/DependenceFlags.h"
17 #include "clang/AST/Expr.h"
18 #include "clang/AST/ExprCXX.h"
19 #include "clang/AST/ExprObjC.h"
20 #include "clang/AST/TypeOrdering.h"
21 #include "clang/Basic/Diagnostic.h"
22 #include "clang/Basic/DiagnosticOptions.h"
23 #include "clang/Basic/PartialDiagnostic.h"
24 #include "clang/Basic/SourceManager.h"
25 #include "clang/Basic/TargetInfo.h"
26 #include "clang/Sema/Initialization.h"
27 #include "clang/Sema/Lookup.h"
28 #include "clang/Sema/Overload.h"
29 #include "clang/Sema/SemaInternal.h"
30 #include "clang/Sema/Template.h"
31 #include "clang/Sema/TemplateDeduction.h"
32 #include "llvm/ADT/DenseSet.h"
33 #include "llvm/ADT/Optional.h"
34 #include "llvm/ADT/STLExtras.h"
35 #include "llvm/ADT/SmallPtrSet.h"
36 #include "llvm/ADT/SmallString.h"
37 #include <algorithm>
38 #include <cstdlib>
39 
40 using namespace clang;
41 using namespace sema;
42 
43 using AllowedExplicit = Sema::AllowedExplicit;
44 
45 static bool functionHasPassObjectSizeParams(const FunctionDecl *FD) {
46   return llvm::any_of(FD->parameters(), [](const ParmVarDecl *P) {
47     return P->hasAttr<PassObjectSizeAttr>();
48   });
49 }
50 
51 /// A convenience routine for creating a decayed reference to a function.
52 static ExprResult
53 CreateFunctionRefExpr(Sema &S, FunctionDecl *Fn, NamedDecl *FoundDecl,
54                       const Expr *Base, bool HadMultipleCandidates,
55                       SourceLocation Loc = SourceLocation(),
56                       const DeclarationNameLoc &LocInfo = DeclarationNameLoc()){
57   if (S.DiagnoseUseOfDecl(FoundDecl, Loc))
58     return ExprError();
59   // If FoundDecl is different from Fn (such as if one is a template
60   // and the other a specialization), make sure DiagnoseUseOfDecl is
61   // called on both.
62   // FIXME: This would be more comprehensively addressed by modifying
63   // DiagnoseUseOfDecl to accept both the FoundDecl and the decl
64   // being used.
65   if (FoundDecl != Fn && S.DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Fn, Loc))
66     return ExprError();
67   DeclRefExpr *DRE = new (S.Context)
68       DeclRefExpr(S.Context, Fn, false, Fn->getType(), VK_LValue, Loc, LocInfo);
69   if (HadMultipleCandidates)
70     DRE->setHadMultipleCandidates(true);
71 
72   S.MarkDeclRefReferenced(DRE, Base);
73   if (auto *FPT = DRE->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) {
74     if (isUnresolvedExceptionSpec(FPT->getExceptionSpecType())) {
75       S.ResolveExceptionSpec(Loc, FPT);
76       DRE->setType(Fn->getType());
77     }
78   }
79   return S.ImpCastExprToType(DRE, S.Context.getPointerType(DRE->getType()),
80                              CK_FunctionToPointerDecay);
81 }
82 
83 static bool IsStandardConversion(Sema &S, Expr* From, QualType ToType,
84                                  bool InOverloadResolution,
85                                  StandardConversionSequence &SCS,
86                                  bool CStyle,
87                                  bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion);
88 
89 static bool IsTransparentUnionStandardConversion(Sema &S, Expr* From,
90                                                  QualType &ToType,
91                                                  bool InOverloadResolution,
92                                                  StandardConversionSequence &SCS,
93                                                  bool CStyle);
94 static OverloadingResult
95 IsUserDefinedConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
96                         UserDefinedConversionSequence& User,
97                         OverloadCandidateSet& Conversions,
98                         AllowedExplicit AllowExplicit,
99                         bool AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit);
100 
101 static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
102 CompareStandardConversionSequences(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc,
103                                    const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1,
104                                    const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2);
105 
106 static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
107 CompareQualificationConversions(Sema &S,
108                                 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1,
109                                 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2);
110 
111 static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
112 CompareDerivedToBaseConversions(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc,
113                                 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1,
114                                 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2);
115 
116 /// GetConversionRank - Retrieve the implicit conversion rank
117 /// corresponding to the given implicit conversion kind.
118 ImplicitConversionRank clang::GetConversionRank(ImplicitConversionKind Kind) {
119   static const ImplicitConversionRank
120     Rank[(int)ICK_Num_Conversion_Kinds] = {
121     ICR_Exact_Match,
122     ICR_Exact_Match,
123     ICR_Exact_Match,
124     ICR_Exact_Match,
125     ICR_Exact_Match,
126     ICR_Exact_Match,
127     ICR_Promotion,
128     ICR_Promotion,
129     ICR_Promotion,
130     ICR_Conversion,
131     ICR_Conversion,
132     ICR_Conversion,
133     ICR_Conversion,
134     ICR_Conversion,
135     ICR_Conversion,
136     ICR_Conversion,
137     ICR_Conversion,
138     ICR_Conversion,
139     ICR_Conversion,
140     ICR_Conversion,
141     ICR_OCL_Scalar_Widening,
142     ICR_Complex_Real_Conversion,
143     ICR_Conversion,
144     ICR_Conversion,
145     ICR_Writeback_Conversion,
146     ICR_Exact_Match, // NOTE(gbiv): This may not be completely right --
147                      // it was omitted by the patch that added
148                      // ICK_Zero_Event_Conversion
149     ICR_C_Conversion,
150     ICR_C_Conversion_Extension
151   };
152   return Rank[(int)Kind];
153 }
154 
155 /// GetImplicitConversionName - Return the name of this kind of
156 /// implicit conversion.
157 static const char* GetImplicitConversionName(ImplicitConversionKind Kind) {
158   static const char* const Name[(int)ICK_Num_Conversion_Kinds] = {
159     "No conversion",
160     "Lvalue-to-rvalue",
161     "Array-to-pointer",
162     "Function-to-pointer",
163     "Function pointer conversion",
164     "Qualification",
165     "Integral promotion",
166     "Floating point promotion",
167     "Complex promotion",
168     "Integral conversion",
169     "Floating conversion",
170     "Complex conversion",
171     "Floating-integral conversion",
172     "Pointer conversion",
173     "Pointer-to-member conversion",
174     "Boolean conversion",
175     "Compatible-types conversion",
176     "Derived-to-base conversion",
177     "Vector conversion",
178     "SVE Vector conversion",
179     "Vector splat",
180     "Complex-real conversion",
181     "Block Pointer conversion",
182     "Transparent Union Conversion",
183     "Writeback conversion",
184     "OpenCL Zero Event Conversion",
185     "C specific type conversion",
186     "Incompatible pointer conversion"
187   };
188   return Name[Kind];
189 }
190 
191 /// StandardConversionSequence - Set the standard conversion
192 /// sequence to the identity conversion.
193 void StandardConversionSequence::setAsIdentityConversion() {
194   First = ICK_Identity;
195   Second = ICK_Identity;
196   Third = ICK_Identity;
197   DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr = false;
198   QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime = false;
199   ReferenceBinding = false;
200   DirectBinding = false;
201   IsLvalueReference = true;
202   BindsToFunctionLvalue = false;
203   BindsToRvalue = false;
204   BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier = false;
205   ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding = false;
206   CopyConstructor = nullptr;
207 }
208 
209 /// getRank - Retrieve the rank of this standard conversion sequence
210 /// (C++ 13.3.3.1.1p3). The rank is the largest rank of each of the
211 /// implicit conversions.
212 ImplicitConversionRank StandardConversionSequence::getRank() const {
213   ImplicitConversionRank Rank = ICR_Exact_Match;
214   if  (GetConversionRank(First) > Rank)
215     Rank = GetConversionRank(First);
216   if  (GetConversionRank(Second) > Rank)
217     Rank = GetConversionRank(Second);
218   if  (GetConversionRank(Third) > Rank)
219     Rank = GetConversionRank(Third);
220   return Rank;
221 }
222 
223 /// isPointerConversionToBool - Determines whether this conversion is
224 /// a conversion of a pointer or pointer-to-member to bool. This is
225 /// used as part of the ranking of standard conversion sequences
226 /// (C++ 13.3.3.2p4).
227 bool StandardConversionSequence::isPointerConversionToBool() const {
228   // Note that FromType has not necessarily been transformed by the
229   // array-to-pointer or function-to-pointer implicit conversions, so
230   // check for their presence as well as checking whether FromType is
231   // a pointer.
232   if (getToType(1)->isBooleanType() &&
233       (getFromType()->isPointerType() ||
234        getFromType()->isMemberPointerType() ||
235        getFromType()->isObjCObjectPointerType() ||
236        getFromType()->isBlockPointerType() ||
237        First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer || First == ICK_Function_To_Pointer))
238     return true;
239 
240   return false;
241 }
242 
243 /// isPointerConversionToVoidPointer - Determines whether this
244 /// conversion is a conversion of a pointer to a void pointer. This is
245 /// used as part of the ranking of standard conversion sequences (C++
246 /// 13.3.3.2p4).
247 bool
248 StandardConversionSequence::
249 isPointerConversionToVoidPointer(ASTContext& Context) const {
250   QualType FromType = getFromType();
251   QualType ToType = getToType(1);
252 
253   // Note that FromType has not necessarily been transformed by the
254   // array-to-pointer implicit conversion, so check for its presence
255   // and redo the conversion to get a pointer.
256   if (First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer)
257     FromType = Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType);
258 
259   if (Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion && FromType->isAnyPointerType())
260     if (const PointerType* ToPtrType = ToType->getAs<PointerType>())
261       return ToPtrType->getPointeeType()->isVoidType();
262 
263   return false;
264 }
265 
266 /// Skip any implicit casts which could be either part of a narrowing conversion
267 /// or after one in an implicit conversion.
268 static const Expr *IgnoreNarrowingConversion(ASTContext &Ctx,
269                                              const Expr *Converted) {
270   // We can have cleanups wrapping the converted expression; these need to be
271   // preserved so that destructors run if necessary.
272   if (auto *EWC = dyn_cast<ExprWithCleanups>(Converted)) {
273     Expr *Inner =
274         const_cast<Expr *>(IgnoreNarrowingConversion(Ctx, EWC->getSubExpr()));
275     return ExprWithCleanups::Create(Ctx, Inner, EWC->cleanupsHaveSideEffects(),
276                                     EWC->getObjects());
277   }
278 
279   while (auto *ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(Converted)) {
280     switch (ICE->getCastKind()) {
281     case CK_NoOp:
282     case CK_IntegralCast:
283     case CK_IntegralToBoolean:
284     case CK_IntegralToFloating:
285     case CK_BooleanToSignedIntegral:
286     case CK_FloatingToIntegral:
287     case CK_FloatingToBoolean:
288     case CK_FloatingCast:
289       Converted = ICE->getSubExpr();
290       continue;
291 
292     default:
293       return Converted;
294     }
295   }
296 
297   return Converted;
298 }
299 
300 /// Check if this standard conversion sequence represents a narrowing
301 /// conversion, according to C++11 [dcl.init.list]p7.
302 ///
303 /// \param Ctx  The AST context.
304 /// \param Converted  The result of applying this standard conversion sequence.
305 /// \param ConstantValue  If this is an NK_Constant_Narrowing conversion, the
306 ///        value of the expression prior to the narrowing conversion.
307 /// \param ConstantType  If this is an NK_Constant_Narrowing conversion, the
308 ///        type of the expression prior to the narrowing conversion.
309 /// \param IgnoreFloatToIntegralConversion If true type-narrowing conversions
310 ///        from floating point types to integral types should be ignored.
311 NarrowingKind StandardConversionSequence::getNarrowingKind(
312     ASTContext &Ctx, const Expr *Converted, APValue &ConstantValue,
313     QualType &ConstantType, bool IgnoreFloatToIntegralConversion) const {
314   assert(Ctx.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && "narrowing check outside C++");
315 
316   // C++11 [dcl.init.list]p7:
317   //   A narrowing conversion is an implicit conversion ...
318   QualType FromType = getToType(0);
319   QualType ToType = getToType(1);
320 
321   // A conversion to an enumeration type is narrowing if the conversion to
322   // the underlying type is narrowing. This only arises for expressions of
323   // the form 'Enum{init}'.
324   if (auto *ET = ToType->getAs<EnumType>())
325     ToType = ET->getDecl()->getIntegerType();
326 
327   switch (Second) {
328   // 'bool' is an integral type; dispatch to the right place to handle it.
329   case ICK_Boolean_Conversion:
330     if (FromType->isRealFloatingType())
331       goto FloatingIntegralConversion;
332     if (FromType->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType())
333       goto IntegralConversion;
334     // -- from a pointer type or pointer-to-member type to bool, or
335     return NK_Type_Narrowing;
336 
337   // -- from a floating-point type to an integer type, or
338   //
339   // -- from an integer type or unscoped enumeration type to a floating-point
340   //    type, except where the source is a constant expression and the actual
341   //    value after conversion will fit into the target type and will produce
342   //    the original value when converted back to the original type, or
343   case ICK_Floating_Integral:
344   FloatingIntegralConversion:
345     if (FromType->isRealFloatingType() && ToType->isIntegralType(Ctx)) {
346       return NK_Type_Narrowing;
347     } else if (FromType->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType() &&
348                ToType->isRealFloatingType()) {
349       if (IgnoreFloatToIntegralConversion)
350         return NK_Not_Narrowing;
351       const Expr *Initializer = IgnoreNarrowingConversion(Ctx, Converted);
352       assert(Initializer && "Unknown conversion expression");
353 
354       // If it's value-dependent, we can't tell whether it's narrowing.
355       if (Initializer->isValueDependent())
356         return NK_Dependent_Narrowing;
357 
358       if (Optional<llvm::APSInt> IntConstantValue =
359               Initializer->getIntegerConstantExpr(Ctx)) {
360         // Convert the integer to the floating type.
361         llvm::APFloat Result(Ctx.getFloatTypeSemantics(ToType));
362         Result.convertFromAPInt(*IntConstantValue, IntConstantValue->isSigned(),
363                                 llvm::APFloat::rmNearestTiesToEven);
364         // And back.
365         llvm::APSInt ConvertedValue = *IntConstantValue;
366         bool ignored;
367         Result.convertToInteger(ConvertedValue,
368                                 llvm::APFloat::rmTowardZero, &ignored);
369         // If the resulting value is different, this was a narrowing conversion.
370         if (*IntConstantValue != ConvertedValue) {
371           ConstantValue = APValue(*IntConstantValue);
372           ConstantType = Initializer->getType();
373           return NK_Constant_Narrowing;
374         }
375       } else {
376         // Variables are always narrowings.
377         return NK_Variable_Narrowing;
378       }
379     }
380     return NK_Not_Narrowing;
381 
382   // -- from long double to double or float, or from double to float, except
383   //    where the source is a constant expression and the actual value after
384   //    conversion is within the range of values that can be represented (even
385   //    if it cannot be represented exactly), or
386   case ICK_Floating_Conversion:
387     if (FromType->isRealFloatingType() && ToType->isRealFloatingType() &&
388         Ctx.getFloatingTypeOrder(FromType, ToType) == 1) {
389       // FromType is larger than ToType.
390       const Expr *Initializer = IgnoreNarrowingConversion(Ctx, Converted);
391 
392       // If it's value-dependent, we can't tell whether it's narrowing.
393       if (Initializer->isValueDependent())
394         return NK_Dependent_Narrowing;
395 
396       if (Initializer->isCXX11ConstantExpr(Ctx, &ConstantValue)) {
397         // Constant!
398         assert(ConstantValue.isFloat());
399         llvm::APFloat FloatVal = ConstantValue.getFloat();
400         // Convert the source value into the target type.
401         bool ignored;
402         llvm::APFloat::opStatus ConvertStatus = FloatVal.convert(
403           Ctx.getFloatTypeSemantics(ToType),
404           llvm::APFloat::rmNearestTiesToEven, &ignored);
405         // If there was no overflow, the source value is within the range of
406         // values that can be represented.
407         if (ConvertStatus & llvm::APFloat::opOverflow) {
408           ConstantType = Initializer->getType();
409           return NK_Constant_Narrowing;
410         }
411       } else {
412         return NK_Variable_Narrowing;
413       }
414     }
415     return NK_Not_Narrowing;
416 
417   // -- from an integer type or unscoped enumeration type to an integer type
418   //    that cannot represent all the values of the original type, except where
419   //    the source is a constant expression and the actual value after
420   //    conversion will fit into the target type and will produce the original
421   //    value when converted back to the original type.
422   case ICK_Integral_Conversion:
423   IntegralConversion: {
424     assert(FromType->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType());
425     assert(ToType->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType());
426     const bool FromSigned = FromType->isSignedIntegerOrEnumerationType();
427     const unsigned FromWidth = Ctx.getIntWidth(FromType);
428     const bool ToSigned = ToType->isSignedIntegerOrEnumerationType();
429     const unsigned ToWidth = Ctx.getIntWidth(ToType);
430 
431     if (FromWidth > ToWidth ||
432         (FromWidth == ToWidth && FromSigned != ToSigned) ||
433         (FromSigned && !ToSigned)) {
434       // Not all values of FromType can be represented in ToType.
435       const Expr *Initializer = IgnoreNarrowingConversion(Ctx, Converted);
436 
437       // If it's value-dependent, we can't tell whether it's narrowing.
438       if (Initializer->isValueDependent())
439         return NK_Dependent_Narrowing;
440 
441       Optional<llvm::APSInt> OptInitializerValue;
442       if (!(OptInitializerValue = Initializer->getIntegerConstantExpr(Ctx))) {
443         // Such conversions on variables are always narrowing.
444         return NK_Variable_Narrowing;
445       }
446       llvm::APSInt &InitializerValue = *OptInitializerValue;
447       bool Narrowing = false;
448       if (FromWidth < ToWidth) {
449         // Negative -> unsigned is narrowing. Otherwise, more bits is never
450         // narrowing.
451         if (InitializerValue.isSigned() && InitializerValue.isNegative())
452           Narrowing = true;
453       } else {
454         // Add a bit to the InitializerValue so we don't have to worry about
455         // signed vs. unsigned comparisons.
456         InitializerValue = InitializerValue.extend(
457           InitializerValue.getBitWidth() + 1);
458         // Convert the initializer to and from the target width and signed-ness.
459         llvm::APSInt ConvertedValue = InitializerValue;
460         ConvertedValue = ConvertedValue.trunc(ToWidth);
461         ConvertedValue.setIsSigned(ToSigned);
462         ConvertedValue = ConvertedValue.extend(InitializerValue.getBitWidth());
463         ConvertedValue.setIsSigned(InitializerValue.isSigned());
464         // If the result is different, this was a narrowing conversion.
465         if (ConvertedValue != InitializerValue)
466           Narrowing = true;
467       }
468       if (Narrowing) {
469         ConstantType = Initializer->getType();
470         ConstantValue = APValue(InitializerValue);
471         return NK_Constant_Narrowing;
472       }
473     }
474     return NK_Not_Narrowing;
475   }
476 
477   default:
478     // Other kinds of conversions are not narrowings.
479     return NK_Not_Narrowing;
480   }
481 }
482 
483 /// dump - Print this standard conversion sequence to standard
484 /// error. Useful for debugging overloading issues.
485 LLVM_DUMP_METHOD void StandardConversionSequence::dump() const {
486   raw_ostream &OS = llvm::errs();
487   bool PrintedSomething = false;
488   if (First != ICK_Identity) {
489     OS << GetImplicitConversionName(First);
490     PrintedSomething = true;
491   }
492 
493   if (Second != ICK_Identity) {
494     if (PrintedSomething) {
495       OS << " -> ";
496     }
497     OS << GetImplicitConversionName(Second);
498 
499     if (CopyConstructor) {
500       OS << " (by copy constructor)";
501     } else if (DirectBinding) {
502       OS << " (direct reference binding)";
503     } else if (ReferenceBinding) {
504       OS << " (reference binding)";
505     }
506     PrintedSomething = true;
507   }
508 
509   if (Third != ICK_Identity) {
510     if (PrintedSomething) {
511       OS << " -> ";
512     }
513     OS << GetImplicitConversionName(Third);
514     PrintedSomething = true;
515   }
516 
517   if (!PrintedSomething) {
518     OS << "No conversions required";
519   }
520 }
521 
522 /// dump - Print this user-defined conversion sequence to standard
523 /// error. Useful for debugging overloading issues.
524 void UserDefinedConversionSequence::dump() const {
525   raw_ostream &OS = llvm::errs();
526   if (Before.First || Before.Second || Before.Third) {
527     Before.dump();
528     OS << " -> ";
529   }
530   if (ConversionFunction)
531     OS << '\'' << *ConversionFunction << '\'';
532   else
533     OS << "aggregate initialization";
534   if (After.First || After.Second || After.Third) {
535     OS << " -> ";
536     After.dump();
537   }
538 }
539 
540 /// dump - Print this implicit conversion sequence to standard
541 /// error. Useful for debugging overloading issues.
542 void ImplicitConversionSequence::dump() const {
543   raw_ostream &OS = llvm::errs();
544   if (isStdInitializerListElement())
545     OS << "Worst std::initializer_list element conversion: ";
546   switch (ConversionKind) {
547   case StandardConversion:
548     OS << "Standard conversion: ";
549     Standard.dump();
550     break;
551   case UserDefinedConversion:
552     OS << "User-defined conversion: ";
553     UserDefined.dump();
554     break;
555   case EllipsisConversion:
556     OS << "Ellipsis conversion";
557     break;
558   case AmbiguousConversion:
559     OS << "Ambiguous conversion";
560     break;
561   case BadConversion:
562     OS << "Bad conversion";
563     break;
564   }
565 
566   OS << "\n";
567 }
568 
569 void AmbiguousConversionSequence::construct() {
570   new (&conversions()) ConversionSet();
571 }
572 
573 void AmbiguousConversionSequence::destruct() {
574   conversions().~ConversionSet();
575 }
576 
577 void
578 AmbiguousConversionSequence::copyFrom(const AmbiguousConversionSequence &O) {
579   FromTypePtr = O.FromTypePtr;
580   ToTypePtr = O.ToTypePtr;
581   new (&conversions()) ConversionSet(O.conversions());
582 }
583 
584 namespace {
585   // Structure used by DeductionFailureInfo to store
586   // template argument information.
587   struct DFIArguments {
588     TemplateArgument FirstArg;
589     TemplateArgument SecondArg;
590   };
591   // Structure used by DeductionFailureInfo to store
592   // template parameter and template argument information.
593   struct DFIParamWithArguments : DFIArguments {
594     TemplateParameter Param;
595   };
596   // Structure used by DeductionFailureInfo to store template argument
597   // information and the index of the problematic call argument.
598   struct DFIDeducedMismatchArgs : DFIArguments {
599     TemplateArgumentList *TemplateArgs;
600     unsigned CallArgIndex;
601   };
602   // Structure used by DeductionFailureInfo to store information about
603   // unsatisfied constraints.
604   struct CNSInfo {
605     TemplateArgumentList *TemplateArgs;
606     ConstraintSatisfaction Satisfaction;
607   };
608 }
609 
610 /// Convert from Sema's representation of template deduction information
611 /// to the form used in overload-candidate information.
612 DeductionFailureInfo
613 clang::MakeDeductionFailureInfo(ASTContext &Context,
614                                 Sema::TemplateDeductionResult TDK,
615                                 TemplateDeductionInfo &Info) {
616   DeductionFailureInfo Result;
617   Result.Result = static_cast<unsigned>(TDK);
618   Result.HasDiagnostic = false;
619   switch (TDK) {
620   case Sema::TDK_Invalid:
621   case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
622   case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
623   case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
624   case Sema::TDK_MiscellaneousDeductionFailure:
625   case Sema::TDK_CUDATargetMismatch:
626     Result.Data = nullptr;
627     break;
628 
629   case Sema::TDK_Incomplete:
630   case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
631     Result.Data = Info.Param.getOpaqueValue();
632     break;
633 
634   case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatch:
635   case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatchNested: {
636     // FIXME: Should allocate from normal heap so that we can free this later.
637     auto *Saved = new (Context) DFIDeducedMismatchArgs;
638     Saved->FirstArg = Info.FirstArg;
639     Saved->SecondArg = Info.SecondArg;
640     Saved->TemplateArgs = Info.take();
641     Saved->CallArgIndex = Info.CallArgIndex;
642     Result.Data = Saved;
643     break;
644   }
645 
646   case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch: {
647     // FIXME: Should allocate from normal heap so that we can free this later.
648     DFIArguments *Saved = new (Context) DFIArguments;
649     Saved->FirstArg = Info.FirstArg;
650     Saved->SecondArg = Info.SecondArg;
651     Result.Data = Saved;
652     break;
653   }
654 
655   case Sema::TDK_IncompletePack:
656     // FIXME: It's slightly wasteful to allocate two TemplateArguments for this.
657   case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent:
658   case Sema::TDK_Underqualified: {
659     // FIXME: Should allocate from normal heap so that we can free this later.
660     DFIParamWithArguments *Saved = new (Context) DFIParamWithArguments;
661     Saved->Param = Info.Param;
662     Saved->FirstArg = Info.FirstArg;
663     Saved->SecondArg = Info.SecondArg;
664     Result.Data = Saved;
665     break;
666   }
667 
668   case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure:
669     Result.Data = Info.take();
670     if (Info.hasSFINAEDiagnostic()) {
671       PartialDiagnosticAt *Diag = new (Result.Diagnostic) PartialDiagnosticAt(
672           SourceLocation(), PartialDiagnostic::NullDiagnostic());
673       Info.takeSFINAEDiagnostic(*Diag);
674       Result.HasDiagnostic = true;
675     }
676     break;
677 
678   case Sema::TDK_ConstraintsNotSatisfied: {
679     CNSInfo *Saved = new (Context) CNSInfo;
680     Saved->TemplateArgs = Info.take();
681     Saved->Satisfaction = Info.AssociatedConstraintsSatisfaction;
682     Result.Data = Saved;
683     break;
684   }
685 
686   case Sema::TDK_Success:
687   case Sema::TDK_NonDependentConversionFailure:
688     llvm_unreachable("not a deduction failure");
689   }
690 
691   return Result;
692 }
693 
694 void DeductionFailureInfo::Destroy() {
695   switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) {
696   case Sema::TDK_Success:
697   case Sema::TDK_Invalid:
698   case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
699   case Sema::TDK_Incomplete:
700   case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
701   case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
702   case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
703   case Sema::TDK_CUDATargetMismatch:
704   case Sema::TDK_NonDependentConversionFailure:
705     break;
706 
707   case Sema::TDK_IncompletePack:
708   case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent:
709   case Sema::TDK_Underqualified:
710   case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatch:
711   case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatchNested:
712   case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch:
713     // FIXME: Destroy the data?
714     Data = nullptr;
715     break;
716 
717   case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure:
718     // FIXME: Destroy the template argument list?
719     Data = nullptr;
720     if (PartialDiagnosticAt *Diag = getSFINAEDiagnostic()) {
721       Diag->~PartialDiagnosticAt();
722       HasDiagnostic = false;
723     }
724     break;
725 
726   case Sema::TDK_ConstraintsNotSatisfied:
727     // FIXME: Destroy the template argument list?
728     Data = nullptr;
729     if (PartialDiagnosticAt *Diag = getSFINAEDiagnostic()) {
730       Diag->~PartialDiagnosticAt();
731       HasDiagnostic = false;
732     }
733     break;
734 
735   // Unhandled
736   case Sema::TDK_MiscellaneousDeductionFailure:
737     break;
738   }
739 }
740 
741 PartialDiagnosticAt *DeductionFailureInfo::getSFINAEDiagnostic() {
742   if (HasDiagnostic)
743     return static_cast<PartialDiagnosticAt*>(static_cast<void*>(Diagnostic));
744   return nullptr;
745 }
746 
747 TemplateParameter DeductionFailureInfo::getTemplateParameter() {
748   switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) {
749   case Sema::TDK_Success:
750   case Sema::TDK_Invalid:
751   case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
752   case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
753   case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
754   case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure:
755   case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatch:
756   case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatchNested:
757   case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch:
758   case Sema::TDK_CUDATargetMismatch:
759   case Sema::TDK_NonDependentConversionFailure:
760   case Sema::TDK_ConstraintsNotSatisfied:
761     return TemplateParameter();
762 
763   case Sema::TDK_Incomplete:
764   case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
765     return TemplateParameter::getFromOpaqueValue(Data);
766 
767   case Sema::TDK_IncompletePack:
768   case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent:
769   case Sema::TDK_Underqualified:
770     return static_cast<DFIParamWithArguments*>(Data)->Param;
771 
772   // Unhandled
773   case Sema::TDK_MiscellaneousDeductionFailure:
774     break;
775   }
776 
777   return TemplateParameter();
778 }
779 
780 TemplateArgumentList *DeductionFailureInfo::getTemplateArgumentList() {
781   switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) {
782   case Sema::TDK_Success:
783   case Sema::TDK_Invalid:
784   case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
785   case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
786   case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
787   case Sema::TDK_Incomplete:
788   case Sema::TDK_IncompletePack:
789   case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
790   case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent:
791   case Sema::TDK_Underqualified:
792   case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch:
793   case Sema::TDK_CUDATargetMismatch:
794   case Sema::TDK_NonDependentConversionFailure:
795     return nullptr;
796 
797   case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatch:
798   case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatchNested:
799     return static_cast<DFIDeducedMismatchArgs*>(Data)->TemplateArgs;
800 
801   case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure:
802     return static_cast<TemplateArgumentList*>(Data);
803 
804   case Sema::TDK_ConstraintsNotSatisfied:
805     return static_cast<CNSInfo*>(Data)->TemplateArgs;
806 
807   // Unhandled
808   case Sema::TDK_MiscellaneousDeductionFailure:
809     break;
810   }
811 
812   return nullptr;
813 }
814 
815 const TemplateArgument *DeductionFailureInfo::getFirstArg() {
816   switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) {
817   case Sema::TDK_Success:
818   case Sema::TDK_Invalid:
819   case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
820   case Sema::TDK_Incomplete:
821   case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
822   case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
823   case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
824   case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure:
825   case Sema::TDK_CUDATargetMismatch:
826   case Sema::TDK_NonDependentConversionFailure:
827   case Sema::TDK_ConstraintsNotSatisfied:
828     return nullptr;
829 
830   case Sema::TDK_IncompletePack:
831   case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent:
832   case Sema::TDK_Underqualified:
833   case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatch:
834   case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatchNested:
835   case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch:
836     return &static_cast<DFIArguments*>(Data)->FirstArg;
837 
838   // Unhandled
839   case Sema::TDK_MiscellaneousDeductionFailure:
840     break;
841   }
842 
843   return nullptr;
844 }
845 
846 const TemplateArgument *DeductionFailureInfo::getSecondArg() {
847   switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) {
848   case Sema::TDK_Success:
849   case Sema::TDK_Invalid:
850   case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
851   case Sema::TDK_Incomplete:
852   case Sema::TDK_IncompletePack:
853   case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
854   case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
855   case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
856   case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure:
857   case Sema::TDK_CUDATargetMismatch:
858   case Sema::TDK_NonDependentConversionFailure:
859   case Sema::TDK_ConstraintsNotSatisfied:
860     return nullptr;
861 
862   case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent:
863   case Sema::TDK_Underqualified:
864   case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatch:
865   case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatchNested:
866   case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch:
867     return &static_cast<DFIArguments*>(Data)->SecondArg;
868 
869   // Unhandled
870   case Sema::TDK_MiscellaneousDeductionFailure:
871     break;
872   }
873 
874   return nullptr;
875 }
876 
877 llvm::Optional<unsigned> DeductionFailureInfo::getCallArgIndex() {
878   switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) {
879   case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatch:
880   case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatchNested:
881     return static_cast<DFIDeducedMismatchArgs*>(Data)->CallArgIndex;
882 
883   default:
884     return llvm::None;
885   }
886 }
887 
888 bool OverloadCandidateSet::OperatorRewriteInfo::shouldAddReversed(
889     OverloadedOperatorKind Op) {
890   if (!AllowRewrittenCandidates)
891     return false;
892   return Op == OO_EqualEqual || Op == OO_Spaceship;
893 }
894 
895 bool OverloadCandidateSet::OperatorRewriteInfo::shouldAddReversed(
896     ASTContext &Ctx, const FunctionDecl *FD) {
897   if (!shouldAddReversed(FD->getDeclName().getCXXOverloadedOperator()))
898     return false;
899   // Don't bother adding a reversed candidate that can never be a better
900   // match than the non-reversed version.
901   return FD->getNumParams() != 2 ||
902          !Ctx.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FD->getParamDecl(0)->getType(),
903                                      FD->getParamDecl(1)->getType()) ||
904          FD->hasAttr<EnableIfAttr>();
905 }
906 
907 void OverloadCandidateSet::destroyCandidates() {
908   for (iterator i = begin(), e = end(); i != e; ++i) {
909     for (auto &C : i->Conversions)
910       C.~ImplicitConversionSequence();
911     if (!i->Viable && i->FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_deduction)
912       i->DeductionFailure.Destroy();
913   }
914 }
915 
916 void OverloadCandidateSet::clear(CandidateSetKind CSK) {
917   destroyCandidates();
918   SlabAllocator.Reset();
919   NumInlineBytesUsed = 0;
920   Candidates.clear();
921   Functions.clear();
922   Kind = CSK;
923 }
924 
925 namespace {
926   class UnbridgedCastsSet {
927     struct Entry {
928       Expr **Addr;
929       Expr *Saved;
930     };
931     SmallVector<Entry, 2> Entries;
932 
933   public:
934     void save(Sema &S, Expr *&E) {
935       assert(E->hasPlaceholderType(BuiltinType::ARCUnbridgedCast));
936       Entry entry = { &E, E };
937       Entries.push_back(entry);
938       E = S.stripARCUnbridgedCast(E);
939     }
940 
941     void restore() {
942       for (SmallVectorImpl<Entry>::iterator
943              i = Entries.begin(), e = Entries.end(); i != e; ++i)
944         *i->Addr = i->Saved;
945     }
946   };
947 }
948 
949 /// checkPlaceholderForOverload - Do any interesting placeholder-like
950 /// preprocessing on the given expression.
951 ///
952 /// \param unbridgedCasts a collection to which to add unbridged casts;
953 ///   without this, they will be immediately diagnosed as errors
954 ///
955 /// Return true on unrecoverable error.
956 static bool
957 checkPlaceholderForOverload(Sema &S, Expr *&E,
958                             UnbridgedCastsSet *unbridgedCasts = nullptr) {
959   if (const BuiltinType *placeholder =  E->getType()->getAsPlaceholderType()) {
960     // We can't handle overloaded expressions here because overload
961     // resolution might reasonably tweak them.
962     if (placeholder->getKind() == BuiltinType::Overload) return false;
963 
964     // If the context potentially accepts unbridged ARC casts, strip
965     // the unbridged cast and add it to the collection for later restoration.
966     if (placeholder->getKind() == BuiltinType::ARCUnbridgedCast &&
967         unbridgedCasts) {
968       unbridgedCasts->save(S, E);
969       return false;
970     }
971 
972     // Go ahead and check everything else.
973     ExprResult result = S.CheckPlaceholderExpr(E);
974     if (result.isInvalid())
975       return true;
976 
977     E = result.get();
978     return false;
979   }
980 
981   // Nothing to do.
982   return false;
983 }
984 
985 /// checkArgPlaceholdersForOverload - Check a set of call operands for
986 /// placeholders.
987 static bool checkArgPlaceholdersForOverload(Sema &S,
988                                             MultiExprArg Args,
989                                             UnbridgedCastsSet &unbridged) {
990   for (unsigned i = 0, e = Args.size(); i != e; ++i)
991     if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(S, Args[i], &unbridged))
992       return true;
993 
994   return false;
995 }
996 
997 /// Determine whether the given New declaration is an overload of the
998 /// declarations in Old. This routine returns Ovl_Match or Ovl_NonFunction if
999 /// New and Old cannot be overloaded, e.g., if New has the same signature as
1000 /// some function in Old (C++ 1.3.10) or if the Old declarations aren't
1001 /// functions (or function templates) at all. When it does return Ovl_Match or
1002 /// Ovl_NonFunction, MatchedDecl will point to the decl that New cannot be
1003 /// overloaded with. This decl may be a UsingShadowDecl on top of the underlying
1004 /// declaration.
1005 ///
1006 /// Example: Given the following input:
1007 ///
1008 ///   void f(int, float); // #1
1009 ///   void f(int, int); // #2
1010 ///   int f(int, int); // #3
1011 ///
1012 /// When we process #1, there is no previous declaration of "f", so IsOverload
1013 /// will not be used.
1014 ///
1015 /// When we process #2, Old contains only the FunctionDecl for #1. By comparing
1016 /// the parameter types, we see that #1 and #2 are overloaded (since they have
1017 /// different signatures), so this routine returns Ovl_Overload; MatchedDecl is
1018 /// unchanged.
1019 ///
1020 /// When we process #3, Old is an overload set containing #1 and #2. We compare
1021 /// the signatures of #3 to #1 (they're overloaded, so we do nothing) and then
1022 /// #3 to #2. Since the signatures of #3 and #2 are identical (return types of
1023 /// functions are not part of the signature), IsOverload returns Ovl_Match and
1024 /// MatchedDecl will be set to point to the FunctionDecl for #2.
1025 ///
1026 /// 'NewIsUsingShadowDecl' indicates that 'New' is being introduced into a class
1027 /// by a using declaration. The rules for whether to hide shadow declarations
1028 /// ignore some properties which otherwise figure into a function template's
1029 /// signature.
1030 Sema::OverloadKind
1031 Sema::CheckOverload(Scope *S, FunctionDecl *New, const LookupResult &Old,
1032                     NamedDecl *&Match, bool NewIsUsingDecl) {
1033   for (LookupResult::iterator I = Old.begin(), E = Old.end();
1034          I != E; ++I) {
1035     NamedDecl *OldD = *I;
1036 
1037     bool OldIsUsingDecl = false;
1038     if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(OldD)) {
1039       OldIsUsingDecl = true;
1040 
1041       // We can always introduce two using declarations into the same
1042       // context, even if they have identical signatures.
1043       if (NewIsUsingDecl) continue;
1044 
1045       OldD = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(OldD)->getTargetDecl();
1046     }
1047 
1048     // A using-declaration does not conflict with another declaration
1049     // if one of them is hidden.
1050     if ((OldIsUsingDecl || NewIsUsingDecl) && !isVisible(*I))
1051       continue;
1052 
1053     // If either declaration was introduced by a using declaration,
1054     // we'll need to use slightly different rules for matching.
1055     // Essentially, these rules are the normal rules, except that
1056     // function templates hide function templates with different
1057     // return types or template parameter lists.
1058     bool UseMemberUsingDeclRules =
1059       (OldIsUsingDecl || NewIsUsingDecl) && CurContext->isRecord() &&
1060       !New->getFriendObjectKind();
1061 
1062     if (FunctionDecl *OldF = OldD->getAsFunction()) {
1063       if (!IsOverload(New, OldF, UseMemberUsingDeclRules)) {
1064         if (UseMemberUsingDeclRules && OldIsUsingDecl) {
1065           HideUsingShadowDecl(S, cast<UsingShadowDecl>(*I));
1066           continue;
1067         }
1068 
1069         if (!isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(OldD) &&
1070             !shouldLinkPossiblyHiddenDecl(*I, New))
1071           continue;
1072 
1073         Match = *I;
1074         return Ovl_Match;
1075       }
1076 
1077       // Builtins that have custom typechecking or have a reference should
1078       // not be overloadable or redeclarable.
1079       if (!getASTContext().canBuiltinBeRedeclared(OldF)) {
1080         Match = *I;
1081         return Ovl_NonFunction;
1082       }
1083     } else if (isa<UsingDecl>(OldD) || isa<UsingPackDecl>(OldD)) {
1084       // We can overload with these, which can show up when doing
1085       // redeclaration checks for UsingDecls.
1086       assert(Old.getLookupKind() == LookupUsingDeclName);
1087     } else if (isa<TagDecl>(OldD)) {
1088       // We can always overload with tags by hiding them.
1089     } else if (auto *UUD = dyn_cast<UnresolvedUsingValueDecl>(OldD)) {
1090       // Optimistically assume that an unresolved using decl will
1091       // overload; if it doesn't, we'll have to diagnose during
1092       // template instantiation.
1093       //
1094       // Exception: if the scope is dependent and this is not a class
1095       // member, the using declaration can only introduce an enumerator.
1096       if (UUD->getQualifier()->isDependent() && !UUD->isCXXClassMember()) {
1097         Match = *I;
1098         return Ovl_NonFunction;
1099       }
1100     } else {
1101       // (C++ 13p1):
1102       //   Only function declarations can be overloaded; object and type
1103       //   declarations cannot be overloaded.
1104       Match = *I;
1105       return Ovl_NonFunction;
1106     }
1107   }
1108 
1109   // C++ [temp.friend]p1:
1110   //   For a friend function declaration that is not a template declaration:
1111   //    -- if the name of the friend is a qualified or unqualified template-id,
1112   //       [...], otherwise
1113   //    -- if the name of the friend is a qualified-id and a matching
1114   //       non-template function is found in the specified class or namespace,
1115   //       the friend declaration refers to that function, otherwise,
1116   //    -- if the name of the friend is a qualified-id and a matching function
1117   //       template is found in the specified class or namespace, the friend
1118   //       declaration refers to the deduced specialization of that function
1119   //       template, otherwise
1120   //    -- the name shall be an unqualified-id [...]
1121   // If we get here for a qualified friend declaration, we've just reached the
1122   // third bullet. If the type of the friend is dependent, skip this lookup
1123   // until instantiation.
1124   if (New->getFriendObjectKind() && New->getQualifier() &&
1125       !New->getDescribedFunctionTemplate() &&
1126       !New->getDependentSpecializationInfo() &&
1127       !New->getType()->isDependentType()) {
1128     LookupResult TemplateSpecResult(LookupResult::Temporary, Old);
1129     TemplateSpecResult.addAllDecls(Old);
1130     if (CheckFunctionTemplateSpecialization(New, nullptr, TemplateSpecResult,
1131                                             /*QualifiedFriend*/true)) {
1132       New->setInvalidDecl();
1133       return Ovl_Overload;
1134     }
1135 
1136     Match = TemplateSpecResult.getAsSingle<FunctionDecl>();
1137     return Ovl_Match;
1138   }
1139 
1140   return Ovl_Overload;
1141 }
1142 
1143 bool Sema::IsOverload(FunctionDecl *New, FunctionDecl *Old,
1144                       bool UseMemberUsingDeclRules, bool ConsiderCudaAttrs,
1145                       bool ConsiderRequiresClauses) {
1146   // C++ [basic.start.main]p2: This function shall not be overloaded.
1147   if (New->isMain())
1148     return false;
1149 
1150   // MSVCRT user defined entry points cannot be overloaded.
1151   if (New->isMSVCRTEntryPoint())
1152     return false;
1153 
1154   FunctionTemplateDecl *OldTemplate = Old->getDescribedFunctionTemplate();
1155   FunctionTemplateDecl *NewTemplate = New->getDescribedFunctionTemplate();
1156 
1157   // C++ [temp.fct]p2:
1158   //   A function template can be overloaded with other function templates
1159   //   and with normal (non-template) functions.
1160   if ((OldTemplate == nullptr) != (NewTemplate == nullptr))
1161     return true;
1162 
1163   // Is the function New an overload of the function Old?
1164   QualType OldQType = Context.getCanonicalType(Old->getType());
1165   QualType NewQType = Context.getCanonicalType(New->getType());
1166 
1167   // Compare the signatures (C++ 1.3.10) of the two functions to
1168   // determine whether they are overloads. If we find any mismatch
1169   // in the signature, they are overloads.
1170 
1171   // If either of these functions is a K&R-style function (no
1172   // prototype), then we consider them to have matching signatures.
1173   if (isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(OldQType.getTypePtr()) ||
1174       isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(NewQType.getTypePtr()))
1175     return false;
1176 
1177   const FunctionProtoType *OldType = cast<FunctionProtoType>(OldQType);
1178   const FunctionProtoType *NewType = cast<FunctionProtoType>(NewQType);
1179 
1180   // The signature of a function includes the types of its
1181   // parameters (C++ 1.3.10), which includes the presence or absence
1182   // of the ellipsis; see C++ DR 357).
1183   if (OldQType != NewQType &&
1184       (OldType->getNumParams() != NewType->getNumParams() ||
1185        OldType->isVariadic() != NewType->isVariadic() ||
1186        !FunctionParamTypesAreEqual(OldType, NewType)))
1187     return true;
1188 
1189   // C++ [temp.over.link]p4:
1190   //   The signature of a function template consists of its function
1191   //   signature, its return type and its template parameter list. The names
1192   //   of the template parameters are significant only for establishing the
1193   //   relationship between the template parameters and the rest of the
1194   //   signature.
1195   //
1196   // We check the return type and template parameter lists for function
1197   // templates first; the remaining checks follow.
1198   //
1199   // However, we don't consider either of these when deciding whether
1200   // a member introduced by a shadow declaration is hidden.
1201   if (!UseMemberUsingDeclRules && NewTemplate &&
1202       (!TemplateParameterListsAreEqual(NewTemplate->getTemplateParameters(),
1203                                        OldTemplate->getTemplateParameters(),
1204                                        false, TPL_TemplateMatch) ||
1205        !Context.hasSameType(Old->getDeclaredReturnType(),
1206                             New->getDeclaredReturnType())))
1207     return true;
1208 
1209   // If the function is a class member, its signature includes the
1210   // cv-qualifiers (if any) and ref-qualifier (if any) on the function itself.
1211   //
1212   // As part of this, also check whether one of the member functions
1213   // is static, in which case they are not overloads (C++
1214   // 13.1p2). While not part of the definition of the signature,
1215   // this check is important to determine whether these functions
1216   // can be overloaded.
1217   CXXMethodDecl *OldMethod = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Old);
1218   CXXMethodDecl *NewMethod = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(New);
1219   if (OldMethod && NewMethod &&
1220       !OldMethod->isStatic() && !NewMethod->isStatic()) {
1221     if (OldMethod->getRefQualifier() != NewMethod->getRefQualifier()) {
1222       if (!UseMemberUsingDeclRules &&
1223           (OldMethod->getRefQualifier() == RQ_None ||
1224            NewMethod->getRefQualifier() == RQ_None)) {
1225         // C++0x [over.load]p2:
1226         //   - Member function declarations with the same name and the same
1227         //     parameter-type-list as well as member function template
1228         //     declarations with the same name, the same parameter-type-list, and
1229         //     the same template parameter lists cannot be overloaded if any of
1230         //     them, but not all, have a ref-qualifier (8.3.5).
1231         Diag(NewMethod->getLocation(), diag::err_ref_qualifier_overload)
1232           << NewMethod->getRefQualifier() << OldMethod->getRefQualifier();
1233         Diag(OldMethod->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration);
1234       }
1235       return true;
1236     }
1237 
1238     // We may not have applied the implicit const for a constexpr member
1239     // function yet (because we haven't yet resolved whether this is a static
1240     // or non-static member function). Add it now, on the assumption that this
1241     // is a redeclaration of OldMethod.
1242     auto OldQuals = OldMethod->getMethodQualifiers();
1243     auto NewQuals = NewMethod->getMethodQualifiers();
1244     if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus14 && NewMethod->isConstexpr() &&
1245         !isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(NewMethod))
1246       NewQuals.addConst();
1247     // We do not allow overloading based off of '__restrict'.
1248     OldQuals.removeRestrict();
1249     NewQuals.removeRestrict();
1250     if (OldQuals != NewQuals)
1251       return true;
1252   }
1253 
1254   // Though pass_object_size is placed on parameters and takes an argument, we
1255   // consider it to be a function-level modifier for the sake of function
1256   // identity. Either the function has one or more parameters with
1257   // pass_object_size or it doesn't.
1258   if (functionHasPassObjectSizeParams(New) !=
1259       functionHasPassObjectSizeParams(Old))
1260     return true;
1261 
1262   // enable_if attributes are an order-sensitive part of the signature.
1263   for (specific_attr_iterator<EnableIfAttr>
1264          NewI = New->specific_attr_begin<EnableIfAttr>(),
1265          NewE = New->specific_attr_end<EnableIfAttr>(),
1266          OldI = Old->specific_attr_begin<EnableIfAttr>(),
1267          OldE = Old->specific_attr_end<EnableIfAttr>();
1268        NewI != NewE || OldI != OldE; ++NewI, ++OldI) {
1269     if (NewI == NewE || OldI == OldE)
1270       return true;
1271     llvm::FoldingSetNodeID NewID, OldID;
1272     NewI->getCond()->Profile(NewID, Context, true);
1273     OldI->getCond()->Profile(OldID, Context, true);
1274     if (NewID != OldID)
1275       return true;
1276   }
1277 
1278   if (getLangOpts().CUDA && ConsiderCudaAttrs) {
1279     // Don't allow overloading of destructors.  (In theory we could, but it
1280     // would be a giant change to clang.)
1281     if (!isa<CXXDestructorDecl>(New)) {
1282       CUDAFunctionTarget NewTarget = IdentifyCUDATarget(New),
1283                          OldTarget = IdentifyCUDATarget(Old);
1284       if (NewTarget != CFT_InvalidTarget) {
1285         assert((OldTarget != CFT_InvalidTarget) &&
1286                "Unexpected invalid target.");
1287 
1288         // Allow overloading of functions with same signature and different CUDA
1289         // target attributes.
1290         if (NewTarget != OldTarget)
1291           return true;
1292       }
1293     }
1294   }
1295 
1296   if (ConsiderRequiresClauses) {
1297     Expr *NewRC = New->getTrailingRequiresClause(),
1298          *OldRC = Old->getTrailingRequiresClause();
1299     if ((NewRC != nullptr) != (OldRC != nullptr))
1300       // RC are most certainly different - these are overloads.
1301       return true;
1302 
1303     if (NewRC) {
1304       llvm::FoldingSetNodeID NewID, OldID;
1305       NewRC->Profile(NewID, Context, /*Canonical=*/true);
1306       OldRC->Profile(OldID, Context, /*Canonical=*/true);
1307       if (NewID != OldID)
1308         // RCs are not equivalent - these are overloads.
1309         return true;
1310     }
1311   }
1312 
1313   // The signatures match; this is not an overload.
1314   return false;
1315 }
1316 
1317 /// Tries a user-defined conversion from From to ToType.
1318 ///
1319 /// Produces an implicit conversion sequence for when a standard conversion
1320 /// is not an option. See TryImplicitConversion for more information.
1321 static ImplicitConversionSequence
1322 TryUserDefinedConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
1323                          bool SuppressUserConversions,
1324                          AllowedExplicit AllowExplicit,
1325                          bool InOverloadResolution,
1326                          bool CStyle,
1327                          bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion,
1328                          bool AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit) {
1329   ImplicitConversionSequence ICS;
1330 
1331   if (SuppressUserConversions) {
1332     // We're not in the case above, so there is no conversion that
1333     // we can perform.
1334     ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, From, ToType);
1335     return ICS;
1336   }
1337 
1338   // Attempt user-defined conversion.
1339   OverloadCandidateSet Conversions(From->getExprLoc(),
1340                                    OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Normal);
1341   switch (IsUserDefinedConversion(S, From, ToType, ICS.UserDefined,
1342                                   Conversions, AllowExplicit,
1343                                   AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit)) {
1344   case OR_Success:
1345   case OR_Deleted:
1346     ICS.setUserDefined();
1347     // C++ [over.ics.user]p4:
1348     //   A conversion of an expression of class type to the same class
1349     //   type is given Exact Match rank, and a conversion of an
1350     //   expression of class type to a base class of that type is
1351     //   given Conversion rank, in spite of the fact that a copy
1352     //   constructor (i.e., a user-defined conversion function) is
1353     //   called for those cases.
1354     if (CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor
1355           = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(ICS.UserDefined.ConversionFunction)) {
1356       QualType FromCanon
1357         = S.Context.getCanonicalType(From->getType().getUnqualifiedType());
1358       QualType ToCanon
1359         = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToType).getUnqualifiedType();
1360       if (Constructor->isCopyConstructor() &&
1361           (FromCanon == ToCanon ||
1362            S.IsDerivedFrom(From->getBeginLoc(), FromCanon, ToCanon))) {
1363         // Turn this into a "standard" conversion sequence, so that it
1364         // gets ranked with standard conversion sequences.
1365         DeclAccessPair Found = ICS.UserDefined.FoundConversionFunction;
1366         ICS.setStandard();
1367         ICS.Standard.setAsIdentityConversion();
1368         ICS.Standard.setFromType(From->getType());
1369         ICS.Standard.setAllToTypes(ToType);
1370         ICS.Standard.CopyConstructor = Constructor;
1371         ICS.Standard.FoundCopyConstructor = Found;
1372         if (ToCanon != FromCanon)
1373           ICS.Standard.Second = ICK_Derived_To_Base;
1374       }
1375     }
1376     break;
1377 
1378   case OR_Ambiguous:
1379     ICS.setAmbiguous();
1380     ICS.Ambiguous.setFromType(From->getType());
1381     ICS.Ambiguous.setToType(ToType);
1382     for (OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Cand = Conversions.begin();
1383          Cand != Conversions.end(); ++Cand)
1384       if (Cand->Best)
1385         ICS.Ambiguous.addConversion(Cand->FoundDecl, Cand->Function);
1386     break;
1387 
1388     // Fall through.
1389   case OR_No_Viable_Function:
1390     ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, From, ToType);
1391     break;
1392   }
1393 
1394   return ICS;
1395 }
1396 
1397 /// TryImplicitConversion - Attempt to perform an implicit conversion
1398 /// from the given expression (Expr) to the given type (ToType). This
1399 /// function returns an implicit conversion sequence that can be used
1400 /// to perform the initialization. Given
1401 ///
1402 ///   void f(float f);
1403 ///   void g(int i) { f(i); }
1404 ///
1405 /// this routine would produce an implicit conversion sequence to
1406 /// describe the initialization of f from i, which will be a standard
1407 /// conversion sequence containing an lvalue-to-rvalue conversion (C++
1408 /// 4.1) followed by a floating-integral conversion (C++ 4.9).
1409 //
1410 /// Note that this routine only determines how the conversion can be
1411 /// performed; it does not actually perform the conversion. As such,
1412 /// it will not produce any diagnostics if no conversion is available,
1413 /// but will instead return an implicit conversion sequence of kind
1414 /// "BadConversion".
1415 ///
1416 /// If @p SuppressUserConversions, then user-defined conversions are
1417 /// not permitted.
1418 /// If @p AllowExplicit, then explicit user-defined conversions are
1419 /// permitted.
1420 ///
1421 /// \param AllowObjCWritebackConversion Whether we allow the Objective-C
1422 /// writeback conversion, which allows __autoreleasing id* parameters to
1423 /// be initialized with __strong id* or __weak id* arguments.
1424 static ImplicitConversionSequence
1425 TryImplicitConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
1426                       bool SuppressUserConversions,
1427                       AllowedExplicit AllowExplicit,
1428                       bool InOverloadResolution,
1429                       bool CStyle,
1430                       bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion,
1431                       bool AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit) {
1432   ImplicitConversionSequence ICS;
1433   if (IsStandardConversion(S, From, ToType, InOverloadResolution,
1434                            ICS.Standard, CStyle, AllowObjCWritebackConversion)){
1435     ICS.setStandard();
1436     return ICS;
1437   }
1438 
1439   if (!S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
1440     ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, From, ToType);
1441     return ICS;
1442   }
1443 
1444   // C++ [over.ics.user]p4:
1445   //   A conversion of an expression of class type to the same class
1446   //   type is given Exact Match rank, and a conversion of an
1447   //   expression of class type to a base class of that type is
1448   //   given Conversion rank, in spite of the fact that a copy/move
1449   //   constructor (i.e., a user-defined conversion function) is
1450   //   called for those cases.
1451   QualType FromType = From->getType();
1452   if (ToType->getAs<RecordType>() && FromType->getAs<RecordType>() &&
1453       (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType) ||
1454        S.IsDerivedFrom(From->getBeginLoc(), FromType, ToType))) {
1455     ICS.setStandard();
1456     ICS.Standard.setAsIdentityConversion();
1457     ICS.Standard.setFromType(FromType);
1458     ICS.Standard.setAllToTypes(ToType);
1459 
1460     // We don't actually check at this point whether there is a valid
1461     // copy/move constructor, since overloading just assumes that it
1462     // exists. When we actually perform initialization, we'll find the
1463     // appropriate constructor to copy the returned object, if needed.
1464     ICS.Standard.CopyConstructor = nullptr;
1465 
1466     // Determine whether this is considered a derived-to-base conversion.
1467     if (!S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType))
1468       ICS.Standard.Second = ICK_Derived_To_Base;
1469 
1470     return ICS;
1471   }
1472 
1473   return TryUserDefinedConversion(S, From, ToType, SuppressUserConversions,
1474                                   AllowExplicit, InOverloadResolution, CStyle,
1475                                   AllowObjCWritebackConversion,
1476                                   AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit);
1477 }
1478 
1479 ImplicitConversionSequence
1480 Sema::TryImplicitConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType,
1481                             bool SuppressUserConversions,
1482                             AllowedExplicit AllowExplicit,
1483                             bool InOverloadResolution,
1484                             bool CStyle,
1485                             bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion) {
1486   return ::TryImplicitConversion(*this, From, ToType, SuppressUserConversions,
1487                                  AllowExplicit, InOverloadResolution, CStyle,
1488                                  AllowObjCWritebackConversion,
1489                                  /*AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit=*/false);
1490 }
1491 
1492 /// PerformImplicitConversion - Perform an implicit conversion of the
1493 /// expression From to the type ToType. Returns the
1494 /// converted expression. Flavor is the kind of conversion we're
1495 /// performing, used in the error message. If @p AllowExplicit,
1496 /// explicit user-defined conversions are permitted.
1497 ExprResult Sema::PerformImplicitConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType,
1498                                            AssignmentAction Action,
1499                                            bool AllowExplicit) {
1500   if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, From))
1501     return ExprError();
1502 
1503   // Objective-C ARC: Determine whether we will allow the writeback conversion.
1504   bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion
1505     = getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount &&
1506       (Action == AA_Passing || Action == AA_Sending);
1507   if (getLangOpts().ObjC)
1508     CheckObjCBridgeRelatedConversions(From->getBeginLoc(), ToType,
1509                                       From->getType(), From);
1510   ImplicitConversionSequence ICS = ::TryImplicitConversion(
1511       *this, From, ToType,
1512       /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false,
1513       AllowExplicit ? AllowedExplicit::All : AllowedExplicit::None,
1514       /*InOverloadResolution=*/false,
1515       /*CStyle=*/false, AllowObjCWritebackConversion,
1516       /*AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit=*/false);
1517   return PerformImplicitConversion(From, ToType, ICS, Action);
1518 }
1519 
1520 /// Determine whether the conversion from FromType to ToType is a valid
1521 /// conversion that strips "noexcept" or "noreturn" off the nested function
1522 /// type.
1523 bool Sema::IsFunctionConversion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType,
1524                                 QualType &ResultTy) {
1525   if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType))
1526     return false;
1527 
1528   // Permit the conversion F(t __attribute__((noreturn))) -> F(t)
1529   //                    or F(t noexcept) -> F(t)
1530   // where F adds one of the following at most once:
1531   //   - a pointer
1532   //   - a member pointer
1533   //   - a block pointer
1534   // Changes here need matching changes in FindCompositePointerType.
1535   CanQualType CanTo = Context.getCanonicalType(ToType);
1536   CanQualType CanFrom = Context.getCanonicalType(FromType);
1537   Type::TypeClass TyClass = CanTo->getTypeClass();
1538   if (TyClass != CanFrom->getTypeClass()) return false;
1539   if (TyClass != Type::FunctionProto && TyClass != Type::FunctionNoProto) {
1540     if (TyClass == Type::Pointer) {
1541       CanTo = CanTo.castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
1542       CanFrom = CanFrom.castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
1543     } else if (TyClass == Type::BlockPointer) {
1544       CanTo = CanTo.castAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
1545       CanFrom = CanFrom.castAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
1546     } else if (TyClass == Type::MemberPointer) {
1547       auto ToMPT = CanTo.castAs<MemberPointerType>();
1548       auto FromMPT = CanFrom.castAs<MemberPointerType>();
1549       // A function pointer conversion cannot change the class of the function.
1550       if (ToMPT->getClass() != FromMPT->getClass())
1551         return false;
1552       CanTo = ToMPT->getPointeeType();
1553       CanFrom = FromMPT->getPointeeType();
1554     } else {
1555       return false;
1556     }
1557 
1558     TyClass = CanTo->getTypeClass();
1559     if (TyClass != CanFrom->getTypeClass()) return false;
1560     if (TyClass != Type::FunctionProto && TyClass != Type::FunctionNoProto)
1561       return false;
1562   }
1563 
1564   const auto *FromFn = cast<FunctionType>(CanFrom);
1565   FunctionType::ExtInfo FromEInfo = FromFn->getExtInfo();
1566 
1567   const auto *ToFn = cast<FunctionType>(CanTo);
1568   FunctionType::ExtInfo ToEInfo = ToFn->getExtInfo();
1569 
1570   bool Changed = false;
1571 
1572   // Drop 'noreturn' if not present in target type.
1573   if (FromEInfo.getNoReturn() && !ToEInfo.getNoReturn()) {
1574     FromFn = Context.adjustFunctionType(FromFn, FromEInfo.withNoReturn(false));
1575     Changed = true;
1576   }
1577 
1578   // Drop 'noexcept' if not present in target type.
1579   if (const auto *FromFPT = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(FromFn)) {
1580     const auto *ToFPT = cast<FunctionProtoType>(ToFn);
1581     if (FromFPT->isNothrow() && !ToFPT->isNothrow()) {
1582       FromFn = cast<FunctionType>(
1583           Context.getFunctionTypeWithExceptionSpec(QualType(FromFPT, 0),
1584                                                    EST_None)
1585                  .getTypePtr());
1586       Changed = true;
1587     }
1588 
1589     // Convert FromFPT's ExtParameterInfo if necessary. The conversion is valid
1590     // only if the ExtParameterInfo lists of the two function prototypes can be
1591     // merged and the merged list is identical to ToFPT's ExtParameterInfo list.
1592     SmallVector<FunctionProtoType::ExtParameterInfo, 4> NewParamInfos;
1593     bool CanUseToFPT, CanUseFromFPT;
1594     if (Context.mergeExtParameterInfo(ToFPT, FromFPT, CanUseToFPT,
1595                                       CanUseFromFPT, NewParamInfos) &&
1596         CanUseToFPT && !CanUseFromFPT) {
1597       FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo ExtInfo = FromFPT->getExtProtoInfo();
1598       ExtInfo.ExtParameterInfos =
1599           NewParamInfos.empty() ? nullptr : NewParamInfos.data();
1600       QualType QT = Context.getFunctionType(FromFPT->getReturnType(),
1601                                             FromFPT->getParamTypes(), ExtInfo);
1602       FromFn = QT->getAs<FunctionType>();
1603       Changed = true;
1604     }
1605   }
1606 
1607   if (!Changed)
1608     return false;
1609 
1610   assert(QualType(FromFn, 0).isCanonical());
1611   if (QualType(FromFn, 0) != CanTo) return false;
1612 
1613   ResultTy = ToType;
1614   return true;
1615 }
1616 
1617 /// Determine whether the conversion from FromType to ToType is a valid
1618 /// vector conversion.
1619 ///
1620 /// \param ICK Will be set to the vector conversion kind, if this is a vector
1621 /// conversion.
1622 static bool IsVectorConversion(Sema &S, QualType FromType,
1623                                QualType ToType, ImplicitConversionKind &ICK) {
1624   // We need at least one of these types to be a vector type to have a vector
1625   // conversion.
1626   if (!ToType->isVectorType() && !FromType->isVectorType())
1627     return false;
1628 
1629   // Identical types require no conversions.
1630   if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType))
1631     return false;
1632 
1633   // There are no conversions between extended vector types, only identity.
1634   if (ToType->isExtVectorType()) {
1635     // There are no conversions between extended vector types other than the
1636     // identity conversion.
1637     if (FromType->isExtVectorType())
1638       return false;
1639 
1640     // Vector splat from any arithmetic type to a vector.
1641     if (FromType->isArithmeticType()) {
1642       ICK = ICK_Vector_Splat;
1643       return true;
1644     }
1645   }
1646 
1647   if (ToType->isSizelessBuiltinType() || FromType->isSizelessBuiltinType())
1648     if (S.Context.areCompatibleSveTypes(FromType, ToType) ||
1649         S.Context.areLaxCompatibleSveTypes(FromType, ToType)) {
1650       ICK = ICK_SVE_Vector_Conversion;
1651       return true;
1652     }
1653 
1654   // We can perform the conversion between vector types in the following cases:
1655   // 1)vector types are equivalent AltiVec and GCC vector types
1656   // 2)lax vector conversions are permitted and the vector types are of the
1657   //   same size
1658   // 3)the destination type does not have the ARM MVE strict-polymorphism
1659   //   attribute, which inhibits lax vector conversion for overload resolution
1660   //   only
1661   if (ToType->isVectorType() && FromType->isVectorType()) {
1662     if (S.Context.areCompatibleVectorTypes(FromType, ToType) ||
1663         (S.isLaxVectorConversion(FromType, ToType) &&
1664          !ToType->hasAttr(attr::ArmMveStrictPolymorphism))) {
1665       ICK = ICK_Vector_Conversion;
1666       return true;
1667     }
1668   }
1669 
1670   return false;
1671 }
1672 
1673 static bool tryAtomicConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
1674                                 bool InOverloadResolution,
1675                                 StandardConversionSequence &SCS,
1676                                 bool CStyle);
1677 
1678 /// IsStandardConversion - Determines whether there is a standard
1679 /// conversion sequence (C++ [conv], C++ [over.ics.scs]) from the
1680 /// expression From to the type ToType. Standard conversion sequences
1681 /// only consider non-class types; for conversions that involve class
1682 /// types, use TryImplicitConversion. If a conversion exists, SCS will
1683 /// contain the standard conversion sequence required to perform this
1684 /// conversion and this routine will return true. Otherwise, this
1685 /// routine will return false and the value of SCS is unspecified.
1686 static bool IsStandardConversion(Sema &S, Expr* From, QualType ToType,
1687                                  bool InOverloadResolution,
1688                                  StandardConversionSequence &SCS,
1689                                  bool CStyle,
1690                                  bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion) {
1691   QualType FromType = From->getType();
1692 
1693   // Standard conversions (C++ [conv])
1694   SCS.setAsIdentityConversion();
1695   SCS.IncompatibleObjC = false;
1696   SCS.setFromType(FromType);
1697   SCS.CopyConstructor = nullptr;
1698 
1699   // There are no standard conversions for class types in C++, so
1700   // abort early. When overloading in C, however, we do permit them.
1701   if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus &&
1702       (FromType->isRecordType() || ToType->isRecordType()))
1703     return false;
1704 
1705   // The first conversion can be an lvalue-to-rvalue conversion,
1706   // array-to-pointer conversion, or function-to-pointer conversion
1707   // (C++ 4p1).
1708 
1709   if (FromType == S.Context.OverloadTy) {
1710     DeclAccessPair AccessPair;
1711     if (FunctionDecl *Fn
1712           = S.ResolveAddressOfOverloadedFunction(From, ToType, false,
1713                                                  AccessPair)) {
1714       // We were able to resolve the address of the overloaded function,
1715       // so we can convert to the type of that function.
1716       FromType = Fn->getType();
1717       SCS.setFromType(FromType);
1718 
1719       // we can sometimes resolve &foo<int> regardless of ToType, so check
1720       // if the type matches (identity) or we are converting to bool
1721       if (!S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(
1722                       S.ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionType(ToType), FromType)) {
1723         QualType resultTy;
1724         // if the function type matches except for [[noreturn]], it's ok
1725         if (!S.IsFunctionConversion(FromType,
1726               S.ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionType(ToType), resultTy))
1727           // otherwise, only a boolean conversion is standard
1728           if (!ToType->isBooleanType())
1729             return false;
1730       }
1731 
1732       // Check if the "from" expression is taking the address of an overloaded
1733       // function and recompute the FromType accordingly. Take advantage of the
1734       // fact that non-static member functions *must* have such an address-of
1735       // expression.
1736       CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn);
1737       if (Method && !Method->isStatic()) {
1738         assert(isa<UnaryOperator>(From->IgnoreParens()) &&
1739                "Non-unary operator on non-static member address");
1740         assert(cast<UnaryOperator>(From->IgnoreParens())->getOpcode()
1741                == UO_AddrOf &&
1742                "Non-address-of operator on non-static member address");
1743         const Type *ClassType
1744           = S.Context.getTypeDeclType(Method->getParent()).getTypePtr();
1745         FromType = S.Context.getMemberPointerType(FromType, ClassType);
1746       } else if (isa<UnaryOperator>(From->IgnoreParens())) {
1747         assert(cast<UnaryOperator>(From->IgnoreParens())->getOpcode() ==
1748                UO_AddrOf &&
1749                "Non-address-of operator for overloaded function expression");
1750         FromType = S.Context.getPointerType(FromType);
1751       }
1752 
1753       // Check that we've computed the proper type after overload resolution.
1754       // FIXME: FixOverloadedFunctionReference has side-effects; we shouldn't
1755       // be calling it from within an NDEBUG block.
1756       assert(S.Context.hasSameType(
1757         FromType,
1758         S.FixOverloadedFunctionReference(From, AccessPair, Fn)->getType()));
1759     } else {
1760       return false;
1761     }
1762   }
1763   // Lvalue-to-rvalue conversion (C++11 4.1):
1764   //   A glvalue (3.10) of a non-function, non-array type T can
1765   //   be converted to a prvalue.
1766   bool argIsLValue = From->isGLValue();
1767   if (argIsLValue &&
1768       !FromType->isFunctionType() && !FromType->isArrayType() &&
1769       S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType) != S.Context.OverloadTy) {
1770     SCS.First = ICK_Lvalue_To_Rvalue;
1771 
1772     // C11 6.3.2.1p2:
1773     //   ... if the lvalue has atomic type, the value has the non-atomic version
1774     //   of the type of the lvalue ...
1775     if (const AtomicType *Atomic = FromType->getAs<AtomicType>())
1776       FromType = Atomic->getValueType();
1777 
1778     // If T is a non-class type, the type of the rvalue is the
1779     // cv-unqualified version of T. Otherwise, the type of the rvalue
1780     // is T (C++ 4.1p1). C++ can't get here with class types; in C, we
1781     // just strip the qualifiers because they don't matter.
1782     FromType = FromType.getUnqualifiedType();
1783   } else if (FromType->isArrayType()) {
1784     // Array-to-pointer conversion (C++ 4.2)
1785     SCS.First = ICK_Array_To_Pointer;
1786 
1787     // An lvalue or rvalue of type "array of N T" or "array of unknown
1788     // bound of T" can be converted to an rvalue of type "pointer to
1789     // T" (C++ 4.2p1).
1790     FromType = S.Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType);
1791 
1792     if (S.IsStringLiteralToNonConstPointerConversion(From, ToType)) {
1793       // This conversion is deprecated in C++03 (D.4)
1794       SCS.DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr = true;
1795 
1796       // For the purpose of ranking in overload resolution
1797       // (13.3.3.1.1), this conversion is considered an
1798       // array-to-pointer conversion followed by a qualification
1799       // conversion (4.4). (C++ 4.2p2)
1800       SCS.Second = ICK_Identity;
1801       SCS.Third = ICK_Qualification;
1802       SCS.QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime = false;
1803       SCS.setAllToTypes(FromType);
1804       return true;
1805     }
1806   } else if (FromType->isFunctionType() && argIsLValue) {
1807     // Function-to-pointer conversion (C++ 4.3).
1808     SCS.First = ICK_Function_To_Pointer;
1809 
1810     if (auto *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(From->IgnoreParenCasts()))
1811       if (auto *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(DRE->getDecl()))
1812         if (!S.checkAddressOfFunctionIsAvailable(FD))
1813           return false;
1814 
1815     // An lvalue of function type T can be converted to an rvalue of
1816     // type "pointer to T." The result is a pointer to the
1817     // function. (C++ 4.3p1).
1818     FromType = S.Context.getPointerType(FromType);
1819   } else {
1820     // We don't require any conversions for the first step.
1821     SCS.First = ICK_Identity;
1822   }
1823   SCS.setToType(0, FromType);
1824 
1825   // The second conversion can be an integral promotion, floating
1826   // point promotion, integral conversion, floating point conversion,
1827   // floating-integral conversion, pointer conversion,
1828   // pointer-to-member conversion, or boolean conversion (C++ 4p1).
1829   // For overloading in C, this can also be a "compatible-type"
1830   // conversion.
1831   bool IncompatibleObjC = false;
1832   ImplicitConversionKind SecondICK = ICK_Identity;
1833   if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType)) {
1834     // The unqualified versions of the types are the same: there's no
1835     // conversion to do.
1836     SCS.Second = ICK_Identity;
1837   } else if (S.IsIntegralPromotion(From, FromType, ToType)) {
1838     // Integral promotion (C++ 4.5).
1839     SCS.Second = ICK_Integral_Promotion;
1840     FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
1841   } else if (S.IsFloatingPointPromotion(FromType, ToType)) {
1842     // Floating point promotion (C++ 4.6).
1843     SCS.Second = ICK_Floating_Promotion;
1844     FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
1845   } else if (S.IsComplexPromotion(FromType, ToType)) {
1846     // Complex promotion (Clang extension)
1847     SCS.Second = ICK_Complex_Promotion;
1848     FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
1849   } else if (ToType->isBooleanType() &&
1850              (FromType->isArithmeticType() ||
1851               FromType->isAnyPointerType() ||
1852               FromType->isBlockPointerType() ||
1853               FromType->isMemberPointerType())) {
1854     // Boolean conversions (C++ 4.12).
1855     SCS.Second = ICK_Boolean_Conversion;
1856     FromType = S.Context.BoolTy;
1857   } else if (FromType->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType() &&
1858              ToType->isIntegralType(S.Context)) {
1859     // Integral conversions (C++ 4.7).
1860     SCS.Second = ICK_Integral_Conversion;
1861     FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
1862   } else if (FromType->isAnyComplexType() && ToType->isAnyComplexType()) {
1863     // Complex conversions (C99 6.3.1.6)
1864     SCS.Second = ICK_Complex_Conversion;
1865     FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
1866   } else if ((FromType->isAnyComplexType() && ToType->isArithmeticType()) ||
1867              (ToType->isAnyComplexType() && FromType->isArithmeticType())) {
1868     // Complex-real conversions (C99 6.3.1.7)
1869     SCS.Second = ICK_Complex_Real;
1870     FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
1871   } else if (FromType->isRealFloatingType() && ToType->isRealFloatingType()) {
1872     // FIXME: disable conversions between long double and __float128 if
1873     // their representation is different until there is back end support
1874     // We of course allow this conversion if long double is really double.
1875 
1876     // Conversions between bfloat and other floats are not permitted.
1877     if (FromType == S.Context.BFloat16Ty || ToType == S.Context.BFloat16Ty)
1878       return false;
1879     if (&S.Context.getFloatTypeSemantics(FromType) !=
1880         &S.Context.getFloatTypeSemantics(ToType)) {
1881       bool Float128AndLongDouble = ((FromType == S.Context.Float128Ty &&
1882                                     ToType == S.Context.LongDoubleTy) ||
1883                                    (FromType == S.Context.LongDoubleTy &&
1884                                     ToType == S.Context.Float128Ty));
1885       if (Float128AndLongDouble &&
1886           (&S.Context.getFloatTypeSemantics(S.Context.LongDoubleTy) ==
1887            &llvm::APFloat::PPCDoubleDouble()))
1888         return false;
1889     }
1890     // Floating point conversions (C++ 4.8).
1891     SCS.Second = ICK_Floating_Conversion;
1892     FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
1893   } else if ((FromType->isRealFloatingType() &&
1894               ToType->isIntegralType(S.Context)) ||
1895              (FromType->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType() &&
1896               ToType->isRealFloatingType())) {
1897     // Conversions between bfloat and int are not permitted.
1898     if (FromType->isBFloat16Type() || ToType->isBFloat16Type())
1899       return false;
1900 
1901     // Floating-integral conversions (C++ 4.9).
1902     SCS.Second = ICK_Floating_Integral;
1903     FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
1904   } else if (S.IsBlockPointerConversion(FromType, ToType, FromType)) {
1905     SCS.Second = ICK_Block_Pointer_Conversion;
1906   } else if (AllowObjCWritebackConversion &&
1907              S.isObjCWritebackConversion(FromType, ToType, FromType)) {
1908     SCS.Second = ICK_Writeback_Conversion;
1909   } else if (S.IsPointerConversion(From, FromType, ToType, InOverloadResolution,
1910                                    FromType, IncompatibleObjC)) {
1911     // Pointer conversions (C++ 4.10).
1912     SCS.Second = ICK_Pointer_Conversion;
1913     SCS.IncompatibleObjC = IncompatibleObjC;
1914     FromType = FromType.getUnqualifiedType();
1915   } else if (S.IsMemberPointerConversion(From, FromType, ToType,
1916                                          InOverloadResolution, FromType)) {
1917     // Pointer to member conversions (4.11).
1918     SCS.Second = ICK_Pointer_Member;
1919   } else if (IsVectorConversion(S, FromType, ToType, SecondICK)) {
1920     SCS.Second = SecondICK;
1921     FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
1922   } else if (!S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus &&
1923              S.Context.typesAreCompatible(ToType, FromType)) {
1924     // Compatible conversions (Clang extension for C function overloading)
1925     SCS.Second = ICK_Compatible_Conversion;
1926     FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
1927   } else if (IsTransparentUnionStandardConversion(S, From, ToType,
1928                                              InOverloadResolution,
1929                                              SCS, CStyle)) {
1930     SCS.Second = ICK_TransparentUnionConversion;
1931     FromType = ToType;
1932   } else if (tryAtomicConversion(S, From, ToType, InOverloadResolution, SCS,
1933                                  CStyle)) {
1934     // tryAtomicConversion has updated the standard conversion sequence
1935     // appropriately.
1936     return true;
1937   } else if (ToType->isEventT() &&
1938              From->isIntegerConstantExpr(S.getASTContext()) &&
1939              From->EvaluateKnownConstInt(S.getASTContext()) == 0) {
1940     SCS.Second = ICK_Zero_Event_Conversion;
1941     FromType = ToType;
1942   } else if (ToType->isQueueT() &&
1943              From->isIntegerConstantExpr(S.getASTContext()) &&
1944              (From->EvaluateKnownConstInt(S.getASTContext()) == 0)) {
1945     SCS.Second = ICK_Zero_Queue_Conversion;
1946     FromType = ToType;
1947   } else if (ToType->isSamplerT() &&
1948              From->isIntegerConstantExpr(S.getASTContext())) {
1949     SCS.Second = ICK_Compatible_Conversion;
1950     FromType = ToType;
1951   } else {
1952     // No second conversion required.
1953     SCS.Second = ICK_Identity;
1954   }
1955   SCS.setToType(1, FromType);
1956 
1957   // The third conversion can be a function pointer conversion or a
1958   // qualification conversion (C++ [conv.fctptr], [conv.qual]).
1959   bool ObjCLifetimeConversion;
1960   if (S.IsFunctionConversion(FromType, ToType, FromType)) {
1961     // Function pointer conversions (removing 'noexcept') including removal of
1962     // 'noreturn' (Clang extension).
1963     SCS.Third = ICK_Function_Conversion;
1964   } else if (S.IsQualificationConversion(FromType, ToType, CStyle,
1965                                          ObjCLifetimeConversion)) {
1966     SCS.Third = ICK_Qualification;
1967     SCS.QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime = ObjCLifetimeConversion;
1968     FromType = ToType;
1969   } else {
1970     // No conversion required
1971     SCS.Third = ICK_Identity;
1972   }
1973 
1974   // C++ [over.best.ics]p6:
1975   //   [...] Any difference in top-level cv-qualification is
1976   //   subsumed by the initialization itself and does not constitute
1977   //   a conversion. [...]
1978   QualType CanonFrom = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType);
1979   QualType CanonTo = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToType);
1980   if (CanonFrom.getLocalUnqualifiedType()
1981                                      == CanonTo.getLocalUnqualifiedType() &&
1982       CanonFrom.getLocalQualifiers() != CanonTo.getLocalQualifiers()) {
1983     FromType = ToType;
1984     CanonFrom = CanonTo;
1985   }
1986 
1987   SCS.setToType(2, FromType);
1988 
1989   if (CanonFrom == CanonTo)
1990     return true;
1991 
1992   // If we have not converted the argument type to the parameter type,
1993   // this is a bad conversion sequence, unless we're resolving an overload in C.
1994   if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus || !InOverloadResolution)
1995     return false;
1996 
1997   ExprResult ER = ExprResult{From};
1998   Sema::AssignConvertType Conv =
1999       S.CheckSingleAssignmentConstraints(ToType, ER,
2000                                          /*Diagnose=*/false,
2001                                          /*DiagnoseCFAudited=*/false,
2002                                          /*ConvertRHS=*/false);
2003   ImplicitConversionKind SecondConv;
2004   switch (Conv) {
2005   case Sema::Compatible:
2006     SecondConv = ICK_C_Only_Conversion;
2007     break;
2008   // For our purposes, discarding qualifiers is just as bad as using an
2009   // incompatible pointer. Note that an IncompatiblePointer conversion can drop
2010   // qualifiers, as well.
2011   case Sema::CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers:
2012   case Sema::IncompatiblePointer:
2013   case Sema::IncompatiblePointerSign:
2014     SecondConv = ICK_Incompatible_Pointer_Conversion;
2015     break;
2016   default:
2017     return false;
2018   }
2019 
2020   // First can only be an lvalue conversion, so we pretend that this was the
2021   // second conversion. First should already be valid from earlier in the
2022   // function.
2023   SCS.Second = SecondConv;
2024   SCS.setToType(1, ToType);
2025 
2026   // Third is Identity, because Second should rank us worse than any other
2027   // conversion. This could also be ICK_Qualification, but it's simpler to just
2028   // lump everything in with the second conversion, and we don't gain anything
2029   // from making this ICK_Qualification.
2030   SCS.Third = ICK_Identity;
2031   SCS.setToType(2, ToType);
2032   return true;
2033 }
2034 
2035 static bool
2036 IsTransparentUnionStandardConversion(Sema &S, Expr* From,
2037                                      QualType &ToType,
2038                                      bool InOverloadResolution,
2039                                      StandardConversionSequence &SCS,
2040                                      bool CStyle) {
2041 
2042   const RecordType *UT = ToType->getAsUnionType();
2043   if (!UT || !UT->getDecl()->hasAttr<TransparentUnionAttr>())
2044     return false;
2045   // The field to initialize within the transparent union.
2046   RecordDecl *UD = UT->getDecl();
2047   // It's compatible if the expression matches any of the fields.
2048   for (const auto *it : UD->fields()) {
2049     if (IsStandardConversion(S, From, it->getType(), InOverloadResolution, SCS,
2050                              CStyle, /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/false)) {
2051       ToType = it->getType();
2052       return true;
2053     }
2054   }
2055   return false;
2056 }
2057 
2058 /// IsIntegralPromotion - Determines whether the conversion from the
2059 /// expression From (whose potentially-adjusted type is FromType) to
2060 /// ToType is an integral promotion (C++ 4.5). If so, returns true and
2061 /// sets PromotedType to the promoted type.
2062 bool Sema::IsIntegralPromotion(Expr *From, QualType FromType, QualType ToType) {
2063   const BuiltinType *To = ToType->getAs<BuiltinType>();
2064   // All integers are built-in.
2065   if (!To) {
2066     return false;
2067   }
2068 
2069   // An rvalue of type char, signed char, unsigned char, short int, or
2070   // unsigned short int can be converted to an rvalue of type int if
2071   // int can represent all the values of the source type; otherwise,
2072   // the source rvalue can be converted to an rvalue of type unsigned
2073   // int (C++ 4.5p1).
2074   if (FromType->isPromotableIntegerType() && !FromType->isBooleanType() &&
2075       !FromType->isEnumeralType()) {
2076     if (// We can promote any signed, promotable integer type to an int
2077         (FromType->isSignedIntegerType() ||
2078          // We can promote any unsigned integer type whose size is
2079          // less than int to an int.
2080          Context.getTypeSize(FromType) < Context.getTypeSize(ToType))) {
2081       return To->getKind() == BuiltinType::Int;
2082     }
2083 
2084     return To->getKind() == BuiltinType::UInt;
2085   }
2086 
2087   // C++11 [conv.prom]p3:
2088   //   A prvalue of an unscoped enumeration type whose underlying type is not
2089   //   fixed (7.2) can be converted to an rvalue a prvalue of the first of the
2090   //   following types that can represent all the values of the enumeration
2091   //   (i.e., the values in the range bmin to bmax as described in 7.2): int,
2092   //   unsigned int, long int, unsigned long int, long long int, or unsigned
2093   //   long long int. If none of the types in that list can represent all the
2094   //   values of the enumeration, an rvalue a prvalue of an unscoped enumeration
2095   //   type can be converted to an rvalue a prvalue of the extended integer type
2096   //   with lowest integer conversion rank (4.13) greater than the rank of long
2097   //   long in which all the values of the enumeration can be represented. If
2098   //   there are two such extended types, the signed one is chosen.
2099   // C++11 [conv.prom]p4:
2100   //   A prvalue of an unscoped enumeration type whose underlying type is fixed
2101   //   can be converted to a prvalue of its underlying type. Moreover, if
2102   //   integral promotion can be applied to its underlying type, a prvalue of an
2103   //   unscoped enumeration type whose underlying type is fixed can also be
2104   //   converted to a prvalue of the promoted underlying type.
2105   if (const EnumType *FromEnumType = FromType->getAs<EnumType>()) {
2106     // C++0x 7.2p9: Note that this implicit enum to int conversion is not
2107     // provided for a scoped enumeration.
2108     if (FromEnumType->getDecl()->isScoped())
2109       return false;
2110 
2111     // We can perform an integral promotion to the underlying type of the enum,
2112     // even if that's not the promoted type. Note that the check for promoting
2113     // the underlying type is based on the type alone, and does not consider
2114     // the bitfield-ness of the actual source expression.
2115     if (FromEnumType->getDecl()->isFixed()) {
2116       QualType Underlying = FromEnumType->getDecl()->getIntegerType();
2117       return Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(Underlying, ToType) ||
2118              IsIntegralPromotion(nullptr, Underlying, ToType);
2119     }
2120 
2121     // We have already pre-calculated the promotion type, so this is trivial.
2122     if (ToType->isIntegerType() &&
2123         isCompleteType(From->getBeginLoc(), FromType))
2124       return Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(
2125           ToType, FromEnumType->getDecl()->getPromotionType());
2126 
2127     // C++ [conv.prom]p5:
2128     //   If the bit-field has an enumerated type, it is treated as any other
2129     //   value of that type for promotion purposes.
2130     //
2131     // ... so do not fall through into the bit-field checks below in C++.
2132     if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
2133       return false;
2134   }
2135 
2136   // C++0x [conv.prom]p2:
2137   //   A prvalue of type char16_t, char32_t, or wchar_t (3.9.1) can be converted
2138   //   to an rvalue a prvalue of the first of the following types that can
2139   //   represent all the values of its underlying type: int, unsigned int,
2140   //   long int, unsigned long int, long long int, or unsigned long long int.
2141   //   If none of the types in that list can represent all the values of its
2142   //   underlying type, an rvalue a prvalue of type char16_t, char32_t,
2143   //   or wchar_t can be converted to an rvalue a prvalue of its underlying
2144   //   type.
2145   if (FromType->isAnyCharacterType() && !FromType->isCharType() &&
2146       ToType->isIntegerType()) {
2147     // Determine whether the type we're converting from is signed or
2148     // unsigned.
2149     bool FromIsSigned = FromType->isSignedIntegerType();
2150     uint64_t FromSize = Context.getTypeSize(FromType);
2151 
2152     // The types we'll try to promote to, in the appropriate
2153     // order. Try each of these types.
2154     QualType PromoteTypes[6] = {
2155       Context.IntTy, Context.UnsignedIntTy,
2156       Context.LongTy, Context.UnsignedLongTy ,
2157       Context.LongLongTy, Context.UnsignedLongLongTy
2158     };
2159     for (int Idx = 0; Idx < 6; ++Idx) {
2160       uint64_t ToSize = Context.getTypeSize(PromoteTypes[Idx]);
2161       if (FromSize < ToSize ||
2162           (FromSize == ToSize &&
2163            FromIsSigned == PromoteTypes[Idx]->isSignedIntegerType())) {
2164         // We found the type that we can promote to. If this is the
2165         // type we wanted, we have a promotion. Otherwise, no
2166         // promotion.
2167         return Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType, PromoteTypes[Idx]);
2168       }
2169     }
2170   }
2171 
2172   // An rvalue for an integral bit-field (9.6) can be converted to an
2173   // rvalue of type int if int can represent all the values of the
2174   // bit-field; otherwise, it can be converted to unsigned int if
2175   // unsigned int can represent all the values of the bit-field. If
2176   // the bit-field is larger yet, no integral promotion applies to
2177   // it. If the bit-field has an enumerated type, it is treated as any
2178   // other value of that type for promotion purposes (C++ 4.5p3).
2179   // FIXME: We should delay checking of bit-fields until we actually perform the
2180   // conversion.
2181   //
2182   // FIXME: In C, only bit-fields of types _Bool, int, or unsigned int may be
2183   // promoted, per C11 6.3.1.1/2. We promote all bit-fields (including enum
2184   // bit-fields and those whose underlying type is larger than int) for GCC
2185   // compatibility.
2186   if (From) {
2187     if (FieldDecl *MemberDecl = From->getSourceBitField()) {
2188       Optional<llvm::APSInt> BitWidth;
2189       if (FromType->isIntegralType(Context) &&
2190           (BitWidth =
2191                MemberDecl->getBitWidth()->getIntegerConstantExpr(Context))) {
2192         llvm::APSInt ToSize(BitWidth->getBitWidth(), BitWidth->isUnsigned());
2193         ToSize = Context.getTypeSize(ToType);
2194 
2195         // Are we promoting to an int from a bitfield that fits in an int?
2196         if (*BitWidth < ToSize ||
2197             (FromType->isSignedIntegerType() && *BitWidth <= ToSize)) {
2198           return To->getKind() == BuiltinType::Int;
2199         }
2200 
2201         // Are we promoting to an unsigned int from an unsigned bitfield
2202         // that fits into an unsigned int?
2203         if (FromType->isUnsignedIntegerType() && *BitWidth <= ToSize) {
2204           return To->getKind() == BuiltinType::UInt;
2205         }
2206 
2207         return false;
2208       }
2209     }
2210   }
2211 
2212   // An rvalue of type bool can be converted to an rvalue of type int,
2213   // with false becoming zero and true becoming one (C++ 4.5p4).
2214   if (FromType->isBooleanType() && To->getKind() == BuiltinType::Int) {
2215     return true;
2216   }
2217 
2218   return false;
2219 }
2220 
2221 /// IsFloatingPointPromotion - Determines whether the conversion from
2222 /// FromType to ToType is a floating point promotion (C++ 4.6). If so,
2223 /// returns true and sets PromotedType to the promoted type.
2224 bool Sema::IsFloatingPointPromotion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType) {
2225   if (const BuiltinType *FromBuiltin = FromType->getAs<BuiltinType>())
2226     if (const BuiltinType *ToBuiltin = ToType->getAs<BuiltinType>()) {
2227       /// An rvalue of type float can be converted to an rvalue of type
2228       /// double. (C++ 4.6p1).
2229       if (FromBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Float &&
2230           ToBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Double)
2231         return true;
2232 
2233       // C99 6.3.1.5p1:
2234       //   When a float is promoted to double or long double, or a
2235       //   double is promoted to long double [...].
2236       if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus &&
2237           (FromBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Float ||
2238            FromBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Double) &&
2239           (ToBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::LongDouble ||
2240            ToBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Float128))
2241         return true;
2242 
2243       // Half can be promoted to float.
2244       if (!getLangOpts().NativeHalfType &&
2245            FromBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Half &&
2246           ToBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Float)
2247         return true;
2248     }
2249 
2250   return false;
2251 }
2252 
2253 /// Determine if a conversion is a complex promotion.
2254 ///
2255 /// A complex promotion is defined as a complex -> complex conversion
2256 /// where the conversion between the underlying real types is a
2257 /// floating-point or integral promotion.
2258 bool Sema::IsComplexPromotion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType) {
2259   const ComplexType *FromComplex = FromType->getAs<ComplexType>();
2260   if (!FromComplex)
2261     return false;
2262 
2263   const ComplexType *ToComplex = ToType->getAs<ComplexType>();
2264   if (!ToComplex)
2265     return false;
2266 
2267   return IsFloatingPointPromotion(FromComplex->getElementType(),
2268                                   ToComplex->getElementType()) ||
2269     IsIntegralPromotion(nullptr, FromComplex->getElementType(),
2270                         ToComplex->getElementType());
2271 }
2272 
2273 /// BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType - In a pointer conversion from
2274 /// the pointer type FromPtr to a pointer to type ToPointee, with the
2275 /// same type qualifiers as FromPtr has on its pointee type. ToType,
2276 /// if non-empty, will be a pointer to ToType that may or may not have
2277 /// the right set of qualifiers on its pointee.
2278 ///
2279 static QualType
2280 BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(const Type *FromPtr,
2281                                    QualType ToPointee, QualType ToType,
2282                                    ASTContext &Context,
2283                                    bool StripObjCLifetime = false) {
2284   assert((FromPtr->getTypeClass() == Type::Pointer ||
2285           FromPtr->getTypeClass() == Type::ObjCObjectPointer) &&
2286          "Invalid similarly-qualified pointer type");
2287 
2288   /// Conversions to 'id' subsume cv-qualifier conversions.
2289   if (ToType->isObjCIdType() || ToType->isObjCQualifiedIdType())
2290     return ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
2291 
2292   QualType CanonFromPointee
2293     = Context.getCanonicalType(FromPtr->getPointeeType());
2294   QualType CanonToPointee = Context.getCanonicalType(ToPointee);
2295   Qualifiers Quals = CanonFromPointee.getQualifiers();
2296 
2297   if (StripObjCLifetime)
2298     Quals.removeObjCLifetime();
2299 
2300   // Exact qualifier match -> return the pointer type we're converting to.
2301   if (CanonToPointee.getLocalQualifiers() == Quals) {
2302     // ToType is exactly what we need. Return it.
2303     if (!ToType.isNull())
2304       return ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
2305 
2306     // Build a pointer to ToPointee. It has the right qualifiers
2307     // already.
2308     if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(ToType))
2309       return Context.getObjCObjectPointerType(ToPointee);
2310     return Context.getPointerType(ToPointee);
2311   }
2312 
2313   // Just build a canonical type that has the right qualifiers.
2314   QualType QualifiedCanonToPointee
2315     = Context.getQualifiedType(CanonToPointee.getLocalUnqualifiedType(), Quals);
2316 
2317   if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(ToType))
2318     return Context.getObjCObjectPointerType(QualifiedCanonToPointee);
2319   return Context.getPointerType(QualifiedCanonToPointee);
2320 }
2321 
2322 static bool isNullPointerConstantForConversion(Expr *Expr,
2323                                                bool InOverloadResolution,
2324                                                ASTContext &Context) {
2325   // Handle value-dependent integral null pointer constants correctly.
2326   // http://www.open-std.org/jtc1/sc22/wg21/docs/cwg_active.html#903
2327   if (Expr->isValueDependent() && !Expr->isTypeDependent() &&
2328       Expr->getType()->isIntegerType() && !Expr->getType()->isEnumeralType())
2329     return !InOverloadResolution;
2330 
2331   return Expr->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
2332                     InOverloadResolution? Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull
2333                                         : Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull);
2334 }
2335 
2336 /// IsPointerConversion - Determines whether the conversion of the
2337 /// expression From, which has the (possibly adjusted) type FromType,
2338 /// can be converted to the type ToType via a pointer conversion (C++
2339 /// 4.10). If so, returns true and places the converted type (that
2340 /// might differ from ToType in its cv-qualifiers at some level) into
2341 /// ConvertedType.
2342 ///
2343 /// This routine also supports conversions to and from block pointers
2344 /// and conversions with Objective-C's 'id', 'id<protocols...>', and
2345 /// pointers to interfaces. FIXME: Once we've determined the
2346 /// appropriate overloading rules for Objective-C, we may want to
2347 /// split the Objective-C checks into a different routine; however,
2348 /// GCC seems to consider all of these conversions to be pointer
2349 /// conversions, so for now they live here. IncompatibleObjC will be
2350 /// set if the conversion is an allowed Objective-C conversion that
2351 /// should result in a warning.
2352 bool Sema::IsPointerConversion(Expr *From, QualType FromType, QualType ToType,
2353                                bool InOverloadResolution,
2354                                QualType& ConvertedType,
2355                                bool &IncompatibleObjC) {
2356   IncompatibleObjC = false;
2357   if (isObjCPointerConversion(FromType, ToType, ConvertedType,
2358                               IncompatibleObjC))
2359     return true;
2360 
2361   // Conversion from a null pointer constant to any Objective-C pointer type.
2362   if (ToType->isObjCObjectPointerType() &&
2363       isNullPointerConstantForConversion(From, InOverloadResolution, Context)) {
2364     ConvertedType = ToType;
2365     return true;
2366   }
2367 
2368   // Blocks: Block pointers can be converted to void*.
2369   if (FromType->isBlockPointerType() && ToType->isPointerType() &&
2370       ToType->castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType()) {
2371     ConvertedType = ToType;
2372     return true;
2373   }
2374   // Blocks: A null pointer constant can be converted to a block
2375   // pointer type.
2376   if (ToType->isBlockPointerType() &&
2377       isNullPointerConstantForConversion(From, InOverloadResolution, Context)) {
2378     ConvertedType = ToType;
2379     return true;
2380   }
2381 
2382   // If the left-hand-side is nullptr_t, the right side can be a null
2383   // pointer constant.
2384   if (ToType->isNullPtrType() &&
2385       isNullPointerConstantForConversion(From, InOverloadResolution, Context)) {
2386     ConvertedType = ToType;
2387     return true;
2388   }
2389 
2390   const PointerType* ToTypePtr = ToType->getAs<PointerType>();
2391   if (!ToTypePtr)
2392     return false;
2393 
2394   // A null pointer constant can be converted to a pointer type (C++ 4.10p1).
2395   if (isNullPointerConstantForConversion(From, InOverloadResolution, Context)) {
2396     ConvertedType = ToType;
2397     return true;
2398   }
2399 
2400   // Beyond this point, both types need to be pointers
2401   // , including objective-c pointers.
2402   QualType ToPointeeType = ToTypePtr->getPointeeType();
2403   if (FromType->isObjCObjectPointerType() && ToPointeeType->isVoidType() &&
2404       !getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount) {
2405     ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(
2406                                       FromType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(),
2407                                                        ToPointeeType,
2408                                                        ToType, Context);
2409     return true;
2410   }
2411   const PointerType *FromTypePtr = FromType->getAs<PointerType>();
2412   if (!FromTypePtr)
2413     return false;
2414 
2415   QualType FromPointeeType = FromTypePtr->getPointeeType();
2416 
2417   // If the unqualified pointee types are the same, this can't be a
2418   // pointer conversion, so don't do all of the work below.
2419   if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType))
2420     return false;
2421 
2422   // An rvalue of type "pointer to cv T," where T is an object type,
2423   // can be converted to an rvalue of type "pointer to cv void" (C++
2424   // 4.10p2).
2425   if (FromPointeeType->isIncompleteOrObjectType() &&
2426       ToPointeeType->isVoidType()) {
2427     ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromTypePtr,
2428                                                        ToPointeeType,
2429                                                        ToType, Context,
2430                                                    /*StripObjCLifetime=*/true);
2431     return true;
2432   }
2433 
2434   // MSVC allows implicit function to void* type conversion.
2435   if (getLangOpts().MSVCCompat && FromPointeeType->isFunctionType() &&
2436       ToPointeeType->isVoidType()) {
2437     ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromTypePtr,
2438                                                        ToPointeeType,
2439                                                        ToType, Context);
2440     return true;
2441   }
2442 
2443   // When we're overloading in C, we allow a special kind of pointer
2444   // conversion for compatible-but-not-identical pointee types.
2445   if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus &&
2446       Context.typesAreCompatible(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType)) {
2447     ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromTypePtr,
2448                                                        ToPointeeType,
2449                                                        ToType, Context);
2450     return true;
2451   }
2452 
2453   // C++ [conv.ptr]p3:
2454   //
2455   //   An rvalue of type "pointer to cv D," where D is a class type,
2456   //   can be converted to an rvalue of type "pointer to cv B," where
2457   //   B is a base class (clause 10) of D. If B is an inaccessible
2458   //   (clause 11) or ambiguous (10.2) base class of D, a program that
2459   //   necessitates this conversion is ill-formed. The result of the
2460   //   conversion is a pointer to the base class sub-object of the
2461   //   derived class object. The null pointer value is converted to
2462   //   the null pointer value of the destination type.
2463   //
2464   // Note that we do not check for ambiguity or inaccessibility
2465   // here. That is handled by CheckPointerConversion.
2466   if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && FromPointeeType->isRecordType() &&
2467       ToPointeeType->isRecordType() &&
2468       !Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType) &&
2469       IsDerivedFrom(From->getBeginLoc(), FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType)) {
2470     ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromTypePtr,
2471                                                        ToPointeeType,
2472                                                        ToType, Context);
2473     return true;
2474   }
2475 
2476   if (FromPointeeType->isVectorType() && ToPointeeType->isVectorType() &&
2477       Context.areCompatibleVectorTypes(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType)) {
2478     ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromTypePtr,
2479                                                        ToPointeeType,
2480                                                        ToType, Context);
2481     return true;
2482   }
2483 
2484   return false;
2485 }
2486 
2487 /// Adopt the given qualifiers for the given type.
2488 static QualType AdoptQualifiers(ASTContext &Context, QualType T, Qualifiers Qs){
2489   Qualifiers TQs = T.getQualifiers();
2490 
2491   // Check whether qualifiers already match.
2492   if (TQs == Qs)
2493     return T;
2494 
2495   if (Qs.compatiblyIncludes(TQs))
2496     return Context.getQualifiedType(T, Qs);
2497 
2498   return Context.getQualifiedType(T.getUnqualifiedType(), Qs);
2499 }
2500 
2501 /// isObjCPointerConversion - Determines whether this is an
2502 /// Objective-C pointer conversion. Subroutine of IsPointerConversion,
2503 /// with the same arguments and return values.
2504 bool Sema::isObjCPointerConversion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType,
2505                                    QualType& ConvertedType,
2506                                    bool &IncompatibleObjC) {
2507   if (!getLangOpts().ObjC)
2508     return false;
2509 
2510   // The set of qualifiers on the type we're converting from.
2511   Qualifiers FromQualifiers = FromType.getQualifiers();
2512 
2513   // First, we handle all conversions on ObjC object pointer types.
2514   const ObjCObjectPointerType* ToObjCPtr =
2515     ToType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
2516   const ObjCObjectPointerType *FromObjCPtr =
2517     FromType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
2518 
2519   if (ToObjCPtr && FromObjCPtr) {
2520     // If the pointee types are the same (ignoring qualifications),
2521     // then this is not a pointer conversion.
2522     if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToObjCPtr->getPointeeType(),
2523                                        FromObjCPtr->getPointeeType()))
2524       return false;
2525 
2526     // Conversion between Objective-C pointers.
2527     if (Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(ToObjCPtr, FromObjCPtr)) {
2528       const ObjCInterfaceType* LHS = ToObjCPtr->getInterfaceType();
2529       const ObjCInterfaceType* RHS = FromObjCPtr->getInterfaceType();
2530       if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && LHS && RHS &&
2531           !ToObjCPtr->getPointeeType().isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(
2532                                                 FromObjCPtr->getPointeeType()))
2533         return false;
2534       ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromObjCPtr,
2535                                                    ToObjCPtr->getPointeeType(),
2536                                                          ToType, Context);
2537       ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ConvertedType, FromQualifiers);
2538       return true;
2539     }
2540 
2541     if (Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(FromObjCPtr, ToObjCPtr)) {
2542       // Okay: this is some kind of implicit downcast of Objective-C
2543       // interfaces, which is permitted. However, we're going to
2544       // complain about it.
2545       IncompatibleObjC = true;
2546       ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromObjCPtr,
2547                                                    ToObjCPtr->getPointeeType(),
2548                                                          ToType, Context);
2549       ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ConvertedType, FromQualifiers);
2550       return true;
2551     }
2552   }
2553   // Beyond this point, both types need to be C pointers or block pointers.
2554   QualType ToPointeeType;
2555   if (const PointerType *ToCPtr = ToType->getAs<PointerType>())
2556     ToPointeeType = ToCPtr->getPointeeType();
2557   else if (const BlockPointerType *ToBlockPtr =
2558             ToType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()) {
2559     // Objective C++: We're able to convert from a pointer to any object
2560     // to a block pointer type.
2561     if (FromObjCPtr && FromObjCPtr->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
2562       ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ToType, FromQualifiers);
2563       return true;
2564     }
2565     ToPointeeType = ToBlockPtr->getPointeeType();
2566   }
2567   else if (FromType->getAs<BlockPointerType>() &&
2568            ToObjCPtr && ToObjCPtr->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
2569     // Objective C++: We're able to convert from a block pointer type to a
2570     // pointer to any object.
2571     ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ToType, FromQualifiers);
2572     return true;
2573   }
2574   else
2575     return false;
2576 
2577   QualType FromPointeeType;
2578   if (const PointerType *FromCPtr = FromType->getAs<PointerType>())
2579     FromPointeeType = FromCPtr->getPointeeType();
2580   else if (const BlockPointerType *FromBlockPtr =
2581            FromType->getAs<BlockPointerType>())
2582     FromPointeeType = FromBlockPtr->getPointeeType();
2583   else
2584     return false;
2585 
2586   // If we have pointers to pointers, recursively check whether this
2587   // is an Objective-C conversion.
2588   if (FromPointeeType->isPointerType() && ToPointeeType->isPointerType() &&
2589       isObjCPointerConversion(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType, ConvertedType,
2590                               IncompatibleObjC)) {
2591     // We always complain about this conversion.
2592     IncompatibleObjC = true;
2593     ConvertedType = Context.getPointerType(ConvertedType);
2594     ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ConvertedType, FromQualifiers);
2595     return true;
2596   }
2597   // Allow conversion of pointee being objective-c pointer to another one;
2598   // as in I* to id.
2599   if (FromPointeeType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>() &&
2600       ToPointeeType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>() &&
2601       isObjCPointerConversion(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType, ConvertedType,
2602                               IncompatibleObjC)) {
2603 
2604     ConvertedType = Context.getPointerType(ConvertedType);
2605     ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ConvertedType, FromQualifiers);
2606     return true;
2607   }
2608 
2609   // If we have pointers to functions or blocks, check whether the only
2610   // differences in the argument and result types are in Objective-C
2611   // pointer conversions. If so, we permit the conversion (but
2612   // complain about it).
2613   const FunctionProtoType *FromFunctionType
2614     = FromPointeeType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
2615   const FunctionProtoType *ToFunctionType
2616     = ToPointeeType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
2617   if (FromFunctionType && ToFunctionType) {
2618     // If the function types are exactly the same, this isn't an
2619     // Objective-C pointer conversion.
2620     if (Context.getCanonicalType(FromPointeeType)
2621           == Context.getCanonicalType(ToPointeeType))
2622       return false;
2623 
2624     // Perform the quick checks that will tell us whether these
2625     // function types are obviously different.
2626     if (FromFunctionType->getNumParams() != ToFunctionType->getNumParams() ||
2627         FromFunctionType->isVariadic() != ToFunctionType->isVariadic() ||
2628         FromFunctionType->getMethodQuals() != ToFunctionType->getMethodQuals())
2629       return false;
2630 
2631     bool HasObjCConversion = false;
2632     if (Context.getCanonicalType(FromFunctionType->getReturnType()) ==
2633         Context.getCanonicalType(ToFunctionType->getReturnType())) {
2634       // Okay, the types match exactly. Nothing to do.
2635     } else if (isObjCPointerConversion(FromFunctionType->getReturnType(),
2636                                        ToFunctionType->getReturnType(),
2637                                        ConvertedType, IncompatibleObjC)) {
2638       // Okay, we have an Objective-C pointer conversion.
2639       HasObjCConversion = true;
2640     } else {
2641       // Function types are too different. Abort.
2642       return false;
2643     }
2644 
2645     // Check argument types.
2646     for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, NumArgs = FromFunctionType->getNumParams();
2647          ArgIdx != NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
2648       QualType FromArgType = FromFunctionType->getParamType(ArgIdx);
2649       QualType ToArgType = ToFunctionType->getParamType(ArgIdx);
2650       if (Context.getCanonicalType(FromArgType)
2651             == Context.getCanonicalType(ToArgType)) {
2652         // Okay, the types match exactly. Nothing to do.
2653       } else if (isObjCPointerConversion(FromArgType, ToArgType,
2654                                          ConvertedType, IncompatibleObjC)) {
2655         // Okay, we have an Objective-C pointer conversion.
2656         HasObjCConversion = true;
2657       } else {
2658         // Argument types are too different. Abort.
2659         return false;
2660       }
2661     }
2662 
2663     if (HasObjCConversion) {
2664       // We had an Objective-C conversion. Allow this pointer
2665       // conversion, but complain about it.
2666       ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ToType, FromQualifiers);
2667       IncompatibleObjC = true;
2668       return true;
2669     }
2670   }
2671 
2672   return false;
2673 }
2674 
2675 /// Determine whether this is an Objective-C writeback conversion,
2676 /// used for parameter passing when performing automatic reference counting.
2677 ///
2678 /// \param FromType The type we're converting form.
2679 ///
2680 /// \param ToType The type we're converting to.
2681 ///
2682 /// \param ConvertedType The type that will be produced after applying
2683 /// this conversion.
2684 bool Sema::isObjCWritebackConversion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType,
2685                                      QualType &ConvertedType) {
2686   if (!getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount ||
2687       Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType))
2688     return false;
2689 
2690   // Parameter must be a pointer to __autoreleasing (with no other qualifiers).
2691   QualType ToPointee;
2692   if (const PointerType *ToPointer = ToType->getAs<PointerType>())
2693     ToPointee = ToPointer->getPointeeType();
2694   else
2695     return false;
2696 
2697   Qualifiers ToQuals = ToPointee.getQualifiers();
2698   if (!ToPointee->isObjCLifetimeType() ||
2699       ToQuals.getObjCLifetime() != Qualifiers::OCL_Autoreleasing ||
2700       !ToQuals.withoutObjCLifetime().empty())
2701     return false;
2702 
2703   // Argument must be a pointer to __strong to __weak.
2704   QualType FromPointee;
2705   if (const PointerType *FromPointer = FromType->getAs<PointerType>())
2706     FromPointee = FromPointer->getPointeeType();
2707   else
2708     return false;
2709 
2710   Qualifiers FromQuals = FromPointee.getQualifiers();
2711   if (!FromPointee->isObjCLifetimeType() ||
2712       (FromQuals.getObjCLifetime() != Qualifiers::OCL_Strong &&
2713        FromQuals.getObjCLifetime() != Qualifiers::OCL_Weak))
2714     return false;
2715 
2716   // Make sure that we have compatible qualifiers.
2717   FromQuals.setObjCLifetime(Qualifiers::OCL_Autoreleasing);
2718   if (!ToQuals.compatiblyIncludes(FromQuals))
2719     return false;
2720 
2721   // Remove qualifiers from the pointee type we're converting from; they
2722   // aren't used in the compatibility check belong, and we'll be adding back
2723   // qualifiers (with __autoreleasing) if the compatibility check succeeds.
2724   FromPointee = FromPointee.getUnqualifiedType();
2725 
2726   // The unqualified form of the pointee types must be compatible.
2727   ToPointee = ToPointee.getUnqualifiedType();
2728   bool IncompatibleObjC;
2729   if (Context.typesAreCompatible(FromPointee, ToPointee))
2730     FromPointee = ToPointee;
2731   else if (!isObjCPointerConversion(FromPointee, ToPointee, FromPointee,
2732                                     IncompatibleObjC))
2733     return false;
2734 
2735   /// Construct the type we're converting to, which is a pointer to
2736   /// __autoreleasing pointee.
2737   FromPointee = Context.getQualifiedType(FromPointee, FromQuals);
2738   ConvertedType = Context.getPointerType(FromPointee);
2739   return true;
2740 }
2741 
2742 bool Sema::IsBlockPointerConversion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType,
2743                                     QualType& ConvertedType) {
2744   QualType ToPointeeType;
2745   if (const BlockPointerType *ToBlockPtr =
2746         ToType->getAs<BlockPointerType>())
2747     ToPointeeType = ToBlockPtr->getPointeeType();
2748   else
2749     return false;
2750 
2751   QualType FromPointeeType;
2752   if (const BlockPointerType *FromBlockPtr =
2753       FromType->getAs<BlockPointerType>())
2754     FromPointeeType = FromBlockPtr->getPointeeType();
2755   else
2756     return false;
2757   // We have pointer to blocks, check whether the only
2758   // differences in the argument and result types are in Objective-C
2759   // pointer conversions. If so, we permit the conversion.
2760 
2761   const FunctionProtoType *FromFunctionType
2762     = FromPointeeType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
2763   const FunctionProtoType *ToFunctionType
2764     = ToPointeeType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
2765 
2766   if (!FromFunctionType || !ToFunctionType)
2767     return false;
2768 
2769   if (Context.hasSameType(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType))
2770     return true;
2771 
2772   // Perform the quick checks that will tell us whether these
2773   // function types are obviously different.
2774   if (FromFunctionType->getNumParams() != ToFunctionType->getNumParams() ||
2775       FromFunctionType->isVariadic() != ToFunctionType->isVariadic())
2776     return false;
2777 
2778   FunctionType::ExtInfo FromEInfo = FromFunctionType->getExtInfo();
2779   FunctionType::ExtInfo ToEInfo = ToFunctionType->getExtInfo();
2780   if (FromEInfo != ToEInfo)
2781     return false;
2782 
2783   bool IncompatibleObjC = false;
2784   if (Context.hasSameType(FromFunctionType->getReturnType(),
2785                           ToFunctionType->getReturnType())) {
2786     // Okay, the types match exactly. Nothing to do.
2787   } else {
2788     QualType RHS = FromFunctionType->getReturnType();
2789     QualType LHS = ToFunctionType->getReturnType();
2790     if ((!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus || !RHS->isRecordType()) &&
2791         !RHS.hasQualifiers() && LHS.hasQualifiers())
2792        LHS = LHS.getUnqualifiedType();
2793 
2794      if (Context.hasSameType(RHS,LHS)) {
2795        // OK exact match.
2796      } else if (isObjCPointerConversion(RHS, LHS,
2797                                         ConvertedType, IncompatibleObjC)) {
2798      if (IncompatibleObjC)
2799        return false;
2800      // Okay, we have an Objective-C pointer conversion.
2801      }
2802      else
2803        return false;
2804    }
2805 
2806    // Check argument types.
2807    for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, NumArgs = FromFunctionType->getNumParams();
2808         ArgIdx != NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
2809      IncompatibleObjC = false;
2810      QualType FromArgType = FromFunctionType->getParamType(ArgIdx);
2811      QualType ToArgType = ToFunctionType->getParamType(ArgIdx);
2812      if (Context.hasSameType(FromArgType, ToArgType)) {
2813        // Okay, the types match exactly. Nothing to do.
2814      } else if (isObjCPointerConversion(ToArgType, FromArgType,
2815                                         ConvertedType, IncompatibleObjC)) {
2816        if (IncompatibleObjC)
2817          return false;
2818        // Okay, we have an Objective-C pointer conversion.
2819      } else
2820        // Argument types are too different. Abort.
2821        return false;
2822    }
2823 
2824    SmallVector<FunctionProtoType::ExtParameterInfo, 4> NewParamInfos;
2825    bool CanUseToFPT, CanUseFromFPT;
2826    if (!Context.mergeExtParameterInfo(ToFunctionType, FromFunctionType,
2827                                       CanUseToFPT, CanUseFromFPT,
2828                                       NewParamInfos))
2829      return false;
2830 
2831    ConvertedType = ToType;
2832    return true;
2833 }
2834 
2835 enum {
2836   ft_default,
2837   ft_different_class,
2838   ft_parameter_arity,
2839   ft_parameter_mismatch,
2840   ft_return_type,
2841   ft_qualifer_mismatch,
2842   ft_noexcept
2843 };
2844 
2845 /// Attempts to get the FunctionProtoType from a Type. Handles
2846 /// MemberFunctionPointers properly.
2847 static const FunctionProtoType *tryGetFunctionProtoType(QualType FromType) {
2848   if (auto *FPT = FromType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>())
2849     return FPT;
2850 
2851   if (auto *MPT = FromType->getAs<MemberPointerType>())
2852     return MPT->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
2853 
2854   return nullptr;
2855 }
2856 
2857 /// HandleFunctionTypeMismatch - Gives diagnostic information for differeing
2858 /// function types.  Catches different number of parameter, mismatch in
2859 /// parameter types, and different return types.
2860 void Sema::HandleFunctionTypeMismatch(PartialDiagnostic &PDiag,
2861                                       QualType FromType, QualType ToType) {
2862   // If either type is not valid, include no extra info.
2863   if (FromType.isNull() || ToType.isNull()) {
2864     PDiag << ft_default;
2865     return;
2866   }
2867 
2868   // Get the function type from the pointers.
2869   if (FromType->isMemberPointerType() && ToType->isMemberPointerType()) {
2870     const auto *FromMember = FromType->castAs<MemberPointerType>(),
2871                *ToMember = ToType->castAs<MemberPointerType>();
2872     if (!Context.hasSameType(FromMember->getClass(), ToMember->getClass())) {
2873       PDiag << ft_different_class << QualType(ToMember->getClass(), 0)
2874             << QualType(FromMember->getClass(), 0);
2875       return;
2876     }
2877     FromType = FromMember->getPointeeType();
2878     ToType = ToMember->getPointeeType();
2879   }
2880 
2881   if (FromType->isPointerType())
2882     FromType = FromType->getPointeeType();
2883   if (ToType->isPointerType())
2884     ToType = ToType->getPointeeType();
2885 
2886   // Remove references.
2887   FromType = FromType.getNonReferenceType();
2888   ToType = ToType.getNonReferenceType();
2889 
2890   // Don't print extra info for non-specialized template functions.
2891   if (FromType->isInstantiationDependentType() &&
2892       !FromType->getAs<TemplateSpecializationType>()) {
2893     PDiag << ft_default;
2894     return;
2895   }
2896 
2897   // No extra info for same types.
2898   if (Context.hasSameType(FromType, ToType)) {
2899     PDiag << ft_default;
2900     return;
2901   }
2902 
2903   const FunctionProtoType *FromFunction = tryGetFunctionProtoType(FromType),
2904                           *ToFunction = tryGetFunctionProtoType(ToType);
2905 
2906   // Both types need to be function types.
2907   if (!FromFunction || !ToFunction) {
2908     PDiag << ft_default;
2909     return;
2910   }
2911 
2912   if (FromFunction->getNumParams() != ToFunction->getNumParams()) {
2913     PDiag << ft_parameter_arity << ToFunction->getNumParams()
2914           << FromFunction->getNumParams();
2915     return;
2916   }
2917 
2918   // Handle different parameter types.
2919   unsigned ArgPos;
2920   if (!FunctionParamTypesAreEqual(FromFunction, ToFunction, &ArgPos)) {
2921     PDiag << ft_parameter_mismatch << ArgPos + 1
2922           << ToFunction->getParamType(ArgPos)
2923           << FromFunction->getParamType(ArgPos);
2924     return;
2925   }
2926 
2927   // Handle different return type.
2928   if (!Context.hasSameType(FromFunction->getReturnType(),
2929                            ToFunction->getReturnType())) {
2930     PDiag << ft_return_type << ToFunction->getReturnType()
2931           << FromFunction->getReturnType();
2932     return;
2933   }
2934 
2935   if (FromFunction->getMethodQuals() != ToFunction->getMethodQuals()) {
2936     PDiag << ft_qualifer_mismatch << ToFunction->getMethodQuals()
2937           << FromFunction->getMethodQuals();
2938     return;
2939   }
2940 
2941   // Handle exception specification differences on canonical type (in C++17
2942   // onwards).
2943   if (cast<FunctionProtoType>(FromFunction->getCanonicalTypeUnqualified())
2944           ->isNothrow() !=
2945       cast<FunctionProtoType>(ToFunction->getCanonicalTypeUnqualified())
2946           ->isNothrow()) {
2947     PDiag << ft_noexcept;
2948     return;
2949   }
2950 
2951   // Unable to find a difference, so add no extra info.
2952   PDiag << ft_default;
2953 }
2954 
2955 /// FunctionParamTypesAreEqual - This routine checks two function proto types
2956 /// for equality of their argument types. Caller has already checked that
2957 /// they have same number of arguments.  If the parameters are different,
2958 /// ArgPos will have the parameter index of the first different parameter.
2959 bool Sema::FunctionParamTypesAreEqual(const FunctionProtoType *OldType,
2960                                       const FunctionProtoType *NewType,
2961                                       unsigned *ArgPos) {
2962   for (FunctionProtoType::param_type_iterator O = OldType->param_type_begin(),
2963                                               N = NewType->param_type_begin(),
2964                                               E = OldType->param_type_end();
2965        O && (O != E); ++O, ++N) {
2966     // Ignore address spaces in pointee type. This is to disallow overloading
2967     // on __ptr32/__ptr64 address spaces.
2968     QualType Old = Context.removePtrSizeAddrSpace(O->getUnqualifiedType());
2969     QualType New = Context.removePtrSizeAddrSpace(N->getUnqualifiedType());
2970 
2971     if (!Context.hasSameType(Old, New)) {
2972       if (ArgPos)
2973         *ArgPos = O - OldType->param_type_begin();
2974       return false;
2975     }
2976   }
2977   return true;
2978 }
2979 
2980 /// CheckPointerConversion - Check the pointer conversion from the
2981 /// expression From to the type ToType. This routine checks for
2982 /// ambiguous or inaccessible derived-to-base pointer
2983 /// conversions for which IsPointerConversion has already returned
2984 /// true. It returns true and produces a diagnostic if there was an
2985 /// error, or returns false otherwise.
2986 bool Sema::CheckPointerConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType,
2987                                   CastKind &Kind,
2988                                   CXXCastPath& BasePath,
2989                                   bool IgnoreBaseAccess,
2990                                   bool Diagnose) {
2991   QualType FromType = From->getType();
2992   bool IsCStyleOrFunctionalCast = IgnoreBaseAccess;
2993 
2994   Kind = CK_BitCast;
2995 
2996   if (Diagnose && !IsCStyleOrFunctionalCast && !FromType->isAnyPointerType() &&
2997       From->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull) ==
2998           Expr::NPCK_ZeroExpression) {
2999     if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(From->getType(), Context.BoolTy))
3000       DiagRuntimeBehavior(From->getExprLoc(), From,
3001                           PDiag(diag::warn_impcast_bool_to_null_pointer)
3002                             << ToType << From->getSourceRange());
3003     else if (!isUnevaluatedContext())
3004       Diag(From->getExprLoc(), diag::warn_non_literal_null_pointer)
3005         << ToType << From->getSourceRange();
3006   }
3007   if (const PointerType *ToPtrType = ToType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
3008     if (const PointerType *FromPtrType = FromType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
3009       QualType FromPointeeType = FromPtrType->getPointeeType(),
3010                ToPointeeType   = ToPtrType->getPointeeType();
3011 
3012       if (FromPointeeType->isRecordType() && ToPointeeType->isRecordType() &&
3013           !Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType)) {
3014         // We must have a derived-to-base conversion. Check an
3015         // ambiguous or inaccessible conversion.
3016         unsigned InaccessibleID = 0;
3017         unsigned AmbiguousID = 0;
3018         if (Diagnose) {
3019           InaccessibleID = diag::err_upcast_to_inaccessible_base;
3020           AmbiguousID = diag::err_ambiguous_derived_to_base_conv;
3021         }
3022         if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(
3023                 FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType, InaccessibleID, AmbiguousID,
3024                 From->getExprLoc(), From->getSourceRange(), DeclarationName(),
3025                 &BasePath, IgnoreBaseAccess))
3026           return true;
3027 
3028         // The conversion was successful.
3029         Kind = CK_DerivedToBase;
3030       }
3031 
3032       if (Diagnose && !IsCStyleOrFunctionalCast &&
3033           FromPointeeType->isFunctionType() && ToPointeeType->isVoidType()) {
3034         assert(getLangOpts().MSVCCompat &&
3035                "this should only be possible with MSVCCompat!");
3036         Diag(From->getExprLoc(), diag::ext_ms_impcast_fn_obj)
3037             << From->getSourceRange();
3038       }
3039     }
3040   } else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *ToPtrType =
3041                ToType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
3042     if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *FromPtrType =
3043           FromType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
3044       // Objective-C++ conversions are always okay.
3045       // FIXME: We should have a different class of conversions for the
3046       // Objective-C++ implicit conversions.
3047       if (FromPtrType->isObjCBuiltinType() || ToPtrType->isObjCBuiltinType())
3048         return false;
3049     } else if (FromType->isBlockPointerType()) {
3050       Kind = CK_BlockPointerToObjCPointerCast;
3051     } else {
3052       Kind = CK_CPointerToObjCPointerCast;
3053     }
3054   } else if (ToType->isBlockPointerType()) {
3055     if (!FromType->isBlockPointerType())
3056       Kind = CK_AnyPointerToBlockPointerCast;
3057   }
3058 
3059   // We shouldn't fall into this case unless it's valid for other
3060   // reasons.
3061   if (From->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull))
3062     Kind = CK_NullToPointer;
3063 
3064   return false;
3065 }
3066 
3067 /// IsMemberPointerConversion - Determines whether the conversion of the
3068 /// expression From, which has the (possibly adjusted) type FromType, can be
3069 /// converted to the type ToType via a member pointer conversion (C++ 4.11).
3070 /// If so, returns true and places the converted type (that might differ from
3071 /// ToType in its cv-qualifiers at some level) into ConvertedType.
3072 bool Sema::IsMemberPointerConversion(Expr *From, QualType FromType,
3073                                      QualType ToType,
3074                                      bool InOverloadResolution,
3075                                      QualType &ConvertedType) {
3076   const MemberPointerType *ToTypePtr = ToType->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
3077   if (!ToTypePtr)
3078     return false;
3079 
3080   // A null pointer constant can be converted to a member pointer (C++ 4.11p1)
3081   if (From->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
3082                     InOverloadResolution? Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull
3083                                         : Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
3084     ConvertedType = ToType;
3085     return true;
3086   }
3087 
3088   // Otherwise, both types have to be member pointers.
3089   const MemberPointerType *FromTypePtr = FromType->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
3090   if (!FromTypePtr)
3091     return false;
3092 
3093   // A pointer to member of B can be converted to a pointer to member of D,
3094   // where D is derived from B (C++ 4.11p2).
3095   QualType FromClass(FromTypePtr->getClass(), 0);
3096   QualType ToClass(ToTypePtr->getClass(), 0);
3097 
3098   if (!Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromClass, ToClass) &&
3099       IsDerivedFrom(From->getBeginLoc(), ToClass, FromClass)) {
3100     ConvertedType = Context.getMemberPointerType(FromTypePtr->getPointeeType(),
3101                                                  ToClass.getTypePtr());
3102     return true;
3103   }
3104 
3105   return false;
3106 }
3107 
3108 /// CheckMemberPointerConversion - Check the member pointer conversion from the
3109 /// expression From to the type ToType. This routine checks for ambiguous or
3110 /// virtual or inaccessible base-to-derived member pointer conversions
3111 /// for which IsMemberPointerConversion has already returned true. It returns
3112 /// true and produces a diagnostic if there was an error, or returns false
3113 /// otherwise.
3114 bool Sema::CheckMemberPointerConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType,
3115                                         CastKind &Kind,
3116                                         CXXCastPath &BasePath,
3117                                         bool IgnoreBaseAccess) {
3118   QualType FromType = From->getType();
3119   const MemberPointerType *FromPtrType = FromType->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
3120   if (!FromPtrType) {
3121     // This must be a null pointer to member pointer conversion
3122     assert(From->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
3123                                        Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull) &&
3124            "Expr must be null pointer constant!");
3125     Kind = CK_NullToMemberPointer;
3126     return false;
3127   }
3128 
3129   const MemberPointerType *ToPtrType = ToType->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
3130   assert(ToPtrType && "No member pointer cast has a target type "
3131                       "that is not a member pointer.");
3132 
3133   QualType FromClass = QualType(FromPtrType->getClass(), 0);
3134   QualType ToClass   = QualType(ToPtrType->getClass(), 0);
3135 
3136   // FIXME: What about dependent types?
3137   assert(FromClass->isRecordType() && "Pointer into non-class.");
3138   assert(ToClass->isRecordType() && "Pointer into non-class.");
3139 
3140   CXXBasePaths Paths(/*FindAmbiguities=*/true, /*RecordPaths=*/true,
3141                      /*DetectVirtual=*/true);
3142   bool DerivationOkay =
3143       IsDerivedFrom(From->getBeginLoc(), ToClass, FromClass, Paths);
3144   assert(DerivationOkay &&
3145          "Should not have been called if derivation isn't OK.");
3146   (void)DerivationOkay;
3147 
3148   if (Paths.isAmbiguous(Context.getCanonicalType(FromClass).
3149                                   getUnqualifiedType())) {
3150     std::string PathDisplayStr = getAmbiguousPathsDisplayString(Paths);
3151     Diag(From->getExprLoc(), diag::err_ambiguous_memptr_conv)
3152       << 0 << FromClass << ToClass << PathDisplayStr << From->getSourceRange();
3153     return true;
3154   }
3155 
3156   if (const RecordType *VBase = Paths.getDetectedVirtual()) {
3157     Diag(From->getExprLoc(), diag::err_memptr_conv_via_virtual)
3158       << FromClass << ToClass << QualType(VBase, 0)
3159       << From->getSourceRange();
3160     return true;
3161   }
3162 
3163   if (!IgnoreBaseAccess)
3164     CheckBaseClassAccess(From->getExprLoc(), FromClass, ToClass,
3165                          Paths.front(),
3166                          diag::err_downcast_from_inaccessible_base);
3167 
3168   // Must be a base to derived member conversion.
3169   BuildBasePathArray(Paths, BasePath);
3170   Kind = CK_BaseToDerivedMemberPointer;
3171   return false;
3172 }
3173 
3174 /// Determine whether the lifetime conversion between the two given
3175 /// qualifiers sets is nontrivial.
3176 static bool isNonTrivialObjCLifetimeConversion(Qualifiers FromQuals,
3177                                                Qualifiers ToQuals) {
3178   // Converting anything to const __unsafe_unretained is trivial.
3179   if (ToQuals.hasConst() &&
3180       ToQuals.getObjCLifetime() == Qualifiers::OCL_ExplicitNone)
3181     return false;
3182 
3183   return true;
3184 }
3185 
3186 /// Perform a single iteration of the loop for checking if a qualification
3187 /// conversion is valid.
3188 ///
3189 /// Specifically, check whether any change between the qualifiers of \p
3190 /// FromType and \p ToType is permissible, given knowledge about whether every
3191 /// outer layer is const-qualified.
3192 static bool isQualificationConversionStep(QualType FromType, QualType ToType,
3193                                           bool CStyle, bool IsTopLevel,
3194                                           bool &PreviousToQualsIncludeConst,
3195                                           bool &ObjCLifetimeConversion) {
3196   Qualifiers FromQuals = FromType.getQualifiers();
3197   Qualifiers ToQuals = ToType.getQualifiers();
3198 
3199   // Ignore __unaligned qualifier if this type is void.
3200   if (ToType.getUnqualifiedType()->isVoidType())
3201     FromQuals.removeUnaligned();
3202 
3203   // Objective-C ARC:
3204   //   Check Objective-C lifetime conversions.
3205   if (FromQuals.getObjCLifetime() != ToQuals.getObjCLifetime()) {
3206     if (ToQuals.compatiblyIncludesObjCLifetime(FromQuals)) {
3207       if (isNonTrivialObjCLifetimeConversion(FromQuals, ToQuals))
3208         ObjCLifetimeConversion = true;
3209       FromQuals.removeObjCLifetime();
3210       ToQuals.removeObjCLifetime();
3211     } else {
3212       // Qualification conversions cannot cast between different
3213       // Objective-C lifetime qualifiers.
3214       return false;
3215     }
3216   }
3217 
3218   // Allow addition/removal of GC attributes but not changing GC attributes.
3219   if (FromQuals.getObjCGCAttr() != ToQuals.getObjCGCAttr() &&
3220       (!FromQuals.hasObjCGCAttr() || !ToQuals.hasObjCGCAttr())) {
3221     FromQuals.removeObjCGCAttr();
3222     ToQuals.removeObjCGCAttr();
3223   }
3224 
3225   //   -- for every j > 0, if const is in cv 1,j then const is in cv
3226   //      2,j, and similarly for volatile.
3227   if (!CStyle && !ToQuals.compatiblyIncludes(FromQuals))
3228     return false;
3229 
3230   // If address spaces mismatch:
3231   //  - in top level it is only valid to convert to addr space that is a
3232   //    superset in all cases apart from C-style casts where we allow
3233   //    conversions between overlapping address spaces.
3234   //  - in non-top levels it is not a valid conversion.
3235   if (ToQuals.getAddressSpace() != FromQuals.getAddressSpace() &&
3236       (!IsTopLevel ||
3237        !(ToQuals.isAddressSpaceSupersetOf(FromQuals) ||
3238          (CStyle && FromQuals.isAddressSpaceSupersetOf(ToQuals)))))
3239     return false;
3240 
3241   //   -- if the cv 1,j and cv 2,j are different, then const is in
3242   //      every cv for 0 < k < j.
3243   if (!CStyle && FromQuals.getCVRQualifiers() != ToQuals.getCVRQualifiers() &&
3244       !PreviousToQualsIncludeConst)
3245     return false;
3246 
3247   // Keep track of whether all prior cv-qualifiers in the "to" type
3248   // include const.
3249   PreviousToQualsIncludeConst =
3250       PreviousToQualsIncludeConst && ToQuals.hasConst();
3251   return true;
3252 }
3253 
3254 /// IsQualificationConversion - Determines whether the conversion from
3255 /// an rvalue of type FromType to ToType is a qualification conversion
3256 /// (C++ 4.4).
3257 ///
3258 /// \param ObjCLifetimeConversion Output parameter that will be set to indicate
3259 /// when the qualification conversion involves a change in the Objective-C
3260 /// object lifetime.
3261 bool
3262 Sema::IsQualificationConversion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType,
3263                                 bool CStyle, bool &ObjCLifetimeConversion) {
3264   FromType = Context.getCanonicalType(FromType);
3265   ToType = Context.getCanonicalType(ToType);
3266   ObjCLifetimeConversion = false;
3267 
3268   // If FromType and ToType are the same type, this is not a
3269   // qualification conversion.
3270   if (FromType.getUnqualifiedType() == ToType.getUnqualifiedType())
3271     return false;
3272 
3273   // (C++ 4.4p4):
3274   //   A conversion can add cv-qualifiers at levels other than the first
3275   //   in multi-level pointers, subject to the following rules: [...]
3276   bool PreviousToQualsIncludeConst = true;
3277   bool UnwrappedAnyPointer = false;
3278   while (Context.UnwrapSimilarTypes(FromType, ToType)) {
3279     if (!isQualificationConversionStep(
3280             FromType, ToType, CStyle, !UnwrappedAnyPointer,
3281             PreviousToQualsIncludeConst, ObjCLifetimeConversion))
3282       return false;
3283     UnwrappedAnyPointer = true;
3284   }
3285 
3286   // We are left with FromType and ToType being the pointee types
3287   // after unwrapping the original FromType and ToType the same number
3288   // of times. If we unwrapped any pointers, and if FromType and
3289   // ToType have the same unqualified type (since we checked
3290   // qualifiers above), then this is a qualification conversion.
3291   return UnwrappedAnyPointer && Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType,ToType);
3292 }
3293 
3294 /// - Determine whether this is a conversion from a scalar type to an
3295 /// atomic type.
3296 ///
3297 /// If successful, updates \c SCS's second and third steps in the conversion
3298 /// sequence to finish the conversion.
3299 static bool tryAtomicConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
3300                                 bool InOverloadResolution,
3301                                 StandardConversionSequence &SCS,
3302                                 bool CStyle) {
3303   const AtomicType *ToAtomic = ToType->getAs<AtomicType>();
3304   if (!ToAtomic)
3305     return false;
3306 
3307   StandardConversionSequence InnerSCS;
3308   if (!IsStandardConversion(S, From, ToAtomic->getValueType(),
3309                             InOverloadResolution, InnerSCS,
3310                             CStyle, /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/false))
3311     return false;
3312 
3313   SCS.Second = InnerSCS.Second;
3314   SCS.setToType(1, InnerSCS.getToType(1));
3315   SCS.Third = InnerSCS.Third;
3316   SCS.QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime
3317     = InnerSCS.QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime;
3318   SCS.setToType(2, InnerSCS.getToType(2));
3319   return true;
3320 }
3321 
3322 static bool isFirstArgumentCompatibleWithType(ASTContext &Context,
3323                                               CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor,
3324                                               QualType Type) {
3325   const auto *CtorType = Constructor->getType()->castAs<FunctionProtoType>();
3326   if (CtorType->getNumParams() > 0) {
3327     QualType FirstArg = CtorType->getParamType(0);
3328     if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(Type, FirstArg.getNonReferenceType()))
3329       return true;
3330   }
3331   return false;
3332 }
3333 
3334 static OverloadingResult
3335 IsInitializerListConstructorConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
3336                                        CXXRecordDecl *To,
3337                                        UserDefinedConversionSequence &User,
3338                                        OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet,
3339                                        bool AllowExplicit) {
3340   CandidateSet.clear(OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_InitByUserDefinedConversion);
3341   for (auto *D : S.LookupConstructors(To)) {
3342     auto Info = getConstructorInfo(D);
3343     if (!Info)
3344       continue;
3345 
3346     bool Usable = !Info.Constructor->isInvalidDecl() &&
3347                   S.isInitListConstructor(Info.Constructor);
3348     if (Usable) {
3349       // If the first argument is (a reference to) the target type,
3350       // suppress conversions.
3351       bool SuppressUserConversions = isFirstArgumentCompatibleWithType(
3352           S.Context, Info.Constructor, ToType);
3353       if (Info.ConstructorTmpl)
3354         S.AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(Info.ConstructorTmpl, Info.FoundDecl,
3355                                        /*ExplicitArgs*/ nullptr, From,
3356                                        CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions,
3357                                        /*PartialOverloading*/ false,
3358                                        AllowExplicit);
3359       else
3360         S.AddOverloadCandidate(Info.Constructor, Info.FoundDecl, From,
3361                                CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions,
3362                                /*PartialOverloading*/ false, AllowExplicit);
3363     }
3364   }
3365 
3366   bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1);
3367 
3368   OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
3369   switch (auto Result =
3370               CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(S, From->getBeginLoc(), Best)) {
3371   case OR_Deleted:
3372   case OR_Success: {
3373     // Record the standard conversion we used and the conversion function.
3374     CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor = cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Best->Function);
3375     QualType ThisType = Constructor->getThisType();
3376     // Initializer lists don't have conversions as such.
3377     User.Before.setAsIdentityConversion();
3378     User.HadMultipleCandidates = HadMultipleCandidates;
3379     User.ConversionFunction = Constructor;
3380     User.FoundConversionFunction = Best->FoundDecl;
3381     User.After.setAsIdentityConversion();
3382     User.After.setFromType(ThisType->castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType());
3383     User.After.setAllToTypes(ToType);
3384     return Result;
3385   }
3386 
3387   case OR_No_Viable_Function:
3388     return OR_No_Viable_Function;
3389   case OR_Ambiguous:
3390     return OR_Ambiguous;
3391   }
3392 
3393   llvm_unreachable("Invalid OverloadResult!");
3394 }
3395 
3396 /// Determines whether there is a user-defined conversion sequence
3397 /// (C++ [over.ics.user]) that converts expression From to the type
3398 /// ToType. If such a conversion exists, User will contain the
3399 /// user-defined conversion sequence that performs such a conversion
3400 /// and this routine will return true. Otherwise, this routine returns
3401 /// false and User is unspecified.
3402 ///
3403 /// \param AllowExplicit  true if the conversion should consider C++0x
3404 /// "explicit" conversion functions as well as non-explicit conversion
3405 /// functions (C++0x [class.conv.fct]p2).
3406 ///
3407 /// \param AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit true if the conversion should
3408 /// allow an extra Objective-C pointer conversion on uses of explicit
3409 /// constructors. Requires \c AllowExplicit to also be set.
3410 static OverloadingResult
3411 IsUserDefinedConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
3412                         UserDefinedConversionSequence &User,
3413                         OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet,
3414                         AllowedExplicit AllowExplicit,
3415                         bool AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit) {
3416   assert(AllowExplicit != AllowedExplicit::None ||
3417          !AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit);
3418   CandidateSet.clear(OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_InitByUserDefinedConversion);
3419 
3420   // Whether we will only visit constructors.
3421   bool ConstructorsOnly = false;
3422 
3423   // If the type we are conversion to is a class type, enumerate its
3424   // constructors.
3425   if (const RecordType *ToRecordType = ToType->getAs<RecordType>()) {
3426     // C++ [over.match.ctor]p1:
3427     //   When objects of class type are direct-initialized (8.5), or
3428     //   copy-initialized from an expression of the same or a
3429     //   derived class type (8.5), overload resolution selects the
3430     //   constructor. [...] For copy-initialization, the candidate
3431     //   functions are all the converting constructors (12.3.1) of
3432     //   that class. The argument list is the expression-list within
3433     //   the parentheses of the initializer.
3434     if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType, From->getType()) ||
3435         (From->getType()->getAs<RecordType>() &&
3436          S.IsDerivedFrom(From->getBeginLoc(), From->getType(), ToType)))
3437       ConstructorsOnly = true;
3438 
3439     if (!S.isCompleteType(From->getExprLoc(), ToType)) {
3440       // We're not going to find any constructors.
3441     } else if (CXXRecordDecl *ToRecordDecl
3442                  = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(ToRecordType->getDecl())) {
3443 
3444       Expr **Args = &From;
3445       unsigned NumArgs = 1;
3446       bool ListInitializing = false;
3447       if (InitListExpr *InitList = dyn_cast<InitListExpr>(From)) {
3448         // But first, see if there is an init-list-constructor that will work.
3449         OverloadingResult Result = IsInitializerListConstructorConversion(
3450             S, From, ToType, ToRecordDecl, User, CandidateSet,
3451             AllowExplicit == AllowedExplicit::All);
3452         if (Result != OR_No_Viable_Function)
3453           return Result;
3454         // Never mind.
3455         CandidateSet.clear(
3456             OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_InitByUserDefinedConversion);
3457 
3458         // If we're list-initializing, we pass the individual elements as
3459         // arguments, not the entire list.
3460         Args = InitList->getInits();
3461         NumArgs = InitList->getNumInits();
3462         ListInitializing = true;
3463       }
3464 
3465       for (auto *D : S.LookupConstructors(ToRecordDecl)) {
3466         auto Info = getConstructorInfo(D);
3467         if (!Info)
3468           continue;
3469 
3470         bool Usable = !Info.Constructor->isInvalidDecl();
3471         if (!ListInitializing)
3472           Usable = Usable && Info.Constructor->isConvertingConstructor(
3473                                  /*AllowExplicit*/ true);
3474         if (Usable) {
3475           bool SuppressUserConversions = !ConstructorsOnly;
3476           if (SuppressUserConversions && ListInitializing) {
3477             SuppressUserConversions = false;
3478             if (NumArgs == 1) {
3479               // If the first argument is (a reference to) the target type,
3480               // suppress conversions.
3481               SuppressUserConversions = isFirstArgumentCompatibleWithType(
3482                   S.Context, Info.Constructor, ToType);
3483             }
3484           }
3485           if (Info.ConstructorTmpl)
3486             S.AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(
3487                 Info.ConstructorTmpl, Info.FoundDecl,
3488                 /*ExplicitArgs*/ nullptr, llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs),
3489                 CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions,
3490                 /*PartialOverloading*/ false,
3491                 AllowExplicit == AllowedExplicit::All);
3492           else
3493             // Allow one user-defined conversion when user specifies a
3494             // From->ToType conversion via an static cast (c-style, etc).
3495             S.AddOverloadCandidate(Info.Constructor, Info.FoundDecl,
3496                                    llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs),
3497                                    CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions,
3498                                    /*PartialOverloading*/ false,
3499                                    AllowExplicit == AllowedExplicit::All);
3500         }
3501       }
3502     }
3503   }
3504 
3505   // Enumerate conversion functions, if we're allowed to.
3506   if (ConstructorsOnly || isa<InitListExpr>(From)) {
3507   } else if (!S.isCompleteType(From->getBeginLoc(), From->getType())) {
3508     // No conversion functions from incomplete types.
3509   } else if (const RecordType *FromRecordType =
3510                  From->getType()->getAs<RecordType>()) {
3511     if (CXXRecordDecl *FromRecordDecl
3512          = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(FromRecordType->getDecl())) {
3513       // Add all of the conversion functions as candidates.
3514       const auto &Conversions = FromRecordDecl->getVisibleConversionFunctions();
3515       for (auto I = Conversions.begin(), E = Conversions.end(); I != E; ++I) {
3516         DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = I.getPair();
3517         NamedDecl *D = FoundDecl.getDecl();
3518         CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D->getDeclContext());
3519         if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D))
3520           D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl();
3521 
3522         CXXConversionDecl *Conv;
3523         FunctionTemplateDecl *ConvTemplate;
3524         if ((ConvTemplate = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D)))
3525           Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(ConvTemplate->getTemplatedDecl());
3526         else
3527           Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D);
3528 
3529         if (ConvTemplate)
3530           S.AddTemplateConversionCandidate(
3531               ConvTemplate, FoundDecl, ActingContext, From, ToType,
3532               CandidateSet, AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit,
3533               AllowExplicit != AllowedExplicit::None);
3534         else
3535           S.AddConversionCandidate(Conv, FoundDecl, ActingContext, From, ToType,
3536                                    CandidateSet, AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit,
3537                                    AllowExplicit != AllowedExplicit::None);
3538       }
3539     }
3540   }
3541 
3542   bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1);
3543 
3544   OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
3545   switch (auto Result =
3546               CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(S, From->getBeginLoc(), Best)) {
3547   case OR_Success:
3548   case OR_Deleted:
3549     // Record the standard conversion we used and the conversion function.
3550     if (CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor
3551           = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Best->Function)) {
3552       // C++ [over.ics.user]p1:
3553       //   If the user-defined conversion is specified by a
3554       //   constructor (12.3.1), the initial standard conversion
3555       //   sequence converts the source type to the type required by
3556       //   the argument of the constructor.
3557       //
3558       QualType ThisType = Constructor->getThisType();
3559       if (isa<InitListExpr>(From)) {
3560         // Initializer lists don't have conversions as such.
3561         User.Before.setAsIdentityConversion();
3562       } else {
3563         if (Best->Conversions[0].isEllipsis())
3564           User.EllipsisConversion = true;
3565         else {
3566           User.Before = Best->Conversions[0].Standard;
3567           User.EllipsisConversion = false;
3568         }
3569       }
3570       User.HadMultipleCandidates = HadMultipleCandidates;
3571       User.ConversionFunction = Constructor;
3572       User.FoundConversionFunction = Best->FoundDecl;
3573       User.After.setAsIdentityConversion();
3574       User.After.setFromType(ThisType->castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType());
3575       User.After.setAllToTypes(ToType);
3576       return Result;
3577     }
3578     if (CXXConversionDecl *Conversion
3579                  = dyn_cast<CXXConversionDecl>(Best->Function)) {
3580       // C++ [over.ics.user]p1:
3581       //
3582       //   [...] If the user-defined conversion is specified by a
3583       //   conversion function (12.3.2), the initial standard
3584       //   conversion sequence converts the source type to the
3585       //   implicit object parameter of the conversion function.
3586       User.Before = Best->Conversions[0].Standard;
3587       User.HadMultipleCandidates = HadMultipleCandidates;
3588       User.ConversionFunction = Conversion;
3589       User.FoundConversionFunction = Best->FoundDecl;
3590       User.EllipsisConversion = false;
3591 
3592       // C++ [over.ics.user]p2:
3593       //   The second standard conversion sequence converts the
3594       //   result of the user-defined conversion to the target type
3595       //   for the sequence. Since an implicit conversion sequence
3596       //   is an initialization, the special rules for
3597       //   initialization by user-defined conversion apply when
3598       //   selecting the best user-defined conversion for a
3599       //   user-defined conversion sequence (see 13.3.3 and
3600       //   13.3.3.1).
3601       User.After = Best->FinalConversion;
3602       return Result;
3603     }
3604     llvm_unreachable("Not a constructor or conversion function?");
3605 
3606   case OR_No_Viable_Function:
3607     return OR_No_Viable_Function;
3608 
3609   case OR_Ambiguous:
3610     return OR_Ambiguous;
3611   }
3612 
3613   llvm_unreachable("Invalid OverloadResult!");
3614 }
3615 
3616 bool
3617 Sema::DiagnoseMultipleUserDefinedConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType) {
3618   ImplicitConversionSequence ICS;
3619   OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(From->getExprLoc(),
3620                                     OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Normal);
3621   OverloadingResult OvResult =
3622     IsUserDefinedConversion(*this, From, ToType, ICS.UserDefined,
3623                             CandidateSet, AllowedExplicit::None, false);
3624 
3625   if (!(OvResult == OR_Ambiguous ||
3626         (OvResult == OR_No_Viable_Function && !CandidateSet.empty())))
3627     return false;
3628 
3629   auto Cands = CandidateSet.CompleteCandidates(
3630       *this,
3631       OvResult == OR_Ambiguous ? OCD_AmbiguousCandidates : OCD_AllCandidates,
3632       From);
3633   if (OvResult == OR_Ambiguous)
3634     Diag(From->getBeginLoc(), diag::err_typecheck_ambiguous_condition)
3635         << From->getType() << ToType << From->getSourceRange();
3636   else { // OR_No_Viable_Function && !CandidateSet.empty()
3637     if (!RequireCompleteType(From->getBeginLoc(), ToType,
3638                              diag::err_typecheck_nonviable_condition_incomplete,
3639                              From->getType(), From->getSourceRange()))
3640       Diag(From->getBeginLoc(), diag::err_typecheck_nonviable_condition)
3641           << false << From->getType() << From->getSourceRange() << ToType;
3642   }
3643 
3644   CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(
3645                               *this, From, Cands);
3646   return true;
3647 }
3648 
3649 // Helper for compareConversionFunctions that gets the FunctionType that the
3650 // conversion-operator return  value 'points' to, or nullptr.
3651 static const FunctionType *
3652 getConversionOpReturnTyAsFunction(CXXConversionDecl *Conv) {
3653   const FunctionType *ConvFuncTy = Conv->getType()->castAs<FunctionType>();
3654   const PointerType *RetPtrTy =
3655       ConvFuncTy->getReturnType()->getAs<PointerType>();
3656 
3657   if (!RetPtrTy)
3658     return nullptr;
3659 
3660   return RetPtrTy->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionType>();
3661 }
3662 
3663 /// Compare the user-defined conversion functions or constructors
3664 /// of two user-defined conversion sequences to determine whether any ordering
3665 /// is possible.
3666 static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
3667 compareConversionFunctions(Sema &S, FunctionDecl *Function1,
3668                            FunctionDecl *Function2) {
3669   CXXConversionDecl *Conv1 = dyn_cast_or_null<CXXConversionDecl>(Function1);
3670   CXXConversionDecl *Conv2 = dyn_cast_or_null<CXXConversionDecl>(Function2);
3671   if (!Conv1 || !Conv2)
3672     return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3673 
3674   if (!Conv1->getParent()->isLambda() || !Conv2->getParent()->isLambda())
3675     return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3676 
3677   // Objective-C++:
3678   //   If both conversion functions are implicitly-declared conversions from
3679   //   a lambda closure type to a function pointer and a block pointer,
3680   //   respectively, always prefer the conversion to a function pointer,
3681   //   because the function pointer is more lightweight and is more likely
3682   //   to keep code working.
3683   if (S.getLangOpts().ObjC && S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11) {
3684     bool Block1 = Conv1->getConversionType()->isBlockPointerType();
3685     bool Block2 = Conv2->getConversionType()->isBlockPointerType();
3686     if (Block1 != Block2)
3687       return Block1 ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse
3688                     : ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3689   }
3690 
3691   // In order to support multiple calling conventions for the lambda conversion
3692   // operator (such as when the free and member function calling convention is
3693   // different), prefer the 'free' mechanism, followed by the calling-convention
3694   // of operator(). The latter is in place to support the MSVC-like solution of
3695   // defining ALL of the possible conversions in regards to calling-convention.
3696   const FunctionType *Conv1FuncRet = getConversionOpReturnTyAsFunction(Conv1);
3697   const FunctionType *Conv2FuncRet = getConversionOpReturnTyAsFunction(Conv2);
3698 
3699   if (Conv1FuncRet && Conv2FuncRet &&
3700       Conv1FuncRet->getCallConv() != Conv2FuncRet->getCallConv()) {
3701     CallingConv Conv1CC = Conv1FuncRet->getCallConv();
3702     CallingConv Conv2CC = Conv2FuncRet->getCallConv();
3703 
3704     CXXMethodDecl *CallOp = Conv2->getParent()->getLambdaCallOperator();
3705     const FunctionProtoType *CallOpProto =
3706         CallOp->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
3707 
3708     CallingConv CallOpCC =
3709         CallOp->getType()->getAs<FunctionType>()->getCallConv();
3710     CallingConv DefaultFree = S.Context.getDefaultCallingConvention(
3711         CallOpProto->isVariadic(), /*IsCXXMethod=*/false);
3712     CallingConv DefaultMember = S.Context.getDefaultCallingConvention(
3713         CallOpProto->isVariadic(), /*IsCXXMethod=*/true);
3714 
3715     CallingConv PrefOrder[] = {DefaultFree, DefaultMember, CallOpCC};
3716     for (CallingConv CC : PrefOrder) {
3717       if (Conv1CC == CC)
3718         return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3719       if (Conv2CC == CC)
3720         return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3721     }
3722   }
3723 
3724   return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3725 }
3726 
3727 static bool hasDeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtrConversion(
3728     const ImplicitConversionSequence &ICS) {
3729   return (ICS.isStandard() && ICS.Standard.DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr) ||
3730          (ICS.isUserDefined() &&
3731           ICS.UserDefined.Before.DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr);
3732 }
3733 
3734 /// CompareImplicitConversionSequences - Compare two implicit
3735 /// conversion sequences to determine whether one is better than the
3736 /// other or if they are indistinguishable (C++ 13.3.3.2).
3737 static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
3738 CompareImplicitConversionSequences(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc,
3739                                    const ImplicitConversionSequence& ICS1,
3740                                    const ImplicitConversionSequence& ICS2)
3741 {
3742   // (C++ 13.3.3.2p2): When comparing the basic forms of implicit
3743   // conversion sequences (as defined in 13.3.3.1)
3744   //   -- a standard conversion sequence (13.3.3.1.1) is a better
3745   //      conversion sequence than a user-defined conversion sequence or
3746   //      an ellipsis conversion sequence, and
3747   //   -- a user-defined conversion sequence (13.3.3.1.2) is a better
3748   //      conversion sequence than an ellipsis conversion sequence
3749   //      (13.3.3.1.3).
3750   //
3751   // C++0x [over.best.ics]p10:
3752   //   For the purpose of ranking implicit conversion sequences as
3753   //   described in 13.3.3.2, the ambiguous conversion sequence is
3754   //   treated as a user-defined sequence that is indistinguishable
3755   //   from any other user-defined conversion sequence.
3756 
3757   // String literal to 'char *' conversion has been deprecated in C++03. It has
3758   // been removed from C++11. We still accept this conversion, if it happens at
3759   // the best viable function. Otherwise, this conversion is considered worse
3760   // than ellipsis conversion. Consider this as an extension; this is not in the
3761   // standard. For example:
3762   //
3763   // int &f(...);    // #1
3764   // void f(char*);  // #2
3765   // void g() { int &r = f("foo"); }
3766   //
3767   // In C++03, we pick #2 as the best viable function.
3768   // In C++11, we pick #1 as the best viable function, because ellipsis
3769   // conversion is better than string-literal to char* conversion (since there
3770   // is no such conversion in C++11). If there was no #1 at all or #1 couldn't
3771   // convert arguments, #2 would be the best viable function in C++11.
3772   // If the best viable function has this conversion, a warning will be issued
3773   // in C++03, or an ExtWarn (+SFINAE failure) will be issued in C++11.
3774 
3775   if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 && !S.getLangOpts().WritableStrings &&
3776       hasDeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtrConversion(ICS1) !=
3777       hasDeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtrConversion(ICS2))
3778     return hasDeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtrConversion(ICS1)
3779                ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse
3780                : ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3781 
3782   if (ICS1.getKindRank() < ICS2.getKindRank())
3783     return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3784   if (ICS2.getKindRank() < ICS1.getKindRank())
3785     return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3786 
3787   // The following checks require both conversion sequences to be of
3788   // the same kind.
3789   if (ICS1.getKind() != ICS2.getKind())
3790     return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3791 
3792   ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind Result =
3793       ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3794 
3795   // Two implicit conversion sequences of the same form are
3796   // indistinguishable conversion sequences unless one of the
3797   // following rules apply: (C++ 13.3.3.2p3):
3798 
3799   // List-initialization sequence L1 is a better conversion sequence than
3800   // list-initialization sequence L2 if:
3801   // - L1 converts to std::initializer_list<X> for some X and L2 does not, or,
3802   //   if not that,
3803   // - L1 converts to type "array of N1 T", L2 converts to type "array of N2 T",
3804   //   and N1 is smaller than N2.,
3805   // even if one of the other rules in this paragraph would otherwise apply.
3806   if (!ICS1.isBad()) {
3807     if (ICS1.isStdInitializerListElement() &&
3808         !ICS2.isStdInitializerListElement())
3809       return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3810     if (!ICS1.isStdInitializerListElement() &&
3811         ICS2.isStdInitializerListElement())
3812       return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3813   }
3814 
3815   if (ICS1.isStandard())
3816     // Standard conversion sequence S1 is a better conversion sequence than
3817     // standard conversion sequence S2 if [...]
3818     Result = CompareStandardConversionSequences(S, Loc,
3819                                                 ICS1.Standard, ICS2.Standard);
3820   else if (ICS1.isUserDefined()) {
3821     // User-defined conversion sequence U1 is a better conversion
3822     // sequence than another user-defined conversion sequence U2 if
3823     // they contain the same user-defined conversion function or
3824     // constructor and if the second standard conversion sequence of
3825     // U1 is better than the second standard conversion sequence of
3826     // U2 (C++ 13.3.3.2p3).
3827     if (ICS1.UserDefined.ConversionFunction ==
3828           ICS2.UserDefined.ConversionFunction)
3829       Result = CompareStandardConversionSequences(S, Loc,
3830                                                   ICS1.UserDefined.After,
3831                                                   ICS2.UserDefined.After);
3832     else
3833       Result = compareConversionFunctions(S,
3834                                           ICS1.UserDefined.ConversionFunction,
3835                                           ICS2.UserDefined.ConversionFunction);
3836   }
3837 
3838   return Result;
3839 }
3840 
3841 // Per 13.3.3.2p3, compare the given standard conversion sequences to
3842 // determine if one is a proper subset of the other.
3843 static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
3844 compareStandardConversionSubsets(ASTContext &Context,
3845                                  const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1,
3846                                  const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2) {
3847   ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind Result
3848     = ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3849 
3850   // the identity conversion sequence is considered to be a subsequence of
3851   // any non-identity conversion sequence
3852   if (SCS1.isIdentityConversion() && !SCS2.isIdentityConversion())
3853     return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3854   else if (!SCS1.isIdentityConversion() && SCS2.isIdentityConversion())
3855     return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3856 
3857   if (SCS1.Second != SCS2.Second) {
3858     if (SCS1.Second == ICK_Identity)
3859       Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3860     else if (SCS2.Second == ICK_Identity)
3861       Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3862     else
3863       return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3864   } else if (!Context.hasSimilarType(SCS1.getToType(1), SCS2.getToType(1)))
3865     return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3866 
3867   if (SCS1.Third == SCS2.Third) {
3868     return Context.hasSameType(SCS1.getToType(2), SCS2.getToType(2))? Result
3869                              : ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3870   }
3871 
3872   if (SCS1.Third == ICK_Identity)
3873     return Result == ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse
3874              ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable
3875              : ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3876 
3877   if (SCS2.Third == ICK_Identity)
3878     return Result == ImplicitConversionSequence::Better
3879              ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable
3880              : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3881 
3882   return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3883 }
3884 
3885 /// Determine whether one of the given reference bindings is better
3886 /// than the other based on what kind of bindings they are.
3887 static bool
3888 isBetterReferenceBindingKind(const StandardConversionSequence &SCS1,
3889                              const StandardConversionSequence &SCS2) {
3890   // C++0x [over.ics.rank]p3b4:
3891   //   -- S1 and S2 are reference bindings (8.5.3) and neither refers to an
3892   //      implicit object parameter of a non-static member function declared
3893   //      without a ref-qualifier, and *either* S1 binds an rvalue reference
3894   //      to an rvalue and S2 binds an lvalue reference *or S1 binds an
3895   //      lvalue reference to a function lvalue and S2 binds an rvalue
3896   //      reference*.
3897   //
3898   // FIXME: Rvalue references. We're going rogue with the above edits,
3899   // because the semantics in the current C++0x working paper (N3225 at the
3900   // time of this writing) break the standard definition of std::forward
3901   // and std::reference_wrapper when dealing with references to functions.
3902   // Proposed wording changes submitted to CWG for consideration.
3903   if (SCS1.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier ||
3904       SCS2.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier)
3905     return false;
3906 
3907   return (!SCS1.IsLvalueReference && SCS1.BindsToRvalue &&
3908           SCS2.IsLvalueReference) ||
3909          (SCS1.IsLvalueReference && SCS1.BindsToFunctionLvalue &&
3910           !SCS2.IsLvalueReference && SCS2.BindsToFunctionLvalue);
3911 }
3912 
3913 enum class FixedEnumPromotion {
3914   None,
3915   ToUnderlyingType,
3916   ToPromotedUnderlyingType
3917 };
3918 
3919 /// Returns kind of fixed enum promotion the \a SCS uses.
3920 static FixedEnumPromotion
3921 getFixedEnumPromtion(Sema &S, const StandardConversionSequence &SCS) {
3922 
3923   if (SCS.Second != ICK_Integral_Promotion)
3924     return FixedEnumPromotion::None;
3925 
3926   QualType FromType = SCS.getFromType();
3927   if (!FromType->isEnumeralType())
3928     return FixedEnumPromotion::None;
3929 
3930   EnumDecl *Enum = FromType->getAs<EnumType>()->getDecl();
3931   if (!Enum->isFixed())
3932     return FixedEnumPromotion::None;
3933 
3934   QualType UnderlyingType = Enum->getIntegerType();
3935   if (S.Context.hasSameType(SCS.getToType(1), UnderlyingType))
3936     return FixedEnumPromotion::ToUnderlyingType;
3937 
3938   return FixedEnumPromotion::ToPromotedUnderlyingType;
3939 }
3940 
3941 /// CompareStandardConversionSequences - Compare two standard
3942 /// conversion sequences to determine whether one is better than the
3943 /// other or if they are indistinguishable (C++ 13.3.3.2p3).
3944 static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
3945 CompareStandardConversionSequences(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc,
3946                                    const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1,
3947                                    const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2)
3948 {
3949   // Standard conversion sequence S1 is a better conversion sequence
3950   // than standard conversion sequence S2 if (C++ 13.3.3.2p3):
3951 
3952   //  -- S1 is a proper subsequence of S2 (comparing the conversion
3953   //     sequences in the canonical form defined by 13.3.3.1.1,
3954   //     excluding any Lvalue Transformation; the identity conversion
3955   //     sequence is considered to be a subsequence of any
3956   //     non-identity conversion sequence) or, if not that,
3957   if (ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind CK
3958         = compareStandardConversionSubsets(S.Context, SCS1, SCS2))
3959     return CK;
3960 
3961   //  -- the rank of S1 is better than the rank of S2 (by the rules
3962   //     defined below), or, if not that,
3963   ImplicitConversionRank Rank1 = SCS1.getRank();
3964   ImplicitConversionRank Rank2 = SCS2.getRank();
3965   if (Rank1 < Rank2)
3966     return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3967   else if (Rank2 < Rank1)
3968     return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3969 
3970   // (C++ 13.3.3.2p4): Two conversion sequences with the same rank
3971   // are indistinguishable unless one of the following rules
3972   // applies:
3973 
3974   //   A conversion that is not a conversion of a pointer, or
3975   //   pointer to member, to bool is better than another conversion
3976   //   that is such a conversion.
3977   if (SCS1.isPointerConversionToBool() != SCS2.isPointerConversionToBool())
3978     return SCS2.isPointerConversionToBool()
3979              ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Better
3980              : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3981 
3982   // C++14 [over.ics.rank]p4b2:
3983   // This is retroactively applied to C++11 by CWG 1601.
3984   //
3985   //   A conversion that promotes an enumeration whose underlying type is fixed
3986   //   to its underlying type is better than one that promotes to the promoted
3987   //   underlying type, if the two are different.
3988   FixedEnumPromotion FEP1 = getFixedEnumPromtion(S, SCS1);
3989   FixedEnumPromotion FEP2 = getFixedEnumPromtion(S, SCS2);
3990   if (FEP1 != FixedEnumPromotion::None && FEP2 != FixedEnumPromotion::None &&
3991       FEP1 != FEP2)
3992     return FEP1 == FixedEnumPromotion::ToUnderlyingType
3993                ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Better
3994                : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3995 
3996   // C++ [over.ics.rank]p4b2:
3997   //
3998   //   If class B is derived directly or indirectly from class A,
3999   //   conversion of B* to A* is better than conversion of B* to
4000   //   void*, and conversion of A* to void* is better than conversion
4001   //   of B* to void*.
4002   bool SCS1ConvertsToVoid
4003     = SCS1.isPointerConversionToVoidPointer(S.Context);
4004   bool SCS2ConvertsToVoid
4005     = SCS2.isPointerConversionToVoidPointer(S.Context);
4006   if (SCS1ConvertsToVoid != SCS2ConvertsToVoid) {
4007     // Exactly one of the conversion sequences is a conversion to
4008     // a void pointer; it's the worse conversion.
4009     return SCS2ConvertsToVoid ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Better
4010                               : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
4011   } else if (!SCS1ConvertsToVoid && !SCS2ConvertsToVoid) {
4012     // Neither conversion sequence converts to a void pointer; compare
4013     // their derived-to-base conversions.
4014     if (ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind DerivedCK
4015           = CompareDerivedToBaseConversions(S, Loc, SCS1, SCS2))
4016       return DerivedCK;
4017   } else if (SCS1ConvertsToVoid && SCS2ConvertsToVoid &&
4018              !S.Context.hasSameType(SCS1.getFromType(), SCS2.getFromType())) {
4019     // Both conversion sequences are conversions to void
4020     // pointers. Compare the source types to determine if there's an
4021     // inheritance relationship in their sources.
4022     QualType FromType1 = SCS1.getFromType();
4023     QualType FromType2 = SCS2.getFromType();
4024 
4025     // Adjust the types we're converting from via the array-to-pointer
4026     // conversion, if we need to.
4027     if (SCS1.First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer)
4028       FromType1 = S.Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType1);
4029     if (SCS2.First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer)
4030       FromType2 = S.Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType2);
4031 
4032     QualType FromPointee1 = FromType1->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType();
4033     QualType FromPointee2 = FromType2->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType();
4034 
4035     if (S.IsDerivedFrom(Loc, FromPointee2, FromPointee1))
4036       return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
4037     else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(Loc, FromPointee1, FromPointee2))
4038       return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
4039 
4040     // Objective-C++: If one interface is more specific than the
4041     // other, it is the better one.
4042     const ObjCObjectPointerType* FromObjCPtr1
4043       = FromType1->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
4044     const ObjCObjectPointerType* FromObjCPtr2
4045       = FromType2->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
4046     if (FromObjCPtr1 && FromObjCPtr2) {
4047       bool AssignLeft = S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(FromObjCPtr1,
4048                                                           FromObjCPtr2);
4049       bool AssignRight = S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(FromObjCPtr2,
4050                                                            FromObjCPtr1);
4051       if (AssignLeft != AssignRight) {
4052         return AssignLeft? ImplicitConversionSequence::Better
4053                          : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
4054       }
4055     }
4056   }
4057 
4058   if (SCS1.ReferenceBinding && SCS2.ReferenceBinding) {
4059     // Check for a better reference binding based on the kind of bindings.
4060     if (isBetterReferenceBindingKind(SCS1, SCS2))
4061       return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
4062     else if (isBetterReferenceBindingKind(SCS2, SCS1))
4063       return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
4064   }
4065 
4066   // Compare based on qualification conversions (C++ 13.3.3.2p3,
4067   // bullet 3).
4068   if (ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind QualCK
4069         = CompareQualificationConversions(S, SCS1, SCS2))
4070     return QualCK;
4071 
4072   if (SCS1.ReferenceBinding && SCS2.ReferenceBinding) {
4073     // C++ [over.ics.rank]p3b4:
4074     //   -- S1 and S2 are reference bindings (8.5.3), and the types to
4075     //      which the references refer are the same type except for
4076     //      top-level cv-qualifiers, and the type to which the reference
4077     //      initialized by S2 refers is more cv-qualified than the type
4078     //      to which the reference initialized by S1 refers.
4079     QualType T1 = SCS1.getToType(2);
4080     QualType T2 = SCS2.getToType(2);
4081     T1 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(T1);
4082     T2 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(T2);
4083     Qualifiers T1Quals, T2Quals;
4084     QualType UnqualT1 = S.Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T1, T1Quals);
4085     QualType UnqualT2 = S.Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T2, T2Quals);
4086     if (UnqualT1 == UnqualT2) {
4087       // Objective-C++ ARC: If the references refer to objects with different
4088       // lifetimes, prefer bindings that don't change lifetime.
4089       if (SCS1.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding !=
4090                                           SCS2.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding) {
4091         return SCS1.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding
4092                                            ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse
4093                                            : ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
4094       }
4095 
4096       // If the type is an array type, promote the element qualifiers to the
4097       // type for comparison.
4098       if (isa<ArrayType>(T1) && T1Quals)
4099         T1 = S.Context.getQualifiedType(UnqualT1, T1Quals);
4100       if (isa<ArrayType>(T2) && T2Quals)
4101         T2 = S.Context.getQualifiedType(UnqualT2, T2Quals);
4102       if (T2.isMoreQualifiedThan(T1))
4103         return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
4104       if (T1.isMoreQualifiedThan(T2))
4105         return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
4106     }
4107   }
4108 
4109   // In Microsoft mode, prefer an integral conversion to a
4110   // floating-to-integral conversion if the integral conversion
4111   // is between types of the same size.
4112   // For example:
4113   // void f(float);
4114   // void f(int);
4115   // int main {
4116   //    long a;
4117   //    f(a);
4118   // }
4119   // Here, MSVC will call f(int) instead of generating a compile error
4120   // as clang will do in standard mode.
4121   if (S.getLangOpts().MSVCCompat && SCS1.Second == ICK_Integral_Conversion &&
4122       SCS2.Second == ICK_Floating_Integral &&
4123       S.Context.getTypeSize(SCS1.getFromType()) ==
4124           S.Context.getTypeSize(SCS1.getToType(2)))
4125     return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
4126 
4127   // Prefer a compatible vector conversion over a lax vector conversion
4128   // For example:
4129   //
4130   // typedef float __v4sf __attribute__((__vector_size__(16)));
4131   // void f(vector float);
4132   // void f(vector signed int);
4133   // int main() {
4134   //   __v4sf a;
4135   //   f(a);
4136   // }
4137   // Here, we'd like to choose f(vector float) and not
4138   // report an ambiguous call error
4139   if (SCS1.Second == ICK_Vector_Conversion &&
4140       SCS2.Second == ICK_Vector_Conversion) {
4141     bool SCS1IsCompatibleVectorConversion = S.Context.areCompatibleVectorTypes(
4142         SCS1.getFromType(), SCS1.getToType(2));
4143     bool SCS2IsCompatibleVectorConversion = S.Context.areCompatibleVectorTypes(
4144         SCS2.getFromType(), SCS2.getToType(2));
4145 
4146     if (SCS1IsCompatibleVectorConversion != SCS2IsCompatibleVectorConversion)
4147       return SCS1IsCompatibleVectorConversion
4148                  ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Better
4149                  : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
4150   }
4151 
4152   if (SCS1.Second == ICK_SVE_Vector_Conversion &&
4153       SCS2.Second == ICK_SVE_Vector_Conversion) {
4154     bool SCS1IsCompatibleSVEVectorConversion =
4155         S.Context.areCompatibleSveTypes(SCS1.getFromType(), SCS1.getToType(2));
4156     bool SCS2IsCompatibleSVEVectorConversion =
4157         S.Context.areCompatibleSveTypes(SCS2.getFromType(), SCS2.getToType(2));
4158 
4159     if (SCS1IsCompatibleSVEVectorConversion !=
4160         SCS2IsCompatibleSVEVectorConversion)
4161       return SCS1IsCompatibleSVEVectorConversion
4162                  ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Better
4163                  : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
4164   }
4165 
4166   return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
4167 }
4168 
4169 /// CompareQualificationConversions - Compares two standard conversion
4170 /// sequences to determine whether they can be ranked based on their
4171 /// qualification conversions (C++ 13.3.3.2p3 bullet 3).
4172 static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
4173 CompareQualificationConversions(Sema &S,
4174                                 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1,
4175                                 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2) {
4176   // C++ 13.3.3.2p3:
4177   //  -- S1 and S2 differ only in their qualification conversion and
4178   //     yield similar types T1 and T2 (C++ 4.4), respectively, and the
4179   //     cv-qualification signature of type T1 is a proper subset of
4180   //     the cv-qualification signature of type T2, and S1 is not the
4181   //     deprecated string literal array-to-pointer conversion (4.2).
4182   if (SCS1.First != SCS2.First || SCS1.Second != SCS2.Second ||
4183       SCS1.Third != SCS2.Third || SCS1.Third != ICK_Qualification)
4184     return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
4185 
4186   // FIXME: the example in the standard doesn't use a qualification
4187   // conversion (!)
4188   QualType T1 = SCS1.getToType(2);
4189   QualType T2 = SCS2.getToType(2);
4190   T1 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(T1);
4191   T2 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(T2);
4192   assert(!T1->isReferenceType() && !T2->isReferenceType());
4193   Qualifiers T1Quals, T2Quals;
4194   QualType UnqualT1 = S.Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T1, T1Quals);
4195   QualType UnqualT2 = S.Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T2, T2Quals);
4196 
4197   // If the types are the same, we won't learn anything by unwrapping
4198   // them.
4199   if (UnqualT1 == UnqualT2)
4200     return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
4201 
4202   ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind Result
4203     = ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
4204 
4205   // Objective-C++ ARC:
4206   //   Prefer qualification conversions not involving a change in lifetime
4207   //   to qualification conversions that do not change lifetime.
4208   if (SCS1.QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime !=
4209                                       SCS2.QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime) {
4210     Result = SCS1.QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime
4211                ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse
4212                : ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
4213   }
4214 
4215   while (S.Context.UnwrapSimilarTypes(T1, T2)) {
4216     // Within each iteration of the loop, we check the qualifiers to
4217     // determine if this still looks like a qualification
4218     // conversion. Then, if all is well, we unwrap one more level of
4219     // pointers or pointers-to-members and do it all again
4220     // until there are no more pointers or pointers-to-members left
4221     // to unwrap. This essentially mimics what
4222     // IsQualificationConversion does, but here we're checking for a
4223     // strict subset of qualifiers.
4224     if (T1.getQualifiers().withoutObjCLifetime() ==
4225         T2.getQualifiers().withoutObjCLifetime())
4226       // The qualifiers are the same, so this doesn't tell us anything
4227       // about how the sequences rank.
4228       // ObjC ownership quals are omitted above as they interfere with
4229       // the ARC overload rule.
4230       ;
4231     else if (T2.isMoreQualifiedThan(T1)) {
4232       // T1 has fewer qualifiers, so it could be the better sequence.
4233       if (Result == ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse)
4234         // Neither has qualifiers that are a subset of the other's
4235         // qualifiers.
4236         return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
4237 
4238       Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
4239     } else if (T1.isMoreQualifiedThan(T2)) {
4240       // T2 has fewer qualifiers, so it could be the better sequence.
4241       if (Result == ImplicitConversionSequence::Better)
4242         // Neither has qualifiers that are a subset of the other's
4243         // qualifiers.
4244         return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
4245 
4246       Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
4247     } else {
4248       // Qualifiers are disjoint.
4249       return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
4250     }
4251 
4252     // If the types after this point are equivalent, we're done.
4253     if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(T1, T2))
4254       break;
4255   }
4256 
4257   // Check that the winning standard conversion sequence isn't using
4258   // the deprecated string literal array to pointer conversion.
4259   switch (Result) {
4260   case ImplicitConversionSequence::Better:
4261     if (SCS1.DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr)
4262       Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
4263     break;
4264 
4265   case ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable:
4266     break;
4267 
4268   case ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse:
4269     if (SCS2.DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr)
4270       Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
4271     break;
4272   }
4273 
4274   return Result;
4275 }
4276 
4277 /// CompareDerivedToBaseConversions - Compares two standard conversion
4278 /// sequences to determine whether they can be ranked based on their
4279 /// various kinds of derived-to-base conversions (C++
4280 /// [over.ics.rank]p4b3).  As part of these checks, we also look at
4281 /// conversions between Objective-C interface types.
4282 static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
4283 CompareDerivedToBaseConversions(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc,
4284                                 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1,
4285                                 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2) {
4286   QualType FromType1 = SCS1.getFromType();
4287   QualType ToType1 = SCS1.getToType(1);
4288   QualType FromType2 = SCS2.getFromType();
4289   QualType ToType2 = SCS2.getToType(1);
4290 
4291   // Adjust the types we're converting from via the array-to-pointer
4292   // conversion, if we need to.
4293   if (SCS1.First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer)
4294     FromType1 = S.Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType1);
4295   if (SCS2.First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer)
4296     FromType2 = S.Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType2);
4297 
4298   // Canonicalize all of the types.
4299   FromType1 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType1);
4300   ToType1 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToType1);
4301   FromType2 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType2);
4302   ToType2 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToType2);
4303 
4304   // C++ [over.ics.rank]p4b3:
4305   //
4306   //   If class B is derived directly or indirectly from class A and
4307   //   class C is derived directly or indirectly from B,
4308   //
4309   // Compare based on pointer conversions.
4310   if (SCS1.Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion &&
4311       SCS2.Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion &&
4312       /*FIXME: Remove if Objective-C id conversions get their own rank*/
4313       FromType1->isPointerType() && FromType2->isPointerType() &&
4314       ToType1->isPointerType() && ToType2->isPointerType()) {
4315     QualType FromPointee1 =
4316         FromType1->castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType();
4317     QualType ToPointee1 =
4318         ToType1->castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType();
4319     QualType FromPointee2 =
4320         FromType2->castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType();
4321     QualType ToPointee2 =
4322         ToType2->castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType();
4323 
4324     //   -- conversion of C* to B* is better than conversion of C* to A*,
4325     if (FromPointee1 == FromPointee2 && ToPointee1 != ToPointee2) {
4326       if (S.IsDerivedFrom(Loc, ToPointee1, ToPointee2))
4327         return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
4328       else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(Loc, ToPointee2, ToPointee1))
4329         return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
4330     }
4331 
4332     //   -- conversion of B* to A* is better than conversion of C* to A*,
4333     if (FromPointee1 != FromPointee2 && ToPointee1 == ToPointee2) {
4334       if (S.IsDerivedFrom(Loc, FromPointee2, FromPointee1))
4335         return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
4336       else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(Loc, FromPointee1, FromPointee2))
4337         return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
4338     }
4339   } else if (SCS1.Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion &&
4340              SCS2.Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion) {
4341     const ObjCObjectPointerType *FromPtr1
4342       = FromType1->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
4343     const ObjCObjectPointerType *FromPtr2
4344       = FromType2->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
4345     const ObjCObjectPointerType *ToPtr1
4346       = ToType1->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
4347     const ObjCObjectPointerType *ToPtr2
4348       = ToType2->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
4349 
4350     if (FromPtr1 && FromPtr2 && ToPtr1 && ToPtr2) {
4351       // Apply the same conversion ranking rules for Objective-C pointer types
4352       // that we do for C++ pointers to class types. However, we employ the
4353       // Objective-C pseudo-subtyping relationship used for assignment of
4354       // Objective-C pointer types.
4355       bool FromAssignLeft
4356         = S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(FromPtr1, FromPtr2);
4357       bool FromAssignRight
4358         = S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(FromPtr2, FromPtr1);
4359       bool ToAssignLeft
4360         = S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(ToPtr1, ToPtr2);
4361       bool ToAssignRight
4362         = S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(ToPtr2, ToPtr1);
4363 
4364       // A conversion to an a non-id object pointer type or qualified 'id'
4365       // type is better than a conversion to 'id'.
4366       if (ToPtr1->isObjCIdType() &&
4367           (ToPtr2->isObjCQualifiedIdType() || ToPtr2->getInterfaceDecl()))
4368         return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
4369       if (ToPtr2->isObjCIdType() &&
4370           (ToPtr1->isObjCQualifiedIdType() || ToPtr1->getInterfaceDecl()))
4371         return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
4372 
4373       // A conversion to a non-id object pointer type is better than a
4374       // conversion to a qualified 'id' type
4375       if (ToPtr1->isObjCQualifiedIdType() && ToPtr2->getInterfaceDecl())
4376         return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
4377       if (ToPtr2->isObjCQualifiedIdType() && ToPtr1->getInterfaceDecl())
4378         return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
4379 
4380       // A conversion to an a non-Class object pointer type or qualified 'Class'
4381       // type is better than a conversion to 'Class'.
4382       if (ToPtr1->isObjCClassType() &&
4383           (ToPtr2->isObjCQualifiedClassType() || ToPtr2->getInterfaceDecl()))
4384         return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
4385       if (ToPtr2->isObjCClassType() &&
4386           (ToPtr1->isObjCQualifiedClassType() || ToPtr1->getInterfaceDecl()))
4387         return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
4388 
4389       // A conversion to a non-Class object pointer type is better than a
4390       // conversion to a qualified 'Class' type.
4391       if (ToPtr1->isObjCQualifiedClassType() && ToPtr2->getInterfaceDecl())
4392         return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
4393       if (ToPtr2->isObjCQualifiedClassType() && ToPtr1->getInterfaceDecl())
4394         return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
4395 
4396       //   -- "conversion of C* to B* is better than conversion of C* to A*,"
4397       if (S.Context.hasSameType(FromType1, FromType2) &&
4398           !FromPtr1->isObjCIdType() && !FromPtr1->isObjCClassType() &&
4399           (ToAssignLeft != ToAssignRight)) {
4400         if (FromPtr1->isSpecialized()) {
4401           // "conversion of B<A> * to B * is better than conversion of B * to
4402           // C *.
4403           bool IsFirstSame =
4404               FromPtr1->getInterfaceDecl() == ToPtr1->getInterfaceDecl();
4405           bool IsSecondSame =
4406               FromPtr1->getInterfaceDecl() == ToPtr2->getInterfaceDecl();
4407           if (IsFirstSame) {
4408             if (!IsSecondSame)
4409               return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
4410           } else if (IsSecondSame)
4411             return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
4412         }
4413         return ToAssignLeft? ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse
4414                            : ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
4415       }
4416 
4417       //   -- "conversion of B* to A* is better than conversion of C* to A*,"
4418       if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType1, ToType2) &&
4419           (FromAssignLeft != FromAssignRight))
4420         return FromAssignLeft? ImplicitConversionSequence::Better
4421         : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
4422     }
4423   }
4424 
4425   // Ranking of member-pointer types.
4426   if (SCS1.Second == ICK_Pointer_Member && SCS2.Second == ICK_Pointer_Member &&
4427       FromType1->isMemberPointerType() && FromType2->isMemberPointerType() &&
4428       ToType1->isMemberPointerType() && ToType2->isMemberPointerType()) {
4429     const auto *FromMemPointer1 = FromType1->castAs<MemberPointerType>();
4430     const auto *ToMemPointer1 = ToType1->castAs<MemberPointerType>();
4431     const auto *FromMemPointer2 = FromType2->castAs<MemberPointerType>();
4432     const auto *ToMemPointer2 = ToType2->castAs<MemberPointerType>();
4433     const Type *FromPointeeType1 = FromMemPointer1->getClass();
4434     const Type *ToPointeeType1 = ToMemPointer1->getClass();
4435     const Type *FromPointeeType2 = FromMemPointer2->getClass();
4436     const Type *ToPointeeType2 = ToMemPointer2->getClass();
4437     QualType FromPointee1 = QualType(FromPointeeType1, 0).getUnqualifiedType();
4438     QualType ToPointee1 = QualType(ToPointeeType1, 0).getUnqualifiedType();
4439     QualType FromPointee2 = QualType(FromPointeeType2, 0).getUnqualifiedType();
4440     QualType ToPointee2 = QualType(ToPointeeType2, 0).getUnqualifiedType();
4441     // conversion of A::* to B::* is better than conversion of A::* to C::*,
4442     if (FromPointee1 == FromPointee2 && ToPointee1 != ToPointee2) {
4443       if (S.IsDerivedFrom(Loc, ToPointee1, ToPointee2))
4444         return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
4445       else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(Loc, ToPointee2, ToPointee1))
4446         return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
4447     }
4448     // conversion of B::* to C::* is better than conversion of A::* to C::*
4449     if (ToPointee1 == ToPointee2 && FromPointee1 != FromPointee2) {
4450       if (S.IsDerivedFrom(Loc, FromPointee1, FromPointee2))
4451         return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
4452       else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(Loc, FromPointee2, FromPointee1))
4453         return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
4454     }
4455   }
4456 
4457   if (SCS1.Second == ICK_Derived_To_Base) {
4458     //   -- conversion of C to B is better than conversion of C to A,
4459     //   -- binding of an expression of type C to a reference of type
4460     //      B& is better than binding an expression of type C to a
4461     //      reference of type A&,
4462     if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType1, FromType2) &&
4463         !S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType1, ToType2)) {
4464       if (S.IsDerivedFrom(Loc, ToType1, ToType2))
4465         return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
4466       else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(Loc, ToType2, ToType1))
4467         return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
4468     }
4469 
4470     //   -- conversion of B to A is better than conversion of C to A.
4471     //   -- binding of an expression of type B to a reference of type
4472     //      A& is better than binding an expression of type C to a
4473     //      reference of type A&,
4474     if (!S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType1, FromType2) &&
4475         S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType1, ToType2)) {
4476       if (S.IsDerivedFrom(Loc, FromType2, FromType1))
4477         return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
4478       else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(Loc, FromType1, FromType2))
4479         return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
4480     }
4481   }
4482 
4483   return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
4484 }
4485 
4486 /// Determine whether the given type is valid, e.g., it is not an invalid
4487 /// C++ class.
4488 static bool isTypeValid(QualType T) {
4489   if (CXXRecordDecl *Record = T->getAsCXXRecordDecl())
4490     return !Record->isInvalidDecl();
4491 
4492   return true;
4493 }
4494 
4495 static QualType withoutUnaligned(ASTContext &Ctx, QualType T) {
4496   if (!T.getQualifiers().hasUnaligned())
4497     return T;
4498 
4499   Qualifiers Q;
4500   T = Ctx.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T, Q);
4501   Q.removeUnaligned();
4502   return Ctx.getQualifiedType(T, Q);
4503 }
4504 
4505 /// CompareReferenceRelationship - Compare the two types T1 and T2 to
4506 /// determine whether they are reference-compatible,
4507 /// reference-related, or incompatible, for use in C++ initialization by
4508 /// reference (C++ [dcl.ref.init]p4). Neither type can be a reference
4509 /// type, and the first type (T1) is the pointee type of the reference
4510 /// type being initialized.
4511 Sema::ReferenceCompareResult
4512 Sema::CompareReferenceRelationship(SourceLocation Loc,
4513                                    QualType OrigT1, QualType OrigT2,
4514                                    ReferenceConversions *ConvOut) {
4515   assert(!OrigT1->isReferenceType() &&
4516     "T1 must be the pointee type of the reference type");
4517   assert(!OrigT2->isReferenceType() && "T2 cannot be a reference type");
4518 
4519   QualType T1 = Context.getCanonicalType(OrigT1);
4520   QualType T2 = Context.getCanonicalType(OrigT2);
4521   Qualifiers T1Quals, T2Quals;
4522   QualType UnqualT1 = Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T1, T1Quals);
4523   QualType UnqualT2 = Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T2, T2Quals);
4524 
4525   ReferenceConversions ConvTmp;
4526   ReferenceConversions &Conv = ConvOut ? *ConvOut : ConvTmp;
4527   Conv = ReferenceConversions();
4528 
4529   // C++2a [dcl.init.ref]p4:
4530   //   Given types "cv1 T1" and "cv2 T2," "cv1 T1" is
4531   //   reference-related to "cv2 T2" if T1 is similar to T2, or
4532   //   T1 is a base class of T2.
4533   //   "cv1 T1" is reference-compatible with "cv2 T2" if
4534   //   a prvalue of type "pointer to cv2 T2" can be converted to the type
4535   //   "pointer to cv1 T1" via a standard conversion sequence.
4536 
4537   // Check for standard conversions we can apply to pointers: derived-to-base
4538   // conversions, ObjC pointer conversions, and function pointer conversions.
4539   // (Qualification conversions are checked last.)
4540   QualType ConvertedT2;
4541   if (UnqualT1 == UnqualT2) {
4542     // Nothing to do.
4543   } else if (isCompleteType(Loc, OrigT2) &&
4544              isTypeValid(UnqualT1) && isTypeValid(UnqualT2) &&
4545              IsDerivedFrom(Loc, UnqualT2, UnqualT1))
4546     Conv |= ReferenceConversions::DerivedToBase;
4547   else if (UnqualT1->isObjCObjectOrInterfaceType() &&
4548            UnqualT2->isObjCObjectOrInterfaceType() &&
4549            Context.canBindObjCObjectType(UnqualT1, UnqualT2))
4550     Conv |= ReferenceConversions::ObjC;
4551   else if (UnqualT2->isFunctionType() &&
4552            IsFunctionConversion(UnqualT2, UnqualT1, ConvertedT2)) {
4553     Conv |= ReferenceConversions::Function;
4554     // No need to check qualifiers; function types don't have them.
4555     return Ref_Compatible;
4556   }
4557   bool ConvertedReferent = Conv != 0;
4558 
4559   // We can have a qualification conversion. Compute whether the types are
4560   // similar at the same time.
4561   bool PreviousToQualsIncludeConst = true;
4562   bool TopLevel = true;
4563   do {
4564     if (T1 == T2)
4565       break;
4566 
4567     // We will need a qualification conversion.
4568     Conv |= ReferenceConversions::Qualification;
4569 
4570     // Track whether we performed a qualification conversion anywhere other
4571     // than the top level. This matters for ranking reference bindings in
4572     // overload resolution.
4573     if (!TopLevel)
4574       Conv |= ReferenceConversions::NestedQualification;
4575 
4576     // MS compiler ignores __unaligned qualifier for references; do the same.
4577     T1 = withoutUnaligned(Context, T1);
4578     T2 = withoutUnaligned(Context, T2);
4579 
4580     // If we find a qualifier mismatch, the types are not reference-compatible,
4581     // but are still be reference-related if they're similar.
4582     bool ObjCLifetimeConversion = false;
4583     if (!isQualificationConversionStep(T2, T1, /*CStyle=*/false, TopLevel,
4584                                        PreviousToQualsIncludeConst,
4585                                        ObjCLifetimeConversion))
4586       return (ConvertedReferent || Context.hasSimilarType(T1, T2))
4587                  ? Ref_Related
4588                  : Ref_Incompatible;
4589 
4590     // FIXME: Should we track this for any level other than the first?
4591     if (ObjCLifetimeConversion)
4592       Conv |= ReferenceConversions::ObjCLifetime;
4593 
4594     TopLevel = false;
4595   } while (Context.UnwrapSimilarTypes(T1, T2));
4596 
4597   // At this point, if the types are reference-related, we must either have the
4598   // same inner type (ignoring qualifiers), or must have already worked out how
4599   // to convert the referent.
4600   return (ConvertedReferent || Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(T1, T2))
4601              ? Ref_Compatible
4602              : Ref_Incompatible;
4603 }
4604 
4605 /// Look for a user-defined conversion to a value reference-compatible
4606 ///        with DeclType. Return true if something definite is found.
4607 static bool
4608 FindConversionForRefInit(Sema &S, ImplicitConversionSequence &ICS,
4609                          QualType DeclType, SourceLocation DeclLoc,
4610                          Expr *Init, QualType T2, bool AllowRvalues,
4611                          bool AllowExplicit) {
4612   assert(T2->isRecordType() && "Can only find conversions of record types.");
4613   auto *T2RecordDecl = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(T2->castAs<RecordType>()->getDecl());
4614 
4615   OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(
4616       DeclLoc, OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_InitByUserDefinedConversion);
4617   const auto &Conversions = T2RecordDecl->getVisibleConversionFunctions();
4618   for (auto I = Conversions.begin(), E = Conversions.end(); I != E; ++I) {
4619     NamedDecl *D = *I;
4620     CXXRecordDecl *ActingDC = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D->getDeclContext());
4621     if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D))
4622       D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl();
4623 
4624     FunctionTemplateDecl *ConvTemplate
4625       = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D);
4626     CXXConversionDecl *Conv;
4627     if (ConvTemplate)
4628       Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(ConvTemplate->getTemplatedDecl());
4629     else
4630       Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D);
4631 
4632     if (AllowRvalues) {
4633       // If we are initializing an rvalue reference, don't permit conversion
4634       // functions that return lvalues.
4635       if (!ConvTemplate && DeclType->isRValueReferenceType()) {
4636         const ReferenceType *RefType
4637           = Conv->getConversionType()->getAs<LValueReferenceType>();
4638         if (RefType && !RefType->getPointeeType()->isFunctionType())
4639           continue;
4640       }
4641 
4642       if (!ConvTemplate &&
4643           S.CompareReferenceRelationship(
4644               DeclLoc,
4645               Conv->getConversionType()
4646                   .getNonReferenceType()
4647                   .getUnqualifiedType(),
4648               DeclType.getNonReferenceType().getUnqualifiedType()) ==
4649               Sema::Ref_Incompatible)
4650         continue;
4651     } else {
4652       // If the conversion function doesn't return a reference type,
4653       // it can't be considered for this conversion. An rvalue reference
4654       // is only acceptable if its referencee is a function type.
4655 
4656       const ReferenceType *RefType =
4657         Conv->getConversionType()->getAs<ReferenceType>();
4658       if (!RefType ||
4659           (!RefType->isLValueReferenceType() &&
4660            !RefType->getPointeeType()->isFunctionType()))
4661         continue;
4662     }
4663 
4664     if (ConvTemplate)
4665       S.AddTemplateConversionCandidate(
4666           ConvTemplate, I.getPair(), ActingDC, Init, DeclType, CandidateSet,
4667           /*AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit=*/false, AllowExplicit);
4668     else
4669       S.AddConversionCandidate(
4670           Conv, I.getPair(), ActingDC, Init, DeclType, CandidateSet,
4671           /*AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit=*/false, AllowExplicit);
4672   }
4673 
4674   bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1);
4675 
4676   OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
4677   switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(S, DeclLoc, Best)) {
4678   case OR_Success:
4679     // C++ [over.ics.ref]p1:
4680     //
4681     //   [...] If the parameter binds directly to the result of
4682     //   applying a conversion function to the argument
4683     //   expression, the implicit conversion sequence is a
4684     //   user-defined conversion sequence (13.3.3.1.2), with the
4685     //   second standard conversion sequence either an identity
4686     //   conversion or, if the conversion function returns an
4687     //   entity of a type that is a derived class of the parameter
4688     //   type, a derived-to-base Conversion.
4689     if (!Best->FinalConversion.DirectBinding)
4690       return false;
4691 
4692     ICS.setUserDefined();
4693     ICS.UserDefined.Before = Best->Conversions[0].Standard;
4694     ICS.UserDefined.After = Best->FinalConversion;
4695     ICS.UserDefined.HadMultipleCandidates = HadMultipleCandidates;
4696     ICS.UserDefined.ConversionFunction = Best->Function;
4697     ICS.UserDefined.FoundConversionFunction = Best->FoundDecl;
4698     ICS.UserDefined.EllipsisConversion = false;
4699     assert(ICS.UserDefined.After.ReferenceBinding &&
4700            ICS.UserDefined.After.DirectBinding &&
4701            "Expected a direct reference binding!");
4702     return true;
4703 
4704   case OR_Ambiguous:
4705     ICS.setAmbiguous();
4706     for (OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Cand = CandidateSet.begin();
4707          Cand != CandidateSet.end(); ++Cand)
4708       if (Cand->Best)
4709         ICS.Ambiguous.addConversion(Cand->FoundDecl, Cand->Function);
4710     return true;
4711 
4712   case OR_No_Viable_Function:
4713   case OR_Deleted:
4714     // There was no suitable conversion, or we found a deleted
4715     // conversion; continue with other checks.
4716     return false;
4717   }
4718 
4719   llvm_unreachable("Invalid OverloadResult!");
4720 }
4721 
4722 /// Compute an implicit conversion sequence for reference
4723 /// initialization.
4724 static ImplicitConversionSequence
4725 TryReferenceInit(Sema &S, Expr *Init, QualType DeclType,
4726                  SourceLocation DeclLoc,
4727                  bool SuppressUserConversions,
4728                  bool AllowExplicit) {
4729   assert(DeclType->isReferenceType() && "Reference init needs a reference");
4730 
4731   // Most paths end in a failed conversion.
4732   ImplicitConversionSequence ICS;
4733   ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, Init, DeclType);
4734 
4735   QualType T1 = DeclType->castAs<ReferenceType>()->getPointeeType();
4736   QualType T2 = Init->getType();
4737 
4738   // If the initializer is the address of an overloaded function, try
4739   // to resolve the overloaded function. If all goes well, T2 is the
4740   // type of the resulting function.
4741   if (S.Context.getCanonicalType(T2) == S.Context.OverloadTy) {
4742     DeclAccessPair Found;
4743     if (FunctionDecl *Fn = S.ResolveAddressOfOverloadedFunction(Init, DeclType,
4744                                                                 false, Found))
4745       T2 = Fn->getType();
4746   }
4747 
4748   // Compute some basic properties of the types and the initializer.
4749   bool isRValRef = DeclType->isRValueReferenceType();
4750   Expr::Classification InitCategory = Init->Classify(S.Context);
4751 
4752   Sema::ReferenceConversions RefConv;
4753   Sema::ReferenceCompareResult RefRelationship =
4754       S.CompareReferenceRelationship(DeclLoc, T1, T2, &RefConv);
4755 
4756   auto SetAsReferenceBinding = [&](bool BindsDirectly) {
4757     ICS.setStandard();
4758     ICS.Standard.First = ICK_Identity;
4759     // FIXME: A reference binding can be a function conversion too. We should
4760     // consider that when ordering reference-to-function bindings.
4761     ICS.Standard.Second = (RefConv & Sema::ReferenceConversions::DerivedToBase)
4762                               ? ICK_Derived_To_Base
4763                               : (RefConv & Sema::ReferenceConversions::ObjC)
4764                                     ? ICK_Compatible_Conversion
4765                                     : ICK_Identity;
4766     // FIXME: As a speculative fix to a defect introduced by CWG2352, we rank
4767     // a reference binding that performs a non-top-level qualification
4768     // conversion as a qualification conversion, not as an identity conversion.
4769     ICS.Standard.Third = (RefConv &
4770                               Sema::ReferenceConversions::NestedQualification)
4771                              ? ICK_Qualification
4772                              : ICK_Identity;
4773     ICS.Standard.setFromType(T2);
4774     ICS.Standard.setToType(0, T2);
4775     ICS.Standard.setToType(1, T1);
4776     ICS.Standard.setToType(2, T1);
4777     ICS.Standard.ReferenceBinding = true;
4778     ICS.Standard.DirectBinding = BindsDirectly;
4779     ICS.Standard.IsLvalueReference = !isRValRef;
4780     ICS.Standard.BindsToFunctionLvalue = T2->isFunctionType();
4781     ICS.Standard.BindsToRvalue = InitCategory.isRValue();
4782     ICS.Standard.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier = false;
4783     ICS.Standard.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding =
4784         (RefConv & Sema::ReferenceConversions::ObjCLifetime) != 0;
4785     ICS.Standard.CopyConstructor = nullptr;
4786     ICS.Standard.DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr = false;
4787   };
4788 
4789   // C++0x [dcl.init.ref]p5:
4790   //   A reference to type "cv1 T1" is initialized by an expression
4791   //   of type "cv2 T2" as follows:
4792 
4793   //     -- If reference is an lvalue reference and the initializer expression
4794   if (!isRValRef) {
4795     //     -- is an lvalue (but is not a bit-field), and "cv1 T1" is
4796     //        reference-compatible with "cv2 T2," or
4797     //
4798     // Per C++ [over.ics.ref]p4, we don't check the bit-field property here.
4799     if (InitCategory.isLValue() && RefRelationship == Sema::Ref_Compatible) {
4800       // C++ [over.ics.ref]p1:
4801       //   When a parameter of reference type binds directly (8.5.3)
4802       //   to an argument expression, the implicit conversion sequence
4803       //   is the identity conversion, unless the argument expression
4804       //   has a type that is a derived class of the parameter type,
4805       //   in which case the implicit conversion sequence is a
4806       //   derived-to-base Conversion (13.3.3.1).
4807       SetAsReferenceBinding(/*BindsDirectly=*/true);
4808 
4809       // Nothing more to do: the inaccessibility/ambiguity check for
4810       // derived-to-base conversions is suppressed when we're
4811       // computing the implicit conversion sequence (C++
4812       // [over.best.ics]p2).
4813       return ICS;
4814     }
4815 
4816     //       -- has a class type (i.e., T2 is a class type), where T1 is
4817     //          not reference-related to T2, and can be implicitly
4818     //          converted to an lvalue of type "cv3 T3," where "cv1 T1"
4819     //          is reference-compatible with "cv3 T3" 92) (this
4820     //          conversion is selected by enumerating the applicable
4821     //          conversion functions (13.3.1.6) and choosing the best
4822     //          one through overload resolution (13.3)),
4823     if (!SuppressUserConversions && T2->isRecordType() &&
4824         S.isCompleteType(DeclLoc, T2) &&
4825         RefRelationship == Sema::Ref_Incompatible) {
4826       if (FindConversionForRefInit(S, ICS, DeclType, DeclLoc,
4827                                    Init, T2, /*AllowRvalues=*/false,
4828                                    AllowExplicit))
4829         return ICS;
4830     }
4831   }
4832 
4833   //     -- Otherwise, the reference shall be an lvalue reference to a
4834   //        non-volatile const type (i.e., cv1 shall be const), or the reference
4835   //        shall be an rvalue reference.
4836   if (!isRValRef && (!T1.isConstQualified() || T1.isVolatileQualified())) {
4837     if (InitCategory.isRValue() && RefRelationship != Sema::Ref_Incompatible)
4838       ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::lvalue_ref_to_rvalue, Init, DeclType);
4839     return ICS;
4840   }
4841 
4842   //       -- If the initializer expression
4843   //
4844   //            -- is an xvalue, class prvalue, array prvalue or function
4845   //               lvalue and "cv1 T1" is reference-compatible with "cv2 T2", or
4846   if (RefRelationship == Sema::Ref_Compatible &&
4847       (InitCategory.isXValue() ||
4848        (InitCategory.isPRValue() &&
4849           (T2->isRecordType() || T2->isArrayType())) ||
4850        (InitCategory.isLValue() && T2->isFunctionType()))) {
4851     // In C++11, this is always a direct binding. In C++98/03, it's a direct
4852     // binding unless we're binding to a class prvalue.
4853     // Note: Although xvalues wouldn't normally show up in C++98/03 code, we
4854     // allow the use of rvalue references in C++98/03 for the benefit of
4855     // standard library implementors; therefore, we need the xvalue check here.
4856     SetAsReferenceBinding(/*BindsDirectly=*/S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 ||
4857                           !(InitCategory.isPRValue() || T2->isRecordType()));
4858     return ICS;
4859   }
4860 
4861   //            -- has a class type (i.e., T2 is a class type), where T1 is not
4862   //               reference-related to T2, and can be implicitly converted to
4863   //               an xvalue, class prvalue, or function lvalue of type
4864   //               "cv3 T3", where "cv1 T1" is reference-compatible with
4865   //               "cv3 T3",
4866   //
4867   //          then the reference is bound to the value of the initializer
4868   //          expression in the first case and to the result of the conversion
4869   //          in the second case (or, in either case, to an appropriate base
4870   //          class subobject).
4871   if (!SuppressUserConversions && RefRelationship == Sema::Ref_Incompatible &&
4872       T2->isRecordType() && S.isCompleteType(DeclLoc, T2) &&
4873       FindConversionForRefInit(S, ICS, DeclType, DeclLoc,
4874                                Init, T2, /*AllowRvalues=*/true,
4875                                AllowExplicit)) {
4876     // In the second case, if the reference is an rvalue reference
4877     // and the second standard conversion sequence of the
4878     // user-defined conversion sequence includes an lvalue-to-rvalue
4879     // conversion, the program is ill-formed.
4880     if (ICS.isUserDefined() && isRValRef &&
4881         ICS.UserDefined.After.First == ICK_Lvalue_To_Rvalue)
4882       ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, Init, DeclType);
4883 
4884     return ICS;
4885   }
4886 
4887   // A temporary of function type cannot be created; don't even try.
4888   if (T1->isFunctionType())
4889     return ICS;
4890 
4891   //       -- Otherwise, a temporary of type "cv1 T1" is created and
4892   //          initialized from the initializer expression using the
4893   //          rules for a non-reference copy initialization (8.5). The
4894   //          reference is then bound to the temporary. If T1 is
4895   //          reference-related to T2, cv1 must be the same
4896   //          cv-qualification as, or greater cv-qualification than,
4897   //          cv2; otherwise, the program is ill-formed.
4898   if (RefRelationship == Sema::Ref_Related) {
4899     // If cv1 == cv2 or cv1 is a greater cv-qualified than cv2, then
4900     // we would be reference-compatible or reference-compatible with
4901     // added qualification. But that wasn't the case, so the reference
4902     // initialization fails.
4903     //
4904     // Note that we only want to check address spaces and cvr-qualifiers here.
4905     // ObjC GC, lifetime and unaligned qualifiers aren't important.
4906     Qualifiers T1Quals = T1.getQualifiers();
4907     Qualifiers T2Quals = T2.getQualifiers();
4908     T1Quals.removeObjCGCAttr();
4909     T1Quals.removeObjCLifetime();
4910     T2Quals.removeObjCGCAttr();
4911     T2Quals.removeObjCLifetime();
4912     // MS compiler ignores __unaligned qualifier for references; do the same.
4913     T1Quals.removeUnaligned();
4914     T2Quals.removeUnaligned();
4915     if (!T1Quals.compatiblyIncludes(T2Quals))
4916       return ICS;
4917   }
4918 
4919   // If at least one of the types is a class type, the types are not
4920   // related, and we aren't allowed any user conversions, the
4921   // reference binding fails. This case is important for breaking
4922   // recursion, since TryImplicitConversion below will attempt to
4923   // create a temporary through the use of a copy constructor.
4924   if (SuppressUserConversions && RefRelationship == Sema::Ref_Incompatible &&
4925       (T1->isRecordType() || T2->isRecordType()))
4926     return ICS;
4927 
4928   // If T1 is reference-related to T2 and the reference is an rvalue
4929   // reference, the initializer expression shall not be an lvalue.
4930   if (RefRelationship >= Sema::Ref_Related && isRValRef &&
4931       Init->Classify(S.Context).isLValue()) {
4932     ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::rvalue_ref_to_lvalue, Init, DeclType);
4933     return ICS;
4934   }
4935 
4936   // C++ [over.ics.ref]p2:
4937   //   When a parameter of reference type is not bound directly to
4938   //   an argument expression, the conversion sequence is the one
4939   //   required to convert the argument expression to the
4940   //   underlying type of the reference according to
4941   //   13.3.3.1. Conceptually, this conversion sequence corresponds
4942   //   to copy-initializing a temporary of the underlying type with
4943   //   the argument expression. Any difference in top-level
4944   //   cv-qualification is subsumed by the initialization itself
4945   //   and does not constitute a conversion.
4946   ICS = TryImplicitConversion(S, Init, T1, SuppressUserConversions,
4947                               AllowedExplicit::None,
4948                               /*InOverloadResolution=*/false,
4949                               /*CStyle=*/false,
4950                               /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/false,
4951                               /*AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit=*/false);
4952 
4953   // Of course, that's still a reference binding.
4954   if (ICS.isStandard()) {
4955     ICS.Standard.ReferenceBinding = true;
4956     ICS.Standard.IsLvalueReference = !isRValRef;
4957     ICS.Standard.BindsToFunctionLvalue = false;
4958     ICS.Standard.BindsToRvalue = true;
4959     ICS.Standard.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier = false;
4960     ICS.Standard.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding = false;
4961   } else if (ICS.isUserDefined()) {
4962     const ReferenceType *LValRefType =
4963         ICS.UserDefined.ConversionFunction->getReturnType()
4964             ->getAs<LValueReferenceType>();
4965 
4966     // C++ [over.ics.ref]p3:
4967     //   Except for an implicit object parameter, for which see 13.3.1, a
4968     //   standard conversion sequence cannot be formed if it requires [...]
4969     //   binding an rvalue reference to an lvalue other than a function
4970     //   lvalue.
4971     // Note that the function case is not possible here.
4972     if (isRValRef && LValRefType) {
4973       ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, Init, DeclType);
4974       return ICS;
4975     }
4976 
4977     ICS.UserDefined.After.ReferenceBinding = true;
4978     ICS.UserDefined.After.IsLvalueReference = !isRValRef;
4979     ICS.UserDefined.After.BindsToFunctionLvalue = false;
4980     ICS.UserDefined.After.BindsToRvalue = !LValRefType;
4981     ICS.UserDefined.After.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier = false;
4982     ICS.UserDefined.After.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding = false;
4983   }
4984 
4985   return ICS;
4986 }
4987 
4988 static ImplicitConversionSequence
4989 TryCopyInitialization(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
4990                       bool SuppressUserConversions,
4991                       bool InOverloadResolution,
4992                       bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion,
4993                       bool AllowExplicit = false);
4994 
4995 /// TryListConversion - Try to copy-initialize a value of type ToType from the
4996 /// initializer list From.
4997 static ImplicitConversionSequence
4998 TryListConversion(Sema &S, InitListExpr *From, QualType ToType,
4999                   bool SuppressUserConversions,
5000                   bool InOverloadResolution,
5001                   bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion) {
5002   // C++11 [over.ics.list]p1:
5003   //   When an argument is an initializer list, it is not an expression and
5004   //   special rules apply for converting it to a parameter type.
5005 
5006   ImplicitConversionSequence Result;
5007   Result.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, From, ToType);
5008 
5009   // We need a complete type for what follows. Incomplete types can never be
5010   // initialized from init lists.
5011   if (!S.isCompleteType(From->getBeginLoc(), ToType))
5012     return Result;
5013 
5014   // Per DR1467:
5015   //   If the parameter type is a class X and the initializer list has a single
5016   //   element of type cv U, where U is X or a class derived from X, the
5017   //   implicit conversion sequence is the one required to convert the element
5018   //   to the parameter type.
5019   //
5020   //   Otherwise, if the parameter type is a character array [... ]
5021   //   and the initializer list has a single element that is an
5022   //   appropriately-typed string literal (8.5.2 [dcl.init.string]), the
5023   //   implicit conversion sequence is the identity conversion.
5024   if (From->getNumInits() == 1) {
5025     if (ToType->isRecordType()) {
5026       QualType InitType = From->getInit(0)->getType();
5027       if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(InitType, ToType) ||
5028           S.IsDerivedFrom(From->getBeginLoc(), InitType, ToType))
5029         return TryCopyInitialization(S, From->getInit(0), ToType,
5030                                      SuppressUserConversions,
5031                                      InOverloadResolution,
5032                                      AllowObjCWritebackConversion);
5033     }
5034 
5035     if (const auto *AT = S.Context.getAsArrayType(ToType)) {
5036       if (S.IsStringInit(From->getInit(0), AT)) {
5037         InitializedEntity Entity =
5038           InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(S.Context, ToType,
5039                                                  /*Consumed=*/false);
5040         if (S.CanPerformCopyInitialization(Entity, From)) {
5041           Result.setStandard();
5042           Result.Standard.setAsIdentityConversion();
5043           Result.Standard.setFromType(ToType);
5044           Result.Standard.setAllToTypes(ToType);
5045           return Result;
5046         }
5047       }
5048     }
5049   }
5050 
5051   // C++14 [over.ics.list]p2: Otherwise, if the parameter type [...] (below).
5052   // C++11 [over.ics.list]p2:
5053   //   If the parameter type is std::initializer_list<X> or "array of X" and
5054   //   all the elements can be implicitly converted to X, the implicit
5055   //   conversion sequence is the worst conversion necessary to convert an
5056   //   element of the list to X.
5057   //
5058   // C++14 [over.ics.list]p3:
5059   //   Otherwise, if the parameter type is "array of N X", if the initializer
5060   //   list has exactly N elements or if it has fewer than N elements and X is
5061   //   default-constructible, and if all the elements of the initializer list
5062   //   can be implicitly converted to X, the implicit conversion sequence is
5063   //   the worst conversion necessary to convert an element of the list to X.
5064   //
5065   // FIXME: We're missing a lot of these checks.
5066   bool toStdInitializerList = false;
5067   QualType X;
5068   if (ToType->isArrayType())
5069     X = S.Context.getAsArrayType(ToType)->getElementType();
5070   else
5071     toStdInitializerList = S.isStdInitializerList(ToType, &X);
5072   if (!X.isNull()) {
5073     for (unsigned i = 0, e = From->getNumInits(); i < e; ++i) {
5074       Expr *Init = From->getInit(i);
5075       ImplicitConversionSequence ICS =
5076           TryCopyInitialization(S, Init, X, SuppressUserConversions,
5077                                 InOverloadResolution,
5078                                 AllowObjCWritebackConversion);
5079       // If a single element isn't convertible, fail.
5080       if (ICS.isBad()) {
5081         Result = ICS;
5082         break;
5083       }
5084       // Otherwise, look for the worst conversion.
5085       if (Result.isBad() || CompareImplicitConversionSequences(
5086                                 S, From->getBeginLoc(), ICS, Result) ==
5087                                 ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse)
5088         Result = ICS;
5089     }
5090 
5091     // For an empty list, we won't have computed any conversion sequence.
5092     // Introduce the identity conversion sequence.
5093     if (From->getNumInits() == 0) {
5094       Result.setStandard();
5095       Result.Standard.setAsIdentityConversion();
5096       Result.Standard.setFromType(ToType);
5097       Result.Standard.setAllToTypes(ToType);
5098     }
5099 
5100     Result.setStdInitializerListElement(toStdInitializerList);
5101     return Result;
5102   }
5103 
5104   // C++14 [over.ics.list]p4:
5105   // C++11 [over.ics.list]p3:
5106   //   Otherwise, if the parameter is a non-aggregate class X and overload
5107   //   resolution chooses a single best constructor [...] the implicit
5108   //   conversion sequence is a user-defined conversion sequence. If multiple
5109   //   constructors are viable but none is better than the others, the
5110   //   implicit conversion sequence is a user-defined conversion sequence.
5111   if (ToType->isRecordType() && !ToType->isAggregateType()) {
5112     // This function can deal with initializer lists.
5113     return TryUserDefinedConversion(S, From, ToType, SuppressUserConversions,
5114                                     AllowedExplicit::None,
5115                                     InOverloadResolution, /*CStyle=*/false,
5116                                     AllowObjCWritebackConversion,
5117                                     /*AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit=*/false);
5118   }
5119 
5120   // C++14 [over.ics.list]p5:
5121   // C++11 [over.ics.list]p4:
5122   //   Otherwise, if the parameter has an aggregate type which can be
5123   //   initialized from the initializer list [...] the implicit conversion
5124   //   sequence is a user-defined conversion sequence.
5125   if (ToType->isAggregateType()) {
5126     // Type is an aggregate, argument is an init list. At this point it comes
5127     // down to checking whether the initialization works.
5128     // FIXME: Find out whether this parameter is consumed or not.
5129     InitializedEntity Entity =
5130         InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(S.Context, ToType,
5131                                                /*Consumed=*/false);
5132     if (S.CanPerformAggregateInitializationForOverloadResolution(Entity,
5133                                                                  From)) {
5134       Result.setUserDefined();
5135       Result.UserDefined.Before.setAsIdentityConversion();
5136       // Initializer lists don't have a type.
5137       Result.UserDefined.Before.setFromType(QualType());
5138       Result.UserDefined.Before.setAllToTypes(QualType());
5139 
5140       Result.UserDefined.After.setAsIdentityConversion();
5141       Result.UserDefined.After.setFromType(ToType);
5142       Result.UserDefined.After.setAllToTypes(ToType);
5143       Result.UserDefined.ConversionFunction = nullptr;
5144     }
5145     return Result;
5146   }
5147 
5148   // C++14 [over.ics.list]p6:
5149   // C++11 [over.ics.list]p5:
5150   //   Otherwise, if the parameter is a reference, see 13.3.3.1.4.
5151   if (ToType->isReferenceType()) {
5152     // The standard is notoriously unclear here, since 13.3.3.1.4 doesn't
5153     // mention initializer lists in any way. So we go by what list-
5154     // initialization would do and try to extrapolate from that.
5155 
5156     QualType T1 = ToType->castAs<ReferenceType>()->getPointeeType();
5157 
5158     // If the initializer list has a single element that is reference-related
5159     // to the parameter type, we initialize the reference from that.
5160     if (From->getNumInits() == 1) {
5161       Expr *Init = From->getInit(0);
5162 
5163       QualType T2 = Init->getType();
5164 
5165       // If the initializer is the address of an overloaded function, try
5166       // to resolve the overloaded function. If all goes well, T2 is the
5167       // type of the resulting function.
5168       if (S.Context.getCanonicalType(T2) == S.Context.OverloadTy) {
5169         DeclAccessPair Found;
5170         if (FunctionDecl *Fn = S.ResolveAddressOfOverloadedFunction(
5171                                    Init, ToType, false, Found))
5172           T2 = Fn->getType();
5173       }
5174 
5175       // Compute some basic properties of the types and the initializer.
5176       Sema::ReferenceCompareResult RefRelationship =
5177           S.CompareReferenceRelationship(From->getBeginLoc(), T1, T2);
5178 
5179       if (RefRelationship >= Sema::Ref_Related) {
5180         return TryReferenceInit(S, Init, ToType, /*FIXME*/ From->getBeginLoc(),
5181                                 SuppressUserConversions,
5182                                 /*AllowExplicit=*/false);
5183       }
5184     }
5185 
5186     // Otherwise, we bind the reference to a temporary created from the
5187     // initializer list.
5188     Result = TryListConversion(S, From, T1, SuppressUserConversions,
5189                                InOverloadResolution,
5190                                AllowObjCWritebackConversion);
5191     if (Result.isFailure())
5192       return Result;
5193     assert(!Result.isEllipsis() &&
5194            "Sub-initialization cannot result in ellipsis conversion.");
5195 
5196     // Can we even bind to a temporary?
5197     if (ToType->isRValueReferenceType() ||
5198         (T1.isConstQualified() && !T1.isVolatileQualified())) {
5199       StandardConversionSequence &SCS = Result.isStandard() ? Result.Standard :
5200                                             Result.UserDefined.After;
5201       SCS.ReferenceBinding = true;
5202       SCS.IsLvalueReference = ToType->isLValueReferenceType();
5203       SCS.BindsToRvalue = true;
5204       SCS.BindsToFunctionLvalue = false;
5205       SCS.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier = false;
5206       SCS.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding = false;
5207     } else
5208       Result.setBad(BadConversionSequence::lvalue_ref_to_rvalue,
5209                     From, ToType);
5210     return Result;
5211   }
5212 
5213   // C++14 [over.ics.list]p7:
5214   // C++11 [over.ics.list]p6:
5215   //   Otherwise, if the parameter type is not a class:
5216   if (!ToType->isRecordType()) {
5217     //    - if the initializer list has one element that is not itself an
5218     //      initializer list, the implicit conversion sequence is the one
5219     //      required to convert the element to the parameter type.
5220     unsigned NumInits = From->getNumInits();
5221     if (NumInits == 1 && !isa<InitListExpr>(From->getInit(0)))
5222       Result = TryCopyInitialization(S, From->getInit(0), ToType,
5223                                      SuppressUserConversions,
5224                                      InOverloadResolution,
5225                                      AllowObjCWritebackConversion);
5226     //    - if the initializer list has no elements, the implicit conversion
5227     //      sequence is the identity conversion.
5228     else if (NumInits == 0) {
5229       Result.setStandard();
5230       Result.Standard.setAsIdentityConversion();
5231       Result.Standard.setFromType(ToType);
5232       Result.Standard.setAllToTypes(ToType);
5233     }
5234     return Result;
5235   }
5236 
5237   // C++14 [over.ics.list]p8:
5238   // C++11 [over.ics.list]p7:
5239   //   In all cases other than those enumerated above, no conversion is possible
5240   return Result;
5241 }
5242 
5243 /// TryCopyInitialization - Try to copy-initialize a value of type
5244 /// ToType from the expression From. Return the implicit conversion
5245 /// sequence required to pass this argument, which may be a bad
5246 /// conversion sequence (meaning that the argument cannot be passed to
5247 /// a parameter of this type). If @p SuppressUserConversions, then we
5248 /// do not permit any user-defined conversion sequences.
5249 static ImplicitConversionSequence
5250 TryCopyInitialization(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
5251                       bool SuppressUserConversions,
5252                       bool InOverloadResolution,
5253                       bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion,
5254                       bool AllowExplicit) {
5255   if (InitListExpr *FromInitList = dyn_cast<InitListExpr>(From))
5256     return TryListConversion(S, FromInitList, ToType, SuppressUserConversions,
5257                              InOverloadResolution,AllowObjCWritebackConversion);
5258 
5259   if (ToType->isReferenceType())
5260     return TryReferenceInit(S, From, ToType,
5261                             /*FIXME:*/ From->getBeginLoc(),
5262                             SuppressUserConversions, AllowExplicit);
5263 
5264   return TryImplicitConversion(S, From, ToType,
5265                                SuppressUserConversions,
5266                                AllowedExplicit::None,
5267                                InOverloadResolution,
5268                                /*CStyle=*/false,
5269                                AllowObjCWritebackConversion,
5270                                /*AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit=*/false);
5271 }
5272 
5273 static bool TryCopyInitialization(const CanQualType FromQTy,
5274                                   const CanQualType ToQTy,
5275                                   Sema &S,
5276                                   SourceLocation Loc,
5277                                   ExprValueKind FromVK) {
5278   OpaqueValueExpr TmpExpr(Loc, FromQTy, FromVK);
5279   ImplicitConversionSequence ICS =
5280     TryCopyInitialization(S, &TmpExpr, ToQTy, true, true, false);
5281 
5282   return !ICS.isBad();
5283 }
5284 
5285 /// TryObjectArgumentInitialization - Try to initialize the object
5286 /// parameter of the given member function (@c Method) from the
5287 /// expression @p From.
5288 static ImplicitConversionSequence
5289 TryObjectArgumentInitialization(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, QualType FromType,
5290                                 Expr::Classification FromClassification,
5291                                 CXXMethodDecl *Method,
5292                                 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext) {
5293   QualType ClassType = S.Context.getTypeDeclType(ActingContext);
5294   // [class.dtor]p2: A destructor can be invoked for a const, volatile or
5295   //                 const volatile object.
5296   Qualifiers Quals = Method->getMethodQualifiers();
5297   if (isa<CXXDestructorDecl>(Method)) {
5298     Quals.addConst();
5299     Quals.addVolatile();
5300   }
5301 
5302   QualType ImplicitParamType = S.Context.getQualifiedType(ClassType, Quals);
5303 
5304   // Set up the conversion sequence as a "bad" conversion, to allow us
5305   // to exit early.
5306   ImplicitConversionSequence ICS;
5307 
5308   // We need to have an object of class type.
5309   if (const PointerType *PT = FromType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
5310     FromType = PT->getPointeeType();
5311 
5312     // When we had a pointer, it's implicitly dereferenced, so we
5313     // better have an lvalue.
5314     assert(FromClassification.isLValue());
5315   }
5316 
5317   assert(FromType->isRecordType());
5318 
5319   // C++0x [over.match.funcs]p4:
5320   //   For non-static member functions, the type of the implicit object
5321   //   parameter is
5322   //
5323   //     - "lvalue reference to cv X" for functions declared without a
5324   //        ref-qualifier or with the & ref-qualifier
5325   //     - "rvalue reference to cv X" for functions declared with the &&
5326   //        ref-qualifier
5327   //
5328   // where X is the class of which the function is a member and cv is the
5329   // cv-qualification on the member function declaration.
5330   //
5331   // However, when finding an implicit conversion sequence for the argument, we
5332   // are not allowed to perform user-defined conversions
5333   // (C++ [over.match.funcs]p5). We perform a simplified version of
5334   // reference binding here, that allows class rvalues to bind to
5335   // non-constant references.
5336 
5337   // First check the qualifiers.
5338   QualType FromTypeCanon = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType);
5339   if (ImplicitParamType.getCVRQualifiers()
5340                                     != FromTypeCanon.getLocalCVRQualifiers() &&
5341       !ImplicitParamType.isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(FromTypeCanon)) {
5342     ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::bad_qualifiers,
5343                FromType, ImplicitParamType);
5344     return ICS;
5345   }
5346 
5347   if (FromTypeCanon.hasAddressSpace()) {
5348     Qualifiers QualsImplicitParamType = ImplicitParamType.getQualifiers();
5349     Qualifiers QualsFromType = FromTypeCanon.getQualifiers();
5350     if (!QualsImplicitParamType.isAddressSpaceSupersetOf(QualsFromType)) {
5351       ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::bad_qualifiers,
5352                  FromType, ImplicitParamType);
5353       return ICS;
5354     }
5355   }
5356 
5357   // Check that we have either the same type or a derived type. It
5358   // affects the conversion rank.
5359   QualType ClassTypeCanon = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ClassType);
5360   ImplicitConversionKind SecondKind;
5361   if (ClassTypeCanon == FromTypeCanon.getLocalUnqualifiedType()) {
5362     SecondKind = ICK_Identity;
5363   } else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(Loc, FromType, ClassType))
5364     SecondKind = ICK_Derived_To_Base;
5365   else {
5366     ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::unrelated_class,
5367                FromType, ImplicitParamType);
5368     return ICS;
5369   }
5370 
5371   // Check the ref-qualifier.
5372   switch (Method->getRefQualifier()) {
5373   case RQ_None:
5374     // Do nothing; we don't care about lvalueness or rvalueness.
5375     break;
5376 
5377   case RQ_LValue:
5378     if (!FromClassification.isLValue() && !Quals.hasOnlyConst()) {
5379       // non-const lvalue reference cannot bind to an rvalue
5380       ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::lvalue_ref_to_rvalue, FromType,
5381                  ImplicitParamType);
5382       return ICS;
5383     }
5384     break;
5385 
5386   case RQ_RValue:
5387     if (!FromClassification.isRValue()) {
5388       // rvalue reference cannot bind to an lvalue
5389       ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::rvalue_ref_to_lvalue, FromType,
5390                  ImplicitParamType);
5391       return ICS;
5392     }
5393     break;
5394   }
5395 
5396   // Success. Mark this as a reference binding.
5397   ICS.setStandard();
5398   ICS.Standard.setAsIdentityConversion();
5399   ICS.Standard.Second = SecondKind;
5400   ICS.Standard.setFromType(FromType);
5401   ICS.Standard.setAllToTypes(ImplicitParamType);
5402   ICS.Standard.ReferenceBinding = true;
5403   ICS.Standard.DirectBinding = true;
5404   ICS.Standard.IsLvalueReference = Method->getRefQualifier() != RQ_RValue;
5405   ICS.Standard.BindsToFunctionLvalue = false;
5406   ICS.Standard.BindsToRvalue = FromClassification.isRValue();
5407   ICS.Standard.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier
5408     = (Method->getRefQualifier() == RQ_None);
5409   return ICS;
5410 }
5411 
5412 /// PerformObjectArgumentInitialization - Perform initialization of
5413 /// the implicit object parameter for the given Method with the given
5414 /// expression.
5415 ExprResult
5416 Sema::PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Expr *From,
5417                                           NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier,
5418                                           NamedDecl *FoundDecl,
5419                                           CXXMethodDecl *Method) {
5420   QualType FromRecordType, DestType;
5421   QualType ImplicitParamRecordType  =
5422     Method->getThisType()->castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
5423 
5424   Expr::Classification FromClassification;
5425   if (const PointerType *PT = From->getType()->getAs<PointerType>()) {
5426     FromRecordType = PT->getPointeeType();
5427     DestType = Method->getThisType();
5428     FromClassification = Expr::Classification::makeSimpleLValue();
5429   } else {
5430     FromRecordType = From->getType();
5431     DestType = ImplicitParamRecordType;
5432     FromClassification = From->Classify(Context);
5433 
5434     // When performing member access on an rvalue, materialize a temporary.
5435     if (From->isRValue()) {
5436       From = CreateMaterializeTemporaryExpr(FromRecordType, From,
5437                                             Method->getRefQualifier() !=
5438                                                 RefQualifierKind::RQ_RValue);
5439     }
5440   }
5441 
5442   // Note that we always use the true parent context when performing
5443   // the actual argument initialization.
5444   ImplicitConversionSequence ICS = TryObjectArgumentInitialization(
5445       *this, From->getBeginLoc(), From->getType(), FromClassification, Method,
5446       Method->getParent());
5447   if (ICS.isBad()) {
5448     switch (ICS.Bad.Kind) {
5449     case BadConversionSequence::bad_qualifiers: {
5450       Qualifiers FromQs = FromRecordType.getQualifiers();
5451       Qualifiers ToQs = DestType.getQualifiers();
5452       unsigned CVR = FromQs.getCVRQualifiers() & ~ToQs.getCVRQualifiers();
5453       if (CVR) {
5454         Diag(From->getBeginLoc(), diag::err_member_function_call_bad_cvr)
5455             << Method->getDeclName() << FromRecordType << (CVR - 1)
5456             << From->getSourceRange();
5457         Diag(Method->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
5458           << Method->getDeclName();
5459         return ExprError();
5460       }
5461       break;
5462     }
5463 
5464     case BadConversionSequence::lvalue_ref_to_rvalue:
5465     case BadConversionSequence::rvalue_ref_to_lvalue: {
5466       bool IsRValueQualified =
5467         Method->getRefQualifier() == RefQualifierKind::RQ_RValue;
5468       Diag(From->getBeginLoc(), diag::err_member_function_call_bad_ref)
5469           << Method->getDeclName() << FromClassification.isRValue()
5470           << IsRValueQualified;
5471       Diag(Method->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
5472         << Method->getDeclName();
5473       return ExprError();
5474     }
5475 
5476     case BadConversionSequence::no_conversion:
5477     case BadConversionSequence::unrelated_class:
5478       break;
5479     }
5480 
5481     return Diag(From->getBeginLoc(), diag::err_member_function_call_bad_type)
5482            << ImplicitParamRecordType << FromRecordType
5483            << From->getSourceRange();
5484   }
5485 
5486   if (ICS.Standard.Second == ICK_Derived_To_Base) {
5487     ExprResult FromRes =
5488       PerformObjectMemberConversion(From, Qualifier, FoundDecl, Method);
5489     if (FromRes.isInvalid())
5490       return ExprError();
5491     From = FromRes.get();
5492   }
5493 
5494   if (!Context.hasSameType(From->getType(), DestType)) {
5495     CastKind CK;
5496     QualType PteeTy = DestType->getPointeeType();
5497     LangAS DestAS =
5498         PteeTy.isNull() ? DestType.getAddressSpace() : PteeTy.getAddressSpace();
5499     if (FromRecordType.getAddressSpace() != DestAS)
5500       CK = CK_AddressSpaceConversion;
5501     else
5502       CK = CK_NoOp;
5503     From = ImpCastExprToType(From, DestType, CK, From->getValueKind()).get();
5504   }
5505   return From;
5506 }
5507 
5508 /// TryContextuallyConvertToBool - Attempt to contextually convert the
5509 /// expression From to bool (C++0x [conv]p3).
5510 static ImplicitConversionSequence
5511 TryContextuallyConvertToBool(Sema &S, Expr *From) {
5512   // C++ [dcl.init]/17.8:
5513   //   - Otherwise, if the initialization is direct-initialization, the source
5514   //     type is std::nullptr_t, and the destination type is bool, the initial
5515   //     value of the object being initialized is false.
5516   if (From->getType()->isNullPtrType())
5517     return ImplicitConversionSequence::getNullptrToBool(From->getType(),
5518                                                         S.Context.BoolTy,
5519                                                         From->isGLValue());
5520 
5521   // All other direct-initialization of bool is equivalent to an implicit
5522   // conversion to bool in which explicit conversions are permitted.
5523   return TryImplicitConversion(S, From, S.Context.BoolTy,
5524                                /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false,
5525                                AllowedExplicit::Conversions,
5526                                /*InOverloadResolution=*/false,
5527                                /*CStyle=*/false,
5528                                /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/false,
5529                                /*AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit=*/false);
5530 }
5531 
5532 /// PerformContextuallyConvertToBool - Perform a contextual conversion
5533 /// of the expression From to bool (C++0x [conv]p3).
5534 ExprResult Sema::PerformContextuallyConvertToBool(Expr *From) {
5535   if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, From))
5536     return ExprError();
5537 
5538   ImplicitConversionSequence ICS = TryContextuallyConvertToBool(*this, From);
5539   if (!ICS.isBad())
5540     return PerformImplicitConversion(From, Context.BoolTy, ICS, AA_Converting);
5541 
5542   if (!DiagnoseMultipleUserDefinedConversion(From, Context.BoolTy))
5543     return Diag(From->getBeginLoc(), diag::err_typecheck_bool_condition)
5544            << From->getType() << From->getSourceRange();
5545   return ExprError();
5546 }
5547 
5548 /// Check that the specified conversion is permitted in a converted constant
5549 /// expression, according to C++11 [expr.const]p3. Return true if the conversion
5550 /// is acceptable.
5551 static bool CheckConvertedConstantConversions(Sema &S,
5552                                               StandardConversionSequence &SCS) {
5553   // Since we know that the target type is an integral or unscoped enumeration
5554   // type, most conversion kinds are impossible. All possible First and Third
5555   // conversions are fine.
5556   switch (SCS.Second) {
5557   case ICK_Identity:
5558   case ICK_Integral_Promotion:
5559   case ICK_Integral_Conversion: // Narrowing conversions are checked elsewhere.
5560   case ICK_Zero_Queue_Conversion:
5561     return true;
5562 
5563   case ICK_Boolean_Conversion:
5564     // Conversion from an integral or unscoped enumeration type to bool is
5565     // classified as ICK_Boolean_Conversion, but it's also arguably an integral
5566     // conversion, so we allow it in a converted constant expression.
5567     //
5568     // FIXME: Per core issue 1407, we should not allow this, but that breaks
5569     // a lot of popular code. We should at least add a warning for this
5570     // (non-conforming) extension.
5571     return SCS.getFromType()->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType() &&
5572            SCS.getToType(2)->isBooleanType();
5573 
5574   case ICK_Pointer_Conversion:
5575   case ICK_Pointer_Member:
5576     // C++1z: null pointer conversions and null member pointer conversions are
5577     // only permitted if the source type is std::nullptr_t.
5578     return SCS.getFromType()->isNullPtrType();
5579 
5580   case ICK_Floating_Promotion:
5581   case ICK_Complex_Promotion:
5582   case ICK_Floating_Conversion:
5583   case ICK_Complex_Conversion:
5584   case ICK_Floating_Integral:
5585   case ICK_Compatible_Conversion:
5586   case ICK_Derived_To_Base:
5587   case ICK_Vector_Conversion:
5588   case ICK_SVE_Vector_Conversion:
5589   case ICK_Vector_Splat:
5590   case ICK_Complex_Real:
5591   case ICK_Block_Pointer_Conversion:
5592   case ICK_TransparentUnionConversion:
5593   case ICK_Writeback_Conversion:
5594   case ICK_Zero_Event_Conversion:
5595   case ICK_C_Only_Conversion:
5596   case ICK_Incompatible_Pointer_Conversion:
5597     return false;
5598 
5599   case ICK_Lvalue_To_Rvalue:
5600   case ICK_Array_To_Pointer:
5601   case ICK_Function_To_Pointer:
5602     llvm_unreachable("found a first conversion kind in Second");
5603 
5604   case ICK_Function_Conversion:
5605   case ICK_Qualification:
5606     llvm_unreachable("found a third conversion kind in Second");
5607 
5608   case ICK_Num_Conversion_Kinds:
5609     break;
5610   }
5611 
5612   llvm_unreachable("unknown conversion kind");
5613 }
5614 
5615 /// CheckConvertedConstantExpression - Check that the expression From is a
5616 /// converted constant expression of type T, perform the conversion and produce
5617 /// the converted expression, per C++11 [expr.const]p3.
5618 static ExprResult CheckConvertedConstantExpression(Sema &S, Expr *From,
5619                                                    QualType T, APValue &Value,
5620                                                    Sema::CCEKind CCE,
5621                                                    bool RequireInt,
5622                                                    NamedDecl *Dest) {
5623   assert(S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 &&
5624          "converted constant expression outside C++11");
5625 
5626   if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(S, From))
5627     return ExprError();
5628 
5629   // C++1z [expr.const]p3:
5630   //  A converted constant expression of type T is an expression,
5631   //  implicitly converted to type T, where the converted
5632   //  expression is a constant expression and the implicit conversion
5633   //  sequence contains only [... list of conversions ...].
5634   // C++1z [stmt.if]p2:
5635   //  If the if statement is of the form if constexpr, the value of the
5636   //  condition shall be a contextually converted constant expression of type
5637   //  bool.
5638   ImplicitConversionSequence ICS =
5639       CCE == Sema::CCEK_ConstexprIf || CCE == Sema::CCEK_ExplicitBool
5640           ? TryContextuallyConvertToBool(S, From)
5641           : TryCopyInitialization(S, From, T,
5642                                   /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false,
5643                                   /*InOverloadResolution=*/false,
5644                                   /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/false,
5645                                   /*AllowExplicit=*/false);
5646   StandardConversionSequence *SCS = nullptr;
5647   switch (ICS.getKind()) {
5648   case ImplicitConversionSequence::StandardConversion:
5649     SCS = &ICS.Standard;
5650     break;
5651   case ImplicitConversionSequence::UserDefinedConversion:
5652     if (T->isRecordType())
5653       SCS = &ICS.UserDefined.Before;
5654     else
5655       SCS = &ICS.UserDefined.After;
5656     break;
5657   case ImplicitConversionSequence::AmbiguousConversion:
5658   case ImplicitConversionSequence::BadConversion:
5659     if (!S.DiagnoseMultipleUserDefinedConversion(From, T))
5660       return S.Diag(From->getBeginLoc(),
5661                     diag::err_typecheck_converted_constant_expression)
5662              << From->getType() << From->getSourceRange() << T;
5663     return ExprError();
5664 
5665   case ImplicitConversionSequence::EllipsisConversion:
5666     llvm_unreachable("ellipsis conversion in converted constant expression");
5667   }
5668 
5669   // Check that we would only use permitted conversions.
5670   if (!CheckConvertedConstantConversions(S, *SCS)) {
5671     return S.Diag(From->getBeginLoc(),
5672                   diag::err_typecheck_converted_constant_expression_disallowed)
5673            << From->getType() << From->getSourceRange() << T;
5674   }
5675   // [...] and where the reference binding (if any) binds directly.
5676   if (SCS->ReferenceBinding && !SCS->DirectBinding) {
5677     return S.Diag(From->getBeginLoc(),
5678                   diag::err_typecheck_converted_constant_expression_indirect)
5679            << From->getType() << From->getSourceRange() << T;
5680   }
5681 
5682   // Usually we can simply apply the ImplicitConversionSequence we formed
5683   // earlier, but that's not guaranteed to work when initializing an object of
5684   // class type.
5685   ExprResult Result;
5686   if (T->isRecordType()) {
5687     assert(CCE == Sema::CCEK_TemplateArg &&
5688            "unexpected class type converted constant expr");
5689     Result = S.PerformCopyInitialization(
5690         InitializedEntity::InitializeTemplateParameter(
5691             T, cast<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(Dest)),
5692         SourceLocation(), From);
5693   } else {
5694     Result = S.PerformImplicitConversion(From, T, ICS, Sema::AA_Converting);
5695   }
5696   if (Result.isInvalid())
5697     return Result;
5698 
5699   // C++2a [intro.execution]p5:
5700   //   A full-expression is [...] a constant-expression [...]
5701   Result =
5702       S.ActOnFinishFullExpr(Result.get(), From->getExprLoc(),
5703                             /*DiscardedValue=*/false, /*IsConstexpr=*/true);
5704   if (Result.isInvalid())
5705     return Result;
5706 
5707   // Check for a narrowing implicit conversion.
5708   bool ReturnPreNarrowingValue = false;
5709   APValue PreNarrowingValue;
5710   QualType PreNarrowingType;
5711   switch (SCS->getNarrowingKind(S.Context, Result.get(), PreNarrowingValue,
5712                                 PreNarrowingType)) {
5713   case NK_Dependent_Narrowing:
5714     // Implicit conversion to a narrower type, but the expression is
5715     // value-dependent so we can't tell whether it's actually narrowing.
5716   case NK_Variable_Narrowing:
5717     // Implicit conversion to a narrower type, and the value is not a constant
5718     // expression. We'll diagnose this in a moment.
5719   case NK_Not_Narrowing:
5720     break;
5721 
5722   case NK_Constant_Narrowing:
5723     if (CCE == Sema::CCEK_ArrayBound &&
5724         PreNarrowingType->isIntegralOrEnumerationType() &&
5725         PreNarrowingValue.isInt()) {
5726       // Don't diagnose array bound narrowing here; we produce more precise
5727       // errors by allowing the un-narrowed value through.
5728       ReturnPreNarrowingValue = true;
5729       break;
5730     }
5731     S.Diag(From->getBeginLoc(), diag::ext_cce_narrowing)
5732         << CCE << /*Constant*/ 1
5733         << PreNarrowingValue.getAsString(S.Context, PreNarrowingType) << T;
5734     break;
5735 
5736   case NK_Type_Narrowing:
5737     // FIXME: It would be better to diagnose that the expression is not a
5738     // constant expression.
5739     S.Diag(From->getBeginLoc(), diag::ext_cce_narrowing)
5740         << CCE << /*Constant*/ 0 << From->getType() << T;
5741     break;
5742   }
5743 
5744   if (Result.get()->isValueDependent()) {
5745     Value = APValue();
5746     return Result;
5747   }
5748 
5749   // Check the expression is a constant expression.
5750   SmallVector<PartialDiagnosticAt, 8> Notes;
5751   Expr::EvalResult Eval;
5752   Eval.Diag = &Notes;
5753 
5754   ConstantExprKind Kind;
5755   if (CCE == Sema::CCEK_TemplateArg && T->isRecordType())
5756     Kind = ConstantExprKind::ClassTemplateArgument;
5757   else if (CCE == Sema::CCEK_TemplateArg)
5758     Kind = ConstantExprKind::NonClassTemplateArgument;
5759   else
5760     Kind = ConstantExprKind::Normal;
5761 
5762   if (!Result.get()->EvaluateAsConstantExpr(Eval, S.Context, Kind) ||
5763       (RequireInt && !Eval.Val.isInt())) {
5764     // The expression can't be folded, so we can't keep it at this position in
5765     // the AST.
5766     Result = ExprError();
5767   } else {
5768     Value = Eval.Val;
5769 
5770     if (Notes.empty()) {
5771       // It's a constant expression.
5772       Expr *E = ConstantExpr::Create(S.Context, Result.get(), Value);
5773       if (ReturnPreNarrowingValue)
5774         Value = std::move(PreNarrowingValue);
5775       return E;
5776     }
5777   }
5778 
5779   // It's not a constant expression. Produce an appropriate diagnostic.
5780   if (Notes.size() == 1 &&
5781       Notes[0].second.getDiagID() == diag::note_invalid_subexpr_in_const_expr) {
5782     S.Diag(Notes[0].first, diag::err_expr_not_cce) << CCE;
5783   } else if (!Notes.empty() && Notes[0].second.getDiagID() ==
5784                                    diag::note_constexpr_invalid_template_arg) {
5785     Notes[0].second.setDiagID(diag::err_constexpr_invalid_template_arg);
5786     for (unsigned I = 0; I < Notes.size(); ++I)
5787       S.Diag(Notes[I].first, Notes[I].second);
5788   } else {
5789     S.Diag(From->getBeginLoc(), diag::err_expr_not_cce)
5790         << CCE << From->getSourceRange();
5791     for (unsigned I = 0; I < Notes.size(); ++I)
5792       S.Diag(Notes[I].first, Notes[I].second);
5793   }
5794   return ExprError();
5795 }
5796 
5797 ExprResult Sema::CheckConvertedConstantExpression(Expr *From, QualType T,
5798                                                   APValue &Value, CCEKind CCE,
5799                                                   NamedDecl *Dest) {
5800   return ::CheckConvertedConstantExpression(*this, From, T, Value, CCE, false,
5801                                             Dest);
5802 }
5803 
5804 ExprResult Sema::CheckConvertedConstantExpression(Expr *From, QualType T,
5805                                                   llvm::APSInt &Value,
5806                                                   CCEKind CCE) {
5807   assert(T->isIntegralOrEnumerationType() && "unexpected converted const type");
5808 
5809   APValue V;
5810   auto R = ::CheckConvertedConstantExpression(*this, From, T, V, CCE, true,
5811                                               /*Dest=*/nullptr);
5812   if (!R.isInvalid() && !R.get()->isValueDependent())
5813     Value = V.getInt();
5814   return R;
5815 }
5816 
5817 
5818 /// dropPointerConversions - If the given standard conversion sequence
5819 /// involves any pointer conversions, remove them.  This may change
5820 /// the result type of the conversion sequence.
5821 static void dropPointerConversion(StandardConversionSequence &SCS) {
5822   if (SCS.Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion) {
5823     SCS.Second = ICK_Identity;
5824     SCS.Third = ICK_Identity;
5825     SCS.ToTypePtrs[2] = SCS.ToTypePtrs[1] = SCS.ToTypePtrs[0];
5826   }
5827 }
5828 
5829 /// TryContextuallyConvertToObjCPointer - Attempt to contextually
5830 /// convert the expression From to an Objective-C pointer type.
5831 static ImplicitConversionSequence
5832 TryContextuallyConvertToObjCPointer(Sema &S, Expr *From) {
5833   // Do an implicit conversion to 'id'.
5834   QualType Ty = S.Context.getObjCIdType();
5835   ImplicitConversionSequence ICS
5836     = TryImplicitConversion(S, From, Ty,
5837                             // FIXME: Are these flags correct?
5838                             /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false,
5839                             AllowedExplicit::Conversions,
5840                             /*InOverloadResolution=*/false,
5841                             /*CStyle=*/false,
5842                             /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/false,
5843                             /*AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit=*/true);
5844 
5845   // Strip off any final conversions to 'id'.
5846   switch (ICS.getKind()) {
5847   case ImplicitConversionSequence::BadConversion:
5848   case ImplicitConversionSequence::AmbiguousConversion:
5849   case ImplicitConversionSequence::EllipsisConversion:
5850     break;
5851 
5852   case ImplicitConversionSequence::UserDefinedConversion:
5853     dropPointerConversion(ICS.UserDefined.After);
5854     break;
5855 
5856   case ImplicitConversionSequence::StandardConversion:
5857     dropPointerConversion(ICS.Standard);
5858     break;
5859   }
5860 
5861   return ICS;
5862 }
5863 
5864 /// PerformContextuallyConvertToObjCPointer - Perform a contextual
5865 /// conversion of the expression From to an Objective-C pointer type.
5866 /// Returns a valid but null ExprResult if no conversion sequence exists.
5867 ExprResult Sema::PerformContextuallyConvertToObjCPointer(Expr *From) {
5868   if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, From))
5869     return ExprError();
5870 
5871   QualType Ty = Context.getObjCIdType();
5872   ImplicitConversionSequence ICS =
5873     TryContextuallyConvertToObjCPointer(*this, From);
5874   if (!ICS.isBad())
5875     return PerformImplicitConversion(From, Ty, ICS, AA_Converting);
5876   return ExprResult();
5877 }
5878 
5879 /// Determine whether the provided type is an integral type, or an enumeration
5880 /// type of a permitted flavor.
5881 bool Sema::ICEConvertDiagnoser::match(QualType T) {
5882   return AllowScopedEnumerations ? T->isIntegralOrEnumerationType()
5883                                  : T->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType();
5884 }
5885 
5886 static ExprResult
5887 diagnoseAmbiguousConversion(Sema &SemaRef, SourceLocation Loc, Expr *From,
5888                             Sema::ContextualImplicitConverter &Converter,
5889                             QualType T, UnresolvedSetImpl &ViableConversions) {
5890 
5891   if (Converter.Suppress)
5892     return ExprError();
5893 
5894   Converter.diagnoseAmbiguous(SemaRef, Loc, T) << From->getSourceRange();
5895   for (unsigned I = 0, N = ViableConversions.size(); I != N; ++I) {
5896     CXXConversionDecl *Conv =
5897         cast<CXXConversionDecl>(ViableConversions[I]->getUnderlyingDecl());
5898     QualType ConvTy = Conv->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType();
5899     Converter.noteAmbiguous(SemaRef, Conv, ConvTy);
5900   }
5901   return From;
5902 }
5903 
5904 static bool
5905 diagnoseNoViableConversion(Sema &SemaRef, SourceLocation Loc, Expr *&From,
5906                            Sema::ContextualImplicitConverter &Converter,
5907                            QualType T, bool HadMultipleCandidates,
5908                            UnresolvedSetImpl &ExplicitConversions) {
5909   if (ExplicitConversions.size() == 1 && !Converter.Suppress) {
5910     DeclAccessPair Found = ExplicitConversions[0];
5911     CXXConversionDecl *Conversion =
5912         cast<CXXConversionDecl>(Found->getUnderlyingDecl());
5913 
5914     // The user probably meant to invoke the given explicit
5915     // conversion; use it.
5916     QualType ConvTy = Conversion->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType();
5917     std::string TypeStr;
5918     ConvTy.getAsStringInternal(TypeStr, SemaRef.getPrintingPolicy());
5919 
5920     Converter.diagnoseExplicitConv(SemaRef, Loc, T, ConvTy)
5921         << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(From->getBeginLoc(),
5922                                       "static_cast<" + TypeStr + ">(")
5923         << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(
5924                SemaRef.getLocForEndOfToken(From->getEndLoc()), ")");
5925     Converter.noteExplicitConv(SemaRef, Conversion, ConvTy);
5926 
5927     // If we aren't in a SFINAE context, build a call to the
5928     // explicit conversion function.
5929     if (SemaRef.isSFINAEContext())
5930       return true;
5931 
5932     SemaRef.CheckMemberOperatorAccess(From->getExprLoc(), From, nullptr, Found);
5933     ExprResult Result = SemaRef.BuildCXXMemberCallExpr(From, Found, Conversion,
5934                                                        HadMultipleCandidates);
5935     if (Result.isInvalid())
5936       return true;
5937     // Record usage of conversion in an implicit cast.
5938     From = ImplicitCastExpr::Create(SemaRef.Context, Result.get()->getType(),
5939                                     CK_UserDefinedConversion, Result.get(),
5940                                     nullptr, Result.get()->getValueKind(),
5941                                     SemaRef.CurFPFeatureOverrides());
5942   }
5943   return false;
5944 }
5945 
5946 static bool recordConversion(Sema &SemaRef, SourceLocation Loc, Expr *&From,
5947                              Sema::ContextualImplicitConverter &Converter,
5948                              QualType T, bool HadMultipleCandidates,
5949                              DeclAccessPair &Found) {
5950   CXXConversionDecl *Conversion =
5951       cast<CXXConversionDecl>(Found->getUnderlyingDecl());
5952   SemaRef.CheckMemberOperatorAccess(From->getExprLoc(), From, nullptr, Found);
5953 
5954   QualType ToType = Conversion->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType();
5955   if (!Converter.SuppressConversion) {
5956     if (SemaRef.isSFINAEContext())
5957       return true;
5958 
5959     Converter.diagnoseConversion(SemaRef, Loc, T, ToType)
5960         << From->getSourceRange();
5961   }
5962 
5963   ExprResult Result = SemaRef.BuildCXXMemberCallExpr(From, Found, Conversion,
5964                                                      HadMultipleCandidates);
5965   if (Result.isInvalid())
5966     return true;
5967   // Record usage of conversion in an implicit cast.
5968   From = ImplicitCastExpr::Create(SemaRef.Context, Result.get()->getType(),
5969                                   CK_UserDefinedConversion, Result.get(),
5970                                   nullptr, Result.get()->getValueKind(),
5971                                   SemaRef.CurFPFeatureOverrides());
5972   return false;
5973 }
5974 
5975 static ExprResult finishContextualImplicitConversion(
5976     Sema &SemaRef, SourceLocation Loc, Expr *From,
5977     Sema::ContextualImplicitConverter &Converter) {
5978   if (!Converter.match(From->getType()) && !Converter.Suppress)
5979     Converter.diagnoseNoMatch(SemaRef, Loc, From->getType())
5980         << From->getSourceRange();
5981 
5982   return SemaRef.DefaultLvalueConversion(From);
5983 }
5984 
5985 static void
5986 collectViableConversionCandidates(Sema &SemaRef, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
5987                                   UnresolvedSetImpl &ViableConversions,
5988                                   OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet) {
5989   for (unsigned I = 0, N = ViableConversions.size(); I != N; ++I) {
5990     DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = ViableConversions[I];
5991     NamedDecl *D = FoundDecl.getDecl();
5992     CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D->getDeclContext());
5993     if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D))
5994       D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl();
5995 
5996     CXXConversionDecl *Conv;
5997     FunctionTemplateDecl *ConvTemplate;
5998     if ((ConvTemplate = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D)))
5999       Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(ConvTemplate->getTemplatedDecl());
6000     else
6001       Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D);
6002 
6003     if (ConvTemplate)
6004       SemaRef.AddTemplateConversionCandidate(
6005           ConvTemplate, FoundDecl, ActingContext, From, ToType, CandidateSet,
6006           /*AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit=*/false, /*AllowExplicit*/ true);
6007     else
6008       SemaRef.AddConversionCandidate(Conv, FoundDecl, ActingContext, From,
6009                                      ToType, CandidateSet,
6010                                      /*AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit=*/false,
6011                                      /*AllowExplicit*/ true);
6012   }
6013 }
6014 
6015 /// Attempt to convert the given expression to a type which is accepted
6016 /// by the given converter.
6017 ///
6018 /// This routine will attempt to convert an expression of class type to a
6019 /// type accepted by the specified converter. In C++11 and before, the class
6020 /// must have a single non-explicit conversion function converting to a matching
6021 /// type. In C++1y, there can be multiple such conversion functions, but only
6022 /// one target type.
6023 ///
6024 /// \param Loc The source location of the construct that requires the
6025 /// conversion.
6026 ///
6027 /// \param From The expression we're converting from.
6028 ///
6029 /// \param Converter Used to control and diagnose the conversion process.
6030 ///
6031 /// \returns The expression, converted to an integral or enumeration type if
6032 /// successful.
6033 ExprResult Sema::PerformContextualImplicitConversion(
6034     SourceLocation Loc, Expr *From, ContextualImplicitConverter &Converter) {
6035   // We can't perform any more checking for type-dependent expressions.
6036   if (From->isTypeDependent())
6037     return From;
6038 
6039   // Process placeholders immediately.
6040   if (From->hasPlaceholderType()) {
6041     ExprResult result = CheckPlaceholderExpr(From);
6042     if (result.isInvalid())
6043       return result;
6044     From = result.get();
6045   }
6046 
6047   // If the expression already has a matching type, we're golden.
6048   QualType T = From->getType();
6049   if (Converter.match(T))
6050     return DefaultLvalueConversion(From);
6051 
6052   // FIXME: Check for missing '()' if T is a function type?
6053 
6054   // We can only perform contextual implicit conversions on objects of class
6055   // type.
6056   const RecordType *RecordTy = T->getAs<RecordType>();
6057   if (!RecordTy || !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
6058     if (!Converter.Suppress)
6059       Converter.diagnoseNoMatch(*this, Loc, T) << From->getSourceRange();
6060     return From;
6061   }
6062 
6063   // We must have a complete class type.
6064   struct TypeDiagnoserPartialDiag : TypeDiagnoser {
6065     ContextualImplicitConverter &Converter;
6066     Expr *From;
6067 
6068     TypeDiagnoserPartialDiag(ContextualImplicitConverter &Converter, Expr *From)
6069         : Converter(Converter), From(From) {}
6070 
6071     void diagnose(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, QualType T) override {
6072       Converter.diagnoseIncomplete(S, Loc, T) << From->getSourceRange();
6073     }
6074   } IncompleteDiagnoser(Converter, From);
6075 
6076   if (Converter.Suppress ? !isCompleteType(Loc, T)
6077                          : RequireCompleteType(Loc, T, IncompleteDiagnoser))
6078     return From;
6079 
6080   // Look for a conversion to an integral or enumeration type.
6081   UnresolvedSet<4>
6082       ViableConversions; // These are *potentially* viable in C++1y.
6083   UnresolvedSet<4> ExplicitConversions;
6084   const auto &Conversions =
6085       cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RecordTy->getDecl())->getVisibleConversionFunctions();
6086 
6087   bool HadMultipleCandidates =
6088       (std::distance(Conversions.begin(), Conversions.end()) > 1);
6089 
6090   // To check that there is only one target type, in C++1y:
6091   QualType ToType;
6092   bool HasUniqueTargetType = true;
6093 
6094   // Collect explicit or viable (potentially in C++1y) conversions.
6095   for (auto I = Conversions.begin(), E = Conversions.end(); I != E; ++I) {
6096     NamedDecl *D = (*I)->getUnderlyingDecl();
6097     CXXConversionDecl *Conversion;
6098     FunctionTemplateDecl *ConvTemplate = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D);
6099     if (ConvTemplate) {
6100       if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus14)
6101         Conversion = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(ConvTemplate->getTemplatedDecl());
6102       else
6103         continue; // C++11 does not consider conversion operator templates(?).
6104     } else
6105       Conversion = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D);
6106 
6107     assert((!ConvTemplate || getLangOpts().CPlusPlus14) &&
6108            "Conversion operator templates are considered potentially "
6109            "viable in C++1y");
6110 
6111     QualType CurToType = Conversion->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType();
6112     if (Converter.match(CurToType) || ConvTemplate) {
6113 
6114       if (Conversion->isExplicit()) {
6115         // FIXME: For C++1y, do we need this restriction?
6116         // cf. diagnoseNoViableConversion()
6117         if (!ConvTemplate)
6118           ExplicitConversions.addDecl(I.getDecl(), I.getAccess());
6119       } else {
6120         if (!ConvTemplate && getLangOpts().CPlusPlus14) {
6121           if (ToType.isNull())
6122             ToType = CurToType.getUnqualifiedType();
6123           else if (HasUniqueTargetType &&
6124                    (CurToType.getUnqualifiedType() != ToType))
6125             HasUniqueTargetType = false;
6126         }
6127         ViableConversions.addDecl(I.getDecl(), I.getAccess());
6128       }
6129     }
6130   }
6131 
6132   if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus14) {
6133     // C++1y [conv]p6:
6134     // ... An expression e of class type E appearing in such a context
6135     // is said to be contextually implicitly converted to a specified
6136     // type T and is well-formed if and only if e can be implicitly
6137     // converted to a type T that is determined as follows: E is searched
6138     // for conversion functions whose return type is cv T or reference to
6139     // cv T such that T is allowed by the context. There shall be
6140     // exactly one such T.
6141 
6142     // If no unique T is found:
6143     if (ToType.isNull()) {
6144       if (diagnoseNoViableConversion(*this, Loc, From, Converter, T,
6145                                      HadMultipleCandidates,
6146                                      ExplicitConversions))
6147         return ExprError();
6148       return finishContextualImplicitConversion(*this, Loc, From, Converter);
6149     }
6150 
6151     // If more than one unique Ts are found:
6152     if (!HasUniqueTargetType)
6153       return diagnoseAmbiguousConversion(*this, Loc, From, Converter, T,
6154                                          ViableConversions);
6155 
6156     // If one unique T is found:
6157     // First, build a candidate set from the previously recorded
6158     // potentially viable conversions.
6159     OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(Loc, OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Normal);
6160     collectViableConversionCandidates(*this, From, ToType, ViableConversions,
6161                                       CandidateSet);
6162 
6163     // Then, perform overload resolution over the candidate set.
6164     OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
6165     switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, Loc, Best)) {
6166     case OR_Success: {
6167       // Apply this conversion.
6168       DeclAccessPair Found =
6169           DeclAccessPair::make(Best->Function, Best->FoundDecl.getAccess());
6170       if (recordConversion(*this, Loc, From, Converter, T,
6171                            HadMultipleCandidates, Found))
6172         return ExprError();
6173       break;
6174     }
6175     case OR_Ambiguous:
6176       return diagnoseAmbiguousConversion(*this, Loc, From, Converter, T,
6177                                          ViableConversions);
6178     case OR_No_Viable_Function:
6179       if (diagnoseNoViableConversion(*this, Loc, From, Converter, T,
6180                                      HadMultipleCandidates,
6181                                      ExplicitConversions))
6182         return ExprError();
6183       LLVM_FALLTHROUGH;
6184     case OR_Deleted:
6185       // We'll complain below about a non-integral condition type.
6186       break;
6187     }
6188   } else {
6189     switch (ViableConversions.size()) {
6190     case 0: {
6191       if (diagnoseNoViableConversion(*this, Loc, From, Converter, T,
6192                                      HadMultipleCandidates,
6193                                      ExplicitConversions))
6194         return ExprError();
6195 
6196       // We'll complain below about a non-integral condition type.
6197       break;
6198     }
6199     case 1: {
6200       // Apply this conversion.
6201       DeclAccessPair Found = ViableConversions[0];
6202       if (recordConversion(*this, Loc, From, Converter, T,
6203                            HadMultipleCandidates, Found))
6204         return ExprError();
6205       break;
6206     }
6207     default:
6208       return diagnoseAmbiguousConversion(*this, Loc, From, Converter, T,
6209                                          ViableConversions);
6210     }
6211   }
6212 
6213   return finishContextualImplicitConversion(*this, Loc, From, Converter);
6214 }
6215 
6216 /// IsAcceptableNonMemberOperatorCandidate - Determine whether Fn is
6217 /// an acceptable non-member overloaded operator for a call whose
6218 /// arguments have types T1 (and, if non-empty, T2). This routine
6219 /// implements the check in C++ [over.match.oper]p3b2 concerning
6220 /// enumeration types.
6221 static bool IsAcceptableNonMemberOperatorCandidate(ASTContext &Context,
6222                                                    FunctionDecl *Fn,
6223                                                    ArrayRef<Expr *> Args) {
6224   QualType T1 = Args[0]->getType();
6225   QualType T2 = Args.size() > 1 ? Args[1]->getType() : QualType();
6226 
6227   if (T1->isDependentType() || (!T2.isNull() && T2->isDependentType()))
6228     return true;
6229 
6230   if (T1->isRecordType() || (!T2.isNull() && T2->isRecordType()))
6231     return true;
6232 
6233   const auto *Proto = Fn->getType()->castAs<FunctionProtoType>();
6234   if (Proto->getNumParams() < 1)
6235     return false;
6236 
6237   if (T1->isEnumeralType()) {
6238     QualType ArgType = Proto->getParamType(0).getNonReferenceType();
6239     if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(T1, ArgType))
6240       return true;
6241   }
6242 
6243   if (Proto->getNumParams() < 2)
6244     return false;
6245 
6246   if (!T2.isNull() && T2->isEnumeralType()) {
6247     QualType ArgType = Proto->getParamType(1).getNonReferenceType();
6248     if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(T2, ArgType))
6249       return true;
6250   }
6251 
6252   return false;
6253 }
6254 
6255 /// AddOverloadCandidate - Adds the given function to the set of
6256 /// candidate functions, using the given function call arguments.  If
6257 /// @p SuppressUserConversions, then don't allow user-defined
6258 /// conversions via constructors or conversion operators.
6259 ///
6260 /// \param PartialOverloading true if we are performing "partial" overloading
6261 /// based on an incomplete set of function arguments. This feature is used by
6262 /// code completion.
6263 void Sema::AddOverloadCandidate(
6264     FunctionDecl *Function, DeclAccessPair FoundDecl, ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
6265     OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet, bool SuppressUserConversions,
6266     bool PartialOverloading, bool AllowExplicit, bool AllowExplicitConversions,
6267     ADLCallKind IsADLCandidate, ConversionSequenceList EarlyConversions,
6268     OverloadCandidateParamOrder PO) {
6269   const FunctionProtoType *Proto
6270     = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(Function->getType()->getAs<FunctionType>());
6271   assert(Proto && "Functions without a prototype cannot be overloaded");
6272   assert(!Function->getDescribedFunctionTemplate() &&
6273          "Use AddTemplateOverloadCandidate for function templates");
6274 
6275   if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Function)) {
6276     if (!isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Method)) {
6277       // If we get here, it's because we're calling a member function
6278       // that is named without a member access expression (e.g.,
6279       // "this->f") that was either written explicitly or created
6280       // implicitly. This can happen with a qualified call to a member
6281       // function, e.g., X::f(). We use an empty type for the implied
6282       // object argument (C++ [over.call.func]p3), and the acting context
6283       // is irrelevant.
6284       AddMethodCandidate(Method, FoundDecl, Method->getParent(), QualType(),
6285                          Expr::Classification::makeSimpleLValue(), Args,
6286                          CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions,
6287                          PartialOverloading, EarlyConversions, PO);
6288       return;
6289     }
6290     // We treat a constructor like a non-member function, since its object
6291     // argument doesn't participate in overload resolution.
6292   }
6293 
6294   if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(Function, PO))
6295     return;
6296 
6297   // C++11 [class.copy]p11: [DR1402]
6298   //   A defaulted move constructor that is defined as deleted is ignored by
6299   //   overload resolution.
6300   CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Function);
6301   if (Constructor && Constructor->isDefaulted() && Constructor->isDeleted() &&
6302       Constructor->isMoveConstructor())
6303     return;
6304 
6305   // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context.
6306   EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated(
6307       *this, Sema::ExpressionEvaluationContext::Unevaluated);
6308 
6309   // C++ [over.match.oper]p3:
6310   //   if no operand has a class type, only those non-member functions in the
6311   //   lookup set that have a first parameter of type T1 or "reference to
6312   //   (possibly cv-qualified) T1", when T1 is an enumeration type, or (if there
6313   //   is a right operand) a second parameter of type T2 or "reference to
6314   //   (possibly cv-qualified) T2", when T2 is an enumeration type, are
6315   //   candidate functions.
6316   if (CandidateSet.getKind() == OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Operator &&
6317       !IsAcceptableNonMemberOperatorCandidate(Context, Function, Args))
6318     return;
6319 
6320   // Add this candidate
6321   OverloadCandidate &Candidate =
6322       CandidateSet.addCandidate(Args.size(), EarlyConversions);
6323   Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl;
6324   Candidate.Function = Function;
6325   Candidate.Viable = true;
6326   Candidate.RewriteKind =
6327       CandidateSet.getRewriteInfo().getRewriteKind(Function, PO);
6328   Candidate.IsSurrogate = false;
6329   Candidate.IsADLCandidate = IsADLCandidate;
6330   Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
6331   Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = Args.size();
6332 
6333   // Explicit functions are not actually candidates at all if we're not
6334   // allowing them in this context, but keep them around so we can point
6335   // to them in diagnostics.
6336   if (!AllowExplicit && ExplicitSpecifier::getFromDecl(Function).isExplicit()) {
6337     Candidate.Viable = false;
6338     Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_explicit;
6339     return;
6340   }
6341 
6342   if (Function->isMultiVersion() && Function->hasAttr<TargetAttr>() &&
6343       !Function->getAttr<TargetAttr>()->isDefaultVersion()) {
6344     Candidate.Viable = false;
6345     Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_non_default_multiversion_function;
6346     return;
6347   }
6348 
6349   if (Constructor) {
6350     // C++ [class.copy]p3:
6351     //   A member function template is never instantiated to perform the copy
6352     //   of a class object to an object of its class type.
6353     QualType ClassType = Context.getTypeDeclType(Constructor->getParent());
6354     if (Args.size() == 1 && Constructor->isSpecializationCopyingObject() &&
6355         (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ClassType, Args[0]->getType()) ||
6356          IsDerivedFrom(Args[0]->getBeginLoc(), Args[0]->getType(),
6357                        ClassType))) {
6358       Candidate.Viable = false;
6359       Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_illegal_constructor;
6360       return;
6361     }
6362 
6363     // C++ [over.match.funcs]p8: (proposed DR resolution)
6364     //   A constructor inherited from class type C that has a first parameter
6365     //   of type "reference to P" (including such a constructor instantiated
6366     //   from a template) is excluded from the set of candidate functions when
6367     //   constructing an object of type cv D if the argument list has exactly
6368     //   one argument and D is reference-related to P and P is reference-related
6369     //   to C.
6370     auto *Shadow = dyn_cast<ConstructorUsingShadowDecl>(FoundDecl.getDecl());
6371     if (Shadow && Args.size() == 1 && Constructor->getNumParams() >= 1 &&
6372         Constructor->getParamDecl(0)->getType()->isReferenceType()) {
6373       QualType P = Constructor->getParamDecl(0)->getType()->getPointeeType();
6374       QualType C = Context.getRecordType(Constructor->getParent());
6375       QualType D = Context.getRecordType(Shadow->getParent());
6376       SourceLocation Loc = Args.front()->getExprLoc();
6377       if ((Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(P, C) || IsDerivedFrom(Loc, P, C)) &&
6378           (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(D, P) || IsDerivedFrom(Loc, D, P))) {
6379         Candidate.Viable = false;
6380         Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_inhctor_slice;
6381         return;
6382       }
6383     }
6384 
6385     // Check that the constructor is capable of constructing an object in the
6386     // destination address space.
6387     if (!Qualifiers::isAddressSpaceSupersetOf(
6388             Constructor->getMethodQualifiers().getAddressSpace(),
6389             CandidateSet.getDestAS())) {
6390       Candidate.Viable = false;
6391       Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_object_addrspace_mismatch;
6392     }
6393   }
6394 
6395   unsigned NumParams = Proto->getNumParams();
6396 
6397   // (C++ 13.3.2p2): A candidate function having fewer than m
6398   // parameters is viable only if it has an ellipsis in its parameter
6399   // list (8.3.5).
6400   if (TooManyArguments(NumParams, Args.size(), PartialOverloading) &&
6401       !Proto->isVariadic()) {
6402     Candidate.Viable = false;
6403     Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_many_arguments;
6404     return;
6405   }
6406 
6407   // (C++ 13.3.2p2): A candidate function having more than m parameters
6408   // is viable only if the (m+1)st parameter has a default argument
6409   // (8.3.6). For the purposes of overload resolution, the
6410   // parameter list is truncated on the right, so that there are
6411   // exactly m parameters.
6412   unsigned MinRequiredArgs = Function->getMinRequiredArguments();
6413   if (Args.size() < MinRequiredArgs && !PartialOverloading) {
6414     // Not enough arguments.
6415     Candidate.Viable = false;
6416     Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_few_arguments;
6417     return;
6418   }
6419 
6420   // (CUDA B.1): Check for invalid calls between targets.
6421   if (getLangOpts().CUDA)
6422     if (const FunctionDecl *Caller = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(CurContext))
6423       // Skip the check for callers that are implicit members, because in this
6424       // case we may not yet know what the member's target is; the target is
6425       // inferred for the member automatically, based on the bases and fields of
6426       // the class.
6427       if (!Caller->isImplicit() && !IsAllowedCUDACall(Caller, Function)) {
6428         Candidate.Viable = false;
6429         Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_target;
6430         return;
6431       }
6432 
6433   if (Function->getTrailingRequiresClause()) {
6434     ConstraintSatisfaction Satisfaction;
6435     if (CheckFunctionConstraints(Function, Satisfaction) ||
6436         !Satisfaction.IsSatisfied) {
6437       Candidate.Viable = false;
6438       Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_constraints_not_satisfied;
6439       return;
6440     }
6441   }
6442 
6443   // Determine the implicit conversion sequences for each of the
6444   // arguments.
6445   for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < Args.size(); ++ArgIdx) {
6446     unsigned ConvIdx =
6447         PO == OverloadCandidateParamOrder::Reversed ? 1 - ArgIdx : ArgIdx;
6448     if (Candidate.Conversions[ConvIdx].isInitialized()) {
6449       // We already formed a conversion sequence for this parameter during
6450       // template argument deduction.
6451     } else if (ArgIdx < NumParams) {
6452       // (C++ 13.3.2p3): for F to be a viable function, there shall
6453       // exist for each argument an implicit conversion sequence
6454       // (13.3.3.1) that converts that argument to the corresponding
6455       // parameter of F.
6456       QualType ParamType = Proto->getParamType(ArgIdx);
6457       Candidate.Conversions[ConvIdx] = TryCopyInitialization(
6458           *this, Args[ArgIdx], ParamType, SuppressUserConversions,
6459           /*InOverloadResolution=*/true,
6460           /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/
6461           getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount, AllowExplicitConversions);
6462       if (Candidate.Conversions[ConvIdx].isBad()) {
6463         Candidate.Viable = false;
6464         Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
6465         return;
6466       }
6467     } else {
6468       // (C++ 13.3.2p2): For the purposes of overload resolution, any
6469       // argument for which there is no corresponding parameter is
6470       // considered to ""match the ellipsis" (C+ 13.3.3.1.3).
6471       Candidate.Conversions[ConvIdx].setEllipsis();
6472     }
6473   }
6474 
6475   if (EnableIfAttr *FailedAttr =
6476           CheckEnableIf(Function, CandidateSet.getLocation(), Args)) {
6477     Candidate.Viable = false;
6478     Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_enable_if;
6479     Candidate.DeductionFailure.Data = FailedAttr;
6480     return;
6481   }
6482 
6483   if (LangOpts.OpenCL && isOpenCLDisabledDecl(Function)) {
6484     Candidate.Viable = false;
6485     Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_ext_disabled;
6486     return;
6487   }
6488 }
6489 
6490 ObjCMethodDecl *
6491 Sema::SelectBestMethod(Selector Sel, MultiExprArg Args, bool IsInstance,
6492                        SmallVectorImpl<ObjCMethodDecl *> &Methods) {
6493   if (Methods.size() <= 1)
6494     return nullptr;
6495 
6496   for (unsigned b = 0, e = Methods.size(); b < e; b++) {
6497     bool Match = true;
6498     ObjCMethodDecl *Method = Methods[b];
6499     unsigned NumNamedArgs = Sel.getNumArgs();
6500     // Method might have more arguments than selector indicates. This is due
6501     // to addition of c-style arguments in method.
6502     if (Method->param_size() > NumNamedArgs)
6503       NumNamedArgs = Method->param_size();
6504     if (Args.size() < NumNamedArgs)
6505       continue;
6506 
6507     for (unsigned i = 0; i < NumNamedArgs; i++) {
6508       // We can't do any type-checking on a type-dependent argument.
6509       if (Args[i]->isTypeDependent()) {
6510         Match = false;
6511         break;
6512       }
6513 
6514       ParmVarDecl *param = Method->parameters()[i];
6515       Expr *argExpr = Args[i];
6516       assert(argExpr && "SelectBestMethod(): missing expression");
6517 
6518       // Strip the unbridged-cast placeholder expression off unless it's
6519       // a consumed argument.
6520       if (argExpr->hasPlaceholderType(BuiltinType::ARCUnbridgedCast) &&
6521           !param->hasAttr<CFConsumedAttr>())
6522         argExpr = stripARCUnbridgedCast(argExpr);
6523 
6524       // If the parameter is __unknown_anytype, move on to the next method.
6525       if (param->getType() == Context.UnknownAnyTy) {
6526         Match = false;
6527         break;
6528       }
6529 
6530       ImplicitConversionSequence ConversionState
6531         = TryCopyInitialization(*this, argExpr, param->getType(),
6532                                 /*SuppressUserConversions*/false,
6533                                 /*InOverloadResolution=*/true,
6534                                 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/
6535                                 getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount,
6536                                 /*AllowExplicit*/false);
6537       // This function looks for a reasonably-exact match, so we consider
6538       // incompatible pointer conversions to be a failure here.
6539       if (ConversionState.isBad() ||
6540           (ConversionState.isStandard() &&
6541            ConversionState.Standard.Second ==
6542                ICK_Incompatible_Pointer_Conversion)) {
6543         Match = false;
6544         break;
6545       }
6546     }
6547     // Promote additional arguments to variadic methods.
6548     if (Match && Method->isVariadic()) {
6549       for (unsigned i = NumNamedArgs, e = Args.size(); i < e; ++i) {
6550         if (Args[i]->isTypeDependent()) {
6551           Match = false;
6552           break;
6553         }
6554         ExprResult Arg = DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion(Args[i], VariadicMethod,
6555                                                           nullptr);
6556         if (Arg.isInvalid()) {
6557           Match = false;
6558           break;
6559         }
6560       }
6561     } else {
6562       // Check for extra arguments to non-variadic methods.
6563       if (Args.size() != NumNamedArgs)
6564         Match = false;
6565       else if (Match && NumNamedArgs == 0 && Methods.size() > 1) {
6566         // Special case when selectors have no argument. In this case, select
6567         // one with the most general result type of 'id'.
6568         for (unsigned b = 0, e = Methods.size(); b < e; b++) {
6569           QualType ReturnT = Methods[b]->getReturnType();
6570           if (ReturnT->isObjCIdType())
6571             return Methods[b];
6572         }
6573       }
6574     }
6575 
6576     if (Match)
6577       return Method;
6578   }
6579   return nullptr;
6580 }
6581 
6582 static bool convertArgsForAvailabilityChecks(
6583     Sema &S, FunctionDecl *Function, Expr *ThisArg, SourceLocation CallLoc,
6584     ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, Sema::SFINAETrap &Trap, bool MissingImplicitThis,
6585     Expr *&ConvertedThis, SmallVectorImpl<Expr *> &ConvertedArgs) {
6586   if (ThisArg) {
6587     CXXMethodDecl *Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Function);
6588     assert(!isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Method) &&
6589            "Shouldn't have `this` for ctors!");
6590     assert(!Method->isStatic() && "Shouldn't have `this` for static methods!");
6591     ExprResult R = S.PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(
6592         ThisArg, /*Qualifier=*/nullptr, Method, Method);
6593     if (R.isInvalid())
6594       return false;
6595     ConvertedThis = R.get();
6596   } else {
6597     if (auto *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Function)) {
6598       (void)MD;
6599       assert((MissingImplicitThis || MD->isStatic() ||
6600               isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(MD)) &&
6601              "Expected `this` for non-ctor instance methods");
6602     }
6603     ConvertedThis = nullptr;
6604   }
6605 
6606   // Ignore any variadic arguments. Converting them is pointless, since the
6607   // user can't refer to them in the function condition.
6608   unsigned ArgSizeNoVarargs = std::min(Function->param_size(), Args.size());
6609 
6610   // Convert the arguments.
6611   for (unsigned I = 0; I != ArgSizeNoVarargs; ++I) {
6612     ExprResult R;
6613     R = S.PerformCopyInitialization(InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(
6614                                         S.Context, Function->getParamDecl(I)),
6615                                     SourceLocation(), Args[I]);
6616 
6617     if (R.isInvalid())
6618       return false;
6619 
6620     ConvertedArgs.push_back(R.get());
6621   }
6622 
6623   if (Trap.hasErrorOccurred())
6624     return false;
6625 
6626   // Push default arguments if needed.
6627   if (!Function->isVariadic() && Args.size() < Function->getNumParams()) {
6628     for (unsigned i = Args.size(), e = Function->getNumParams(); i != e; ++i) {
6629       ParmVarDecl *P = Function->getParamDecl(i);
6630       if (!P->hasDefaultArg())
6631         return false;
6632       ExprResult R = S.BuildCXXDefaultArgExpr(CallLoc, Function, P);
6633       if (R.isInvalid())
6634         return false;
6635       ConvertedArgs.push_back(R.get());
6636     }
6637 
6638     if (Trap.hasErrorOccurred())
6639       return false;
6640   }
6641   return true;
6642 }
6643 
6644 EnableIfAttr *Sema::CheckEnableIf(FunctionDecl *Function,
6645                                   SourceLocation CallLoc,
6646                                   ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
6647                                   bool MissingImplicitThis) {
6648   auto EnableIfAttrs = Function->specific_attrs<EnableIfAttr>();
6649   if (EnableIfAttrs.begin() == EnableIfAttrs.end())
6650     return nullptr;
6651 
6652   SFINAETrap Trap(*this);
6653   SmallVector<Expr *, 16> ConvertedArgs;
6654   // FIXME: We should look into making enable_if late-parsed.
6655   Expr *DiscardedThis;
6656   if (!convertArgsForAvailabilityChecks(
6657           *this, Function, /*ThisArg=*/nullptr, CallLoc, Args, Trap,
6658           /*MissingImplicitThis=*/true, DiscardedThis, ConvertedArgs))
6659     return *EnableIfAttrs.begin();
6660 
6661   for (auto *EIA : EnableIfAttrs) {
6662     APValue Result;
6663     // FIXME: This doesn't consider value-dependent cases, because doing so is
6664     // very difficult. Ideally, we should handle them more gracefully.
6665     if (EIA->getCond()->isValueDependent() ||
6666         !EIA->getCond()->EvaluateWithSubstitution(
6667             Result, Context, Function, llvm::makeArrayRef(ConvertedArgs)))
6668       return EIA;
6669 
6670     if (!Result.isInt() || !Result.getInt().getBoolValue())
6671       return EIA;
6672   }
6673   return nullptr;
6674 }
6675 
6676 template <typename CheckFn>
6677 static bool diagnoseDiagnoseIfAttrsWith(Sema &S, const NamedDecl *ND,
6678                                         bool ArgDependent, SourceLocation Loc,
6679                                         CheckFn &&IsSuccessful) {
6680   SmallVector<const DiagnoseIfAttr *, 8> Attrs;
6681   for (const auto *DIA : ND->specific_attrs<DiagnoseIfAttr>()) {
6682     if (ArgDependent == DIA->getArgDependent())
6683       Attrs.push_back(DIA);
6684   }
6685 
6686   // Common case: No diagnose_if attributes, so we can quit early.
6687   if (Attrs.empty())
6688     return false;
6689 
6690   auto WarningBegin = std::stable_partition(
6691       Attrs.begin(), Attrs.end(),
6692       [](const DiagnoseIfAttr *DIA) { return DIA->isError(); });
6693 
6694   // Note that diagnose_if attributes are late-parsed, so they appear in the
6695   // correct order (unlike enable_if attributes).
6696   auto ErrAttr = llvm::find_if(llvm::make_range(Attrs.begin(), WarningBegin),
6697                                IsSuccessful);
6698   if (ErrAttr != WarningBegin) {
6699     const DiagnoseIfAttr *DIA = *ErrAttr;
6700     S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_diagnose_if_succeeded) << DIA->getMessage();
6701     S.Diag(DIA->getLocation(), diag::note_from_diagnose_if)
6702         << DIA->getParent() << DIA->getCond()->getSourceRange();
6703     return true;
6704   }
6705 
6706   for (const auto *DIA : llvm::make_range(WarningBegin, Attrs.end()))
6707     if (IsSuccessful(DIA)) {
6708       S.Diag(Loc, diag::warn_diagnose_if_succeeded) << DIA->getMessage();
6709       S.Diag(DIA->getLocation(), diag::note_from_diagnose_if)
6710           << DIA->getParent() << DIA->getCond()->getSourceRange();
6711     }
6712 
6713   return false;
6714 }
6715 
6716 bool Sema::diagnoseArgDependentDiagnoseIfAttrs(const FunctionDecl *Function,
6717                                                const Expr *ThisArg,
6718                                                ArrayRef<const Expr *> Args,
6719                                                SourceLocation Loc) {
6720   return diagnoseDiagnoseIfAttrsWith(
6721       *this, Function, /*ArgDependent=*/true, Loc,
6722       [&](const DiagnoseIfAttr *DIA) {
6723         APValue Result;
6724         // It's sane to use the same Args for any redecl of this function, since
6725         // EvaluateWithSubstitution only cares about the position of each
6726         // argument in the arg list, not the ParmVarDecl* it maps to.
6727         if (!DIA->getCond()->EvaluateWithSubstitution(
6728                 Result, Context, cast<FunctionDecl>(DIA->getParent()), Args, ThisArg))
6729           return false;
6730         return Result.isInt() && Result.getInt().getBoolValue();
6731       });
6732 }
6733 
6734 bool Sema::diagnoseArgIndependentDiagnoseIfAttrs(const NamedDecl *ND,
6735                                                  SourceLocation Loc) {
6736   return diagnoseDiagnoseIfAttrsWith(
6737       *this, ND, /*ArgDependent=*/false, Loc,
6738       [&](const DiagnoseIfAttr *DIA) {
6739         bool Result;
6740         return DIA->getCond()->EvaluateAsBooleanCondition(Result, Context) &&
6741                Result;
6742       });
6743 }
6744 
6745 /// Add all of the function declarations in the given function set to
6746 /// the overload candidate set.
6747 void Sema::AddFunctionCandidates(const UnresolvedSetImpl &Fns,
6748                                  ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
6749                                  OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet,
6750                                  TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs,
6751                                  bool SuppressUserConversions,
6752                                  bool PartialOverloading,
6753                                  bool FirstArgumentIsBase) {
6754   for (UnresolvedSetIterator F = Fns.begin(), E = Fns.end(); F != E; ++F) {
6755     NamedDecl *D = F.getDecl()->getUnderlyingDecl();
6756     ArrayRef<Expr *> FunctionArgs = Args;
6757 
6758     FunctionTemplateDecl *FunTmpl = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D);
6759     FunctionDecl *FD =
6760         FunTmpl ? FunTmpl->getTemplatedDecl() : cast<FunctionDecl>(D);
6761 
6762     if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(FD) && !cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD)->isStatic()) {
6763       QualType ObjectType;
6764       Expr::Classification ObjectClassification;
6765       if (Args.size() > 0) {
6766         if (Expr *E = Args[0]) {
6767           // Use the explicit base to restrict the lookup:
6768           ObjectType = E->getType();
6769           // Pointers in the object arguments are implicitly dereferenced, so we
6770           // always classify them as l-values.
6771           if (!ObjectType.isNull() && ObjectType->isPointerType())
6772             ObjectClassification = Expr::Classification::makeSimpleLValue();
6773           else
6774             ObjectClassification = E->Classify(Context);
6775         } // .. else there is an implicit base.
6776         FunctionArgs = Args.slice(1);
6777       }
6778       if (FunTmpl) {
6779         AddMethodTemplateCandidate(
6780             FunTmpl, F.getPair(),
6781             cast<CXXRecordDecl>(FunTmpl->getDeclContext()),
6782             ExplicitTemplateArgs, ObjectType, ObjectClassification,
6783             FunctionArgs, CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions,
6784             PartialOverloading);
6785       } else {
6786         AddMethodCandidate(cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD), F.getPair(),
6787                            cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD)->getParent(), ObjectType,
6788                            ObjectClassification, FunctionArgs, CandidateSet,
6789                            SuppressUserConversions, PartialOverloading);
6790       }
6791     } else {
6792       // This branch handles both standalone functions and static methods.
6793 
6794       // Slice the first argument (which is the base) when we access
6795       // static method as non-static.
6796       if (Args.size() > 0 &&
6797           (!Args[0] || (FirstArgumentIsBase && isa<CXXMethodDecl>(FD) &&
6798                         !isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(FD)))) {
6799         assert(cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD)->isStatic());
6800         FunctionArgs = Args.slice(1);
6801       }
6802       if (FunTmpl) {
6803         AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(FunTmpl, F.getPair(),
6804                                      ExplicitTemplateArgs, FunctionArgs,
6805                                      CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions,
6806                                      PartialOverloading);
6807       } else {
6808         AddOverloadCandidate(FD, F.getPair(), FunctionArgs, CandidateSet,
6809                              SuppressUserConversions, PartialOverloading);
6810       }
6811     }
6812   }
6813 }
6814 
6815 /// AddMethodCandidate - Adds a named decl (which is some kind of
6816 /// method) as a method candidate to the given overload set.
6817 void Sema::AddMethodCandidate(DeclAccessPair FoundDecl, QualType ObjectType,
6818                               Expr::Classification ObjectClassification,
6819                               ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
6820                               OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet,
6821                               bool SuppressUserConversions,
6822                               OverloadCandidateParamOrder PO) {
6823   NamedDecl *Decl = FoundDecl.getDecl();
6824   CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Decl->getDeclContext());
6825 
6826   if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(Decl))
6827     Decl = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(Decl)->getTargetDecl();
6828 
6829   if (FunctionTemplateDecl *TD = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(Decl)) {
6830     assert(isa<CXXMethodDecl>(TD->getTemplatedDecl()) &&
6831            "Expected a member function template");
6832     AddMethodTemplateCandidate(TD, FoundDecl, ActingContext,
6833                                /*ExplicitArgs*/ nullptr, ObjectType,
6834                                ObjectClassification, Args, CandidateSet,
6835                                SuppressUserConversions, false, PO);
6836   } else {
6837     AddMethodCandidate(cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Decl), FoundDecl, ActingContext,
6838                        ObjectType, ObjectClassification, Args, CandidateSet,
6839                        SuppressUserConversions, false, None, PO);
6840   }
6841 }
6842 
6843 /// AddMethodCandidate - Adds the given C++ member function to the set
6844 /// of candidate functions, using the given function call arguments
6845 /// and the object argument (@c Object). For example, in a call
6846 /// @c o.f(a1,a2), @c Object will contain @c o and @c Args will contain
6847 /// both @c a1 and @c a2. If @p SuppressUserConversions, then don't
6848 /// allow user-defined conversions via constructors or conversion
6849 /// operators.
6850 void
6851 Sema::AddMethodCandidate(CXXMethodDecl *Method, DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
6852                          CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext, QualType ObjectType,
6853                          Expr::Classification ObjectClassification,
6854                          ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
6855                          OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet,
6856                          bool SuppressUserConversions,
6857                          bool PartialOverloading,
6858                          ConversionSequenceList EarlyConversions,
6859                          OverloadCandidateParamOrder PO) {
6860   const FunctionProtoType *Proto
6861     = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(Method->getType()->getAs<FunctionType>());
6862   assert(Proto && "Methods without a prototype cannot be overloaded");
6863   assert(!isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Method) &&
6864          "Use AddOverloadCandidate for constructors");
6865 
6866   if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(Method, PO))
6867     return;
6868 
6869   // C++11 [class.copy]p23: [DR1402]
6870   //   A defaulted move assignment operator that is defined as deleted is
6871   //   ignored by overload resolution.
6872   if (Method->isDefaulted() && Method->isDeleted() &&
6873       Method->isMoveAssignmentOperator())
6874     return;
6875 
6876   // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context.
6877   EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated(
6878       *this, Sema::ExpressionEvaluationContext::Unevaluated);
6879 
6880   // Add this candidate
6881   OverloadCandidate &Candidate =
6882       CandidateSet.addCandidate(Args.size() + 1, EarlyConversions);
6883   Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl;
6884   Candidate.Function = Method;
6885   Candidate.RewriteKind =
6886       CandidateSet.getRewriteInfo().getRewriteKind(Method, PO);
6887   Candidate.IsSurrogate = false;
6888   Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
6889   Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = Args.size();
6890 
6891   unsigned NumParams = Proto->getNumParams();
6892 
6893   // (C++ 13.3.2p2): A candidate function having fewer than m
6894   // parameters is viable only if it has an ellipsis in its parameter
6895   // list (8.3.5).
6896   if (TooManyArguments(NumParams, Args.size(), PartialOverloading) &&
6897       !Proto->isVariadic()) {
6898     Candidate.Viable = false;
6899     Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_many_arguments;
6900     return;
6901   }
6902 
6903   // (C++ 13.3.2p2): A candidate function having more than m parameters
6904   // is viable only if the (m+1)st parameter has a default argument
6905   // (8.3.6). For the purposes of overload resolution, the
6906   // parameter list is truncated on the right, so that there are
6907   // exactly m parameters.
6908   unsigned MinRequiredArgs = Method->getMinRequiredArguments();
6909   if (Args.size() < MinRequiredArgs && !PartialOverloading) {
6910     // Not enough arguments.
6911     Candidate.Viable = false;
6912     Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_few_arguments;
6913     return;
6914   }
6915 
6916   Candidate.Viable = true;
6917 
6918   if (Method->isStatic() || ObjectType.isNull())
6919     // The implicit object argument is ignored.
6920     Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = true;
6921   else {
6922     unsigned ConvIdx = PO == OverloadCandidateParamOrder::Reversed ? 1 : 0;
6923     // Determine the implicit conversion sequence for the object
6924     // parameter.
6925     Candidate.Conversions[ConvIdx] = TryObjectArgumentInitialization(
6926         *this, CandidateSet.getLocation(), ObjectType, ObjectClassification,
6927         Method, ActingContext);
6928     if (Candidate.Conversions[ConvIdx].isBad()) {
6929       Candidate.Viable = false;
6930       Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
6931       return;
6932     }
6933   }
6934 
6935   // (CUDA B.1): Check for invalid calls between targets.
6936   if (getLangOpts().CUDA)
6937     if (const FunctionDecl *Caller = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(CurContext))
6938       if (!IsAllowedCUDACall(Caller, Method)) {
6939         Candidate.Viable = false;
6940         Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_target;
6941         return;
6942       }
6943 
6944   if (Method->getTrailingRequiresClause()) {
6945     ConstraintSatisfaction Satisfaction;
6946     if (CheckFunctionConstraints(Method, Satisfaction) ||
6947         !Satisfaction.IsSatisfied) {
6948       Candidate.Viable = false;
6949       Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_constraints_not_satisfied;
6950       return;
6951     }
6952   }
6953 
6954   // Determine the implicit conversion sequences for each of the
6955   // arguments.
6956   for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < Args.size(); ++ArgIdx) {
6957     unsigned ConvIdx =
6958         PO == OverloadCandidateParamOrder::Reversed ? 0 : (ArgIdx + 1);
6959     if (Candidate.Conversions[ConvIdx].isInitialized()) {
6960       // We already formed a conversion sequence for this parameter during
6961       // template argument deduction.
6962     } else if (ArgIdx < NumParams) {
6963       // (C++ 13.3.2p3): for F to be a viable function, there shall
6964       // exist for each argument an implicit conversion sequence
6965       // (13.3.3.1) that converts that argument to the corresponding
6966       // parameter of F.
6967       QualType ParamType = Proto->getParamType(ArgIdx);
6968       Candidate.Conversions[ConvIdx]
6969         = TryCopyInitialization(*this, Args[ArgIdx], ParamType,
6970                                 SuppressUserConversions,
6971                                 /*InOverloadResolution=*/true,
6972                                 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/
6973                                   getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount);
6974       if (Candidate.Conversions[ConvIdx].isBad()) {
6975         Candidate.Viable = false;
6976         Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
6977         return;
6978       }
6979     } else {
6980       // (C++ 13.3.2p2): For the purposes of overload resolution, any
6981       // argument for which there is no corresponding parameter is
6982       // considered to "match the ellipsis" (C+ 13.3.3.1.3).
6983       Candidate.Conversions[ConvIdx].setEllipsis();
6984     }
6985   }
6986 
6987   if (EnableIfAttr *FailedAttr =
6988           CheckEnableIf(Method, CandidateSet.getLocation(), Args, true)) {
6989     Candidate.Viable = false;
6990     Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_enable_if;
6991     Candidate.DeductionFailure.Data = FailedAttr;
6992     return;
6993   }
6994 
6995   if (Method->isMultiVersion() && Method->hasAttr<TargetAttr>() &&
6996       !Method->getAttr<TargetAttr>()->isDefaultVersion()) {
6997     Candidate.Viable = false;
6998     Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_non_default_multiversion_function;
6999   }
7000 }
7001 
7002 /// Add a C++ member function template as a candidate to the candidate
7003 /// set, using template argument deduction to produce an appropriate member
7004 /// function template specialization.
7005 void Sema::AddMethodTemplateCandidate(
7006     FunctionTemplateDecl *MethodTmpl, DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
7007     CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext,
7008     TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs, QualType ObjectType,
7009     Expr::Classification ObjectClassification, ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
7010     OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet, bool SuppressUserConversions,
7011     bool PartialOverloading, OverloadCandidateParamOrder PO) {
7012   if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(MethodTmpl, PO))
7013     return;
7014 
7015   // C++ [over.match.funcs]p7:
7016   //   In each case where a candidate is a function template, candidate
7017   //   function template specializations are generated using template argument
7018   //   deduction (14.8.3, 14.8.2). Those candidates are then handled as
7019   //   candidate functions in the usual way.113) A given name can refer to one
7020   //   or more function templates and also to a set of overloaded non-template
7021   //   functions. In such a case, the candidate functions generated from each
7022   //   function template are combined with the set of non-template candidate
7023   //   functions.
7024   TemplateDeductionInfo Info(CandidateSet.getLocation());
7025   FunctionDecl *Specialization = nullptr;
7026   ConversionSequenceList Conversions;
7027   if (TemplateDeductionResult Result = DeduceTemplateArguments(
7028           MethodTmpl, ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args, Specialization, Info,
7029           PartialOverloading, [&](ArrayRef<QualType> ParamTypes) {
7030             return CheckNonDependentConversions(
7031                 MethodTmpl, ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet, Conversions,
7032                 SuppressUserConversions, ActingContext, ObjectType,
7033                 ObjectClassification, PO);
7034           })) {
7035     OverloadCandidate &Candidate =
7036         CandidateSet.addCandidate(Conversions.size(), Conversions);
7037     Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl;
7038     Candidate.Function = MethodTmpl->getTemplatedDecl();
7039     Candidate.Viable = false;
7040     Candidate.RewriteKind =
7041       CandidateSet.getRewriteInfo().getRewriteKind(Candidate.Function, PO);
7042     Candidate.IsSurrogate = false;
7043     Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument =
7044         cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Candidate.Function)->isStatic() ||
7045         ObjectType.isNull();
7046     Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = Args.size();
7047     if (Result == TDK_NonDependentConversionFailure)
7048       Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
7049     else {
7050       Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_deduction;
7051       Candidate.DeductionFailure = MakeDeductionFailureInfo(Context, Result,
7052                                                             Info);
7053     }
7054     return;
7055   }
7056 
7057   // Add the function template specialization produced by template argument
7058   // deduction as a candidate.
7059   assert(Specialization && "Missing member function template specialization?");
7060   assert(isa<CXXMethodDecl>(Specialization) &&
7061          "Specialization is not a member function?");
7062   AddMethodCandidate(cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Specialization), FoundDecl,
7063                      ActingContext, ObjectType, ObjectClassification, Args,
7064                      CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions, PartialOverloading,
7065                      Conversions, PO);
7066 }
7067 
7068 /// Determine whether a given function template has a simple explicit specifier
7069 /// or a non-value-dependent explicit-specification that evaluates to true.
7070 static bool isNonDependentlyExplicit(FunctionTemplateDecl *FTD) {
7071   return ExplicitSpecifier::getFromDecl(FTD->getTemplatedDecl()).isExplicit();
7072 }
7073 
7074 /// Add a C++ function template specialization as a candidate
7075 /// in the candidate set, using template argument deduction to produce
7076 /// an appropriate function template specialization.
7077 void Sema::AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(
7078     FunctionTemplateDecl *FunctionTemplate, DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
7079     TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs, ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
7080     OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet, bool SuppressUserConversions,
7081     bool PartialOverloading, bool AllowExplicit, ADLCallKind IsADLCandidate,
7082     OverloadCandidateParamOrder PO) {
7083   if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(FunctionTemplate, PO))
7084     return;
7085 
7086   // If the function template has a non-dependent explicit specification,
7087   // exclude it now if appropriate; we are not permitted to perform deduction
7088   // and substitution in this case.
7089   if (!AllowExplicit && isNonDependentlyExplicit(FunctionTemplate)) {
7090     OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.addCandidate();
7091     Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl;
7092     Candidate.Function = FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl();
7093     Candidate.Viable = false;
7094     Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_explicit;
7095     return;
7096   }
7097 
7098   // C++ [over.match.funcs]p7:
7099   //   In each case where a candidate is a function template, candidate
7100   //   function template specializations are generated using template argument
7101   //   deduction (14.8.3, 14.8.2). Those candidates are then handled as
7102   //   candidate functions in the usual way.113) A given name can refer to one
7103   //   or more function templates and also to a set of overloaded non-template
7104   //   functions. In such a case, the candidate functions generated from each
7105   //   function template are combined with the set of non-template candidate
7106   //   functions.
7107   TemplateDeductionInfo Info(CandidateSet.getLocation());
7108   FunctionDecl *Specialization = nullptr;
7109   ConversionSequenceList Conversions;
7110   if (TemplateDeductionResult Result = DeduceTemplateArguments(
7111           FunctionTemplate, ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args, Specialization, Info,
7112           PartialOverloading, [&](ArrayRef<QualType> ParamTypes) {
7113             return CheckNonDependentConversions(
7114                 FunctionTemplate, ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet, Conversions,
7115                 SuppressUserConversions, nullptr, QualType(), {}, PO);
7116           })) {
7117     OverloadCandidate &Candidate =
7118         CandidateSet.addCandidate(Conversions.size(), Conversions);
7119     Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl;
7120     Candidate.Function = FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl();
7121     Candidate.Viable = false;
7122     Candidate.RewriteKind =
7123       CandidateSet.getRewriteInfo().getRewriteKind(Candidate.Function, PO);
7124     Candidate.IsSurrogate = false;
7125     Candidate.IsADLCandidate = IsADLCandidate;
7126     // Ignore the object argument if there is one, since we don't have an object
7127     // type.
7128     Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument =
7129         isa<CXXMethodDecl>(Candidate.Function) &&
7130         !isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Candidate.Function);
7131     Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = Args.size();
7132     if (Result == TDK_NonDependentConversionFailure)
7133       Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
7134     else {
7135       Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_deduction;
7136       Candidate.DeductionFailure = MakeDeductionFailureInfo(Context, Result,
7137                                                             Info);
7138     }
7139     return;
7140   }
7141 
7142   // Add the function template specialization produced by template argument
7143   // deduction as a candidate.
7144   assert(Specialization && "Missing function template specialization?");
7145   AddOverloadCandidate(
7146       Specialization, FoundDecl, Args, CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions,
7147       PartialOverloading, AllowExplicit,
7148       /*AllowExplicitConversions*/ false, IsADLCandidate, Conversions, PO);
7149 }
7150 
7151 /// Check that implicit conversion sequences can be formed for each argument
7152 /// whose corresponding parameter has a non-dependent type, per DR1391's
7153 /// [temp.deduct.call]p10.
7154 bool Sema::CheckNonDependentConversions(
7155     FunctionTemplateDecl *FunctionTemplate, ArrayRef<QualType> ParamTypes,
7156     ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet,
7157     ConversionSequenceList &Conversions, bool SuppressUserConversions,
7158     CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext, QualType ObjectType,
7159     Expr::Classification ObjectClassification, OverloadCandidateParamOrder PO) {
7160   // FIXME: The cases in which we allow explicit conversions for constructor
7161   // arguments never consider calling a constructor template. It's not clear
7162   // that is correct.
7163   const bool AllowExplicit = false;
7164 
7165   auto *FD = FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl();
7166   auto *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD);
7167   bool HasThisConversion = Method && !isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Method);
7168   unsigned ThisConversions = HasThisConversion ? 1 : 0;
7169 
7170   Conversions =
7171       CandidateSet.allocateConversionSequences(ThisConversions + Args.size());
7172 
7173   // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context.
7174   EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated(
7175       *this, Sema::ExpressionEvaluationContext::Unevaluated);
7176 
7177   // For a method call, check the 'this' conversion here too. DR1391 doesn't
7178   // require that, but this check should never result in a hard error, and
7179   // overload resolution is permitted to sidestep instantiations.
7180   if (HasThisConversion && !cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD)->isStatic() &&
7181       !ObjectType.isNull()) {
7182     unsigned ConvIdx = PO == OverloadCandidateParamOrder::Reversed ? 1 : 0;
7183     Conversions[ConvIdx] = TryObjectArgumentInitialization(
7184         *this, CandidateSet.getLocation(), ObjectType, ObjectClassification,
7185         Method, ActingContext);
7186     if (Conversions[ConvIdx].isBad())
7187       return true;
7188   }
7189 
7190   for (unsigned I = 0, N = std::min(ParamTypes.size(), Args.size()); I != N;
7191        ++I) {
7192     QualType ParamType = ParamTypes[I];
7193     if (!ParamType->isDependentType()) {
7194       unsigned ConvIdx = PO == OverloadCandidateParamOrder::Reversed
7195                              ? 0
7196                              : (ThisConversions + I);
7197       Conversions[ConvIdx]
7198         = TryCopyInitialization(*this, Args[I], ParamType,
7199                                 SuppressUserConversions,
7200                                 /*InOverloadResolution=*/true,
7201                                 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/
7202                                   getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount,
7203                                 AllowExplicit);
7204       if (Conversions[ConvIdx].isBad())
7205         return true;
7206     }
7207   }
7208 
7209   return false;
7210 }
7211 
7212 /// Determine whether this is an allowable conversion from the result
7213 /// of an explicit conversion operator to the expected type, per C++
7214 /// [over.match.conv]p1 and [over.match.ref]p1.
7215 ///
7216 /// \param ConvType The return type of the conversion function.
7217 ///
7218 /// \param ToType The type we are converting to.
7219 ///
7220 /// \param AllowObjCPointerConversion Allow a conversion from one
7221 /// Objective-C pointer to another.
7222 ///
7223 /// \returns true if the conversion is allowable, false otherwise.
7224 static bool isAllowableExplicitConversion(Sema &S,
7225                                           QualType ConvType, QualType ToType,
7226                                           bool AllowObjCPointerConversion) {
7227   QualType ToNonRefType = ToType.getNonReferenceType();
7228 
7229   // Easy case: the types are the same.
7230   if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ConvType, ToNonRefType))
7231     return true;
7232 
7233   // Allow qualification conversions.
7234   bool ObjCLifetimeConversion;
7235   if (S.IsQualificationConversion(ConvType, ToNonRefType, /*CStyle*/false,
7236                                   ObjCLifetimeConversion))
7237     return true;
7238 
7239   // If we're not allowed to consider Objective-C pointer conversions,
7240   // we're done.
7241   if (!AllowObjCPointerConversion)
7242     return false;
7243 
7244   // Is this an Objective-C pointer conversion?
7245   bool IncompatibleObjC = false;
7246   QualType ConvertedType;
7247   return S.isObjCPointerConversion(ConvType, ToNonRefType, ConvertedType,
7248                                    IncompatibleObjC);
7249 }
7250 
7251 /// AddConversionCandidate - Add a C++ conversion function as a
7252 /// candidate in the candidate set (C++ [over.match.conv],
7253 /// C++ [over.match.copy]). From is the expression we're converting from,
7254 /// and ToType is the type that we're eventually trying to convert to
7255 /// (which may or may not be the same type as the type that the
7256 /// conversion function produces).
7257 void Sema::AddConversionCandidate(
7258     CXXConversionDecl *Conversion, DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
7259     CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
7260     OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet, bool AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit,
7261     bool AllowExplicit, bool AllowResultConversion) {
7262   assert(!Conversion->getDescribedFunctionTemplate() &&
7263          "Conversion function templates use AddTemplateConversionCandidate");
7264   QualType ConvType = Conversion->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType();
7265   if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(Conversion))
7266     return;
7267 
7268   // If the conversion function has an undeduced return type, trigger its
7269   // deduction now.
7270   if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus14 && ConvType->isUndeducedType()) {
7271     if (DeduceReturnType(Conversion, From->getExprLoc()))
7272       return;
7273     ConvType = Conversion->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType();
7274   }
7275 
7276   // If we don't allow any conversion of the result type, ignore conversion
7277   // functions that don't convert to exactly (possibly cv-qualified) T.
7278   if (!AllowResultConversion &&
7279       !Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(Conversion->getConversionType(), ToType))
7280     return;
7281 
7282   // Per C++ [over.match.conv]p1, [over.match.ref]p1, an explicit conversion
7283   // operator is only a candidate if its return type is the target type or
7284   // can be converted to the target type with a qualification conversion.
7285   //
7286   // FIXME: Include such functions in the candidate list and explain why we
7287   // can't select them.
7288   if (Conversion->isExplicit() &&
7289       !isAllowableExplicitConversion(*this, ConvType, ToType,
7290                                      AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit))
7291     return;
7292 
7293   // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context.
7294   EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated(
7295       *this, Sema::ExpressionEvaluationContext::Unevaluated);
7296 
7297   // Add this candidate
7298   OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.addCandidate(1);
7299   Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl;
7300   Candidate.Function = Conversion;
7301   Candidate.IsSurrogate = false;
7302   Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
7303   Candidate.FinalConversion.setAsIdentityConversion();
7304   Candidate.FinalConversion.setFromType(ConvType);
7305   Candidate.FinalConversion.setAllToTypes(ToType);
7306   Candidate.Viable = true;
7307   Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = 1;
7308 
7309   // Explicit functions are not actually candidates at all if we're not
7310   // allowing them in this context, but keep them around so we can point
7311   // to them in diagnostics.
7312   if (!AllowExplicit && Conversion->isExplicit()) {
7313     Candidate.Viable = false;
7314     Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_explicit;
7315     return;
7316   }
7317 
7318   // C++ [over.match.funcs]p4:
7319   //   For conversion functions, the function is considered to be a member of
7320   //   the class of the implicit implied object argument for the purpose of
7321   //   defining the type of the implicit object parameter.
7322   //
7323   // Determine the implicit conversion sequence for the implicit
7324   // object parameter.
7325   QualType ImplicitParamType = From->getType();
7326   if (const PointerType *FromPtrType = ImplicitParamType->getAs<PointerType>())
7327     ImplicitParamType = FromPtrType->getPointeeType();
7328   CXXRecordDecl *ConversionContext
7329     = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(ImplicitParamType->castAs<RecordType>()->getDecl());
7330 
7331   Candidate.Conversions[0] = TryObjectArgumentInitialization(
7332       *this, CandidateSet.getLocation(), From->getType(),
7333       From->Classify(Context), Conversion, ConversionContext);
7334 
7335   if (Candidate.Conversions[0].isBad()) {
7336     Candidate.Viable = false;
7337     Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
7338     return;
7339   }
7340 
7341   if (Conversion->getTrailingRequiresClause()) {
7342     ConstraintSatisfaction Satisfaction;
7343     if (CheckFunctionConstraints(Conversion, Satisfaction) ||
7344         !Satisfaction.IsSatisfied) {
7345       Candidate.Viable = false;
7346       Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_constraints_not_satisfied;
7347       return;
7348     }
7349   }
7350 
7351   // We won't go through a user-defined type conversion function to convert a
7352   // derived to base as such conversions are given Conversion Rank. They only
7353   // go through a copy constructor. 13.3.3.1.2-p4 [over.ics.user]
7354   QualType FromCanon
7355     = Context.getCanonicalType(From->getType().getUnqualifiedType());
7356   QualType ToCanon = Context.getCanonicalType(ToType).getUnqualifiedType();
7357   if (FromCanon == ToCanon ||
7358       IsDerivedFrom(CandidateSet.getLocation(), FromCanon, ToCanon)) {
7359     Candidate.Viable = false;
7360     Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_trivial_conversion;
7361     return;
7362   }
7363 
7364   // To determine what the conversion from the result of calling the
7365   // conversion function to the type we're eventually trying to
7366   // convert to (ToType), we need to synthesize a call to the
7367   // conversion function and attempt copy initialization from it. This
7368   // makes sure that we get the right semantics with respect to
7369   // lvalues/rvalues and the type. Fortunately, we can allocate this
7370   // call on the stack and we don't need its arguments to be
7371   // well-formed.
7372   DeclRefExpr ConversionRef(Context, Conversion, false, Conversion->getType(),
7373                             VK_LValue, From->getBeginLoc());
7374   ImplicitCastExpr ConversionFn(ImplicitCastExpr::OnStack,
7375                                 Context.getPointerType(Conversion->getType()),
7376                                 CK_FunctionToPointerDecay, &ConversionRef,
7377                                 VK_RValue, FPOptionsOverride());
7378 
7379   QualType ConversionType = Conversion->getConversionType();
7380   if (!isCompleteType(From->getBeginLoc(), ConversionType)) {
7381     Candidate.Viable = false;
7382     Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_final_conversion;
7383     return;
7384   }
7385 
7386   ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ConversionType);
7387 
7388   // Note that it is safe to allocate CallExpr on the stack here because
7389   // there are 0 arguments (i.e., nothing is allocated using ASTContext's
7390   // allocator).
7391   QualType CallResultType = ConversionType.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
7392 
7393   alignas(CallExpr) char Buffer[sizeof(CallExpr) + sizeof(Stmt *)];
7394   CallExpr *TheTemporaryCall = CallExpr::CreateTemporary(
7395       Buffer, &ConversionFn, CallResultType, VK, From->getBeginLoc());
7396 
7397   ImplicitConversionSequence ICS =
7398       TryCopyInitialization(*this, TheTemporaryCall, ToType,
7399                             /*SuppressUserConversions=*/true,
7400                             /*InOverloadResolution=*/false,
7401                             /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/false);
7402 
7403   switch (ICS.getKind()) {
7404   case ImplicitConversionSequence::StandardConversion:
7405     Candidate.FinalConversion = ICS.Standard;
7406 
7407     // C++ [over.ics.user]p3:
7408     //   If the user-defined conversion is specified by a specialization of a
7409     //   conversion function template, the second standard conversion sequence
7410     //   shall have exact match rank.
7411     if (Conversion->getPrimaryTemplate() &&
7412         GetConversionRank(ICS.Standard.Second) != ICR_Exact_Match) {
7413       Candidate.Viable = false;
7414       Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_final_conversion_not_exact;
7415       return;
7416     }
7417 
7418     // C++0x [dcl.init.ref]p5:
7419     //    In the second case, if the reference is an rvalue reference and
7420     //    the second standard conversion sequence of the user-defined
7421     //    conversion sequence includes an lvalue-to-rvalue conversion, the
7422     //    program is ill-formed.
7423     if (ToType->isRValueReferenceType() &&
7424         ICS.Standard.First == ICK_Lvalue_To_Rvalue) {
7425       Candidate.Viable = false;
7426       Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_final_conversion;
7427       return;
7428     }
7429     break;
7430 
7431   case ImplicitConversionSequence::BadConversion:
7432     Candidate.Viable = false;
7433     Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_final_conversion;
7434     return;
7435 
7436   default:
7437     llvm_unreachable(
7438            "Can only end up with a standard conversion sequence or failure");
7439   }
7440 
7441   if (EnableIfAttr *FailedAttr =
7442           CheckEnableIf(Conversion, CandidateSet.getLocation(), None)) {
7443     Candidate.Viable = false;
7444     Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_enable_if;
7445     Candidate.DeductionFailure.Data = FailedAttr;
7446     return;
7447   }
7448 
7449   if (Conversion->isMultiVersion() && Conversion->hasAttr<TargetAttr>() &&
7450       !Conversion->getAttr<TargetAttr>()->isDefaultVersion()) {
7451     Candidate.Viable = false;
7452     Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_non_default_multiversion_function;
7453   }
7454 }
7455 
7456 /// Adds a conversion function template specialization
7457 /// candidate to the overload set, using template argument deduction
7458 /// to deduce the template arguments of the conversion function
7459 /// template from the type that we are converting to (C++
7460 /// [temp.deduct.conv]).
7461 void Sema::AddTemplateConversionCandidate(
7462     FunctionTemplateDecl *FunctionTemplate, DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
7463     CXXRecordDecl *ActingDC, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
7464     OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet, bool AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit,
7465     bool AllowExplicit, bool AllowResultConversion) {
7466   assert(isa<CXXConversionDecl>(FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl()) &&
7467          "Only conversion function templates permitted here");
7468 
7469   if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(FunctionTemplate))
7470     return;
7471 
7472   // If the function template has a non-dependent explicit specification,
7473   // exclude it now if appropriate; we are not permitted to perform deduction
7474   // and substitution in this case.
7475   if (!AllowExplicit && isNonDependentlyExplicit(FunctionTemplate)) {
7476     OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.addCandidate();
7477     Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl;
7478     Candidate.Function = FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl();
7479     Candidate.Viable = false;
7480     Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_explicit;
7481     return;
7482   }
7483 
7484   TemplateDeductionInfo Info(CandidateSet.getLocation());
7485   CXXConversionDecl *Specialization = nullptr;
7486   if (TemplateDeductionResult Result
7487         = DeduceTemplateArguments(FunctionTemplate, ToType,
7488                                   Specialization, Info)) {
7489     OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.addCandidate();
7490     Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl;
7491     Candidate.Function = FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl();
7492     Candidate.Viable = false;
7493     Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_deduction;
7494     Candidate.IsSurrogate = false;
7495     Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
7496     Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = 1;
7497     Candidate.DeductionFailure = MakeDeductionFailureInfo(Context, Result,
7498                                                           Info);
7499     return;
7500   }
7501 
7502   // Add the conversion function template specialization produced by
7503   // template argument deduction as a candidate.
7504   assert(Specialization && "Missing function template specialization?");
7505   AddConversionCandidate(Specialization, FoundDecl, ActingDC, From, ToType,
7506                          CandidateSet, AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit,
7507                          AllowExplicit, AllowResultConversion);
7508 }
7509 
7510 /// AddSurrogateCandidate - Adds a "surrogate" candidate function that
7511 /// converts the given @c Object to a function pointer via the
7512 /// conversion function @c Conversion, and then attempts to call it
7513 /// with the given arguments (C++ [over.call.object]p2-4). Proto is
7514 /// the type of function that we'll eventually be calling.
7515 void Sema::AddSurrogateCandidate(CXXConversionDecl *Conversion,
7516                                  DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
7517                                  CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext,
7518                                  const FunctionProtoType *Proto,
7519                                  Expr *Object,
7520                                  ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
7521                                  OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet) {
7522   if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(Conversion))
7523     return;
7524 
7525   // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context.
7526   EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated(
7527       *this, Sema::ExpressionEvaluationContext::Unevaluated);
7528 
7529   OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.addCandidate(Args.size() + 1);
7530   Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl;
7531   Candidate.Function = nullptr;
7532   Candidate.Surrogate = Conversion;
7533   Candidate.Viable = true;
7534   Candidate.IsSurrogate = true;
7535   Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
7536   Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = Args.size();
7537 
7538   // Determine the implicit conversion sequence for the implicit
7539   // object parameter.
7540   ImplicitConversionSequence ObjectInit = TryObjectArgumentInitialization(
7541       *this, CandidateSet.getLocation(), Object->getType(),
7542       Object->Classify(Context), Conversion, ActingContext);
7543   if (ObjectInit.isBad()) {
7544     Candidate.Viable = false;
7545     Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
7546     Candidate.Conversions[0] = ObjectInit;
7547     return;
7548   }
7549 
7550   // The first conversion is actually a user-defined conversion whose
7551   // first conversion is ObjectInit's standard conversion (which is
7552   // effectively a reference binding). Record it as such.
7553   Candidate.Conversions[0].setUserDefined();
7554   Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.Before = ObjectInit.Standard;
7555   Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.EllipsisConversion = false;
7556   Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.HadMultipleCandidates = false;
7557   Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.ConversionFunction = Conversion;
7558   Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.FoundConversionFunction = FoundDecl;
7559   Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.After
7560     = Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.Before;
7561   Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.After.setAsIdentityConversion();
7562 
7563   // Find the
7564   unsigned NumParams = Proto->getNumParams();
7565 
7566   // (C++ 13.3.2p2): A candidate function having fewer than m
7567   // parameters is viable only if it has an ellipsis in its parameter
7568   // list (8.3.5).
7569   if (Args.size() > NumParams && !Proto->isVariadic()) {
7570     Candidate.Viable = false;
7571     Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_many_arguments;
7572     return;
7573   }
7574 
7575   // Function types don't have any default arguments, so just check if
7576   // we have enough arguments.
7577   if (Args.size() < NumParams) {
7578     // Not enough arguments.
7579     Candidate.Viable = false;
7580     Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_few_arguments;
7581     return;
7582   }
7583 
7584   // Determine the implicit conversion sequences for each of the
7585   // arguments.
7586   for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, N = Args.size(); ArgIdx != N; ++ArgIdx) {
7587     if (ArgIdx < NumParams) {
7588       // (C++ 13.3.2p3): for F to be a viable function, there shall
7589       // exist for each argument an implicit conversion sequence
7590       // (13.3.3.1) that converts that argument to the corresponding
7591       // parameter of F.
7592       QualType ParamType = Proto->getParamType(ArgIdx);
7593       Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1]
7594         = TryCopyInitialization(*this, Args[ArgIdx], ParamType,
7595                                 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false,
7596                                 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false,
7597                                 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/
7598                                   getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount);
7599       if (Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1].isBad()) {
7600         Candidate.Viable = false;
7601         Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
7602         return;
7603       }
7604     } else {
7605       // (C++ 13.3.2p2): For the purposes of overload resolution, any
7606       // argument for which there is no corresponding parameter is
7607       // considered to ""match the ellipsis" (C+ 13.3.3.1.3).
7608       Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1].setEllipsis();
7609     }
7610   }
7611 
7612   if (EnableIfAttr *FailedAttr =
7613           CheckEnableIf(Conversion, CandidateSet.getLocation(), None)) {
7614     Candidate.Viable = false;
7615     Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_enable_if;
7616     Candidate.DeductionFailure.Data = FailedAttr;
7617     return;
7618   }
7619 }
7620 
7621 /// Add all of the non-member operator function declarations in the given
7622 /// function set to the overload candidate set.
7623 void Sema::AddNonMemberOperatorCandidates(
7624     const UnresolvedSetImpl &Fns, ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
7625     OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet,
7626     TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs) {
7627   for (UnresolvedSetIterator F = Fns.begin(), E = Fns.end(); F != E; ++F) {
7628     NamedDecl *D = F.getDecl()->getUnderlyingDecl();
7629     ArrayRef<Expr *> FunctionArgs = Args;
7630 
7631     FunctionTemplateDecl *FunTmpl = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D);
7632     FunctionDecl *FD =
7633         FunTmpl ? FunTmpl->getTemplatedDecl() : cast<FunctionDecl>(D);
7634 
7635     // Don't consider rewritten functions if we're not rewriting.
7636     if (!CandidateSet.getRewriteInfo().isAcceptableCandidate(FD))
7637       continue;
7638 
7639     assert(!isa<CXXMethodDecl>(FD) &&
7640            "unqualified operator lookup found a member function");
7641 
7642     if (FunTmpl) {
7643       AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(FunTmpl, F.getPair(), ExplicitTemplateArgs,
7644                                    FunctionArgs, CandidateSet);
7645       if (CandidateSet.getRewriteInfo().shouldAddReversed(Context, FD))
7646         AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(
7647             FunTmpl, F.getPair(), ExplicitTemplateArgs,
7648             {FunctionArgs[1], FunctionArgs[0]}, CandidateSet, false, false,
7649             true, ADLCallKind::NotADL, OverloadCandidateParamOrder::Reversed);
7650     } else {
7651       if (ExplicitTemplateArgs)
7652         continue;
7653       AddOverloadCandidate(FD, F.getPair(), FunctionArgs, CandidateSet);
7654       if (CandidateSet.getRewriteInfo().shouldAddReversed(Context, FD))
7655         AddOverloadCandidate(FD, F.getPair(),
7656                              {FunctionArgs[1], FunctionArgs[0]}, CandidateSet,
7657                              false, false, true, false, ADLCallKind::NotADL,
7658                              None, OverloadCandidateParamOrder::Reversed);
7659     }
7660   }
7661 }
7662 
7663 /// Add overload candidates for overloaded operators that are
7664 /// member functions.
7665 ///
7666 /// Add the overloaded operator candidates that are member functions
7667 /// for the operator Op that was used in an operator expression such
7668 /// as "x Op y". , Args/NumArgs provides the operator arguments, and
7669 /// CandidateSet will store the added overload candidates. (C++
7670 /// [over.match.oper]).
7671 void Sema::AddMemberOperatorCandidates(OverloadedOperatorKind Op,
7672                                        SourceLocation OpLoc,
7673                                        ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
7674                                        OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet,
7675                                        OverloadCandidateParamOrder PO) {
7676   DeclarationName OpName = Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(Op);
7677 
7678   // C++ [over.match.oper]p3:
7679   //   For a unary operator @ with an operand of a type whose
7680   //   cv-unqualified version is T1, and for a binary operator @ with
7681   //   a left operand of a type whose cv-unqualified version is T1 and
7682   //   a right operand of a type whose cv-unqualified version is T2,
7683   //   three sets of candidate functions, designated member
7684   //   candidates, non-member candidates and built-in candidates, are
7685   //   constructed as follows:
7686   QualType T1 = Args[0]->getType();
7687 
7688   //     -- If T1 is a complete class type or a class currently being
7689   //        defined, the set of member candidates is the result of the
7690   //        qualified lookup of T1::operator@ (13.3.1.1.1); otherwise,
7691   //        the set of member candidates is empty.
7692   if (const RecordType *T1Rec = T1->getAs<RecordType>()) {
7693     // Complete the type if it can be completed.
7694     if (!isCompleteType(OpLoc, T1) && !T1Rec->isBeingDefined())
7695       return;
7696     // If the type is neither complete nor being defined, bail out now.
7697     if (!T1Rec->getDecl()->getDefinition())
7698       return;
7699 
7700     LookupResult Operators(*this, OpName, OpLoc, LookupOrdinaryName);
7701     LookupQualifiedName(Operators, T1Rec->getDecl());
7702     Operators.suppressDiagnostics();
7703 
7704     for (LookupResult::iterator Oper = Operators.begin(),
7705                              OperEnd = Operators.end();
7706          Oper != OperEnd;
7707          ++Oper)
7708       AddMethodCandidate(Oper.getPair(), Args[0]->getType(),
7709                          Args[0]->Classify(Context), Args.slice(1),
7710                          CandidateSet, /*SuppressUserConversion=*/false, PO);
7711   }
7712 }
7713 
7714 /// AddBuiltinCandidate - Add a candidate for a built-in
7715 /// operator. ResultTy and ParamTys are the result and parameter types
7716 /// of the built-in candidate, respectively. Args and NumArgs are the
7717 /// arguments being passed to the candidate. IsAssignmentOperator
7718 /// should be true when this built-in candidate is an assignment
7719 /// operator. NumContextualBoolArguments is the number of arguments
7720 /// (at the beginning of the argument list) that will be contextually
7721 /// converted to bool.
7722 void Sema::AddBuiltinCandidate(QualType *ParamTys, ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
7723                                OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
7724                                bool IsAssignmentOperator,
7725                                unsigned NumContextualBoolArguments) {
7726   // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context.
7727   EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated(
7728       *this, Sema::ExpressionEvaluationContext::Unevaluated);
7729 
7730   // Add this candidate
7731   OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.addCandidate(Args.size());
7732   Candidate.FoundDecl = DeclAccessPair::make(nullptr, AS_none);
7733   Candidate.Function = nullptr;
7734   Candidate.IsSurrogate = false;
7735   Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
7736   std::copy(ParamTys, ParamTys + Args.size(), Candidate.BuiltinParamTypes);
7737 
7738   // Determine the implicit conversion sequences for each of the
7739   // arguments.
7740   Candidate.Viable = true;
7741   Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = Args.size();
7742   for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, N = Args.size(); ArgIdx != N; ++ArgIdx) {
7743     // C++ [over.match.oper]p4:
7744     //   For the built-in assignment operators, conversions of the
7745     //   left operand are restricted as follows:
7746     //     -- no temporaries are introduced to hold the left operand, and
7747     //     -- no user-defined conversions are applied to the left
7748     //        operand to achieve a type match with the left-most
7749     //        parameter of a built-in candidate.
7750     //
7751     // We block these conversions by turning off user-defined
7752     // conversions, since that is the only way that initialization of
7753     // a reference to a non-class type can occur from something that
7754     // is not of the same type.
7755     if (ArgIdx < NumContextualBoolArguments) {
7756       assert(ParamTys[ArgIdx] == Context.BoolTy &&
7757              "Contextual conversion to bool requires bool type");
7758       Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx]
7759         = TryContextuallyConvertToBool(*this, Args[ArgIdx]);
7760     } else {
7761       Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx]
7762         = TryCopyInitialization(*this, Args[ArgIdx], ParamTys[ArgIdx],
7763                                 ArgIdx == 0 && IsAssignmentOperator,
7764                                 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false,
7765                                 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/
7766                                   getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount);
7767     }
7768     if (Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx].isBad()) {
7769       Candidate.Viable = false;
7770       Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
7771       break;
7772     }
7773   }
7774 }
7775 
7776 namespace {
7777 
7778 /// BuiltinCandidateTypeSet - A set of types that will be used for the
7779 /// candidate operator functions for built-in operators (C++
7780 /// [over.built]). The types are separated into pointer types and
7781 /// enumeration types.
7782 class BuiltinCandidateTypeSet  {
7783   /// TypeSet - A set of types.
7784   typedef llvm::SetVector<QualType, SmallVector<QualType, 8>,
7785                           llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8>> TypeSet;
7786 
7787   /// PointerTypes - The set of pointer types that will be used in the
7788   /// built-in candidates.
7789   TypeSet PointerTypes;
7790 
7791   /// MemberPointerTypes - The set of member pointer types that will be
7792   /// used in the built-in candidates.
7793   TypeSet MemberPointerTypes;
7794 
7795   /// EnumerationTypes - The set of enumeration types that will be
7796   /// used in the built-in candidates.
7797   TypeSet EnumerationTypes;
7798 
7799   /// The set of vector types that will be used in the built-in
7800   /// candidates.
7801   TypeSet VectorTypes;
7802 
7803   /// The set of matrix types that will be used in the built-in
7804   /// candidates.
7805   TypeSet MatrixTypes;
7806 
7807   /// A flag indicating non-record types are viable candidates
7808   bool HasNonRecordTypes;
7809 
7810   /// A flag indicating whether either arithmetic or enumeration types
7811   /// were present in the candidate set.
7812   bool HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes;
7813 
7814   /// A flag indicating whether the nullptr type was present in the
7815   /// candidate set.
7816   bool HasNullPtrType;
7817 
7818   /// Sema - The semantic analysis instance where we are building the
7819   /// candidate type set.
7820   Sema &SemaRef;
7821 
7822   /// Context - The AST context in which we will build the type sets.
7823   ASTContext &Context;
7824 
7825   bool AddPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(QualType Ty,
7826                                                const Qualifiers &VisibleQuals);
7827   bool AddMemberPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(QualType Ty);
7828 
7829 public:
7830   /// iterator - Iterates through the types that are part of the set.
7831   typedef TypeSet::iterator iterator;
7832 
7833   BuiltinCandidateTypeSet(Sema &SemaRef)
7834     : HasNonRecordTypes(false),
7835       HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes(false),
7836       HasNullPtrType(false),
7837       SemaRef(SemaRef),
7838       Context(SemaRef.Context) { }
7839 
7840   void AddTypesConvertedFrom(QualType Ty,
7841                              SourceLocation Loc,
7842                              bool AllowUserConversions,
7843                              bool AllowExplicitConversions,
7844                              const Qualifiers &VisibleTypeConversionsQuals);
7845 
7846   llvm::iterator_range<iterator> pointer_types() { return PointerTypes; }
7847   llvm::iterator_range<iterator> member_pointer_types() {
7848     return MemberPointerTypes;
7849   }
7850   llvm::iterator_range<iterator> enumeration_types() {
7851     return EnumerationTypes;
7852   }
7853   llvm::iterator_range<iterator> vector_types() { return VectorTypes; }
7854   llvm::iterator_range<iterator> matrix_types() { return MatrixTypes; }
7855 
7856   bool containsMatrixType(QualType Ty) const { return MatrixTypes.count(Ty); }
7857   bool hasNonRecordTypes() { return HasNonRecordTypes; }
7858   bool hasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes() { return HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes; }
7859   bool hasNullPtrType() const { return HasNullPtrType; }
7860 };
7861 
7862 } // end anonymous namespace
7863 
7864 /// AddPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants - Add the pointer type @p Ty to
7865 /// the set of pointer types along with any more-qualified variants of
7866 /// that type. For example, if @p Ty is "int const *", this routine
7867 /// will add "int const *", "int const volatile *", "int const
7868 /// restrict *", and "int const volatile restrict *" to the set of
7869 /// pointer types. Returns true if the add of @p Ty itself succeeded,
7870 /// false otherwise.
7871 ///
7872 /// FIXME: what to do about extended qualifiers?
7873 bool
7874 BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::AddPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(QualType Ty,
7875                                              const Qualifiers &VisibleQuals) {
7876 
7877   // Insert this type.
7878   if (!PointerTypes.insert(Ty))
7879     return false;
7880 
7881   QualType PointeeTy;
7882   const PointerType *PointerTy = Ty->getAs<PointerType>();
7883   bool buildObjCPtr = false;
7884   if (!PointerTy) {
7885     const ObjCObjectPointerType *PTy = Ty->castAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
7886     PointeeTy = PTy->getPointeeType();
7887     buildObjCPtr = true;
7888   } else {
7889     PointeeTy = PointerTy->getPointeeType();
7890   }
7891 
7892   // Don't add qualified variants of arrays. For one, they're not allowed
7893   // (the qualifier would sink to the element type), and for another, the
7894   // only overload situation where it matters is subscript or pointer +- int,
7895   // and those shouldn't have qualifier variants anyway.
7896   if (PointeeTy->isArrayType())
7897     return true;
7898 
7899   unsigned BaseCVR = PointeeTy.getCVRQualifiers();
7900   bool hasVolatile = VisibleQuals.hasVolatile();
7901   bool hasRestrict = VisibleQuals.hasRestrict();
7902 
7903   // Iterate through all strict supersets of BaseCVR.
7904   for (unsigned CVR = BaseCVR+1; CVR <= Qualifiers::CVRMask; ++CVR) {
7905     if ((CVR | BaseCVR) != CVR) continue;
7906     // Skip over volatile if no volatile found anywhere in the types.
7907     if ((CVR & Qualifiers::Volatile) && !hasVolatile) continue;
7908 
7909     // Skip over restrict if no restrict found anywhere in the types, or if
7910     // the type cannot be restrict-qualified.
7911     if ((CVR & Qualifiers::Restrict) &&
7912         (!hasRestrict ||
7913          (!(PointeeTy->isAnyPointerType() || PointeeTy->isReferenceType()))))
7914       continue;
7915 
7916     // Build qualified pointee type.
7917     QualType QPointeeTy = Context.getCVRQualifiedType(PointeeTy, CVR);
7918 
7919     // Build qualified pointer type.
7920     QualType QPointerTy;
7921     if (!buildObjCPtr)
7922       QPointerTy = Context.getPointerType(QPointeeTy);
7923     else
7924       QPointerTy = Context.getObjCObjectPointerType(QPointeeTy);
7925 
7926     // Insert qualified pointer type.
7927     PointerTypes.insert(QPointerTy);
7928   }
7929 
7930   return true;
7931 }
7932 
7933 /// AddMemberPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants - Add the pointer type @p Ty
7934 /// to the set of pointer types along with any more-qualified variants of
7935 /// that type. For example, if @p Ty is "int const *", this routine
7936 /// will add "int const *", "int const volatile *", "int const
7937 /// restrict *", and "int const volatile restrict *" to the set of
7938 /// pointer types. Returns true if the add of @p Ty itself succeeded,
7939 /// false otherwise.
7940 ///
7941 /// FIXME: what to do about extended qualifiers?
7942 bool
7943 BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::AddMemberPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(
7944     QualType Ty) {
7945   // Insert this type.
7946   if (!MemberPointerTypes.insert(Ty))
7947     return false;
7948 
7949   const MemberPointerType *PointerTy = Ty->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
7950   assert(PointerTy && "type was not a member pointer type!");
7951 
7952   QualType PointeeTy = PointerTy->getPointeeType();
7953   // Don't add qualified variants of arrays. For one, they're not allowed
7954   // (the qualifier would sink to the element type), and for another, the
7955   // only overload situation where it matters is subscript or pointer +- int,
7956   // and those shouldn't have qualifier variants anyway.
7957   if (PointeeTy->isArrayType())
7958     return true;
7959   const Type *ClassTy = PointerTy->getClass();
7960 
7961   // Iterate through all strict supersets of the pointee type's CVR
7962   // qualifiers.
7963   unsigned BaseCVR = PointeeTy.getCVRQualifiers();
7964   for (unsigned CVR = BaseCVR+1; CVR <= Qualifiers::CVRMask; ++CVR) {
7965     if ((CVR | BaseCVR) != CVR) continue;
7966 
7967     QualType QPointeeTy = Context.getCVRQualifiedType(PointeeTy, CVR);
7968     MemberPointerTypes.insert(
7969       Context.getMemberPointerType(QPointeeTy, ClassTy));
7970   }
7971 
7972   return true;
7973 }
7974 
7975 /// AddTypesConvertedFrom - Add each of the types to which the type @p
7976 /// Ty can be implicit converted to the given set of @p Types. We're
7977 /// primarily interested in pointer types and enumeration types. We also
7978 /// take member pointer types, for the conditional operator.
7979 /// AllowUserConversions is true if we should look at the conversion
7980 /// functions of a class type, and AllowExplicitConversions if we
7981 /// should also include the explicit conversion functions of a class
7982 /// type.
7983 void
7984 BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::AddTypesConvertedFrom(QualType Ty,
7985                                                SourceLocation Loc,
7986                                                bool AllowUserConversions,
7987                                                bool AllowExplicitConversions,
7988                                                const Qualifiers &VisibleQuals) {
7989   // Only deal with canonical types.
7990   Ty = Context.getCanonicalType(Ty);
7991 
7992   // Look through reference types; they aren't part of the type of an
7993   // expression for the purposes of conversions.
7994   if (const ReferenceType *RefTy = Ty->getAs<ReferenceType>())
7995     Ty = RefTy->getPointeeType();
7996 
7997   // If we're dealing with an array type, decay to the pointer.
7998   if (Ty->isArrayType())
7999     Ty = SemaRef.Context.getArrayDecayedType(Ty);
8000 
8001   // Otherwise, we don't care about qualifiers on the type.
8002   Ty = Ty.getLocalUnqualifiedType();
8003 
8004   // Flag if we ever add a non-record type.
8005   const RecordType *TyRec = Ty->getAs<RecordType>();
8006   HasNonRecordTypes = HasNonRecordTypes || !TyRec;
8007 
8008   // Flag if we encounter an arithmetic type.
8009   HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes =
8010     HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes || Ty->isArithmeticType();
8011 
8012   if (Ty->isObjCIdType() || Ty->isObjCClassType())
8013     PointerTypes.insert(Ty);
8014   else if (Ty->getAs<PointerType>() || Ty->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
8015     // Insert our type, and its more-qualified variants, into the set
8016     // of types.
8017     if (!AddPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(Ty, VisibleQuals))
8018       return;
8019   } else if (Ty->isMemberPointerType()) {
8020     // Member pointers are far easier, since the pointee can't be converted.
8021     if (!AddMemberPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(Ty))
8022       return;
8023   } else if (Ty->isEnumeralType()) {
8024     HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes = true;
8025     EnumerationTypes.insert(Ty);
8026   } else if (Ty->isVectorType()) {
8027     // We treat vector types as arithmetic types in many contexts as an
8028     // extension.
8029     HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes = true;
8030     VectorTypes.insert(Ty);
8031   } else if (Ty->isMatrixType()) {
8032     // Similar to vector types, we treat vector types as arithmetic types in
8033     // many contexts as an extension.
8034     HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes = true;
8035     MatrixTypes.insert(Ty);
8036   } else if (Ty->isNullPtrType()) {
8037     HasNullPtrType = true;
8038   } else if (AllowUserConversions && TyRec) {
8039     // No conversion functions in incomplete types.
8040     if (!SemaRef.isCompleteType(Loc, Ty))
8041       return;
8042 
8043     CXXRecordDecl *ClassDecl = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(TyRec->getDecl());
8044     for (NamedDecl *D : ClassDecl->getVisibleConversionFunctions()) {
8045       if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D))
8046         D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl();
8047 
8048       // Skip conversion function templates; they don't tell us anything
8049       // about which builtin types we can convert to.
8050       if (isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D))
8051         continue;
8052 
8053       CXXConversionDecl *Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D);
8054       if (AllowExplicitConversions || !Conv->isExplicit()) {
8055         AddTypesConvertedFrom(Conv->getConversionType(), Loc, false, false,
8056                               VisibleQuals);
8057       }
8058     }
8059   }
8060 }
8061 /// Helper function for adjusting address spaces for the pointer or reference
8062 /// operands of builtin operators depending on the argument.
8063 static QualType AdjustAddressSpaceForBuiltinOperandType(Sema &S, QualType T,
8064                                                         Expr *Arg) {
8065   return S.Context.getAddrSpaceQualType(T, Arg->getType().getAddressSpace());
8066 }
8067 
8068 /// Helper function for AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates() that adds
8069 /// the volatile- and non-volatile-qualified assignment operators for the
8070 /// given type to the candidate set.
8071 static void AddBuiltinAssignmentOperatorCandidates(Sema &S,
8072                                                    QualType T,
8073                                                    ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
8074                                     OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet) {
8075   QualType ParamTypes[2];
8076 
8077   // T& operator=(T&, T)
8078   ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(
8079       AdjustAddressSpaceForBuiltinOperandType(S, T, Args[0]));
8080   ParamTypes[1] = T;
8081   S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet,
8082                         /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/true);
8083 
8084   if (!S.Context.getCanonicalType(T).isVolatileQualified()) {
8085     // volatile T& operator=(volatile T&, T)
8086     ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(
8087         AdjustAddressSpaceForBuiltinOperandType(S, S.Context.getVolatileType(T),
8088                                                 Args[0]));
8089     ParamTypes[1] = T;
8090     S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet,
8091                           /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/true);
8092   }
8093 }
8094 
8095 /// CollectVRQualifiers - This routine returns Volatile/Restrict qualifiers,
8096 /// if any, found in visible type conversion functions found in ArgExpr's type.
8097 static  Qualifiers CollectVRQualifiers(ASTContext &Context, Expr* ArgExpr) {
8098     Qualifiers VRQuals;
8099     const RecordType *TyRec;
8100     if (const MemberPointerType *RHSMPType =
8101         ArgExpr->getType()->getAs<MemberPointerType>())
8102       TyRec = RHSMPType->getClass()->getAs<RecordType>();
8103     else
8104       TyRec = ArgExpr->getType()->getAs<RecordType>();
8105     if (!TyRec) {
8106       // Just to be safe, assume the worst case.
8107       VRQuals.addVolatile();
8108       VRQuals.addRestrict();
8109       return VRQuals;
8110     }
8111 
8112     CXXRecordDecl *ClassDecl = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(TyRec->getDecl());
8113     if (!ClassDecl->hasDefinition())
8114       return VRQuals;
8115 
8116     for (NamedDecl *D : ClassDecl->getVisibleConversionFunctions()) {
8117       if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D))
8118         D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl();
8119       if (CXXConversionDecl *Conv = dyn_cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D)) {
8120         QualType CanTy = Context.getCanonicalType(Conv->getConversionType());
8121         if (const ReferenceType *ResTypeRef = CanTy->getAs<ReferenceType>())
8122           CanTy = ResTypeRef->getPointeeType();
8123         // Need to go down the pointer/mempointer chain and add qualifiers
8124         // as see them.
8125         bool done = false;
8126         while (!done) {
8127           if (CanTy.isRestrictQualified())
8128             VRQuals.addRestrict();
8129           if (const PointerType *ResTypePtr = CanTy->getAs<PointerType>())
8130             CanTy = ResTypePtr->getPointeeType();
8131           else if (const MemberPointerType *ResTypeMPtr =
8132                 CanTy->getAs<MemberPointerType>())
8133             CanTy = ResTypeMPtr->getPointeeType();
8134           else
8135             done = true;
8136           if (CanTy.isVolatileQualified())
8137             VRQuals.addVolatile();
8138           if (VRQuals.hasRestrict() && VRQuals.hasVolatile())
8139             return VRQuals;
8140         }
8141       }
8142     }
8143     return VRQuals;
8144 }
8145 
8146 namespace {
8147 
8148 /// Helper class to manage the addition of builtin operator overload
8149 /// candidates. It provides shared state and utility methods used throughout
8150 /// the process, as well as a helper method to add each group of builtin
8151 /// operator overloads from the standard to a candidate set.
8152 class BuiltinOperatorOverloadBuilder {
8153   // Common instance state available to all overload candidate addition methods.
8154   Sema &S;
8155   ArrayRef<Expr *> Args;
8156   Qualifiers VisibleTypeConversionsQuals;
8157   bool HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType;
8158   SmallVectorImpl<BuiltinCandidateTypeSet> &CandidateTypes;
8159   OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet;
8160 
8161   static constexpr int ArithmeticTypesCap = 24;
8162   SmallVector<CanQualType, ArithmeticTypesCap> ArithmeticTypes;
8163 
8164   // Define some indices used to iterate over the arithmetic types in
8165   // ArithmeticTypes.  The "promoted arithmetic types" are the arithmetic
8166   // types are that preserved by promotion (C++ [over.built]p2).
8167   unsigned FirstIntegralType,
8168            LastIntegralType;
8169   unsigned FirstPromotedIntegralType,
8170            LastPromotedIntegralType;
8171   unsigned FirstPromotedArithmeticType,
8172            LastPromotedArithmeticType;
8173   unsigned NumArithmeticTypes;
8174 
8175   void InitArithmeticTypes() {
8176     // Start of promoted types.
8177     FirstPromotedArithmeticType = 0;
8178     ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.FloatTy);
8179     ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.DoubleTy);
8180     ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.LongDoubleTy);
8181     if (S.Context.getTargetInfo().hasFloat128Type())
8182       ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.Float128Ty);
8183 
8184     // Start of integral types.
8185     FirstIntegralType = ArithmeticTypes.size();
8186     FirstPromotedIntegralType = ArithmeticTypes.size();
8187     ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.IntTy);
8188     ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.LongTy);
8189     ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.LongLongTy);
8190     if (S.Context.getTargetInfo().hasInt128Type() ||
8191         (S.Context.getAuxTargetInfo() &&
8192          S.Context.getAuxTargetInfo()->hasInt128Type()))
8193       ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.Int128Ty);
8194     ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.UnsignedIntTy);
8195     ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.UnsignedLongTy);
8196     ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.UnsignedLongLongTy);
8197     if (S.Context.getTargetInfo().hasInt128Type() ||
8198         (S.Context.getAuxTargetInfo() &&
8199          S.Context.getAuxTargetInfo()->hasInt128Type()))
8200       ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.UnsignedInt128Ty);
8201     LastPromotedIntegralType = ArithmeticTypes.size();
8202     LastPromotedArithmeticType = ArithmeticTypes.size();
8203     // End of promoted types.
8204 
8205     ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.BoolTy);
8206     ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.CharTy);
8207     ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.WCharTy);
8208     if (S.Context.getLangOpts().Char8)
8209       ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.Char8Ty);
8210     ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.Char16Ty);
8211     ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.Char32Ty);
8212     ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.SignedCharTy);
8213     ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.ShortTy);
8214     ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.UnsignedCharTy);
8215     ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.UnsignedShortTy);
8216     LastIntegralType = ArithmeticTypes.size();
8217     NumArithmeticTypes = ArithmeticTypes.size();
8218     // End of integral types.
8219     // FIXME: What about complex? What about half?
8220 
8221     assert(ArithmeticTypes.size() <= ArithmeticTypesCap &&
8222            "Enough inline storage for all arithmetic types.");
8223   }
8224 
8225   /// Helper method to factor out the common pattern of adding overloads
8226   /// for '++' and '--' builtin operators.
8227   void addPlusPlusMinusMinusStyleOverloads(QualType CandidateTy,
8228                                            bool HasVolatile,
8229                                            bool HasRestrict) {
8230     QualType ParamTypes[2] = {
8231       S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(CandidateTy),
8232       S.Context.IntTy
8233     };
8234 
8235     // Non-volatile version.
8236     S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet);
8237 
8238     // Use a heuristic to reduce number of builtin candidates in the set:
8239     // add volatile version only if there are conversions to a volatile type.
8240     if (HasVolatile) {
8241       ParamTypes[0] =
8242         S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(
8243           S.Context.getVolatileType(CandidateTy));
8244       S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet);
8245     }
8246 
8247     // Add restrict version only if there are conversions to a restrict type
8248     // and our candidate type is a non-restrict-qualified pointer.
8249     if (HasRestrict && CandidateTy->isAnyPointerType() &&
8250         !CandidateTy.isRestrictQualified()) {
8251       ParamTypes[0]
8252         = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(
8253             S.Context.getCVRQualifiedType(CandidateTy, Qualifiers::Restrict));
8254       S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet);
8255 
8256       if (HasVolatile) {
8257         ParamTypes[0]
8258           = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(
8259               S.Context.getCVRQualifiedType(CandidateTy,
8260                                             (Qualifiers::Volatile |
8261                                              Qualifiers::Restrict)));
8262         S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet);
8263       }
8264     }
8265 
8266   }
8267 
8268   /// Helper to add an overload candidate for a binary builtin with types \p L
8269   /// and \p R.
8270   void AddCandidate(QualType L, QualType R) {
8271     QualType LandR[2] = {L, R};
8272     S.AddBuiltinCandidate(LandR, Args, CandidateSet);
8273   }
8274 
8275 public:
8276   BuiltinOperatorOverloadBuilder(
8277     Sema &S, ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
8278     Qualifiers VisibleTypeConversionsQuals,
8279     bool HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType,
8280     SmallVectorImpl<BuiltinCandidateTypeSet> &CandidateTypes,
8281     OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet)
8282     : S(S), Args(Args),
8283       VisibleTypeConversionsQuals(VisibleTypeConversionsQuals),
8284       HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType(
8285         HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType),
8286       CandidateTypes(CandidateTypes),
8287       CandidateSet(CandidateSet) {
8288 
8289     InitArithmeticTypes();
8290   }
8291 
8292   // Increment is deprecated for bool since C++17.
8293   //
8294   // C++ [over.built]p3:
8295   //
8296   //   For every pair (T, VQ), where T is an arithmetic type other
8297   //   than bool, and VQ is either volatile or empty, there exist
8298   //   candidate operator functions of the form
8299   //
8300   //       VQ T&      operator++(VQ T&);
8301   //       T          operator++(VQ T&, int);
8302   //
8303   // C++ [over.built]p4:
8304   //
8305   //   For every pair (T, VQ), where T is an arithmetic type other
8306   //   than bool, and VQ is either volatile or empty, there exist
8307   //   candidate operator functions of the form
8308   //
8309   //       VQ T&      operator--(VQ T&);
8310   //       T          operator--(VQ T&, int);
8311   void addPlusPlusMinusMinusArithmeticOverloads(OverloadedOperatorKind Op) {
8312     if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType)
8313       return;
8314 
8315     for (unsigned Arith = 0; Arith < NumArithmeticTypes; ++Arith) {
8316       const auto TypeOfT = ArithmeticTypes[Arith];
8317       if (TypeOfT == S.Context.BoolTy) {
8318         if (Op == OO_MinusMinus)
8319           continue;
8320         if (Op == OO_PlusPlus && S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus17)
8321           continue;
8322       }
8323       addPlusPlusMinusMinusStyleOverloads(
8324         TypeOfT,
8325         VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile(),
8326         VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasRestrict());
8327     }
8328   }
8329 
8330   // C++ [over.built]p5:
8331   //
8332   //   For every pair (T, VQ), where T is a cv-qualified or
8333   //   cv-unqualified object type, and VQ is either volatile or
8334   //   empty, there exist candidate operator functions of the form
8335   //
8336   //       T*VQ&      operator++(T*VQ&);
8337   //       T*VQ&      operator--(T*VQ&);
8338   //       T*         operator++(T*VQ&, int);
8339   //       T*         operator--(T*VQ&, int);
8340   void addPlusPlusMinusMinusPointerOverloads() {
8341     for (QualType PtrTy : CandidateTypes[0].pointer_types()) {
8342       // Skip pointer types that aren't pointers to object types.
8343       if (!PtrTy->getPointeeType()->isObjectType())
8344         continue;
8345 
8346       addPlusPlusMinusMinusStyleOverloads(
8347           PtrTy,
8348           (!PtrTy.isVolatileQualified() &&
8349            VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile()),
8350           (!PtrTy.isRestrictQualified() &&
8351            VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasRestrict()));
8352     }
8353   }
8354 
8355   // C++ [over.built]p6:
8356   //   For every cv-qualified or cv-unqualified object type T, there
8357   //   exist candidate operator functions of the form
8358   //
8359   //       T&         operator*(T*);
8360   //
8361   // C++ [over.built]p7:
8362   //   For every function type T that does not have cv-qualifiers or a
8363   //   ref-qualifier, there exist candidate operator functions of the form
8364   //       T&         operator*(T*);
8365   void addUnaryStarPointerOverloads() {
8366     for (QualType ParamTy : CandidateTypes[0].pointer_types()) {
8367       QualType PointeeTy = ParamTy->getPointeeType();
8368       if (!PointeeTy->isObjectType() && !PointeeTy->isFunctionType())
8369         continue;
8370 
8371       if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto =PointeeTy->getAs<FunctionProtoType>())
8372         if (Proto->getMethodQuals() || Proto->getRefQualifier())
8373           continue;
8374 
8375       S.AddBuiltinCandidate(&ParamTy, Args, CandidateSet);
8376     }
8377   }
8378 
8379   // C++ [over.built]p9:
8380   //  For every promoted arithmetic type T, there exist candidate
8381   //  operator functions of the form
8382   //
8383   //       T         operator+(T);
8384   //       T         operator-(T);
8385   void addUnaryPlusOrMinusArithmeticOverloads() {
8386     if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType)
8387       return;
8388 
8389     for (unsigned Arith = FirstPromotedArithmeticType;
8390          Arith < LastPromotedArithmeticType; ++Arith) {
8391       QualType ArithTy = ArithmeticTypes[Arith];
8392       S.AddBuiltinCandidate(&ArithTy, Args, CandidateSet);
8393     }
8394 
8395     // Extension: We also add these operators for vector types.
8396     for (QualType VecTy : CandidateTypes[0].vector_types())
8397       S.AddBuiltinCandidate(&VecTy, Args, CandidateSet);
8398   }
8399 
8400   // C++ [over.built]p8:
8401   //   For every type T, there exist candidate operator functions of
8402   //   the form
8403   //
8404   //       T*         operator+(T*);
8405   void addUnaryPlusPointerOverloads() {
8406     for (QualType ParamTy : CandidateTypes[0].pointer_types())
8407       S.AddBuiltinCandidate(&ParamTy, Args, CandidateSet);
8408   }
8409 
8410   // C++ [over.built]p10:
8411   //   For every promoted integral type T, there exist candidate
8412   //   operator functions of the form
8413   //
8414   //        T         operator~(T);
8415   void addUnaryTildePromotedIntegralOverloads() {
8416     if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType)
8417       return;
8418 
8419     for (unsigned Int = FirstPromotedIntegralType;
8420          Int < LastPromotedIntegralType; ++Int) {
8421       QualType IntTy = ArithmeticTypes[Int];
8422       S.AddBuiltinCandidate(&IntTy, Args, CandidateSet);
8423     }
8424 
8425     // Extension: We also add this operator for vector types.
8426     for (QualType VecTy : CandidateTypes[0].vector_types())
8427       S.AddBuiltinCandidate(&VecTy, Args, CandidateSet);
8428   }
8429 
8430   // C++ [over.match.oper]p16:
8431   //   For every pointer to member type T or type std::nullptr_t, there
8432   //   exist candidate operator functions of the form
8433   //
8434   //        bool operator==(T,T);
8435   //        bool operator!=(T,T);
8436   void addEqualEqualOrNotEqualMemberPointerOrNullptrOverloads() {
8437     /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled.
8438     llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes;
8439 
8440     for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, N = Args.size(); ArgIdx != N; ++ArgIdx) {
8441       for (QualType MemPtrTy : CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_types()) {
8442         // Don't add the same builtin candidate twice.
8443         if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(MemPtrTy)).second)
8444           continue;
8445 
8446         QualType ParamTypes[2] = {MemPtrTy, MemPtrTy};
8447         S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet);
8448       }
8449 
8450       if (CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].hasNullPtrType()) {
8451         CanQualType NullPtrTy = S.Context.getCanonicalType(S.Context.NullPtrTy);
8452         if (AddedTypes.insert(NullPtrTy).second) {
8453           QualType ParamTypes[2] = { NullPtrTy, NullPtrTy };
8454           S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet);
8455         }
8456       }
8457     }
8458   }
8459 
8460   // C++ [over.built]p15:
8461   //
8462   //   For every T, where T is an enumeration type or a pointer type,
8463   //   there exist candidate operator functions of the form
8464   //
8465   //        bool       operator<(T, T);
8466   //        bool       operator>(T, T);
8467   //        bool       operator<=(T, T);
8468   //        bool       operator>=(T, T);
8469   //        bool       operator==(T, T);
8470   //        bool       operator!=(T, T);
8471   //           R       operator<=>(T, T)
8472   void addGenericBinaryPointerOrEnumeralOverloads() {
8473     // C++ [over.match.oper]p3:
8474     //   [...]the built-in candidates include all of the candidate operator
8475     //   functions defined in 13.6 that, compared to the given operator, [...]
8476     //   do not have the same parameter-type-list as any non-template non-member
8477     //   candidate.
8478     //
8479     // Note that in practice, this only affects enumeration types because there
8480     // aren't any built-in candidates of record type, and a user-defined operator
8481     // must have an operand of record or enumeration type. Also, the only other
8482     // overloaded operator with enumeration arguments, operator=,
8483     // cannot be overloaded for enumeration types, so this is the only place
8484     // where we must suppress candidates like this.
8485     llvm::DenseSet<std::pair<CanQualType, CanQualType> >
8486       UserDefinedBinaryOperators;
8487 
8488     for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, N = Args.size(); ArgIdx != N; ++ArgIdx) {
8489       if (!CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_types().empty()) {
8490         for (OverloadCandidateSet::iterator C = CandidateSet.begin(),
8491                                          CEnd = CandidateSet.end();
8492              C != CEnd; ++C) {
8493           if (!C->Viable || !C->Function || C->Function->getNumParams() != 2)
8494             continue;
8495 
8496           if (C->Function->isFunctionTemplateSpecialization())
8497             continue;
8498 
8499           // We interpret "same parameter-type-list" as applying to the
8500           // "synthesized candidate, with the order of the two parameters
8501           // reversed", not to the original function.
8502           bool Reversed = C->isReversed();
8503           QualType FirstParamType = C->Function->getParamDecl(Reversed ? 1 : 0)
8504                                         ->getType()
8505                                         .getUnqualifiedType();
8506           QualType SecondParamType = C->Function->getParamDecl(Reversed ? 0 : 1)
8507                                          ->getType()
8508                                          .getUnqualifiedType();
8509 
8510           // Skip if either parameter isn't of enumeral type.
8511           if (!FirstParamType->isEnumeralType() ||
8512               !SecondParamType->isEnumeralType())
8513             continue;
8514 
8515           // Add this operator to the set of known user-defined operators.
8516           UserDefinedBinaryOperators.insert(
8517             std::make_pair(S.Context.getCanonicalType(FirstParamType),
8518                            S.Context.getCanonicalType(SecondParamType)));
8519         }
8520       }
8521     }
8522 
8523     /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled.
8524     llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes;
8525 
8526     for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, N = Args.size(); ArgIdx != N; ++ArgIdx) {
8527       for (QualType PtrTy : CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].pointer_types()) {
8528         // Don't add the same builtin candidate twice.
8529         if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(PtrTy)).second)
8530           continue;
8531 
8532         QualType ParamTypes[2] = {PtrTy, PtrTy};
8533         S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet);
8534       }
8535       for (QualType EnumTy : CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_types()) {
8536         CanQualType CanonType = S.Context.getCanonicalType(EnumTy);
8537 
8538         // Don't add the same builtin candidate twice, or if a user defined
8539         // candidate exists.
8540         if (!AddedTypes.insert(CanonType).second ||
8541             UserDefinedBinaryOperators.count(std::make_pair(CanonType,
8542                                                             CanonType)))
8543           continue;
8544         QualType ParamTypes[2] = {EnumTy, EnumTy};
8545         S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet);
8546       }
8547     }
8548   }
8549 
8550   // C++ [over.built]p13:
8551   //
8552   //   For every cv-qualified or cv-unqualified object type T
8553   //   there exist candidate operator functions of the form
8554   //
8555   //      T*         operator+(T*, ptrdiff_t);
8556   //      T&         operator[](T*, ptrdiff_t);    [BELOW]
8557   //      T*         operator-(T*, ptrdiff_t);
8558   //      T*         operator+(ptrdiff_t, T*);
8559   //      T&         operator[](ptrdiff_t, T*);    [BELOW]
8560   //
8561   // C++ [over.built]p14:
8562   //
8563   //   For every T, where T is a pointer to object type, there
8564   //   exist candidate operator functions of the form
8565   //
8566   //      ptrdiff_t  operator-(T, T);
8567   void addBinaryPlusOrMinusPointerOverloads(OverloadedOperatorKind Op) {
8568     /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled.
8569     llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes;
8570 
8571     for (int Arg = 0; Arg < 2; ++Arg) {
8572       QualType AsymmetricParamTypes[2] = {
8573         S.Context.getPointerDiffType(),
8574         S.Context.getPointerDiffType(),
8575       };
8576       for (QualType PtrTy : CandidateTypes[Arg].pointer_types()) {
8577         QualType PointeeTy = PtrTy->getPointeeType();
8578         if (!PointeeTy->isObjectType())
8579           continue;
8580 
8581         AsymmetricParamTypes[Arg] = PtrTy;
8582         if (Arg == 0 || Op == OO_Plus) {
8583           // operator+(T*, ptrdiff_t) or operator-(T*, ptrdiff_t)
8584           // T* operator+(ptrdiff_t, T*);
8585           S.AddBuiltinCandidate(AsymmetricParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet);
8586         }
8587         if (Op == OO_Minus) {
8588           // ptrdiff_t operator-(T, T);
8589           if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(PtrTy)).second)
8590             continue;
8591 
8592           QualType ParamTypes[2] = {PtrTy, PtrTy};
8593           S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet);
8594         }
8595       }
8596     }
8597   }
8598 
8599   // C++ [over.built]p12:
8600   //
8601   //   For every pair of promoted arithmetic types L and R, there
8602   //   exist candidate operator functions of the form
8603   //
8604   //        LR         operator*(L, R);
8605   //        LR         operator/(L, R);
8606   //        LR         operator+(L, R);
8607   //        LR         operator-(L, R);
8608   //        bool       operator<(L, R);
8609   //        bool       operator>(L, R);
8610   //        bool       operator<=(L, R);
8611   //        bool       operator>=(L, R);
8612   //        bool       operator==(L, R);
8613   //        bool       operator!=(L, R);
8614   //
8615   //   where LR is the result of the usual arithmetic conversions
8616   //   between types L and R.
8617   //
8618   // C++ [over.built]p24:
8619   //
8620   //   For every pair of promoted arithmetic types L and R, there exist
8621   //   candidate operator functions of the form
8622   //
8623   //        LR       operator?(bool, L, R);
8624   //
8625   //   where LR is the result of the usual arithmetic conversions
8626   //   between types L and R.
8627   // Our candidates ignore the first parameter.
8628   void addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads() {
8629     if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType)
8630       return;
8631 
8632     for (unsigned Left = FirstPromotedArithmeticType;
8633          Left < LastPromotedArithmeticType; ++Left) {
8634       for (unsigned Right = FirstPromotedArithmeticType;
8635            Right < LastPromotedArithmeticType; ++Right) {
8636         QualType LandR[2] = { ArithmeticTypes[Left],
8637                               ArithmeticTypes[Right] };
8638         S.AddBuiltinCandidate(LandR, Args, CandidateSet);
8639       }
8640     }
8641 
8642     // Extension: Add the binary operators ==, !=, <, <=, >=, >, *, /, and the
8643     // conditional operator for vector types.
8644     for (QualType Vec1Ty : CandidateTypes[0].vector_types())
8645       for (QualType Vec2Ty : CandidateTypes[1].vector_types()) {
8646         QualType LandR[2] = {Vec1Ty, Vec2Ty};
8647         S.AddBuiltinCandidate(LandR, Args, CandidateSet);
8648       }
8649   }
8650 
8651   /// Add binary operator overloads for each candidate matrix type M1, M2:
8652   ///  * (M1, M1) -> M1
8653   ///  * (M1, M1.getElementType()) -> M1
8654   ///  * (M2.getElementType(), M2) -> M2
8655   ///  * (M2, M2) -> M2 // Only if M2 is not part of CandidateTypes[0].
8656   void addMatrixBinaryArithmeticOverloads() {
8657     if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType)
8658       return;
8659 
8660     for (QualType M1 : CandidateTypes[0].matrix_types()) {
8661       AddCandidate(M1, cast<MatrixType>(M1)->getElementType());
8662       AddCandidate(M1, M1);
8663     }
8664 
8665     for (QualType M2 : CandidateTypes[1].matrix_types()) {
8666       AddCandidate(cast<MatrixType>(M2)->getElementType(), M2);
8667       if (!CandidateTypes[0].containsMatrixType(M2))
8668         AddCandidate(M2, M2);
8669     }
8670   }
8671 
8672   // C++2a [over.built]p14:
8673   //
8674   //   For every integral type T there exists a candidate operator function
8675   //   of the form
8676   //
8677   //        std::strong_ordering operator<=>(T, T)
8678   //
8679   // C++2a [over.built]p15:
8680   //
8681   //   For every pair of floating-point types L and R, there exists a candidate
8682   //   operator function of the form
8683   //
8684   //       std::partial_ordering operator<=>(L, R);
8685   //
8686   // FIXME: The current specification for integral types doesn't play nice with
8687   // the direction of p0946r0, which allows mixed integral and unscoped-enum
8688   // comparisons. Under the current spec this can lead to ambiguity during
8689   // overload resolution. For example:
8690   //
8691   //   enum A : int {a};
8692   //   auto x = (a <=> (long)42);
8693   //
8694   //   error: call is ambiguous for arguments 'A' and 'long'.
8695   //   note: candidate operator<=>(int, int)
8696   //   note: candidate operator<=>(long, long)
8697   //
8698   // To avoid this error, this function deviates from the specification and adds
8699   // the mixed overloads `operator<=>(L, R)` where L and R are promoted
8700   // arithmetic types (the same as the generic relational overloads).
8701   //
8702   // For now this function acts as a placeholder.
8703   void addThreeWayArithmeticOverloads() {
8704     addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads();
8705   }
8706 
8707   // C++ [over.built]p17:
8708   //
8709   //   For every pair of promoted integral types L and R, there
8710   //   exist candidate operator functions of the form
8711   //
8712   //      LR         operator%(L, R);
8713   //      LR         operator&(L, R);
8714   //      LR         operator^(L, R);
8715   //      LR         operator|(L, R);
8716   //      L          operator<<(L, R);
8717   //      L          operator>>(L, R);
8718   //
8719   //   where LR is the result of the usual arithmetic conversions
8720   //   between types L and R.
8721   void addBinaryBitwiseArithmeticOverloads(OverloadedOperatorKind Op) {
8722     if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType)
8723       return;
8724 
8725     for (unsigned Left = FirstPromotedIntegralType;
8726          Left < LastPromotedIntegralType; ++Left) {
8727       for (unsigned Right = FirstPromotedIntegralType;
8728            Right < LastPromotedIntegralType; ++Right) {
8729         QualType LandR[2] = { ArithmeticTypes[Left],
8730                               ArithmeticTypes[Right] };
8731         S.AddBuiltinCandidate(LandR, Args, CandidateSet);
8732       }
8733     }
8734   }
8735 
8736   // C++ [over.built]p20:
8737   //
8738   //   For every pair (T, VQ), where T is an enumeration or
8739   //   pointer to member type and VQ is either volatile or
8740   //   empty, there exist candidate operator functions of the form
8741   //
8742   //        VQ T&      operator=(VQ T&, T);
8743   void addAssignmentMemberPointerOrEnumeralOverloads() {
8744     /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled.
8745     llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes;
8746 
8747     for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < 2; ++ArgIdx) {
8748       for (QualType EnumTy : CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_types()) {
8749         if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(EnumTy)).second)
8750           continue;
8751 
8752         AddBuiltinAssignmentOperatorCandidates(S, EnumTy, Args, CandidateSet);
8753       }
8754 
8755       for (QualType MemPtrTy : CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_types()) {
8756         if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(MemPtrTy)).second)
8757           continue;
8758 
8759         AddBuiltinAssignmentOperatorCandidates(S, MemPtrTy, Args, CandidateSet);
8760       }
8761     }
8762   }
8763 
8764   // C++ [over.built]p19:
8765   //
8766   //   For every pair (T, VQ), where T is any type and VQ is either
8767   //   volatile or empty, there exist candidate operator functions
8768   //   of the form
8769   //
8770   //        T*VQ&      operator=(T*VQ&, T*);
8771   //
8772   // C++ [over.built]p21:
8773   //
8774   //   For every pair (T, VQ), where T is a cv-qualified or
8775   //   cv-unqualified object type and VQ is either volatile or
8776   //   empty, there exist candidate operator functions of the form
8777   //
8778   //        T*VQ&      operator+=(T*VQ&, ptrdiff_t);
8779   //        T*VQ&      operator-=(T*VQ&, ptrdiff_t);
8780   void addAssignmentPointerOverloads(bool isEqualOp) {
8781     /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled.
8782     llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes;
8783 
8784     for (QualType PtrTy : CandidateTypes[0].pointer_types()) {
8785       // If this is operator=, keep track of the builtin candidates we added.
8786       if (isEqualOp)
8787         AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(PtrTy));
8788       else if (!PtrTy->getPointeeType()->isObjectType())
8789         continue;
8790 
8791       // non-volatile version
8792       QualType ParamTypes[2] = {
8793           S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(PtrTy),
8794           isEqualOp ? PtrTy : S.Context.getPointerDiffType(),
8795       };
8796       S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet,
8797                             /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/ isEqualOp);
8798 
8799       bool NeedVolatile = !PtrTy.isVolatileQualified() &&
8800                           VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile();
8801       if (NeedVolatile) {
8802         // volatile version
8803         ParamTypes[0] =
8804             S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(S.Context.getVolatileType(PtrTy));
8805         S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet,
8806                               /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/isEqualOp);
8807       }
8808 
8809       if (!PtrTy.isRestrictQualified() &&
8810           VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasRestrict()) {
8811         // restrict version
8812         ParamTypes[0] =
8813             S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(S.Context.getRestrictType(PtrTy));
8814         S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet,
8815                               /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/isEqualOp);
8816 
8817         if (NeedVolatile) {
8818           // volatile restrict version
8819           ParamTypes[0] =
8820               S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(S.Context.getCVRQualifiedType(
8821                   PtrTy, (Qualifiers::Volatile | Qualifiers::Restrict)));
8822           S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet,
8823                                 /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/isEqualOp);
8824         }
8825       }
8826     }
8827 
8828     if (isEqualOp) {
8829       for (QualType PtrTy : CandidateTypes[1].pointer_types()) {
8830         // Make sure we don't add the same candidate twice.
8831         if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(PtrTy)).second)
8832           continue;
8833 
8834         QualType ParamTypes[2] = {
8835             S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(PtrTy),
8836             PtrTy,
8837         };
8838 
8839         // non-volatile version
8840         S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet,
8841                               /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/true);
8842 
8843         bool NeedVolatile = !PtrTy.isVolatileQualified() &&
8844                             VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile();
8845         if (NeedVolatile) {
8846           // volatile version
8847           ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(
8848               S.Context.getVolatileType(PtrTy));
8849           S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet,
8850                                 /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/true);
8851         }
8852 
8853         if (!PtrTy.isRestrictQualified() &&
8854             VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasRestrict()) {
8855           // restrict version
8856           ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(
8857               S.Context.getRestrictType(PtrTy));
8858           S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet,
8859                                 /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/true);
8860 
8861           if (NeedVolatile) {
8862             // volatile restrict version
8863             ParamTypes[0] =
8864                 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(S.Context.getCVRQualifiedType(
8865                     PtrTy, (Qualifiers::Volatile | Qualifiers::Restrict)));
8866             S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet,
8867                                   /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/true);
8868           }
8869         }
8870       }
8871     }
8872   }
8873 
8874   // C++ [over.built]p18:
8875   //
8876   //   For every triple (L, VQ, R), where L is an arithmetic type,
8877   //   VQ is either volatile or empty, and R is a promoted
8878   //   arithmetic type, there exist candidate operator functions of
8879   //   the form
8880   //
8881   //        VQ L&      operator=(VQ L&, R);
8882   //        VQ L&      operator*=(VQ L&, R);
8883   //        VQ L&      operator/=(VQ L&, R);
8884   //        VQ L&      operator+=(VQ L&, R);
8885   //        VQ L&      operator-=(VQ L&, R);
8886   void addAssignmentArithmeticOverloads(bool isEqualOp) {
8887     if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType)
8888       return;
8889 
8890     for (unsigned Left = 0; Left < NumArithmeticTypes; ++Left) {
8891       for (unsigned Right = FirstPromotedArithmeticType;
8892            Right < LastPromotedArithmeticType; ++Right) {
8893         QualType ParamTypes[2];
8894         ParamTypes[1] = ArithmeticTypes[Right];
8895         auto LeftBaseTy = AdjustAddressSpaceForBuiltinOperandType(
8896             S, ArithmeticTypes[Left], Args[0]);
8897         // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is empty).
8898         ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(LeftBaseTy);
8899         S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet,
8900                               /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/isEqualOp);
8901 
8902         // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is 'volatile').
8903         if (VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile()) {
8904           ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getVolatileType(LeftBaseTy);
8905           ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(ParamTypes[0]);
8906           S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet,
8907                                 /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/isEqualOp);
8908         }
8909       }
8910     }
8911 
8912     // Extension: Add the binary operators =, +=, -=, *=, /= for vector types.
8913     for (QualType Vec1Ty : CandidateTypes[0].vector_types())
8914       for (QualType Vec2Ty : CandidateTypes[0].vector_types()) {
8915         QualType ParamTypes[2];
8916         ParamTypes[1] = Vec2Ty;
8917         // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is empty).
8918         ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(Vec1Ty);
8919         S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet,
8920                               /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/isEqualOp);
8921 
8922         // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is 'volatile').
8923         if (VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile()) {
8924           ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getVolatileType(Vec1Ty);
8925           ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(ParamTypes[0]);
8926           S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet,
8927                                 /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/isEqualOp);
8928         }
8929       }
8930   }
8931 
8932   // C++ [over.built]p22:
8933   //
8934   //   For every triple (L, VQ, R), where L is an integral type, VQ
8935   //   is either volatile or empty, and R is a promoted integral
8936   //   type, there exist candidate operator functions of the form
8937   //
8938   //        VQ L&       operator%=(VQ L&, R);
8939   //        VQ L&       operator<<=(VQ L&, R);
8940   //        VQ L&       operator>>=(VQ L&, R);
8941   //        VQ L&       operator&=(VQ L&, R);
8942   //        VQ L&       operator^=(VQ L&, R);
8943   //        VQ L&       operator|=(VQ L&, R);
8944   void addAssignmentIntegralOverloads() {
8945     if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType)
8946       return;
8947 
8948     for (unsigned Left = FirstIntegralType; Left < LastIntegralType; ++Left) {
8949       for (unsigned Right = FirstPromotedIntegralType;
8950            Right < LastPromotedIntegralType; ++Right) {
8951         QualType ParamTypes[2];
8952         ParamTypes[1] = ArithmeticTypes[Right];
8953         auto LeftBaseTy = AdjustAddressSpaceForBuiltinOperandType(
8954             S, ArithmeticTypes[Left], Args[0]);
8955         // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is empty).
8956         ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(LeftBaseTy);
8957         S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet);
8958         if (VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile()) {
8959           // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is 'volatile').
8960           ParamTypes[0] = LeftBaseTy;
8961           ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getVolatileType(ParamTypes[0]);
8962           ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(ParamTypes[0]);
8963           S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet);
8964         }
8965       }
8966     }
8967   }
8968 
8969   // C++ [over.operator]p23:
8970   //
8971   //   There also exist candidate operator functions of the form
8972   //
8973   //        bool        operator!(bool);
8974   //        bool        operator&&(bool, bool);
8975   //        bool        operator||(bool, bool);
8976   void addExclaimOverload() {
8977     QualType ParamTy = S.Context.BoolTy;
8978     S.AddBuiltinCandidate(&ParamTy, Args, CandidateSet,
8979                           /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/false,
8980                           /*NumContextualBoolArguments=*/1);
8981   }
8982   void addAmpAmpOrPipePipeOverload() {
8983     QualType ParamTypes[2] = { S.Context.BoolTy, S.Context.BoolTy };
8984     S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet,
8985                           /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/false,
8986                           /*NumContextualBoolArguments=*/2);
8987   }
8988 
8989   // C++ [over.built]p13:
8990   //
8991   //   For every cv-qualified or cv-unqualified object type T there
8992   //   exist candidate operator functions of the form
8993   //
8994   //        T*         operator+(T*, ptrdiff_t);     [ABOVE]
8995   //        T&         operator[](T*, ptrdiff_t);
8996   //        T*         operator-(T*, ptrdiff_t);     [ABOVE]
8997   //        T*         operator+(ptrdiff_t, T*);     [ABOVE]
8998   //        T&         operator[](ptrdiff_t, T*);
8999   void addSubscriptOverloads() {
9000     for (QualType PtrTy : CandidateTypes[0].pointer_types()) {
9001       QualType ParamTypes[2] = {PtrTy, S.Context.getPointerDiffType()};
9002       QualType PointeeType = PtrTy->getPointeeType();
9003       if (!PointeeType->isObjectType())
9004         continue;
9005 
9006       // T& operator[](T*, ptrdiff_t)
9007       S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet);
9008     }
9009 
9010     for (QualType PtrTy : CandidateTypes[1].pointer_types()) {
9011       QualType ParamTypes[2] = {S.Context.getPointerDiffType(), PtrTy};
9012       QualType PointeeType = PtrTy->getPointeeType();
9013       if (!PointeeType->isObjectType())
9014         continue;
9015 
9016       // T& operator[](ptrdiff_t, T*)
9017       S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet);
9018     }
9019   }
9020 
9021   // C++ [over.built]p11:
9022   //    For every quintuple (C1, C2, T, CV1, CV2), where C2 is a class type,
9023   //    C1 is the same type as C2 or is a derived class of C2, T is an object
9024   //    type or a function type, and CV1 and CV2 are cv-qualifier-seqs,
9025   //    there exist candidate operator functions of the form
9026   //
9027   //      CV12 T& operator->*(CV1 C1*, CV2 T C2::*);
9028   //
9029   //    where CV12 is the union of CV1 and CV2.
9030   void addArrowStarOverloads() {
9031     for (QualType PtrTy : CandidateTypes[0].pointer_types()) {
9032       QualType C1Ty = PtrTy;
9033       QualType C1;
9034       QualifierCollector Q1;
9035       C1 = QualType(Q1.strip(C1Ty->getPointeeType()), 0);
9036       if (!isa<RecordType>(C1))
9037         continue;
9038       // heuristic to reduce number of builtin candidates in the set.
9039       // Add volatile/restrict version only if there are conversions to a
9040       // volatile/restrict type.
9041       if (!VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile() && Q1.hasVolatile())
9042         continue;
9043       if (!VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasRestrict() && Q1.hasRestrict())
9044         continue;
9045       for (QualType MemPtrTy : CandidateTypes[1].member_pointer_types()) {
9046         const MemberPointerType *mptr = cast<MemberPointerType>(MemPtrTy);
9047         QualType C2 = QualType(mptr->getClass(), 0);
9048         C2 = C2.getUnqualifiedType();
9049         if (C1 != C2 && !S.IsDerivedFrom(CandidateSet.getLocation(), C1, C2))
9050           break;
9051         QualType ParamTypes[2] = {PtrTy, MemPtrTy};
9052         // build CV12 T&
9053         QualType T = mptr->getPointeeType();
9054         if (!VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile() &&
9055             T.isVolatileQualified())
9056           continue;
9057         if (!VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasRestrict() &&
9058             T.isRestrictQualified())
9059           continue;
9060         T = Q1.apply(S.Context, T);
9061         S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet);
9062       }
9063     }
9064   }
9065 
9066   // Note that we don't consider the first argument, since it has been
9067   // contextually converted to bool long ago. The candidates below are
9068   // therefore added as binary.
9069   //
9070   // C++ [over.built]p25:
9071   //   For every type T, where T is a pointer, pointer-to-member, or scoped
9072   //   enumeration type, there exist candidate operator functions of the form
9073   //
9074   //        T        operator?(bool, T, T);
9075   //
9076   void addConditionalOperatorOverloads() {
9077     /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled.
9078     llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes;
9079 
9080     for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < 2; ++ArgIdx) {
9081       for (QualType PtrTy : CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].pointer_types()) {
9082         if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(PtrTy)).second)
9083           continue;
9084 
9085         QualType ParamTypes[2] = {PtrTy, PtrTy};
9086         S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet);
9087       }
9088 
9089       for (QualType MemPtrTy : CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_types()) {
9090         if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(MemPtrTy)).second)
9091           continue;
9092 
9093         QualType ParamTypes[2] = {MemPtrTy, MemPtrTy};
9094         S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet);
9095       }
9096 
9097       if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11) {
9098         for (QualType EnumTy : CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_types()) {
9099           if (!EnumTy->castAs<EnumType>()->getDecl()->isScoped())
9100             continue;
9101 
9102           if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(EnumTy)).second)
9103             continue;
9104 
9105           QualType ParamTypes[2] = {EnumTy, EnumTy};
9106           S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet);
9107         }
9108       }
9109     }
9110   }
9111 };
9112 
9113 } // end anonymous namespace
9114 
9115 /// AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates - Add the appropriate built-in
9116 /// operator overloads to the candidate set (C++ [over.built]), based
9117 /// on the operator @p Op and the arguments given. For example, if the
9118 /// operator is a binary '+', this routine might add "int
9119 /// operator+(int, int)" to cover integer addition.
9120 void Sema::AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates(OverloadedOperatorKind Op,
9121                                         SourceLocation OpLoc,
9122                                         ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
9123                                         OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet) {
9124   // Find all of the types that the arguments can convert to, but only
9125   // if the operator we're looking at has built-in operator candidates
9126   // that make use of these types. Also record whether we encounter non-record
9127   // candidate types or either arithmetic or enumeral candidate types.
9128   Qualifiers VisibleTypeConversionsQuals;
9129   VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.addConst();
9130   for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, N = Args.size(); ArgIdx != N; ++ArgIdx)
9131     VisibleTypeConversionsQuals += CollectVRQualifiers(Context, Args[ArgIdx]);
9132 
9133   bool HasNonRecordCandidateType = false;
9134   bool HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType = false;
9135   SmallVector<BuiltinCandidateTypeSet, 2> CandidateTypes;
9136   for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, N = Args.size(); ArgIdx != N; ++ArgIdx) {
9137     CandidateTypes.emplace_back(*this);
9138     CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].AddTypesConvertedFrom(Args[ArgIdx]->getType(),
9139                                                  OpLoc,
9140                                                  true,
9141                                                  (Op == OO_Exclaim ||
9142                                                   Op == OO_AmpAmp ||
9143                                                   Op == OO_PipePipe),
9144                                                  VisibleTypeConversionsQuals);
9145     HasNonRecordCandidateType = HasNonRecordCandidateType ||
9146         CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].hasNonRecordTypes();
9147     HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType =
9148         HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType ||
9149         CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].hasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes();
9150   }
9151 
9152   // Exit early when no non-record types have been added to the candidate set
9153   // for any of the arguments to the operator.
9154   //
9155   // We can't exit early for !, ||, or &&, since there we have always have
9156   // 'bool' overloads.
9157   if (!HasNonRecordCandidateType &&
9158       !(Op == OO_Exclaim || Op == OO_AmpAmp || Op == OO_PipePipe))
9159     return;
9160 
9161   // Setup an object to manage the common state for building overloads.
9162   BuiltinOperatorOverloadBuilder OpBuilder(*this, Args,
9163                                            VisibleTypeConversionsQuals,
9164                                            HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType,
9165                                            CandidateTypes, CandidateSet);
9166 
9167   // Dispatch over the operation to add in only those overloads which apply.
9168   switch (Op) {
9169   case OO_None:
9170   case NUM_OVERLOADED_OPERATORS:
9171     llvm_unreachable("Expected an overloaded operator");
9172 
9173   case OO_New:
9174   case OO_Delete:
9175   case OO_Array_New:
9176   case OO_Array_Delete:
9177   case OO_Call:
9178     llvm_unreachable(
9179                     "Special operators don't use AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates");
9180 
9181   case OO_Comma:
9182   case OO_Arrow:
9183   case OO_Coawait:
9184     // C++ [over.match.oper]p3:
9185     //   -- For the operator ',', the unary operator '&', the
9186     //      operator '->', or the operator 'co_await', the
9187     //      built-in candidates set is empty.
9188     break;
9189 
9190   case OO_Plus: // '+' is either unary or binary
9191     if (Args.size() == 1)
9192       OpBuilder.addUnaryPlusPointerOverloads();
9193     LLVM_FALLTHROUGH;
9194 
9195   case OO_Minus: // '-' is either unary or binary
9196     if (Args.size() == 1) {
9197       OpBuilder.addUnaryPlusOrMinusArithmeticOverloads();
9198     } else {
9199       OpBuilder.addBinaryPlusOrMinusPointerOverloads(Op);
9200       OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads();
9201       OpBuilder.addMatrixBinaryArithmeticOverloads();
9202     }
9203     break;
9204 
9205   case OO_Star: // '*' is either unary or binary
9206     if (Args.size() == 1)
9207       OpBuilder.addUnaryStarPointerOverloads();
9208     else {
9209       OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads();
9210       OpBuilder.addMatrixBinaryArithmeticOverloads();
9211     }
9212     break;
9213 
9214   case OO_Slash:
9215     OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads();
9216     break;
9217 
9218   case OO_PlusPlus:
9219   case OO_MinusMinus:
9220     OpBuilder.addPlusPlusMinusMinusArithmeticOverloads(Op);
9221     OpBuilder.addPlusPlusMinusMinusPointerOverloads();
9222     break;
9223 
9224   case OO_EqualEqual:
9225   case OO_ExclaimEqual:
9226     OpBuilder.addEqualEqualOrNotEqualMemberPointerOrNullptrOverloads();
9227     LLVM_FALLTHROUGH;
9228 
9229   case OO_Less:
9230   case OO_Greater:
9231   case OO_LessEqual:
9232   case OO_GreaterEqual:
9233     OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryPointerOrEnumeralOverloads();
9234     OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads();
9235     break;
9236 
9237   case OO_Spaceship:
9238     OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryPointerOrEnumeralOverloads();
9239     OpBuilder.addThreeWayArithmeticOverloads();
9240     break;
9241 
9242   case OO_Percent:
9243   case OO_Caret:
9244   case OO_Pipe:
9245   case OO_LessLess:
9246   case OO_GreaterGreater:
9247     OpBuilder.addBinaryBitwiseArithmeticOverloads(Op);
9248     break;
9249 
9250   case OO_Amp: // '&' is either unary or binary
9251     if (Args.size() == 1)
9252       // C++ [over.match.oper]p3:
9253       //   -- For the operator ',', the unary operator '&', or the
9254       //      operator '->', the built-in candidates set is empty.
9255       break;
9256 
9257     OpBuilder.addBinaryBitwiseArithmeticOverloads(Op);
9258     break;
9259 
9260   case OO_Tilde:
9261     OpBuilder.addUnaryTildePromotedIntegralOverloads();
9262     break;
9263 
9264   case OO_Equal:
9265     OpBuilder.addAssignmentMemberPointerOrEnumeralOverloads();
9266     LLVM_FALLTHROUGH;
9267 
9268   case OO_PlusEqual:
9269   case OO_MinusEqual:
9270     OpBuilder.addAssignmentPointerOverloads(Op == OO_Equal);
9271     LLVM_FALLTHROUGH;
9272 
9273   case OO_StarEqual:
9274   case OO_SlashEqual:
9275     OpBuilder.addAssignmentArithmeticOverloads(Op == OO_Equal);
9276     break;
9277 
9278   case OO_PercentEqual:
9279   case OO_LessLessEqual:
9280   case OO_GreaterGreaterEqual:
9281   case OO_AmpEqual:
9282   case OO_CaretEqual:
9283   case OO_PipeEqual:
9284     OpBuilder.addAssignmentIntegralOverloads();
9285     break;
9286 
9287   case OO_Exclaim:
9288     OpBuilder.addExclaimOverload();
9289     break;
9290 
9291   case OO_AmpAmp:
9292   case OO_PipePipe:
9293     OpBuilder.addAmpAmpOrPipePipeOverload();
9294     break;
9295 
9296   case OO_Subscript:
9297     OpBuilder.addSubscriptOverloads();
9298     break;
9299 
9300   case OO_ArrowStar:
9301     OpBuilder.addArrowStarOverloads();
9302     break;
9303 
9304   case OO_Conditional:
9305     OpBuilder.addConditionalOperatorOverloads();
9306     OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads();
9307     break;
9308   }
9309 }
9310 
9311 /// Add function candidates found via argument-dependent lookup
9312 /// to the set of overloading candidates.
9313 ///
9314 /// This routine performs argument-dependent name lookup based on the
9315 /// given function name (which may also be an operator name) and adds
9316 /// all of the overload candidates found by ADL to the overload
9317 /// candidate set (C++ [basic.lookup.argdep]).
9318 void
9319 Sema::AddArgumentDependentLookupCandidates(DeclarationName Name,
9320                                            SourceLocation Loc,
9321                                            ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
9322                                  TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs,
9323                                            OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
9324                                            bool PartialOverloading) {
9325   ADLResult Fns;
9326 
9327   // FIXME: This approach for uniquing ADL results (and removing
9328   // redundant candidates from the set) relies on pointer-equality,
9329   // which means we need to key off the canonical decl.  However,
9330   // always going back to the canonical decl might not get us the
9331   // right set of default arguments.  What default arguments are
9332   // we supposed to consider on ADL candidates, anyway?
9333 
9334   // FIXME: Pass in the explicit template arguments?
9335   ArgumentDependentLookup(Name, Loc, Args, Fns);
9336 
9337   // Erase all of the candidates we already knew about.
9338   for (OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Cand = CandidateSet.begin(),
9339                                    CandEnd = CandidateSet.end();
9340        Cand != CandEnd; ++Cand)
9341     if (Cand->Function) {
9342       Fns.erase(Cand->Function);
9343       if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FunTmpl = Cand->Function->getPrimaryTemplate())
9344         Fns.erase(FunTmpl);
9345     }
9346 
9347   // For each of the ADL candidates we found, add it to the overload
9348   // set.
9349   for (ADLResult::iterator I = Fns.begin(), E = Fns.end(); I != E; ++I) {
9350     DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = DeclAccessPair::make(*I, AS_none);
9351 
9352     if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(*I)) {
9353       if (ExplicitTemplateArgs)
9354         continue;
9355 
9356       AddOverloadCandidate(
9357           FD, FoundDecl, Args, CandidateSet, /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false,
9358           PartialOverloading, /*AllowExplicit=*/true,
9359           /*AllowExplicitConversions=*/false, ADLCallKind::UsesADL);
9360       if (CandidateSet.getRewriteInfo().shouldAddReversed(Context, FD)) {
9361         AddOverloadCandidate(
9362             FD, FoundDecl, {Args[1], Args[0]}, CandidateSet,
9363             /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false, PartialOverloading,
9364             /*AllowExplicit=*/true, /*AllowExplicitConversions=*/false,
9365             ADLCallKind::UsesADL, None, OverloadCandidateParamOrder::Reversed);
9366       }
9367     } else {
9368       auto *FTD = cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(*I);
9369       AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(
9370           FTD, FoundDecl, ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args, CandidateSet,
9371           /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false, PartialOverloading,
9372           /*AllowExplicit=*/true, ADLCallKind::UsesADL);
9373       if (CandidateSet.getRewriteInfo().shouldAddReversed(
9374               Context, FTD->getTemplatedDecl())) {
9375         AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(
9376             FTD, FoundDecl, ExplicitTemplateArgs, {Args[1], Args[0]},
9377             CandidateSet, /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false, PartialOverloading,
9378             /*AllowExplicit=*/true, ADLCallKind::UsesADL,
9379             OverloadCandidateParamOrder::Reversed);
9380       }
9381     }
9382   }
9383 }
9384 
9385 namespace {
9386 enum class Comparison { Equal, Better, Worse };
9387 }
9388 
9389 /// Compares the enable_if attributes of two FunctionDecls, for the purposes of
9390 /// overload resolution.
9391 ///
9392 /// Cand1's set of enable_if attributes are said to be "better" than Cand2's iff
9393 /// Cand1's first N enable_if attributes have precisely the same conditions as
9394 /// Cand2's first N enable_if attributes (where N = the number of enable_if
9395 /// attributes on Cand2), and Cand1 has more than N enable_if attributes.
9396 ///
9397 /// Note that you can have a pair of candidates such that Cand1's enable_if
9398 /// attributes are worse than Cand2's, and Cand2's enable_if attributes are
9399 /// worse than Cand1's.
9400 static Comparison compareEnableIfAttrs(const Sema &S, const FunctionDecl *Cand1,
9401                                        const FunctionDecl *Cand2) {
9402   // Common case: One (or both) decls don't have enable_if attrs.
9403   bool Cand1Attr = Cand1->hasAttr<EnableIfAttr>();
9404   bool Cand2Attr = Cand2->hasAttr<EnableIfAttr>();
9405   if (!Cand1Attr || !Cand2Attr) {
9406     if (Cand1Attr == Cand2Attr)
9407       return Comparison::Equal;
9408     return Cand1Attr ? Comparison::Better : Comparison::Worse;
9409   }
9410 
9411   auto Cand1Attrs = Cand1->specific_attrs<EnableIfAttr>();
9412   auto Cand2Attrs = Cand2->specific_attrs<EnableIfAttr>();
9413 
9414   llvm::FoldingSetNodeID Cand1ID, Cand2ID;
9415   for (auto Pair : zip_longest(Cand1Attrs, Cand2Attrs)) {
9416     Optional<EnableIfAttr *> Cand1A = std::get<0>(Pair);
9417     Optional<EnableIfAttr *> Cand2A = std::get<1>(Pair);
9418 
9419     // It's impossible for Cand1 to be better than (or equal to) Cand2 if Cand1
9420     // has fewer enable_if attributes than Cand2, and vice versa.
9421     if (!Cand1A)
9422       return Comparison::Worse;
9423     if (!Cand2A)
9424       return Comparison::Better;
9425 
9426     Cand1ID.clear();
9427     Cand2ID.clear();
9428 
9429     (*Cand1A)->getCond()->Profile(Cand1ID, S.getASTContext(), true);
9430     (*Cand2A)->getCond()->Profile(Cand2ID, S.getASTContext(), true);
9431     if (Cand1ID != Cand2ID)
9432       return Comparison::Worse;
9433   }
9434 
9435   return Comparison::Equal;
9436 }
9437 
9438 static Comparison
9439 isBetterMultiversionCandidate(const OverloadCandidate &Cand1,
9440                               const OverloadCandidate &Cand2) {
9441   if (!Cand1.Function || !Cand1.Function->isMultiVersion() || !Cand2.Function ||
9442       !Cand2.Function->isMultiVersion())
9443     return Comparison::Equal;
9444 
9445   // If both are invalid, they are equal. If one of them is invalid, the other
9446   // is better.
9447   if (Cand1.Function->isInvalidDecl()) {
9448     if (Cand2.Function->isInvalidDecl())
9449       return Comparison::Equal;
9450     return Comparison::Worse;
9451   }
9452   if (Cand2.Function->isInvalidDecl())
9453     return Comparison::Better;
9454 
9455   // If this is a cpu_dispatch/cpu_specific multiversion situation, prefer
9456   // cpu_dispatch, else arbitrarily based on the identifiers.
9457   bool Cand1CPUDisp = Cand1.Function->hasAttr<CPUDispatchAttr>();
9458   bool Cand2CPUDisp = Cand2.Function->hasAttr<CPUDispatchAttr>();
9459   const auto *Cand1CPUSpec = Cand1.Function->getAttr<CPUSpecificAttr>();
9460   const auto *Cand2CPUSpec = Cand2.Function->getAttr<CPUSpecificAttr>();
9461 
9462   if (!Cand1CPUDisp && !Cand2CPUDisp && !Cand1CPUSpec && !Cand2CPUSpec)
9463     return Comparison::Equal;
9464 
9465   if (Cand1CPUDisp && !Cand2CPUDisp)
9466     return Comparison::Better;
9467   if (Cand2CPUDisp && !Cand1CPUDisp)
9468     return Comparison::Worse;
9469 
9470   if (Cand1CPUSpec && Cand2CPUSpec) {
9471     if (Cand1CPUSpec->cpus_size() != Cand2CPUSpec->cpus_size())
9472       return Cand1CPUSpec->cpus_size() < Cand2CPUSpec->cpus_size()
9473                  ? Comparison::Better
9474                  : Comparison::Worse;
9475 
9476     std::pair<CPUSpecificAttr::cpus_iterator, CPUSpecificAttr::cpus_iterator>
9477         FirstDiff = std::mismatch(
9478             Cand1CPUSpec->cpus_begin(), Cand1CPUSpec->cpus_end(),
9479             Cand2CPUSpec->cpus_begin(),
9480             [](const IdentifierInfo *LHS, const IdentifierInfo *RHS) {
9481               return LHS->getName() == RHS->getName();
9482             });
9483 
9484     assert(FirstDiff.first != Cand1CPUSpec->cpus_end() &&
9485            "Two different cpu-specific versions should not have the same "
9486            "identifier list, otherwise they'd be the same decl!");
9487     return (*FirstDiff.first)->getName() < (*FirstDiff.second)->getName()
9488                ? Comparison::Better
9489                : Comparison::Worse;
9490   }
9491   llvm_unreachable("No way to get here unless both had cpu_dispatch");
9492 }
9493 
9494 /// Compute the type of the implicit object parameter for the given function,
9495 /// if any. Returns None if there is no implicit object parameter, and a null
9496 /// QualType if there is a 'matches anything' implicit object parameter.
9497 static Optional<QualType> getImplicitObjectParamType(ASTContext &Context,
9498                                                      const FunctionDecl *F) {
9499   if (!isa<CXXMethodDecl>(F) || isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(F))
9500     return llvm::None;
9501 
9502   auto *M = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(F);
9503   // Static member functions' object parameters match all types.
9504   if (M->isStatic())
9505     return QualType();
9506 
9507   QualType T = M->getThisObjectType();
9508   if (M->getRefQualifier() == RQ_RValue)
9509     return Context.getRValueReferenceType(T);
9510   return Context.getLValueReferenceType(T);
9511 }
9512 
9513 static bool haveSameParameterTypes(ASTContext &Context, const FunctionDecl *F1,
9514                                    const FunctionDecl *F2, unsigned NumParams) {
9515   if (declaresSameEntity(F1, F2))
9516     return true;
9517 
9518   auto NextParam = [&](const FunctionDecl *F, unsigned &I, bool First) {
9519     if (First) {
9520       if (Optional<QualType> T = getImplicitObjectParamType(Context, F))
9521         return *T;
9522     }
9523     assert(I < F->getNumParams());
9524     return F->getParamDecl(I++)->getType();
9525   };
9526 
9527   unsigned I1 = 0, I2 = 0;
9528   for (unsigned I = 0; I != NumParams; ++I) {
9529     QualType T1 = NextParam(F1, I1, I == 0);
9530     QualType T2 = NextParam(F2, I2, I == 0);
9531     if (!T1.isNull() && !T1.isNull() && !Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(T1, T2))
9532       return false;
9533   }
9534   return true;
9535 }
9536 
9537 /// isBetterOverloadCandidate - Determines whether the first overload
9538 /// candidate is a better candidate than the second (C++ 13.3.3p1).
9539 bool clang::isBetterOverloadCandidate(
9540     Sema &S, const OverloadCandidate &Cand1, const OverloadCandidate &Cand2,
9541     SourceLocation Loc, OverloadCandidateSet::CandidateSetKind Kind) {
9542   // Define viable functions to be better candidates than non-viable
9543   // functions.
9544   if (!Cand2.Viable)
9545     return Cand1.Viable;
9546   else if (!Cand1.Viable)
9547     return false;
9548 
9549   // [CUDA] A function with 'never' preference is marked not viable, therefore
9550   // is never shown up here. The worst preference shown up here is 'wrong side',
9551   // e.g. an H function called by a HD function in device compilation. This is
9552   // valid AST as long as the HD function is not emitted, e.g. it is an inline
9553   // function which is called only by an H function. A deferred diagnostic will
9554   // be triggered if it is emitted. However a wrong-sided function is still
9555   // a viable candidate here.
9556   //
9557   // If Cand1 can be emitted and Cand2 cannot be emitted in the current
9558   // context, Cand1 is better than Cand2. If Cand1 can not be emitted and Cand2
9559   // can be emitted, Cand1 is not better than Cand2. This rule should have
9560   // precedence over other rules.
9561   //
9562   // If both Cand1 and Cand2 can be emitted, or neither can be emitted, then
9563   // other rules should be used to determine which is better. This is because
9564   // host/device based overloading resolution is mostly for determining
9565   // viability of a function. If two functions are both viable, other factors
9566   // should take precedence in preference, e.g. the standard-defined preferences
9567   // like argument conversion ranks or enable_if partial-ordering. The
9568   // preference for pass-object-size parameters is probably most similar to a
9569   // type-based-overloading decision and so should take priority.
9570   //
9571   // If other rules cannot determine which is better, CUDA preference will be
9572   // used again to determine which is better.
9573   //
9574   // TODO: Currently IdentifyCUDAPreference does not return correct values
9575   // for functions called in global variable initializers due to missing
9576   // correct context about device/host. Therefore we can only enforce this
9577   // rule when there is a caller. We should enforce this rule for functions
9578   // in global variable initializers once proper context is added.
9579   //
9580   // TODO: We can only enable the hostness based overloading resolution when
9581   // -fgpu-exclude-wrong-side-overloads is on since this requires deferring
9582   // overloading resolution diagnostics.
9583   if (S.getLangOpts().CUDA && Cand1.Function && Cand2.Function &&
9584       S.getLangOpts().GPUExcludeWrongSideOverloads) {
9585     if (FunctionDecl *Caller = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(S.CurContext)) {
9586       bool IsCallerImplicitHD = Sema::isCUDAImplicitHostDeviceFunction(Caller);
9587       bool IsCand1ImplicitHD =
9588           Sema::isCUDAImplicitHostDeviceFunction(Cand1.Function);
9589       bool IsCand2ImplicitHD =
9590           Sema::isCUDAImplicitHostDeviceFunction(Cand2.Function);
9591       auto P1 = S.IdentifyCUDAPreference(Caller, Cand1.Function);
9592       auto P2 = S.IdentifyCUDAPreference(Caller, Cand2.Function);
9593       assert(P1 != Sema::CFP_Never && P2 != Sema::CFP_Never);
9594       // The implicit HD function may be a function in a system header which
9595       // is forced by pragma. In device compilation, if we prefer HD candidates
9596       // over wrong-sided candidates, overloading resolution may change, which
9597       // may result in non-deferrable diagnostics. As a workaround, we let
9598       // implicit HD candidates take equal preference as wrong-sided candidates.
9599       // This will preserve the overloading resolution.
9600       // TODO: We still need special handling of implicit HD functions since
9601       // they may incur other diagnostics to be deferred. We should make all
9602       // host/device related diagnostics deferrable and remove special handling
9603       // of implicit HD functions.
9604       auto EmitThreshold =
9605           (S.getLangOpts().CUDAIsDevice && IsCallerImplicitHD &&
9606            (IsCand1ImplicitHD || IsCand2ImplicitHD))
9607               ? Sema::CFP_Never
9608               : Sema::CFP_WrongSide;
9609       auto Cand1Emittable = P1 > EmitThreshold;
9610       auto Cand2Emittable = P2 > EmitThreshold;
9611       if (Cand1Emittable && !Cand2Emittable)
9612         return true;
9613       if (!Cand1Emittable && Cand2Emittable)
9614         return false;
9615     }
9616   }
9617 
9618   // C++ [over.match.best]p1:
9619   //
9620   //   -- if F is a static member function, ICS1(F) is defined such
9621   //      that ICS1(F) is neither better nor worse than ICS1(G) for
9622   //      any function G, and, symmetrically, ICS1(G) is neither
9623   //      better nor worse than ICS1(F).
9624   unsigned StartArg = 0;
9625   if (Cand1.IgnoreObjectArgument || Cand2.IgnoreObjectArgument)
9626     StartArg = 1;
9627 
9628   auto IsIllFormedConversion = [&](const ImplicitConversionSequence &ICS) {
9629     // We don't allow incompatible pointer conversions in C++.
9630     if (!S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
9631       return ICS.isStandard() &&
9632              ICS.Standard.Second == ICK_Incompatible_Pointer_Conversion;
9633 
9634     // The only ill-formed conversion we allow in C++ is the string literal to
9635     // char* conversion, which is only considered ill-formed after C++11.
9636     return S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 && !S.getLangOpts().WritableStrings &&
9637            hasDeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtrConversion(ICS);
9638   };
9639 
9640   // Define functions that don't require ill-formed conversions for a given
9641   // argument to be better candidates than functions that do.
9642   unsigned NumArgs = Cand1.Conversions.size();
9643   assert(Cand2.Conversions.size() == NumArgs && "Overload candidate mismatch");
9644   bool HasBetterConversion = false;
9645   for (unsigned ArgIdx = StartArg; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
9646     bool Cand1Bad = IsIllFormedConversion(Cand1.Conversions[ArgIdx]);
9647     bool Cand2Bad = IsIllFormedConversion(Cand2.Conversions[ArgIdx]);
9648     if (Cand1Bad != Cand2Bad) {
9649       if (Cand1Bad)
9650         return false;
9651       HasBetterConversion = true;
9652     }
9653   }
9654 
9655   if (HasBetterConversion)
9656     return true;
9657 
9658   // C++ [over.match.best]p1:
9659   //   A viable function F1 is defined to be a better function than another
9660   //   viable function F2 if for all arguments i, ICSi(F1) is not a worse
9661   //   conversion sequence than ICSi(F2), and then...
9662   bool HasWorseConversion = false;
9663   for (unsigned ArgIdx = StartArg; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
9664     switch (CompareImplicitConversionSequences(S, Loc,
9665                                                Cand1.Conversions[ArgIdx],
9666                                                Cand2.Conversions[ArgIdx])) {
9667     case ImplicitConversionSequence::Better:
9668       // Cand1 has a better conversion sequence.
9669       HasBetterConversion = true;
9670       break;
9671 
9672     case ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse:
9673       if (Cand1.Function && Cand2.Function &&
9674           Cand1.isReversed() != Cand2.isReversed() &&
9675           haveSameParameterTypes(S.Context, Cand1.Function, Cand2.Function,
9676                                  NumArgs)) {
9677         // Work around large-scale breakage caused by considering reversed
9678         // forms of operator== in C++20:
9679         //
9680         // When comparing a function against a reversed function with the same
9681         // parameter types, if we have a better conversion for one argument and
9682         // a worse conversion for the other, the implicit conversion sequences
9683         // are treated as being equally good.
9684         //
9685         // This prevents a comparison function from being considered ambiguous
9686         // with a reversed form that is written in the same way.
9687         //
9688         // We diagnose this as an extension from CreateOverloadedBinOp.
9689         HasWorseConversion = true;
9690         break;
9691       }
9692 
9693       // Cand1 can't be better than Cand2.
9694       return false;
9695 
9696     case ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable:
9697       // Do nothing.
9698       break;
9699     }
9700   }
9701 
9702   //    -- for some argument j, ICSj(F1) is a better conversion sequence than
9703   //       ICSj(F2), or, if not that,
9704   if (HasBetterConversion && !HasWorseConversion)
9705     return true;
9706 
9707   //   -- the context is an initialization by user-defined conversion
9708   //      (see 8.5, 13.3.1.5) and the standard conversion sequence
9709   //      from the return type of F1 to the destination type (i.e.,
9710   //      the type of the entity being initialized) is a better
9711   //      conversion sequence than the standard conversion sequence
9712   //      from the return type of F2 to the destination type.
9713   if (Kind == OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_InitByUserDefinedConversion &&
9714       Cand1.Function && Cand2.Function &&
9715       isa<CXXConversionDecl>(Cand1.Function) &&
9716       isa<CXXConversionDecl>(Cand2.Function)) {
9717     // First check whether we prefer one of the conversion functions over the
9718     // other. This only distinguishes the results in non-standard, extension
9719     // cases such as the conversion from a lambda closure type to a function
9720     // pointer or block.
9721     ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind Result =
9722         compareConversionFunctions(S, Cand1.Function, Cand2.Function);
9723     if (Result == ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable)
9724       Result = CompareStandardConversionSequences(S, Loc,
9725                                                   Cand1.FinalConversion,
9726                                                   Cand2.FinalConversion);
9727 
9728     if (Result != ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable)
9729       return Result == ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
9730 
9731     // FIXME: Compare kind of reference binding if conversion functions
9732     // convert to a reference type used in direct reference binding, per
9733     // C++14 [over.match.best]p1 section 2 bullet 3.
9734   }
9735 
9736   // FIXME: Work around a defect in the C++17 guaranteed copy elision wording,
9737   // as combined with the resolution to CWG issue 243.
9738   //
9739   // When the context is initialization by constructor ([over.match.ctor] or
9740   // either phase of [over.match.list]), a constructor is preferred over
9741   // a conversion function.
9742   if (Kind == OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_InitByConstructor && NumArgs == 1 &&
9743       Cand1.Function && Cand2.Function &&
9744       isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Cand1.Function) !=
9745           isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Cand2.Function))
9746     return isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Cand1.Function);
9747 
9748   //    -- F1 is a non-template function and F2 is a function template
9749   //       specialization, or, if not that,
9750   bool Cand1IsSpecialization = Cand1.Function &&
9751                                Cand1.Function->getPrimaryTemplate();
9752   bool Cand2IsSpecialization = Cand2.Function &&
9753                                Cand2.Function->getPrimaryTemplate();
9754   if (Cand1IsSpecialization != Cand2IsSpecialization)
9755     return Cand2IsSpecialization;
9756 
9757   //   -- F1 and F2 are function template specializations, and the function
9758   //      template for F1 is more specialized than the template for F2
9759   //      according to the partial ordering rules described in 14.5.5.2, or,
9760   //      if not that,
9761   if (Cand1IsSpecialization && Cand2IsSpecialization) {
9762     if (FunctionTemplateDecl *BetterTemplate = S.getMoreSpecializedTemplate(
9763             Cand1.Function->getPrimaryTemplate(),
9764             Cand2.Function->getPrimaryTemplate(), Loc,
9765             isa<CXXConversionDecl>(Cand1.Function) ? TPOC_Conversion
9766                                                    : TPOC_Call,
9767             Cand1.ExplicitCallArguments, Cand2.ExplicitCallArguments,
9768             Cand1.isReversed() ^ Cand2.isReversed()))
9769       return BetterTemplate == Cand1.Function->getPrimaryTemplate();
9770   }
9771 
9772   //   -— F1 and F2 are non-template functions with the same
9773   //      parameter-type-lists, and F1 is more constrained than F2 [...],
9774   if (Cand1.Function && Cand2.Function && !Cand1IsSpecialization &&
9775       !Cand2IsSpecialization && Cand1.Function->hasPrototype() &&
9776       Cand2.Function->hasPrototype()) {
9777     auto *PT1 = cast<FunctionProtoType>(Cand1.Function->getFunctionType());
9778     auto *PT2 = cast<FunctionProtoType>(Cand2.Function->getFunctionType());
9779     if (PT1->getNumParams() == PT2->getNumParams() &&
9780         PT1->isVariadic() == PT2->isVariadic() &&
9781         S.FunctionParamTypesAreEqual(PT1, PT2)) {
9782       Expr *RC1 = Cand1.Function->getTrailingRequiresClause();
9783       Expr *RC2 = Cand2.Function->getTrailingRequiresClause();
9784       if (RC1 && RC2) {
9785         bool AtLeastAsConstrained1, AtLeastAsConstrained2;
9786         if (S.IsAtLeastAsConstrained(Cand1.Function, {RC1}, Cand2.Function,
9787                                      {RC2}, AtLeastAsConstrained1) ||
9788             S.IsAtLeastAsConstrained(Cand2.Function, {RC2}, Cand1.Function,
9789                                      {RC1}, AtLeastAsConstrained2))
9790           return false;
9791         if (AtLeastAsConstrained1 != AtLeastAsConstrained2)
9792           return AtLeastAsConstrained1;
9793       } else if (RC1 || RC2) {
9794         return RC1 != nullptr;
9795       }
9796     }
9797   }
9798 
9799   //   -- F1 is a constructor for a class D, F2 is a constructor for a base
9800   //      class B of D, and for all arguments the corresponding parameters of
9801   //      F1 and F2 have the same type.
9802   // FIXME: Implement the "all parameters have the same type" check.
9803   bool Cand1IsInherited =
9804       dyn_cast_or_null<ConstructorUsingShadowDecl>(Cand1.FoundDecl.getDecl());
9805   bool Cand2IsInherited =
9806       dyn_cast_or_null<ConstructorUsingShadowDecl>(Cand2.FoundDecl.getDecl());
9807   if (Cand1IsInherited != Cand2IsInherited)
9808     return Cand2IsInherited;
9809   else if (Cand1IsInherited) {
9810     assert(Cand2IsInherited);
9811     auto *Cand1Class = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Cand1.Function->getDeclContext());
9812     auto *Cand2Class = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Cand2.Function->getDeclContext());
9813     if (Cand1Class->isDerivedFrom(Cand2Class))
9814       return true;
9815     if (Cand2Class->isDerivedFrom(Cand1Class))
9816       return false;
9817     // Inherited from sibling base classes: still ambiguous.
9818   }
9819 
9820   //   -- F2 is a rewritten candidate (12.4.1.2) and F1 is not
9821   //   -- F1 and F2 are rewritten candidates, and F2 is a synthesized candidate
9822   //      with reversed order of parameters and F1 is not
9823   //
9824   // We rank reversed + different operator as worse than just reversed, but
9825   // that comparison can never happen, because we only consider reversing for
9826   // the maximally-rewritten operator (== or <=>).
9827   if (Cand1.RewriteKind != Cand2.RewriteKind)
9828     return Cand1.RewriteKind < Cand2.RewriteKind;
9829 
9830   // Check C++17 tie-breakers for deduction guides.
9831   {
9832     auto *Guide1 = dyn_cast_or_null<CXXDeductionGuideDecl>(Cand1.Function);
9833     auto *Guide2 = dyn_cast_or_null<CXXDeductionGuideDecl>(Cand2.Function);
9834     if (Guide1 && Guide2) {
9835       //  -- F1 is generated from a deduction-guide and F2 is not
9836       if (Guide1->isImplicit() != Guide2->isImplicit())
9837         return Guide2->isImplicit();
9838 
9839       //  -- F1 is the copy deduction candidate(16.3.1.8) and F2 is not
9840       if (Guide1->isCopyDeductionCandidate())
9841         return true;
9842     }
9843   }
9844 
9845   // Check for enable_if value-based overload resolution.
9846   if (Cand1.Function && Cand2.Function) {
9847     Comparison Cmp = compareEnableIfAttrs(S, Cand1.Function, Cand2.Function);
9848     if (Cmp != Comparison::Equal)
9849       return Cmp == Comparison::Better;
9850   }
9851 
9852   bool HasPS1 = Cand1.Function != nullptr &&
9853                 functionHasPassObjectSizeParams(Cand1.Function);
9854   bool HasPS2 = Cand2.Function != nullptr &&
9855                 functionHasPassObjectSizeParams(Cand2.Function);
9856   if (HasPS1 != HasPS2 && HasPS1)
9857     return true;
9858 
9859   auto MV = isBetterMultiversionCandidate(Cand1, Cand2);
9860   if (MV == Comparison::Better)
9861     return true;
9862   if (MV == Comparison::Worse)
9863     return false;
9864 
9865   // If other rules cannot determine which is better, CUDA preference is used
9866   // to determine which is better.
9867   if (S.getLangOpts().CUDA && Cand1.Function && Cand2.Function) {
9868     FunctionDecl *Caller = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(S.CurContext);
9869     return S.IdentifyCUDAPreference(Caller, Cand1.Function) >
9870            S.IdentifyCUDAPreference(Caller, Cand2.Function);
9871   }
9872 
9873   return false;
9874 }
9875 
9876 /// Determine whether two declarations are "equivalent" for the purposes of
9877 /// name lookup and overload resolution. This applies when the same internal/no
9878 /// linkage entity is defined by two modules (probably by textually including
9879 /// the same header). In such a case, we don't consider the declarations to
9880 /// declare the same entity, but we also don't want lookups with both
9881 /// declarations visible to be ambiguous in some cases (this happens when using
9882 /// a modularized libstdc++).
9883 bool Sema::isEquivalentInternalLinkageDeclaration(const NamedDecl *A,
9884                                                   const NamedDecl *B) {
9885   auto *VA = dyn_cast_or_null<ValueDecl>(A);
9886   auto *VB = dyn_cast_or_null<ValueDecl>(B);
9887   if (!VA || !VB)
9888     return false;
9889 
9890   // The declarations must be declaring the same name as an internal linkage
9891   // entity in different modules.
9892   if (!VA->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext()->Equals(
9893           VB->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext()) ||
9894       getOwningModule(VA) == getOwningModule(VB) ||
9895       VA->isExternallyVisible() || VB->isExternallyVisible())
9896     return false;
9897 
9898   // Check that the declarations appear to be equivalent.
9899   //
9900   // FIXME: Checking the type isn't really enough to resolve the ambiguity.
9901   // For constants and functions, we should check the initializer or body is
9902   // the same. For non-constant variables, we shouldn't allow it at all.
9903   if (Context.hasSameType(VA->getType(), VB->getType()))
9904     return true;
9905 
9906   // Enum constants within unnamed enumerations will have different types, but
9907   // may still be similar enough to be interchangeable for our purposes.
9908   if (auto *EA = dyn_cast<EnumConstantDecl>(VA)) {
9909     if (auto *EB = dyn_cast<EnumConstantDecl>(VB)) {
9910       // Only handle anonymous enums. If the enumerations were named and
9911       // equivalent, they would have been merged to the same type.
9912       auto *EnumA = cast<EnumDecl>(EA->getDeclContext());
9913       auto *EnumB = cast<EnumDecl>(EB->getDeclContext());
9914       if (EnumA->hasNameForLinkage() || EnumB->hasNameForLinkage() ||
9915           !Context.hasSameType(EnumA->getIntegerType(),
9916                                EnumB->getIntegerType()))
9917         return false;
9918       // Allow this only if the value is the same for both enumerators.
9919       return llvm::APSInt::isSameValue(EA->getInitVal(), EB->getInitVal());
9920     }
9921   }
9922 
9923   // Nothing else is sufficiently similar.
9924   return false;
9925 }
9926 
9927 void Sema::diagnoseEquivalentInternalLinkageDeclarations(
9928     SourceLocation Loc, const NamedDecl *D, ArrayRef<const NamedDecl *> Equiv) {
9929   assert(D && "Unknown declaration");
9930   Diag(Loc, diag::ext_equivalent_internal_linkage_decl_in_modules) << D;
9931 
9932   Module *M = getOwningModule(D);
9933   Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_equivalent_internal_linkage_decl)
9934       << !M << (M ? M->getFullModuleName() : "");
9935 
9936   for (auto *E : Equiv) {
9937     Module *M = getOwningModule(E);
9938     Diag(E->getLocation(), diag::note_equivalent_internal_linkage_decl)
9939         << !M << (M ? M->getFullModuleName() : "");
9940   }
9941 }
9942 
9943 /// Computes the best viable function (C++ 13.3.3)
9944 /// within an overload candidate set.
9945 ///
9946 /// \param Loc The location of the function name (or operator symbol) for
9947 /// which overload resolution occurs.
9948 ///
9949 /// \param Best If overload resolution was successful or found a deleted
9950 /// function, \p Best points to the candidate function found.
9951 ///
9952 /// \returns The result of overload resolution.
9953 OverloadingResult
9954 OverloadCandidateSet::BestViableFunction(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc,
9955                                          iterator &Best) {
9956   llvm::SmallVector<OverloadCandidate *, 16> Candidates;
9957   std::transform(begin(), end(), std::back_inserter(Candidates),
9958                  [](OverloadCandidate &Cand) { return &Cand; });
9959 
9960   // [CUDA] HD->H or HD->D calls are technically not allowed by CUDA but
9961   // are accepted by both clang and NVCC. However, during a particular
9962   // compilation mode only one call variant is viable. We need to
9963   // exclude non-viable overload candidates from consideration based
9964   // only on their host/device attributes. Specifically, if one
9965   // candidate call is WrongSide and the other is SameSide, we ignore
9966   // the WrongSide candidate.
9967   // We only need to remove wrong-sided candidates here if
9968   // -fgpu-exclude-wrong-side-overloads is off. When
9969   // -fgpu-exclude-wrong-side-overloads is on, all candidates are compared
9970   // uniformly in isBetterOverloadCandidate.
9971   if (S.getLangOpts().CUDA && !S.getLangOpts().GPUExcludeWrongSideOverloads) {
9972     const FunctionDecl *Caller = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(S.CurContext);
9973     bool ContainsSameSideCandidate =
9974         llvm::any_of(Candidates, [&](OverloadCandidate *Cand) {
9975           // Check viable function only.
9976           return Cand->Viable && Cand->Function &&
9977                  S.IdentifyCUDAPreference(Caller, Cand->Function) ==
9978                      Sema::CFP_SameSide;
9979         });
9980     if (ContainsSameSideCandidate) {
9981       auto IsWrongSideCandidate = [&](OverloadCandidate *Cand) {
9982         // Check viable function only to avoid unnecessary data copying/moving.
9983         return Cand->Viable && Cand->Function &&
9984                S.IdentifyCUDAPreference(Caller, Cand->Function) ==
9985                    Sema::CFP_WrongSide;
9986       };
9987       llvm::erase_if(Candidates, IsWrongSideCandidate);
9988     }
9989   }
9990 
9991   // Find the best viable function.
9992   Best = end();
9993   for (auto *Cand : Candidates) {
9994     Cand->Best = false;
9995     if (Cand->Viable)
9996       if (Best == end() ||
9997           isBetterOverloadCandidate(S, *Cand, *Best, Loc, Kind))
9998         Best = Cand;
9999   }
10000 
10001   // If we didn't find any viable functions, abort.
10002   if (Best == end())
10003     return OR_No_Viable_Function;
10004 
10005   llvm::SmallVector<const NamedDecl *, 4> EquivalentCands;
10006 
10007   llvm::SmallVector<OverloadCandidate*, 4> PendingBest;
10008   PendingBest.push_back(&*Best);
10009   Best->Best = true;
10010 
10011   // Make sure that this function is better than every other viable
10012   // function. If not, we have an ambiguity.
10013   while (!PendingBest.empty()) {
10014     auto *Curr = PendingBest.pop_back_val();
10015     for (auto *Cand : Candidates) {
10016       if (Cand->Viable && !Cand->Best &&
10017           !isBetterOverloadCandidate(S, *Curr, *Cand, Loc, Kind)) {
10018         PendingBest.push_back(Cand);
10019         Cand->Best = true;
10020 
10021         if (S.isEquivalentInternalLinkageDeclaration(Cand->Function,
10022                                                      Curr->Function))
10023           EquivalentCands.push_back(Cand->Function);
10024         else
10025           Best = end();
10026       }
10027     }
10028   }
10029 
10030   // If we found more than one best candidate, this is ambiguous.
10031   if (Best == end())
10032     return OR_Ambiguous;
10033 
10034   // Best is the best viable function.
10035   if (Best->Function && Best->Function->isDeleted())
10036     return OR_Deleted;
10037 
10038   if (!EquivalentCands.empty())
10039     S.diagnoseEquivalentInternalLinkageDeclarations(Loc, Best->Function,
10040                                                     EquivalentCands);
10041 
10042   return OR_Success;
10043 }
10044 
10045 namespace {
10046 
10047 enum OverloadCandidateKind {
10048   oc_function,
10049   oc_method,
10050   oc_reversed_binary_operator,
10051   oc_constructor,
10052   oc_implicit_default_constructor,
10053   oc_implicit_copy_constructor,
10054   oc_implicit_move_constructor,
10055   oc_implicit_copy_assignment,
10056   oc_implicit_move_assignment,
10057   oc_implicit_equality_comparison,
10058   oc_inherited_constructor
10059 };
10060 
10061 enum OverloadCandidateSelect {
10062   ocs_non_template,
10063   ocs_template,
10064   ocs_described_template,
10065 };
10066 
10067 static std::pair<OverloadCandidateKind, OverloadCandidateSelect>
10068 ClassifyOverloadCandidate(Sema &S, NamedDecl *Found, FunctionDecl *Fn,
10069                           OverloadCandidateRewriteKind CRK,
10070                           std::string &Description) {
10071 
10072   bool isTemplate = Fn->isTemplateDecl() || Found->isTemplateDecl();
10073   if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FunTmpl = Fn->getPrimaryTemplate()) {
10074     isTemplate = true;
10075     Description = S.getTemplateArgumentBindingsText(
10076         FunTmpl->getTemplateParameters(), *Fn->getTemplateSpecializationArgs());
10077   }
10078 
10079   OverloadCandidateSelect Select = [&]() {
10080     if (!Description.empty())
10081       return ocs_described_template;
10082     return isTemplate ? ocs_template : ocs_non_template;
10083   }();
10084 
10085   OverloadCandidateKind Kind = [&]() {
10086     if (Fn->isImplicit() && Fn->getOverloadedOperator() == OO_EqualEqual)
10087       return oc_implicit_equality_comparison;
10088 
10089     if (CRK & CRK_Reversed)
10090       return oc_reversed_binary_operator;
10091 
10092     if (CXXConstructorDecl *Ctor = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Fn)) {
10093       if (!Ctor->isImplicit()) {
10094         if (isa<ConstructorUsingShadowDecl>(Found))
10095           return oc_inherited_constructor;
10096         else
10097           return oc_constructor;
10098       }
10099 
10100       if (Ctor->isDefaultConstructor())
10101         return oc_implicit_default_constructor;
10102 
10103       if (Ctor->isMoveConstructor())
10104         return oc_implicit_move_constructor;
10105 
10106       assert(Ctor->isCopyConstructor() &&
10107              "unexpected sort of implicit constructor");
10108       return oc_implicit_copy_constructor;
10109     }
10110 
10111     if (CXXMethodDecl *Meth = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)) {
10112       // This actually gets spelled 'candidate function' for now, but
10113       // it doesn't hurt to split it out.
10114       if (!Meth->isImplicit())
10115         return oc_method;
10116 
10117       if (Meth->isMoveAssignmentOperator())
10118         return oc_implicit_move_assignment;
10119 
10120       if (Meth->isCopyAssignmentOperator())
10121         return oc_implicit_copy_assignment;
10122 
10123       assert(isa<CXXConversionDecl>(Meth) && "expected conversion");
10124       return oc_method;
10125     }
10126 
10127     return oc_function;
10128   }();
10129 
10130   return std::make_pair(Kind, Select);
10131 }
10132 
10133 void MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(Sema &S, Decl *FoundDecl) {
10134   // FIXME: It'd be nice to only emit a note once per using-decl per overload
10135   // set.
10136   if (auto *Shadow = dyn_cast<ConstructorUsingShadowDecl>(FoundDecl))
10137     S.Diag(FoundDecl->getLocation(),
10138            diag::note_ovl_candidate_inherited_constructor)
10139       << Shadow->getNominatedBaseClass();
10140 }
10141 
10142 } // end anonymous namespace
10143 
10144 static bool isFunctionAlwaysEnabled(const ASTContext &Ctx,
10145                                     const FunctionDecl *FD) {
10146   for (auto *EnableIf : FD->specific_attrs<EnableIfAttr>()) {
10147     bool AlwaysTrue;
10148     if (EnableIf->getCond()->isValueDependent() ||
10149         !EnableIf->getCond()->EvaluateAsBooleanCondition(AlwaysTrue, Ctx))
10150       return false;
10151     if (!AlwaysTrue)
10152       return false;
10153   }
10154   return true;
10155 }
10156 
10157 /// Returns true if we can take the address of the function.
10158 ///
10159 /// \param Complain - If true, we'll emit a diagnostic
10160 /// \param InOverloadResolution - For the purposes of emitting a diagnostic, are
10161 ///   we in overload resolution?
10162 /// \param Loc - The location of the statement we're complaining about. Ignored
10163 ///   if we're not complaining, or if we're in overload resolution.
10164 static bool checkAddressOfFunctionIsAvailable(Sema &S, const FunctionDecl *FD,
10165                                               bool Complain,
10166                                               bool InOverloadResolution,
10167                                               SourceLocation Loc) {
10168   if (!isFunctionAlwaysEnabled(S.Context, FD)) {
10169     if (Complain) {
10170       if (InOverloadResolution)
10171         S.Diag(FD->getBeginLoc(),
10172                diag::note_addrof_ovl_candidate_disabled_by_enable_if_attr);
10173       else
10174         S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_addrof_function_disabled_by_enable_if_attr) << FD;
10175     }
10176     return false;
10177   }
10178 
10179   if (FD->getTrailingRequiresClause()) {
10180     ConstraintSatisfaction Satisfaction;
10181     if (S.CheckFunctionConstraints(FD, Satisfaction, Loc))
10182       return false;
10183     if (!Satisfaction.IsSatisfied) {
10184       if (Complain) {
10185         if (InOverloadResolution)
10186           S.Diag(FD->getBeginLoc(),
10187                  diag::note_ovl_candidate_unsatisfied_constraints);
10188         else
10189           S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_addrof_function_constraints_not_satisfied)
10190               << FD;
10191         S.DiagnoseUnsatisfiedConstraint(Satisfaction);
10192       }
10193       return false;
10194     }
10195   }
10196 
10197   auto I = llvm::find_if(FD->parameters(), [](const ParmVarDecl *P) {
10198     return P->hasAttr<PassObjectSizeAttr>();
10199   });
10200   if (I == FD->param_end())
10201     return true;
10202 
10203   if (Complain) {
10204     // Add one to ParamNo because it's user-facing
10205     unsigned ParamNo = std::distance(FD->param_begin(), I) + 1;
10206     if (InOverloadResolution)
10207       S.Diag(FD->getLocation(),
10208              diag::note_ovl_candidate_has_pass_object_size_params)
10209           << ParamNo;
10210     else
10211       S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_address_of_function_with_pass_object_size_params)
10212           << FD << ParamNo;
10213   }
10214   return false;
10215 }
10216 
10217 static bool checkAddressOfCandidateIsAvailable(Sema &S,
10218                                                const FunctionDecl *FD) {
10219   return checkAddressOfFunctionIsAvailable(S, FD, /*Complain=*/true,
10220                                            /*InOverloadResolution=*/true,
10221                                            /*Loc=*/SourceLocation());
10222 }
10223 
10224 bool Sema::checkAddressOfFunctionIsAvailable(const FunctionDecl *Function,
10225                                              bool Complain,
10226                                              SourceLocation Loc) {
10227   return ::checkAddressOfFunctionIsAvailable(*this, Function, Complain,
10228                                              /*InOverloadResolution=*/false,
10229                                              Loc);
10230 }
10231 
10232 // Don't print candidates other than the one that matches the calling
10233 // convention of the call operator, since that is guaranteed to exist.
10234 static bool shouldSkipNotingLambdaConversionDecl(FunctionDecl *Fn) {
10235   const auto *ConvD = dyn_cast<CXXConversionDecl>(Fn);
10236 
10237   if (!ConvD)
10238     return false;
10239   const auto *RD = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Fn->getParent());
10240   if (!RD->isLambda())
10241     return false;
10242 
10243   CXXMethodDecl *CallOp = RD->getLambdaCallOperator();
10244   CallingConv CallOpCC =
10245       CallOp->getType()->getAs<FunctionType>()->getCallConv();
10246   QualType ConvRTy = ConvD->getType()->getAs<FunctionType>()->getReturnType();
10247   CallingConv ConvToCC =
10248       ConvRTy->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionType>()->getCallConv();
10249 
10250   return ConvToCC != CallOpCC;
10251 }
10252 
10253 // Notes the location of an overload candidate.
10254 void Sema::NoteOverloadCandidate(NamedDecl *Found, FunctionDecl *Fn,
10255                                  OverloadCandidateRewriteKind RewriteKind,
10256                                  QualType DestType, bool TakingAddress) {
10257   if (TakingAddress && !checkAddressOfCandidateIsAvailable(*this, Fn))
10258     return;
10259   if (Fn->isMultiVersion() && Fn->hasAttr<TargetAttr>() &&
10260       !Fn->getAttr<TargetAttr>()->isDefaultVersion())
10261     return;
10262   if (shouldSkipNotingLambdaConversionDecl(Fn))
10263     return;
10264 
10265   std::string FnDesc;
10266   std::pair<OverloadCandidateKind, OverloadCandidateSelect> KSPair =
10267       ClassifyOverloadCandidate(*this, Found, Fn, RewriteKind, FnDesc);
10268   PartialDiagnostic PD = PDiag(diag::note_ovl_candidate)
10269                          << (unsigned)KSPair.first << (unsigned)KSPair.second
10270                          << Fn << FnDesc;
10271 
10272   HandleFunctionTypeMismatch(PD, Fn->getType(), DestType);
10273   Diag(Fn->getLocation(), PD);
10274   MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(*this, Found);
10275 }
10276 
10277 static void
10278 MaybeDiagnoseAmbiguousConstraints(Sema &S, ArrayRef<OverloadCandidate> Cands) {
10279   // Perhaps the ambiguity was caused by two atomic constraints that are
10280   // 'identical' but not equivalent:
10281   //
10282   // void foo() requires (sizeof(T) > 4) { } // #1
10283   // void foo() requires (sizeof(T) > 4) && T::value { } // #2
10284   //
10285   // The 'sizeof(T) > 4' constraints are seemingly equivalent and should cause
10286   // #2 to subsume #1, but these constraint are not considered equivalent
10287   // according to the subsumption rules because they are not the same
10288   // source-level construct. This behavior is quite confusing and we should try
10289   // to help the user figure out what happened.
10290 
10291   SmallVector<const Expr *, 3> FirstAC, SecondAC;
10292   FunctionDecl *FirstCand = nullptr, *SecondCand = nullptr;
10293   for (auto I = Cands.begin(), E = Cands.end(); I != E; ++I) {
10294     if (!I->Function)
10295       continue;
10296     SmallVector<const Expr *, 3> AC;
10297     if (auto *Template = I->Function->getPrimaryTemplate())
10298       Template->getAssociatedConstraints(AC);
10299     else
10300       I->Function->getAssociatedConstraints(AC);
10301     if (AC.empty())
10302       continue;
10303     if (FirstCand == nullptr) {
10304       FirstCand = I->Function;
10305       FirstAC = AC;
10306     } else if (SecondCand == nullptr) {
10307       SecondCand = I->Function;
10308       SecondAC = AC;
10309     } else {
10310       // We have more than one pair of constrained functions - this check is
10311       // expensive and we'd rather not try to diagnose it.
10312       return;
10313     }
10314   }
10315   if (!SecondCand)
10316     return;
10317   // The diagnostic can only happen if there are associated constraints on
10318   // both sides (there needs to be some identical atomic constraint).
10319   if (S.MaybeEmitAmbiguousAtomicConstraintsDiagnostic(FirstCand, FirstAC,
10320                                                       SecondCand, SecondAC))
10321     // Just show the user one diagnostic, they'll probably figure it out
10322     // from here.
10323     return;
10324 }
10325 
10326 // Notes the location of all overload candidates designated through
10327 // OverloadedExpr
10328 void Sema::NoteAllOverloadCandidates(Expr *OverloadedExpr, QualType DestType,
10329                                      bool TakingAddress) {
10330   assert(OverloadedExpr->getType() == Context.OverloadTy);
10331 
10332   OverloadExpr::FindResult Ovl = OverloadExpr::find(OverloadedExpr);
10333   OverloadExpr *OvlExpr = Ovl.Expression;
10334 
10335   for (UnresolvedSetIterator I = OvlExpr->decls_begin(),
10336                             IEnd = OvlExpr->decls_end();
10337        I != IEnd; ++I) {
10338     if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FunTmpl =
10339                 dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>((*I)->getUnderlyingDecl()) ) {
10340       NoteOverloadCandidate(*I, FunTmpl->getTemplatedDecl(), CRK_None, DestType,
10341                             TakingAddress);
10342     } else if (FunctionDecl *Fun
10343                       = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>((*I)->getUnderlyingDecl()) ) {
10344       NoteOverloadCandidate(*I, Fun, CRK_None, DestType, TakingAddress);
10345     }
10346   }
10347 }
10348 
10349 /// Diagnoses an ambiguous conversion.  The partial diagnostic is the
10350 /// "lead" diagnostic; it will be given two arguments, the source and
10351 /// target types of the conversion.
10352 void ImplicitConversionSequence::DiagnoseAmbiguousConversion(
10353                                  Sema &S,
10354                                  SourceLocation CaretLoc,
10355                                  const PartialDiagnostic &PDiag) const {
10356   S.Diag(CaretLoc, PDiag)
10357     << Ambiguous.getFromType() << Ambiguous.getToType();
10358   // FIXME: The note limiting machinery is borrowed from
10359   // OverloadCandidateSet::NoteCandidates; there's an opportunity for
10360   // refactoring here.
10361   const OverloadsShown ShowOverloads = S.Diags.getShowOverloads();
10362   unsigned CandsShown = 0;
10363   AmbiguousConversionSequence::const_iterator I, E;
10364   for (I = Ambiguous.begin(), E = Ambiguous.end(); I != E; ++I) {
10365     if (CandsShown >= 4 && ShowOverloads == Ovl_Best)
10366       break;
10367     ++CandsShown;
10368     S.NoteOverloadCandidate(I->first, I->second);
10369   }
10370   if (I != E)
10371     S.Diag(SourceLocation(), diag::note_ovl_too_many_candidates) << int(E - I);
10372 }
10373 
10374 static void DiagnoseBadConversion(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand,
10375                                   unsigned I, bool TakingCandidateAddress) {
10376   const ImplicitConversionSequence &Conv = Cand->Conversions[I];
10377   assert(Conv.isBad());
10378   assert(Cand->Function && "for now, candidate must be a function");
10379   FunctionDecl *Fn = Cand->Function;
10380 
10381   // There's a conversion slot for the object argument if this is a
10382   // non-constructor method.  Note that 'I' corresponds the
10383   // conversion-slot index.
10384   bool isObjectArgument = false;
10385   if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn) && !isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Fn)) {
10386     if (I == 0)
10387       isObjectArgument = true;
10388     else
10389       I--;
10390   }
10391 
10392   std::string FnDesc;
10393   std::pair<OverloadCandidateKind, OverloadCandidateSelect> FnKindPair =
10394       ClassifyOverloadCandidate(S, Cand->FoundDecl, Fn, Cand->getRewriteKind(),
10395                                 FnDesc);
10396 
10397   Expr *FromExpr = Conv.Bad.FromExpr;
10398   QualType FromTy = Conv.Bad.getFromType();
10399   QualType ToTy = Conv.Bad.getToType();
10400 
10401   if (FromTy == S.Context.OverloadTy) {
10402     assert(FromExpr && "overload set argument came from implicit argument?");
10403     Expr *E = FromExpr->IgnoreParens();
10404     if (isa<UnaryOperator>(E))
10405       E = cast<UnaryOperator>(E)->getSubExpr()->IgnoreParens();
10406     DeclarationName Name = cast<OverloadExpr>(E)->getName();
10407 
10408     S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_overload)
10409         << (unsigned)FnKindPair.first << (unsigned)FnKindPair.second << FnDesc
10410         << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange()) << ToTy
10411         << Name << I + 1;
10412     MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->FoundDecl);
10413     return;
10414   }
10415 
10416   // Do some hand-waving analysis to see if the non-viability is due
10417   // to a qualifier mismatch.
10418   CanQualType CFromTy = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromTy);
10419   CanQualType CToTy = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToTy);
10420   if (CanQual<ReferenceType> RT = CToTy->getAs<ReferenceType>())
10421     CToTy = RT->getPointeeType();
10422   else {
10423     // TODO: detect and diagnose the full richness of const mismatches.
10424     if (CanQual<PointerType> FromPT = CFromTy->getAs<PointerType>())
10425       if (CanQual<PointerType> ToPT = CToTy->getAs<PointerType>()) {
10426         CFromTy = FromPT->getPointeeType();
10427         CToTy = ToPT->getPointeeType();
10428       }
10429   }
10430 
10431   if (CToTy.getUnqualifiedType() == CFromTy.getUnqualifiedType() &&
10432       !CToTy.isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(CFromTy)) {
10433     Qualifiers FromQs = CFromTy.getQualifiers();
10434     Qualifiers ToQs = CToTy.getQualifiers();
10435 
10436     if (FromQs.getAddressSpace() != ToQs.getAddressSpace()) {
10437       if (isObjectArgument)
10438         S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_addrspace_this)
10439             << (unsigned)FnKindPair.first << (unsigned)FnKindPair.second
10440             << FnDesc << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
10441             << FromQs.getAddressSpace() << ToQs.getAddressSpace();
10442       else
10443         S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_addrspace)
10444             << (unsigned)FnKindPair.first << (unsigned)FnKindPair.second
10445             << FnDesc << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
10446             << FromQs.getAddressSpace() << ToQs.getAddressSpace()
10447             << ToTy->isReferenceType() << I + 1;
10448       MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->FoundDecl);
10449       return;
10450     }
10451 
10452     if (FromQs.getObjCLifetime() != ToQs.getObjCLifetime()) {
10453       S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_ownership)
10454           << (unsigned)FnKindPair.first << (unsigned)FnKindPair.second << FnDesc
10455           << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange()) << FromTy
10456           << FromQs.getObjCLifetime() << ToQs.getObjCLifetime()
10457           << (unsigned)isObjectArgument << I + 1;
10458       MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->FoundDecl);
10459       return;
10460     }
10461 
10462     if (FromQs.getObjCGCAttr() != ToQs.getObjCGCAttr()) {
10463       S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_gc)
10464           << (unsigned)FnKindPair.first << (unsigned)FnKindPair.second << FnDesc
10465           << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange()) << FromTy
10466           << FromQs.getObjCGCAttr() << ToQs.getObjCGCAttr()
10467           << (unsigned)isObjectArgument << I + 1;
10468       MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->FoundDecl);
10469       return;
10470     }
10471 
10472     if (FromQs.hasUnaligned() != ToQs.hasUnaligned()) {
10473       S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_unaligned)
10474           << (unsigned)FnKindPair.first << (unsigned)FnKindPair.second << FnDesc
10475           << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange()) << FromTy
10476           << FromQs.hasUnaligned() << I + 1;
10477       MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->FoundDecl);
10478       return;
10479     }
10480 
10481     unsigned CVR = FromQs.getCVRQualifiers() & ~ToQs.getCVRQualifiers();
10482     assert(CVR && "expected qualifiers mismatch");
10483 
10484     if (isObjectArgument) {
10485       S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_cvr_this)
10486           << (unsigned)FnKindPair.first << (unsigned)FnKindPair.second << FnDesc
10487           << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange()) << FromTy
10488           << (CVR - 1);
10489     } else {
10490       S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_cvr)
10491           << (unsigned)FnKindPair.first << (unsigned)FnKindPair.second << FnDesc
10492           << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange()) << FromTy
10493           << (CVR - 1) << I + 1;
10494     }
10495     MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->FoundDecl);
10496     return;
10497   }
10498 
10499   if (Conv.Bad.Kind == BadConversionSequence::lvalue_ref_to_rvalue ||
10500       Conv.Bad.Kind == BadConversionSequence::rvalue_ref_to_lvalue) {
10501     S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_value_category)
10502         << (unsigned)FnKindPair.first << (unsigned)FnKindPair.second << FnDesc
10503         << (unsigned)isObjectArgument << I + 1
10504         << (Conv.Bad.Kind == BadConversionSequence::rvalue_ref_to_lvalue)
10505         << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange());
10506     MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->FoundDecl);
10507     return;
10508   }
10509 
10510   // Special diagnostic for failure to convert an initializer list, since
10511   // telling the user that it has type void is not useful.
10512   if (FromExpr && isa<InitListExpr>(FromExpr)) {
10513     S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_list_argument)
10514         << (unsigned)FnKindPair.first << (unsigned)FnKindPair.second << FnDesc
10515         << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange()) << FromTy
10516         << ToTy << (unsigned)isObjectArgument << I + 1;
10517     MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->FoundDecl);
10518     return;
10519   }
10520 
10521   // Diagnose references or pointers to incomplete types differently,
10522   // since it's far from impossible that the incompleteness triggered
10523   // the failure.
10524   QualType TempFromTy = FromTy.getNonReferenceType();
10525   if (const PointerType *PTy = TempFromTy->getAs<PointerType>())
10526     TempFromTy = PTy->getPointeeType();
10527   if (TempFromTy->isIncompleteType()) {
10528     // Emit the generic diagnostic and, optionally, add the hints to it.
10529     S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_conv_incomplete)
10530         << (unsigned)FnKindPair.first << (unsigned)FnKindPair.second << FnDesc
10531         << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange()) << FromTy
10532         << ToTy << (unsigned)isObjectArgument << I + 1
10533         << (unsigned)(Cand->Fix.Kind);
10534 
10535     MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->FoundDecl);
10536     return;
10537   }
10538 
10539   // Diagnose base -> derived pointer conversions.
10540   unsigned BaseToDerivedConversion = 0;
10541   if (const PointerType *FromPtrTy = FromTy->getAs<PointerType>()) {
10542     if (const PointerType *ToPtrTy = ToTy->getAs<PointerType>()) {
10543       if (ToPtrTy->getPointeeType().isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(
10544                                                FromPtrTy->getPointeeType()) &&
10545           !FromPtrTy->getPointeeType()->isIncompleteType() &&
10546           !ToPtrTy->getPointeeType()->isIncompleteType() &&
10547           S.IsDerivedFrom(SourceLocation(), ToPtrTy->getPointeeType(),
10548                           FromPtrTy->getPointeeType()))
10549         BaseToDerivedConversion = 1;
10550     }
10551   } else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *FromPtrTy
10552                                     = FromTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
10553     if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *ToPtrTy
10554                                         = ToTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>())
10555       if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *FromIface = FromPtrTy->getInterfaceDecl())
10556         if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *ToIface = ToPtrTy->getInterfaceDecl())
10557           if (ToPtrTy->getPointeeType().isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(
10558                                                 FromPtrTy->getPointeeType()) &&
10559               FromIface->isSuperClassOf(ToIface))
10560             BaseToDerivedConversion = 2;
10561   } else if (const ReferenceType *ToRefTy = ToTy->getAs<ReferenceType>()) {
10562     if (ToRefTy->getPointeeType().isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(FromTy) &&
10563         !FromTy->isIncompleteType() &&
10564         !ToRefTy->getPointeeType()->isIncompleteType() &&
10565         S.IsDerivedFrom(SourceLocation(), ToRefTy->getPointeeType(), FromTy)) {
10566       BaseToDerivedConversion = 3;
10567     }
10568   }
10569 
10570   if (BaseToDerivedConversion) {
10571     S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_base_to_derived_conv)
10572         << (unsigned)FnKindPair.first << (unsigned)FnKindPair.second << FnDesc
10573         << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
10574         << (BaseToDerivedConversion - 1) << FromTy << ToTy << I + 1;
10575     MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->FoundDecl);
10576     return;
10577   }
10578 
10579   if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(CFromTy) &&
10580       isa<PointerType>(CToTy)) {
10581       Qualifiers FromQs = CFromTy.getQualifiers();
10582       Qualifiers ToQs = CToTy.getQualifiers();
10583       if (FromQs.getObjCLifetime() != ToQs.getObjCLifetime()) {
10584         S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_arc_conv)
10585             << (unsigned)FnKindPair.first << (unsigned)FnKindPair.second
10586             << FnDesc << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
10587             << FromTy << ToTy << (unsigned)isObjectArgument << I + 1;
10588         MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->FoundDecl);
10589         return;
10590       }
10591   }
10592 
10593   if (TakingCandidateAddress &&
10594       !checkAddressOfCandidateIsAvailable(S, Cand->Function))
10595     return;
10596 
10597   // Emit the generic diagnostic and, optionally, add the hints to it.
10598   PartialDiagnostic FDiag = S.PDiag(diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_conv);
10599   FDiag << (unsigned)FnKindPair.first << (unsigned)FnKindPair.second << FnDesc
10600         << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange()) << FromTy
10601         << ToTy << (unsigned)isObjectArgument << I + 1
10602         << (unsigned)(Cand->Fix.Kind);
10603 
10604   // If we can fix the conversion, suggest the FixIts.
10605   for (std::vector<FixItHint>::iterator HI = Cand->Fix.Hints.begin(),
10606        HE = Cand->Fix.Hints.end(); HI != HE; ++HI)
10607     FDiag << *HI;
10608   S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), FDiag);
10609 
10610   MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->FoundDecl);
10611 }
10612 
10613 /// Additional arity mismatch diagnosis specific to a function overload
10614 /// candidates. This is not covered by the more general DiagnoseArityMismatch()
10615 /// over a candidate in any candidate set.
10616 static bool CheckArityMismatch(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand,
10617                                unsigned NumArgs) {
10618   FunctionDecl *Fn = Cand->Function;
10619   unsigned MinParams = Fn->getMinRequiredArguments();
10620 
10621   // With invalid overloaded operators, it's possible that we think we
10622   // have an arity mismatch when in fact it looks like we have the
10623   // right number of arguments, because only overloaded operators have
10624   // the weird behavior of overloading member and non-member functions.
10625   // Just don't report anything.
10626   if (Fn->isInvalidDecl() &&
10627       Fn->getDeclName().getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXOperatorName)
10628     return true;
10629 
10630   if (NumArgs < MinParams) {
10631     assert((Cand->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_few_arguments) ||
10632            (Cand->FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_deduction &&
10633             Cand->DeductionFailure.Result == Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments));
10634   } else {
10635     assert((Cand->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_many_arguments) ||
10636            (Cand->FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_deduction &&
10637             Cand->DeductionFailure.Result == Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments));
10638   }
10639 
10640   return false;
10641 }
10642 
10643 /// General arity mismatch diagnosis over a candidate in a candidate set.
10644 static void DiagnoseArityMismatch(Sema &S, NamedDecl *Found, Decl *D,
10645                                   unsigned NumFormalArgs) {
10646   assert(isa<FunctionDecl>(D) &&
10647       "The templated declaration should at least be a function"
10648       " when diagnosing bad template argument deduction due to too many"
10649       " or too few arguments");
10650 
10651   FunctionDecl *Fn = cast<FunctionDecl>(D);
10652 
10653   // TODO: treat calls to a missing default constructor as a special case
10654   const auto *FnTy = Fn->getType()->castAs<FunctionProtoType>();
10655   unsigned MinParams = Fn->getMinRequiredArguments();
10656 
10657   // at least / at most / exactly
10658   unsigned mode, modeCount;
10659   if (NumFormalArgs < MinParams) {
10660     if (MinParams != FnTy->getNumParams() || FnTy->isVariadic() ||
10661         FnTy->isTemplateVariadic())
10662       mode = 0; // "at least"
10663     else
10664       mode = 2; // "exactly"
10665     modeCount = MinParams;
10666   } else {
10667     if (MinParams != FnTy->getNumParams())
10668       mode = 1; // "at most"
10669     else
10670       mode = 2; // "exactly"
10671     modeCount = FnTy->getNumParams();
10672   }
10673 
10674   std::string Description;
10675   std::pair<OverloadCandidateKind, OverloadCandidateSelect> FnKindPair =
10676       ClassifyOverloadCandidate(S, Found, Fn, CRK_None, Description);
10677 
10678   if (modeCount == 1 && Fn->getParamDecl(0)->getDeclName())
10679     S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_arity_one)
10680         << (unsigned)FnKindPair.first << (unsigned)FnKindPair.second
10681         << Description << mode << Fn->getParamDecl(0) << NumFormalArgs;
10682   else
10683     S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_arity)
10684         << (unsigned)FnKindPair.first << (unsigned)FnKindPair.second
10685         << Description << mode << modeCount << NumFormalArgs;
10686 
10687   MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Found);
10688 }
10689 
10690 /// Arity mismatch diagnosis specific to a function overload candidate.
10691 static void DiagnoseArityMismatch(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand,
10692                                   unsigned NumFormalArgs) {
10693   if (!CheckArityMismatch(S, Cand, NumFormalArgs))
10694     DiagnoseArityMismatch(S, Cand->FoundDecl, Cand->Function, NumFormalArgs);
10695 }
10696 
10697 static TemplateDecl *getDescribedTemplate(Decl *Templated) {
10698   if (TemplateDecl *TD = Templated->getDescribedTemplate())
10699     return TD;
10700   llvm_unreachable("Unsupported: Getting the described template declaration"
10701                    " for bad deduction diagnosis");
10702 }
10703 
10704 /// Diagnose a failed template-argument deduction.
10705 static void DiagnoseBadDeduction(Sema &S, NamedDecl *Found, Decl *Templated,
10706                                  DeductionFailureInfo &DeductionFailure,
10707                                  unsigned NumArgs,
10708                                  bool TakingCandidateAddress) {
10709   TemplateParameter Param = DeductionFailure.getTemplateParameter();
10710   NamedDecl *ParamD;
10711   (ParamD = Param.dyn_cast<TemplateTypeParmDecl*>()) ||
10712   (ParamD = Param.dyn_cast<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl*>()) ||
10713   (ParamD = Param.dyn_cast<TemplateTemplateParmDecl*>());
10714   switch (DeductionFailure.Result) {
10715   case Sema::TDK_Success:
10716     llvm_unreachable("TDK_success while diagnosing bad deduction");
10717 
10718   case Sema::TDK_Incomplete: {
10719     assert(ParamD && "no parameter found for incomplete deduction result");
10720     S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(),
10721            diag::note_ovl_candidate_incomplete_deduction)
10722         << ParamD->getDeclName();
10723     MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Found);
10724     return;
10725   }
10726 
10727   case Sema::TDK_IncompletePack: {
10728     assert(ParamD && "no parameter found for incomplete deduction result");
10729     S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(),
10730            diag::note_ovl_candidate_incomplete_deduction_pack)
10731         << ParamD->getDeclName()
10732         << (DeductionFailure.getFirstArg()->pack_size() + 1)
10733         << *DeductionFailure.getFirstArg();
10734     MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Found);
10735     return;
10736   }
10737 
10738   case Sema::TDK_Underqualified: {
10739     assert(ParamD && "no parameter found for bad qualifiers deduction result");
10740     TemplateTypeParmDecl *TParam = cast<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(ParamD);
10741 
10742     QualType Param = DeductionFailure.getFirstArg()->getAsType();
10743 
10744     // Param will have been canonicalized, but it should just be a
10745     // qualified version of ParamD, so move the qualifiers to that.
10746     QualifierCollector Qs;
10747     Qs.strip(Param);
10748     QualType NonCanonParam = Qs.apply(S.Context, TParam->getTypeForDecl());
10749     assert(S.Context.hasSameType(Param, NonCanonParam));
10750 
10751     // Arg has also been canonicalized, but there's nothing we can do
10752     // about that.  It also doesn't matter as much, because it won't
10753     // have any template parameters in it (because deduction isn't
10754     // done on dependent types).
10755     QualType Arg = DeductionFailure.getSecondArg()->getAsType();
10756 
10757     S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_underqualified)
10758         << ParamD->getDeclName() << Arg << NonCanonParam;
10759     MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Found);
10760     return;
10761   }
10762 
10763   case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent: {
10764     assert(ParamD && "no parameter found for inconsistent deduction result");
10765     int which = 0;
10766     if (isa<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(ParamD))
10767       which = 0;
10768     else if (isa<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(ParamD)) {
10769       // Deduction might have failed because we deduced arguments of two
10770       // different types for a non-type template parameter.
10771       // FIXME: Use a different TDK value for this.
10772       QualType T1 =
10773           DeductionFailure.getFirstArg()->getNonTypeTemplateArgumentType();
10774       QualType T2 =
10775           DeductionFailure.getSecondArg()->getNonTypeTemplateArgumentType();
10776       if (!T1.isNull() && !T2.isNull() && !S.Context.hasSameType(T1, T2)) {
10777         S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(),
10778                diag::note_ovl_candidate_inconsistent_deduction_types)
10779           << ParamD->getDeclName() << *DeductionFailure.getFirstArg() << T1
10780           << *DeductionFailure.getSecondArg() << T2;
10781         MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Found);
10782         return;
10783       }
10784 
10785       which = 1;
10786     } else {
10787       which = 2;
10788     }
10789 
10790     // Tweak the diagnostic if the problem is that we deduced packs of
10791     // different arities. We'll print the actual packs anyway in case that
10792     // includes additional useful information.
10793     if (DeductionFailure.getFirstArg()->getKind() == TemplateArgument::Pack &&
10794         DeductionFailure.getSecondArg()->getKind() == TemplateArgument::Pack &&
10795         DeductionFailure.getFirstArg()->pack_size() !=
10796             DeductionFailure.getSecondArg()->pack_size()) {
10797       which = 3;
10798     }
10799 
10800     S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(),
10801            diag::note_ovl_candidate_inconsistent_deduction)
10802         << which << ParamD->getDeclName() << *DeductionFailure.getFirstArg()
10803         << *DeductionFailure.getSecondArg();
10804     MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Found);
10805     return;
10806   }
10807 
10808   case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
10809     assert(ParamD && "no parameter found for invalid explicit arguments");
10810     if (ParamD->getDeclName())
10811       S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(),
10812              diag::note_ovl_candidate_explicit_arg_mismatch_named)
10813           << ParamD->getDeclName();
10814     else {
10815       int index = 0;
10816       if (TemplateTypeParmDecl *TTP = dyn_cast<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(ParamD))
10817         index = TTP->getIndex();
10818       else if (NonTypeTemplateParmDecl *NTTP
10819                                   = dyn_cast<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(ParamD))
10820         index = NTTP->getIndex();
10821       else
10822         index = cast<TemplateTemplateParmDecl>(ParamD)->getIndex();
10823       S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(),
10824              diag::note_ovl_candidate_explicit_arg_mismatch_unnamed)
10825           << (index + 1);
10826     }
10827     MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Found);
10828     return;
10829 
10830   case Sema::TDK_ConstraintsNotSatisfied: {
10831     // Format the template argument list into the argument string.
10832     SmallString<128> TemplateArgString;
10833     TemplateArgumentList *Args = DeductionFailure.getTemplateArgumentList();
10834     TemplateArgString = " ";
10835     TemplateArgString += S.getTemplateArgumentBindingsText(
10836         getDescribedTemplate(Templated)->getTemplateParameters(), *Args);
10837     if (TemplateArgString.size() == 1)
10838       TemplateArgString.clear();
10839     S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(),
10840            diag::note_ovl_candidate_unsatisfied_constraints)
10841         << TemplateArgString;
10842 
10843     S.DiagnoseUnsatisfiedConstraint(
10844         static_cast<CNSInfo*>(DeductionFailure.Data)->Satisfaction);
10845     return;
10846   }
10847   case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
10848   case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
10849     DiagnoseArityMismatch(S, Found, Templated, NumArgs);
10850     return;
10851 
10852   case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
10853     S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(),
10854            diag::note_ovl_candidate_instantiation_depth);
10855     MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Found);
10856     return;
10857 
10858   case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure: {
10859     // Format the template argument list into the argument string.
10860     SmallString<128> TemplateArgString;
10861     if (TemplateArgumentList *Args =
10862             DeductionFailure.getTemplateArgumentList()) {
10863       TemplateArgString = " ";
10864       TemplateArgString += S.getTemplateArgumentBindingsText(
10865           getDescribedTemplate(Templated)->getTemplateParameters(), *Args);
10866       if (TemplateArgString.size() == 1)
10867         TemplateArgString.clear();
10868     }
10869 
10870     // If this candidate was disabled by enable_if, say so.
10871     PartialDiagnosticAt *PDiag = DeductionFailure.getSFINAEDiagnostic();
10872     if (PDiag && PDiag->second.getDiagID() ==
10873           diag::err_typename_nested_not_found_enable_if) {
10874       // FIXME: Use the source range of the condition, and the fully-qualified
10875       //        name of the enable_if template. These are both present in PDiag.
10876       S.Diag(PDiag->first, diag::note_ovl_candidate_disabled_by_enable_if)
10877         << "'enable_if'" << TemplateArgString;
10878       return;
10879     }
10880 
10881     // We found a specific requirement that disabled the enable_if.
10882     if (PDiag && PDiag->second.getDiagID() ==
10883         diag::err_typename_nested_not_found_requirement) {
10884       S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(),
10885              diag::note_ovl_candidate_disabled_by_requirement)
10886         << PDiag->second.getStringArg(0) << TemplateArgString;
10887       return;
10888     }
10889 
10890     // Format the SFINAE diagnostic into the argument string.
10891     // FIXME: Add a general mechanism to include a PartialDiagnostic *'s
10892     //        formatted message in another diagnostic.
10893     SmallString<128> SFINAEArgString;
10894     SourceRange R;
10895     if (PDiag) {
10896       SFINAEArgString = ": ";
10897       R = SourceRange(PDiag->first, PDiag->first);
10898       PDiag->second.EmitToString(S.getDiagnostics(), SFINAEArgString);
10899     }
10900 
10901     S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(),
10902            diag::note_ovl_candidate_substitution_failure)
10903         << TemplateArgString << SFINAEArgString << R;
10904     MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Found);
10905     return;
10906   }
10907 
10908   case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatch:
10909   case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatchNested: {
10910     // Format the template argument list into the argument string.
10911     SmallString<128> TemplateArgString;
10912     if (TemplateArgumentList *Args =
10913             DeductionFailure.getTemplateArgumentList()) {
10914       TemplateArgString = " ";
10915       TemplateArgString += S.getTemplateArgumentBindingsText(
10916           getDescribedTemplate(Templated)->getTemplateParameters(), *Args);
10917       if (TemplateArgString.size() == 1)
10918         TemplateArgString.clear();
10919     }
10920 
10921     S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_deduced_mismatch)
10922         << (*DeductionFailure.getCallArgIndex() + 1)
10923         << *DeductionFailure.getFirstArg() << *DeductionFailure.getSecondArg()
10924         << TemplateArgString
10925         << (DeductionFailure.Result == Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatchNested);
10926     break;
10927   }
10928 
10929   case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch: {
10930     // FIXME: Provide a source location to indicate what we couldn't match.
10931     TemplateArgument FirstTA = *DeductionFailure.getFirstArg();
10932     TemplateArgument SecondTA = *DeductionFailure.getSecondArg();
10933     if (FirstTA.getKind() == TemplateArgument::Template &&
10934         SecondTA.getKind() == TemplateArgument::Template) {
10935       TemplateName FirstTN = FirstTA.getAsTemplate();
10936       TemplateName SecondTN = SecondTA.getAsTemplate();
10937       if (FirstTN.getKind() == TemplateName::Template &&
10938           SecondTN.getKind() == TemplateName::Template) {
10939         if (FirstTN.getAsTemplateDecl()->getName() ==
10940             SecondTN.getAsTemplateDecl()->getName()) {
10941           // FIXME: This fixes a bad diagnostic where both templates are named
10942           // the same.  This particular case is a bit difficult since:
10943           // 1) It is passed as a string to the diagnostic printer.
10944           // 2) The diagnostic printer only attempts to find a better
10945           //    name for types, not decls.
10946           // Ideally, this should folded into the diagnostic printer.
10947           S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(),
10948                  diag::note_ovl_candidate_non_deduced_mismatch_qualified)
10949               << FirstTN.getAsTemplateDecl() << SecondTN.getAsTemplateDecl();
10950           return;
10951         }
10952       }
10953     }
10954 
10955     if (TakingCandidateAddress && isa<FunctionDecl>(Templated) &&
10956         !checkAddressOfCandidateIsAvailable(S, cast<FunctionDecl>(Templated)))
10957       return;
10958 
10959     // FIXME: For generic lambda parameters, check if the function is a lambda
10960     // call operator, and if so, emit a prettier and more informative
10961     // diagnostic that mentions 'auto' and lambda in addition to
10962     // (or instead of?) the canonical template type parameters.
10963     S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(),
10964            diag::note_ovl_candidate_non_deduced_mismatch)
10965         << FirstTA << SecondTA;
10966     return;
10967   }
10968   // TODO: diagnose these individually, then kill off
10969   // note_ovl_candidate_bad_deduction, which is uselessly vague.
10970   case Sema::TDK_MiscellaneousDeductionFailure:
10971     S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_deduction);
10972     MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Found);
10973     return;
10974   case Sema::TDK_CUDATargetMismatch:
10975     S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(),
10976            diag::note_cuda_ovl_candidate_target_mismatch);
10977     return;
10978   }
10979 }
10980 
10981 /// Diagnose a failed template-argument deduction, for function calls.
10982 static void DiagnoseBadDeduction(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand,
10983                                  unsigned NumArgs,
10984                                  bool TakingCandidateAddress) {
10985   unsigned TDK = Cand->DeductionFailure.Result;
10986   if (TDK == Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments || TDK == Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments) {
10987     if (CheckArityMismatch(S, Cand, NumArgs))
10988       return;
10989   }
10990   DiagnoseBadDeduction(S, Cand->FoundDecl, Cand->Function, // pattern
10991                        Cand->DeductionFailure, NumArgs, TakingCandidateAddress);
10992 }
10993 
10994 /// CUDA: diagnose an invalid call across targets.
10995 static void DiagnoseBadTarget(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand) {
10996   FunctionDecl *Caller = cast<FunctionDecl>(S.CurContext);
10997   FunctionDecl *Callee = Cand->Function;
10998 
10999   Sema::CUDAFunctionTarget CallerTarget = S.IdentifyCUDATarget(Caller),
11000                            CalleeTarget = S.IdentifyCUDATarget(Callee);
11001 
11002   std::string FnDesc;
11003   std::pair<OverloadCandidateKind, OverloadCandidateSelect> FnKindPair =
11004       ClassifyOverloadCandidate(S, Cand->FoundDecl, Callee,
11005                                 Cand->getRewriteKind(), FnDesc);
11006 
11007   S.Diag(Callee->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_target)
11008       << (unsigned)FnKindPair.first << (unsigned)ocs_non_template
11009       << FnDesc /* Ignored */
11010       << CalleeTarget << CallerTarget;
11011 
11012   // This could be an implicit constructor for which we could not infer the
11013   // target due to a collsion. Diagnose that case.
11014   CXXMethodDecl *Meth = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Callee);
11015   if (Meth != nullptr && Meth->isImplicit()) {
11016     CXXRecordDecl *ParentClass = Meth->getParent();
11017     Sema::CXXSpecialMember CSM;
11018 
11019     switch (FnKindPair.first) {
11020     default:
11021       return;
11022     case oc_implicit_default_constructor:
11023       CSM = Sema::CXXDefaultConstructor;
11024       break;
11025     case oc_implicit_copy_constructor:
11026       CSM = Sema::CXXCopyConstructor;
11027       break;
11028     case oc_implicit_move_constructor:
11029       CSM = Sema::CXXMoveConstructor;
11030       break;
11031     case oc_implicit_copy_assignment:
11032       CSM = Sema::CXXCopyAssignment;
11033       break;
11034     case oc_implicit_move_assignment:
11035       CSM = Sema::CXXMoveAssignment;
11036       break;
11037     };
11038 
11039     bool ConstRHS = false;
11040     if (Meth->getNumParams()) {
11041       if (const ReferenceType *RT =
11042               Meth->getParamDecl(0)->getType()->getAs<ReferenceType>()) {
11043         ConstRHS = RT->getPointeeType().isConstQualified();
11044       }
11045     }
11046 
11047     S.inferCUDATargetForImplicitSpecialMember(ParentClass, CSM, Meth,
11048                                               /* ConstRHS */ ConstRHS,
11049                                               /* Diagnose */ true);
11050   }
11051 }
11052 
11053 static void DiagnoseFailedEnableIfAttr(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand) {
11054   FunctionDecl *Callee = Cand->Function;
11055   EnableIfAttr *Attr = static_cast<EnableIfAttr*>(Cand->DeductionFailure.Data);
11056 
11057   S.Diag(Callee->getLocation(),
11058          diag::note_ovl_candidate_disabled_by_function_cond_attr)
11059       << Attr->getCond()->getSourceRange() << Attr->getMessage();
11060 }
11061 
11062 static void DiagnoseFailedExplicitSpec(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand) {
11063   ExplicitSpecifier ES = ExplicitSpecifier::getFromDecl(Cand->Function);
11064   assert(ES.isExplicit() && "not an explicit candidate");
11065 
11066   unsigned Kind;
11067   switch (Cand->Function->getDeclKind()) {
11068   case Decl::Kind::CXXConstructor:
11069     Kind = 0;
11070     break;
11071   case Decl::Kind::CXXConversion:
11072     Kind = 1;
11073     break;
11074   case Decl::Kind::CXXDeductionGuide:
11075     Kind = Cand->Function->isImplicit() ? 0 : 2;
11076     break;
11077   default:
11078     llvm_unreachable("invalid Decl");
11079   }
11080 
11081   // Note the location of the first (in-class) declaration; a redeclaration
11082   // (particularly an out-of-class definition) will typically lack the
11083   // 'explicit' specifier.
11084   // FIXME: This is probably a good thing to do for all 'candidate' notes.
11085   FunctionDecl *First = Cand->Function->getFirstDecl();
11086   if (FunctionDecl *Pattern = First->getTemplateInstantiationPattern())
11087     First = Pattern->getFirstDecl();
11088 
11089   S.Diag(First->getLocation(),
11090          diag::note_ovl_candidate_explicit)
11091       << Kind << (ES.getExpr() ? 1 : 0)
11092       << (ES.getExpr() ? ES.getExpr()->getSourceRange() : SourceRange());
11093 }
11094 
11095 static void DiagnoseOpenCLExtensionDisabled(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand) {
11096   FunctionDecl *Callee = Cand->Function;
11097 
11098   S.Diag(Callee->getLocation(),
11099          diag::note_ovl_candidate_disabled_by_extension)
11100     << S.getOpenCLExtensionsFromDeclExtMap(Callee);
11101 }
11102 
11103 /// Generates a 'note' diagnostic for an overload candidate.  We've
11104 /// already generated a primary error at the call site.
11105 ///
11106 /// It really does need to be a single diagnostic with its caret
11107 /// pointed at the candidate declaration.  Yes, this creates some
11108 /// major challenges of technical writing.  Yes, this makes pointing
11109 /// out problems with specific arguments quite awkward.  It's still
11110 /// better than generating twenty screens of text for every failed
11111 /// overload.
11112 ///
11113 /// It would be great to be able to express per-candidate problems
11114 /// more richly for those diagnostic clients that cared, but we'd
11115 /// still have to be just as careful with the default diagnostics.
11116 /// \param CtorDestAS Addr space of object being constructed (for ctor
11117 /// candidates only).
11118 static void NoteFunctionCandidate(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand,
11119                                   unsigned NumArgs,
11120                                   bool TakingCandidateAddress,
11121                                   LangAS CtorDestAS = LangAS::Default) {
11122   FunctionDecl *Fn = Cand->Function;
11123   if (shouldSkipNotingLambdaConversionDecl(Fn))
11124     return;
11125 
11126   // Note deleted candidates, but only if they're viable.
11127   if (Cand->Viable) {
11128     if (Fn->isDeleted()) {
11129       std::string FnDesc;
11130       std::pair<OverloadCandidateKind, OverloadCandidateSelect> FnKindPair =
11131           ClassifyOverloadCandidate(S, Cand->FoundDecl, Fn,
11132                                     Cand->getRewriteKind(), FnDesc);
11133 
11134       S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_deleted)
11135           << (unsigned)FnKindPair.first << (unsigned)FnKindPair.second << FnDesc
11136           << (Fn->isDeleted() ? (Fn->isDeletedAsWritten() ? 1 : 2) : 0);
11137       MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->FoundDecl);
11138       return;
11139     }
11140 
11141     // We don't really have anything else to say about viable candidates.
11142     S.NoteOverloadCandidate(Cand->FoundDecl, Fn, Cand->getRewriteKind());
11143     return;
11144   }
11145 
11146   switch (Cand->FailureKind) {
11147   case ovl_fail_too_many_arguments:
11148   case ovl_fail_too_few_arguments:
11149     return DiagnoseArityMismatch(S, Cand, NumArgs);
11150 
11151   case ovl_fail_bad_deduction:
11152     return DiagnoseBadDeduction(S, Cand, NumArgs,
11153                                 TakingCandidateAddress);
11154 
11155   case ovl_fail_illegal_constructor: {
11156     S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_illegal_constructor)
11157       << (Fn->getPrimaryTemplate() ? 1 : 0);
11158     MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->FoundDecl);
11159     return;
11160   }
11161 
11162   case ovl_fail_object_addrspace_mismatch: {
11163     Qualifiers QualsForPrinting;
11164     QualsForPrinting.setAddressSpace(CtorDestAS);
11165     S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(),
11166            diag::note_ovl_candidate_illegal_constructor_adrspace_mismatch)
11167         << QualsForPrinting;
11168     MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->FoundDecl);
11169     return;
11170   }
11171 
11172   case ovl_fail_trivial_conversion:
11173   case ovl_fail_bad_final_conversion:
11174   case ovl_fail_final_conversion_not_exact:
11175     return S.NoteOverloadCandidate(Cand->FoundDecl, Fn, Cand->getRewriteKind());
11176 
11177   case ovl_fail_bad_conversion: {
11178     unsigned I = (Cand->IgnoreObjectArgument ? 1 : 0);
11179     for (unsigned N = Cand->Conversions.size(); I != N; ++I)
11180       if (Cand->Conversions[I].isBad())
11181         return DiagnoseBadConversion(S, Cand, I, TakingCandidateAddress);
11182 
11183     // FIXME: this currently happens when we're called from SemaInit
11184     // when user-conversion overload fails.  Figure out how to handle
11185     // those conditions and diagnose them well.
11186     return S.NoteOverloadCandidate(Cand->FoundDecl, Fn, Cand->getRewriteKind());
11187   }
11188 
11189   case ovl_fail_bad_target:
11190     return DiagnoseBadTarget(S, Cand);
11191 
11192   case ovl_fail_enable_if:
11193     return DiagnoseFailedEnableIfAttr(S, Cand);
11194 
11195   case ovl_fail_explicit:
11196     return DiagnoseFailedExplicitSpec(S, Cand);
11197 
11198   case ovl_fail_ext_disabled:
11199     return DiagnoseOpenCLExtensionDisabled(S, Cand);
11200 
11201   case ovl_fail_inhctor_slice:
11202     // It's generally not interesting to note copy/move constructors here.
11203     if (cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Fn)->isCopyOrMoveConstructor())
11204       return;
11205     S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(),
11206            diag::note_ovl_candidate_inherited_constructor_slice)
11207       << (Fn->getPrimaryTemplate() ? 1 : 0)
11208       << Fn->getParamDecl(0)->getType()->isRValueReferenceType();
11209     MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->FoundDecl);
11210     return;
11211 
11212   case ovl_fail_addr_not_available: {
11213     bool Available = checkAddressOfCandidateIsAvailable(S, Cand->Function);
11214     (void)Available;
11215     assert(!Available);
11216     break;
11217   }
11218   case ovl_non_default_multiversion_function:
11219     // Do nothing, these should simply be ignored.
11220     break;
11221 
11222   case ovl_fail_constraints_not_satisfied: {
11223     std::string FnDesc;
11224     std::pair<OverloadCandidateKind, OverloadCandidateSelect> FnKindPair =
11225         ClassifyOverloadCandidate(S, Cand->FoundDecl, Fn,
11226                                   Cand->getRewriteKind(), FnDesc);
11227 
11228     S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(),
11229            diag::note_ovl_candidate_constraints_not_satisfied)
11230         << (unsigned)FnKindPair.first << (unsigned)ocs_non_template
11231         << FnDesc /* Ignored */;
11232     ConstraintSatisfaction Satisfaction;
11233     if (S.CheckFunctionConstraints(Fn, Satisfaction))
11234       break;
11235     S.DiagnoseUnsatisfiedConstraint(Satisfaction);
11236   }
11237   }
11238 }
11239 
11240 static void NoteSurrogateCandidate(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand) {
11241   if (shouldSkipNotingLambdaConversionDecl(Cand->Surrogate))
11242     return;
11243 
11244   // Desugar the type of the surrogate down to a function type,
11245   // retaining as many typedefs as possible while still showing
11246   // the function type (and, therefore, its parameter types).
11247   QualType FnType = Cand->Surrogate->getConversionType();
11248   bool isLValueReference = false;
11249   bool isRValueReference = false;
11250   bool isPointer = false;
11251   if (const LValueReferenceType *FnTypeRef =
11252         FnType->getAs<LValueReferenceType>()) {
11253     FnType = FnTypeRef->getPointeeType();
11254     isLValueReference = true;
11255   } else if (const RValueReferenceType *FnTypeRef =
11256                FnType->getAs<RValueReferenceType>()) {
11257     FnType = FnTypeRef->getPointeeType();
11258     isRValueReference = true;
11259   }
11260   if (const PointerType *FnTypePtr = FnType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
11261     FnType = FnTypePtr->getPointeeType();
11262     isPointer = true;
11263   }
11264   // Desugar down to a function type.
11265   FnType = QualType(FnType->getAs<FunctionType>(), 0);
11266   // Reconstruct the pointer/reference as appropriate.
11267   if (isPointer) FnType = S.Context.getPointerType(FnType);
11268   if (isRValueReference) FnType = S.Context.getRValueReferenceType(FnType);
11269   if (isLValueReference) FnType = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(FnType);
11270 
11271   S.Diag(Cand->Surrogate->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_surrogate_cand)
11272     << FnType;
11273 }
11274 
11275 static void NoteBuiltinOperatorCandidate(Sema &S, StringRef Opc,
11276                                          SourceLocation OpLoc,
11277                                          OverloadCandidate *Cand) {
11278   assert(Cand->Conversions.size() <= 2 && "builtin operator is not binary");
11279   std::string TypeStr("operator");
11280   TypeStr += Opc;
11281   TypeStr += "(";
11282   TypeStr += Cand->BuiltinParamTypes[0].getAsString();
11283   if (Cand->Conversions.size() == 1) {
11284     TypeStr += ")";
11285     S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::note_ovl_builtin_candidate) << TypeStr;
11286   } else {
11287     TypeStr += ", ";
11288     TypeStr += Cand->BuiltinParamTypes[1].getAsString();
11289     TypeStr += ")";
11290     S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::note_ovl_builtin_candidate) << TypeStr;
11291   }
11292 }
11293 
11294 static void NoteAmbiguousUserConversions(Sema &S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
11295                                          OverloadCandidate *Cand) {
11296   for (const ImplicitConversionSequence &ICS : Cand->Conversions) {
11297     if (ICS.isBad()) break; // all meaningless after first invalid
11298     if (!ICS.isAmbiguous()) continue;
11299 
11300     ICS.DiagnoseAmbiguousConversion(
11301         S, OpLoc, S.PDiag(diag::note_ambiguous_type_conversion));
11302   }
11303 }
11304 
11305 static SourceLocation GetLocationForCandidate(const OverloadCandidate *Cand) {
11306   if (Cand->Function)
11307     return Cand->Function->getLocation();
11308   if (Cand->IsSurrogate)
11309     return Cand->Surrogate->getLocation();
11310   return SourceLocation();
11311 }
11312 
11313 static unsigned RankDeductionFailure(const DeductionFailureInfo &DFI) {
11314   switch ((Sema::TemplateDeductionResult)DFI.Result) {
11315   case Sema::TDK_Success:
11316   case Sema::TDK_NonDependentConversionFailure:
11317     llvm_unreachable("non-deduction failure while diagnosing bad deduction");
11318 
11319   case Sema::TDK_Invalid:
11320   case Sema::TDK_Incomplete:
11321   case Sema::TDK_IncompletePack:
11322     return 1;
11323 
11324   case Sema::TDK_Underqualified:
11325   case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent:
11326     return 2;
11327 
11328   case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure:
11329   case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatch:
11330   case Sema::TDK_ConstraintsNotSatisfied:
11331   case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatchNested:
11332   case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch:
11333   case Sema::TDK_MiscellaneousDeductionFailure:
11334   case Sema::TDK_CUDATargetMismatch:
11335     return 3;
11336 
11337   case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
11338     return 4;
11339 
11340   case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
11341     return 5;
11342 
11343   case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
11344   case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
11345     return 6;
11346   }
11347   llvm_unreachable("Unhandled deduction result");
11348 }
11349 
11350 namespace {
11351 struct CompareOverloadCandidatesForDisplay {
11352   Sema &S;
11353   SourceLocation Loc;
11354   size_t NumArgs;
11355   OverloadCandidateSet::CandidateSetKind CSK;
11356 
11357   CompareOverloadCandidatesForDisplay(
11358       Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, size_t NArgs,
11359       OverloadCandidateSet::CandidateSetKind CSK)
11360       : S(S), NumArgs(NArgs), CSK(CSK) {}
11361 
11362   OverloadFailureKind EffectiveFailureKind(const OverloadCandidate *C) const {
11363     // If there are too many or too few arguments, that's the high-order bit we
11364     // want to sort by, even if the immediate failure kind was something else.
11365     if (C->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_many_arguments ||
11366         C->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_few_arguments)
11367       return static_cast<OverloadFailureKind>(C->FailureKind);
11368 
11369     if (C->Function) {
11370       if (NumArgs > C->Function->getNumParams() && !C->Function->isVariadic())
11371         return ovl_fail_too_many_arguments;
11372       if (NumArgs < C->Function->getMinRequiredArguments())
11373         return ovl_fail_too_few_arguments;
11374     }
11375 
11376     return static_cast<OverloadFailureKind>(C->FailureKind);
11377   }
11378 
11379   bool operator()(const OverloadCandidate *L,
11380                   const OverloadCandidate *R) {
11381     // Fast-path this check.
11382     if (L == R) return false;
11383 
11384     // Order first by viability.
11385     if (L->Viable) {
11386       if (!R->Viable) return true;
11387 
11388       // TODO: introduce a tri-valued comparison for overload
11389       // candidates.  Would be more worthwhile if we had a sort
11390       // that could exploit it.
11391       if (isBetterOverloadCandidate(S, *L, *R, SourceLocation(), CSK))
11392         return true;
11393       if (isBetterOverloadCandidate(S, *R, *L, SourceLocation(), CSK))
11394         return false;
11395     } else if (R->Viable)
11396       return false;
11397 
11398     assert(L->Viable == R->Viable);
11399 
11400     // Criteria by which we can sort non-viable candidates:
11401     if (!L->Viable) {
11402       OverloadFailureKind LFailureKind = EffectiveFailureKind(L);
11403       OverloadFailureKind RFailureKind = EffectiveFailureKind(R);
11404 
11405       // 1. Arity mismatches come after other candidates.
11406       if (LFailureKind == ovl_fail_too_many_arguments ||
11407           LFailureKind == ovl_fail_too_few_arguments) {
11408         if (RFailureKind == ovl_fail_too_many_arguments ||
11409             RFailureKind == ovl_fail_too_few_arguments) {
11410           int LDist = std::abs((int)L->getNumParams() - (int)NumArgs);
11411           int RDist = std::abs((int)R->getNumParams() - (int)NumArgs);
11412           if (LDist == RDist) {
11413             if (LFailureKind == RFailureKind)
11414               // Sort non-surrogates before surrogates.
11415               return !L->IsSurrogate && R->IsSurrogate;
11416             // Sort candidates requiring fewer parameters than there were
11417             // arguments given after candidates requiring more parameters
11418             // than there were arguments given.
11419             return LFailureKind == ovl_fail_too_many_arguments;
11420           }
11421           return LDist < RDist;
11422         }
11423         return false;
11424       }
11425       if (RFailureKind == ovl_fail_too_many_arguments ||
11426           RFailureKind == ovl_fail_too_few_arguments)
11427         return true;
11428 
11429       // 2. Bad conversions come first and are ordered by the number
11430       // of bad conversions and quality of good conversions.
11431       if (LFailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_conversion) {
11432         if (RFailureKind != ovl_fail_bad_conversion)
11433           return true;
11434 
11435         // The conversion that can be fixed with a smaller number of changes,
11436         // comes first.
11437         unsigned numLFixes = L->Fix.NumConversionsFixed;
11438         unsigned numRFixes = R->Fix.NumConversionsFixed;
11439         numLFixes = (numLFixes == 0) ? UINT_MAX : numLFixes;
11440         numRFixes = (numRFixes == 0) ? UINT_MAX : numRFixes;
11441         if (numLFixes != numRFixes) {
11442           return numLFixes < numRFixes;
11443         }
11444 
11445         // If there's any ordering between the defined conversions...
11446         // FIXME: this might not be transitive.
11447         assert(L->Conversions.size() == R->Conversions.size());
11448 
11449         int leftBetter = 0;
11450         unsigned I = (L->IgnoreObjectArgument || R->IgnoreObjectArgument);
11451         for (unsigned E = L->Conversions.size(); I != E; ++I) {
11452           switch (CompareImplicitConversionSequences(S, Loc,
11453                                                      L->Conversions[I],
11454                                                      R->Conversions[I])) {
11455           case ImplicitConversionSequence::Better:
11456             leftBetter++;
11457             break;
11458 
11459           case ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse:
11460             leftBetter--;
11461             break;
11462 
11463           case ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable:
11464             break;
11465           }
11466         }
11467         if (leftBetter > 0) return true;
11468         if (leftBetter < 0) return false;
11469 
11470       } else if (RFailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_conversion)
11471         return false;
11472 
11473       if (LFailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_deduction) {
11474         if (RFailureKind != ovl_fail_bad_deduction)
11475           return true;
11476 
11477         if (L->DeductionFailure.Result != R->DeductionFailure.Result)
11478           return RankDeductionFailure(L->DeductionFailure)
11479                < RankDeductionFailure(R->DeductionFailure);
11480       } else if (RFailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_deduction)
11481         return false;
11482 
11483       // TODO: others?
11484     }
11485 
11486     // Sort everything else by location.
11487     SourceLocation LLoc = GetLocationForCandidate(L);
11488     SourceLocation RLoc = GetLocationForCandidate(R);
11489 
11490     // Put candidates without locations (e.g. builtins) at the end.
11491     if (LLoc.isInvalid()) return false;
11492     if (RLoc.isInvalid()) return true;
11493 
11494     return S.SourceMgr.isBeforeInTranslationUnit(LLoc, RLoc);
11495   }
11496 };
11497 }
11498 
11499 /// CompleteNonViableCandidate - Normally, overload resolution only
11500 /// computes up to the first bad conversion. Produces the FixIt set if
11501 /// possible.
11502 static void
11503 CompleteNonViableCandidate(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand,
11504                            ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
11505                            OverloadCandidateSet::CandidateSetKind CSK) {
11506   assert(!Cand->Viable);
11507 
11508   // Don't do anything on failures other than bad conversion.
11509   if (Cand->FailureKind != ovl_fail_bad_conversion)
11510     return;
11511 
11512   // We only want the FixIts if all the arguments can be corrected.
11513   bool Unfixable = false;
11514   // Use a implicit copy initialization to check conversion fixes.
11515   Cand->Fix.setConversionChecker(TryCopyInitialization);
11516 
11517   // Attempt to fix the bad conversion.
11518   unsigned ConvCount = Cand->Conversions.size();
11519   for (unsigned ConvIdx = (Cand->IgnoreObjectArgument ? 1 : 0); /**/;
11520        ++ConvIdx) {
11521     assert(ConvIdx != ConvCount && "no bad conversion in candidate");
11522     if (Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx].isInitialized() &&
11523         Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx].isBad()) {
11524       Unfixable = !Cand->TryToFixBadConversion(ConvIdx, S);
11525       break;
11526     }
11527   }
11528 
11529   // FIXME: this should probably be preserved from the overload
11530   // operation somehow.
11531   bool SuppressUserConversions = false;
11532 
11533   unsigned ConvIdx = 0;
11534   unsigned ArgIdx = 0;
11535   ArrayRef<QualType> ParamTypes;
11536   bool Reversed = Cand->isReversed();
11537 
11538   if (Cand->IsSurrogate) {
11539     QualType ConvType
11540       = Cand->Surrogate->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType();
11541     if (const PointerType *ConvPtrType = ConvType->getAs<PointerType>())
11542       ConvType = ConvPtrType->getPointeeType();
11543     ParamTypes = ConvType->castAs<FunctionProtoType>()->getParamTypes();
11544     // Conversion 0 is 'this', which doesn't have a corresponding parameter.
11545     ConvIdx = 1;
11546   } else if (Cand->Function) {
11547     ParamTypes =
11548         Cand->Function->getType()->castAs<FunctionProtoType>()->getParamTypes();
11549     if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(Cand->Function) &&
11550         !isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Cand->Function) && !Reversed) {
11551       // Conversion 0 is 'this', which doesn't have a corresponding parameter.
11552       ConvIdx = 1;
11553       if (CSK == OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Operator &&
11554           Cand->Function->getDeclName().getCXXOverloadedOperator() != OO_Call)
11555         // Argument 0 is 'this', which doesn't have a corresponding parameter.
11556         ArgIdx = 1;
11557     }
11558   } else {
11559     // Builtin operator.
11560     assert(ConvCount <= 3);
11561     ParamTypes = Cand->BuiltinParamTypes;
11562   }
11563 
11564   // Fill in the rest of the conversions.
11565   for (unsigned ParamIdx = Reversed ? ParamTypes.size() - 1 : 0;
11566        ConvIdx != ConvCount;
11567        ++ConvIdx, ++ArgIdx, ParamIdx += (Reversed ? -1 : 1)) {
11568     assert(ArgIdx < Args.size() && "no argument for this arg conversion");
11569     if (Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx].isInitialized()) {
11570       // We've already checked this conversion.
11571     } else if (ParamIdx < ParamTypes.size()) {
11572       if (ParamTypes[ParamIdx]->isDependentType())
11573         Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx].setAsIdentityConversion(
11574             Args[ArgIdx]->getType());
11575       else {
11576         Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx] =
11577             TryCopyInitialization(S, Args[ArgIdx], ParamTypes[ParamIdx],
11578                                   SuppressUserConversions,
11579                                   /*InOverloadResolution=*/true,
11580                                   /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/
11581                                   S.getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount);
11582         // Store the FixIt in the candidate if it exists.
11583         if (!Unfixable && Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx].isBad())
11584           Unfixable = !Cand->TryToFixBadConversion(ConvIdx, S);
11585       }
11586     } else
11587       Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx].setEllipsis();
11588   }
11589 }
11590 
11591 SmallVector<OverloadCandidate *, 32> OverloadCandidateSet::CompleteCandidates(
11592     Sema &S, OverloadCandidateDisplayKind OCD, ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
11593     SourceLocation OpLoc,
11594     llvm::function_ref<bool(OverloadCandidate &)> Filter) {
11595   // Sort the candidates by viability and position.  Sorting directly would
11596   // be prohibitive, so we make a set of pointers and sort those.
11597   SmallVector<OverloadCandidate*, 32> Cands;
11598   if (OCD == OCD_AllCandidates) Cands.reserve(size());
11599   for (iterator Cand = begin(), LastCand = end(); Cand != LastCand; ++Cand) {
11600     if (!Filter(*Cand))
11601       continue;
11602     switch (OCD) {
11603     case OCD_AllCandidates:
11604       if (!Cand->Viable) {
11605         if (!Cand->Function && !Cand->IsSurrogate) {
11606           // This a non-viable builtin candidate.  We do not, in general,
11607           // want to list every possible builtin candidate.
11608           continue;
11609         }
11610         CompleteNonViableCandidate(S, Cand, Args, Kind);
11611       }
11612       break;
11613 
11614     case OCD_ViableCandidates:
11615       if (!Cand->Viable)
11616         continue;
11617       break;
11618 
11619     case OCD_AmbiguousCandidates:
11620       if (!Cand->Best)
11621         continue;
11622       break;
11623     }
11624 
11625     Cands.push_back(Cand);
11626   }
11627 
11628   llvm::stable_sort(
11629       Cands, CompareOverloadCandidatesForDisplay(S, OpLoc, Args.size(), Kind));
11630 
11631   return Cands;
11632 }
11633 
11634 bool OverloadCandidateSet::shouldDeferDiags(Sema &S, ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
11635                                             SourceLocation OpLoc) {
11636   bool DeferHint = false;
11637   if (S.getLangOpts().CUDA && S.getLangOpts().GPUDeferDiag) {
11638     // Defer diagnostic for CUDA/HIP if there are wrong-sided candidates or
11639     // host device candidates.
11640     auto WrongSidedCands =
11641         CompleteCandidates(S, OCD_AllCandidates, Args, OpLoc, [](auto &Cand) {
11642           return (Cand.Viable == false &&
11643                   Cand.FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_target) ||
11644                  (Cand.Function->template hasAttr<CUDAHostAttr>() &&
11645                   Cand.Function->template hasAttr<CUDADeviceAttr>());
11646         });
11647     DeferHint = WrongSidedCands.size();
11648   }
11649   return DeferHint;
11650 }
11651 
11652 /// When overload resolution fails, prints diagnostic messages containing the
11653 /// candidates in the candidate set.
11654 void OverloadCandidateSet::NoteCandidates(
11655     PartialDiagnosticAt PD, Sema &S, OverloadCandidateDisplayKind OCD,
11656     ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, StringRef Opc, SourceLocation OpLoc,
11657     llvm::function_ref<bool(OverloadCandidate &)> Filter) {
11658 
11659   auto Cands = CompleteCandidates(S, OCD, Args, OpLoc, Filter);
11660 
11661   S.Diag(PD.first, PD.second, shouldDeferDiags(S, Args, OpLoc));
11662 
11663   NoteCandidates(S, Args, Cands, Opc, OpLoc);
11664 
11665   if (OCD == OCD_AmbiguousCandidates)
11666     MaybeDiagnoseAmbiguousConstraints(S, {begin(), end()});
11667 }
11668 
11669 void OverloadCandidateSet::NoteCandidates(Sema &S, ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
11670                                           ArrayRef<OverloadCandidate *> Cands,
11671                                           StringRef Opc, SourceLocation OpLoc) {
11672   bool ReportedAmbiguousConversions = false;
11673 
11674   const OverloadsShown ShowOverloads = S.Diags.getShowOverloads();
11675   unsigned CandsShown = 0;
11676   auto I = Cands.begin(), E = Cands.end();
11677   for (; I != E; ++I) {
11678     OverloadCandidate *Cand = *I;
11679 
11680     // Set an arbitrary limit on the number of candidate functions we'll spam
11681     // the user with.  FIXME: This limit should depend on details of the
11682     // candidate list.
11683     if (CandsShown >= 4 && ShowOverloads == Ovl_Best) {
11684       break;
11685     }
11686     ++CandsShown;
11687 
11688     if (Cand->Function)
11689       NoteFunctionCandidate(S, Cand, Args.size(),
11690                             /*TakingCandidateAddress=*/false, DestAS);
11691     else if (Cand->IsSurrogate)
11692       NoteSurrogateCandidate(S, Cand);
11693     else {
11694       assert(Cand->Viable &&
11695              "Non-viable built-in candidates are not added to Cands.");
11696       // Generally we only see ambiguities including viable builtin
11697       // operators if overload resolution got screwed up by an
11698       // ambiguous user-defined conversion.
11699       //
11700       // FIXME: It's quite possible for different conversions to see
11701       // different ambiguities, though.
11702       if (!ReportedAmbiguousConversions) {
11703         NoteAmbiguousUserConversions(S, OpLoc, Cand);
11704         ReportedAmbiguousConversions = true;
11705       }
11706 
11707       // If this is a viable builtin, print it.
11708       NoteBuiltinOperatorCandidate(S, Opc, OpLoc, Cand);
11709     }
11710   }
11711 
11712   if (I != E)
11713     S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::note_ovl_too_many_candidates,
11714            shouldDeferDiags(S, Args, OpLoc))
11715         << int(E - I);
11716 }
11717 
11718 static SourceLocation
11719 GetLocationForCandidate(const TemplateSpecCandidate *Cand) {
11720   return Cand->Specialization ? Cand->Specialization->getLocation()
11721                               : SourceLocation();
11722 }
11723 
11724 namespace {
11725 struct CompareTemplateSpecCandidatesForDisplay {
11726   Sema &S;
11727   CompareTemplateSpecCandidatesForDisplay(Sema &S) : S(S) {}
11728 
11729   bool operator()(const TemplateSpecCandidate *L,
11730                   const TemplateSpecCandidate *R) {
11731     // Fast-path this check.
11732     if (L == R)
11733       return false;
11734 
11735     // Assuming that both candidates are not matches...
11736 
11737     // Sort by the ranking of deduction failures.
11738     if (L->DeductionFailure.Result != R->DeductionFailure.Result)
11739       return RankDeductionFailure(L->DeductionFailure) <
11740              RankDeductionFailure(R->DeductionFailure);
11741 
11742     // Sort everything else by location.
11743     SourceLocation LLoc = GetLocationForCandidate(L);
11744     SourceLocation RLoc = GetLocationForCandidate(R);
11745 
11746     // Put candidates without locations (e.g. builtins) at the end.
11747     if (LLoc.isInvalid())
11748       return false;
11749     if (RLoc.isInvalid())
11750       return true;
11751 
11752     return S.SourceMgr.isBeforeInTranslationUnit(LLoc, RLoc);
11753   }
11754 };
11755 }
11756 
11757 /// Diagnose a template argument deduction failure.
11758 /// We are treating these failures as overload failures due to bad
11759 /// deductions.
11760 void TemplateSpecCandidate::NoteDeductionFailure(Sema &S,
11761                                                  bool ForTakingAddress) {
11762   DiagnoseBadDeduction(S, FoundDecl, Specialization, // pattern
11763                        DeductionFailure, /*NumArgs=*/0, ForTakingAddress);
11764 }
11765 
11766 void TemplateSpecCandidateSet::destroyCandidates() {
11767   for (iterator i = begin(), e = end(); i != e; ++i) {
11768     i->DeductionFailure.Destroy();
11769   }
11770 }
11771 
11772 void TemplateSpecCandidateSet::clear() {
11773   destroyCandidates();
11774   Candidates.clear();
11775 }
11776 
11777 /// NoteCandidates - When no template specialization match is found, prints
11778 /// diagnostic messages containing the non-matching specializations that form
11779 /// the candidate set.
11780 /// This is analoguous to OverloadCandidateSet::NoteCandidates() with
11781 /// OCD == OCD_AllCandidates and Cand->Viable == false.
11782 void TemplateSpecCandidateSet::NoteCandidates(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc) {
11783   // Sort the candidates by position (assuming no candidate is a match).
11784   // Sorting directly would be prohibitive, so we make a set of pointers
11785   // and sort those.
11786   SmallVector<TemplateSpecCandidate *, 32> Cands;
11787   Cands.reserve(size());
11788   for (iterator Cand = begin(), LastCand = end(); Cand != LastCand; ++Cand) {
11789     if (Cand->Specialization)
11790       Cands.push_back(Cand);
11791     // Otherwise, this is a non-matching builtin candidate.  We do not,
11792     // in general, want to list every possible builtin candidate.
11793   }
11794 
11795   llvm::sort(Cands, CompareTemplateSpecCandidatesForDisplay(S));
11796 
11797   // FIXME: Perhaps rename OverloadsShown and getShowOverloads()
11798   // for generalization purposes (?).
11799   const OverloadsShown ShowOverloads = S.Diags.getShowOverloads();
11800 
11801   SmallVectorImpl<TemplateSpecCandidate *>::iterator I, E;
11802   unsigned CandsShown = 0;
11803   for (I = Cands.begin(), E = Cands.end(); I != E; ++I) {
11804     TemplateSpecCandidate *Cand = *I;
11805 
11806     // Set an arbitrary limit on the number of candidates we'll spam
11807     // the user with.  FIXME: This limit should depend on details of the
11808     // candidate list.
11809     if (CandsShown >= 4 && ShowOverloads == Ovl_Best)
11810       break;
11811     ++CandsShown;
11812 
11813     assert(Cand->Specialization &&
11814            "Non-matching built-in candidates are not added to Cands.");
11815     Cand->NoteDeductionFailure(S, ForTakingAddress);
11816   }
11817 
11818   if (I != E)
11819     S.Diag(Loc, diag::note_ovl_too_many_candidates) << int(E - I);
11820 }
11821 
11822 // [PossiblyAFunctionType]  -->   [Return]
11823 // NonFunctionType --> NonFunctionType
11824 // R (A) --> R(A)
11825 // R (*)(A) --> R (A)
11826 // R (&)(A) --> R (A)
11827 // R (S::*)(A) --> R (A)
11828 QualType Sema::ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionType(QualType PossiblyAFunctionType) {
11829   QualType Ret = PossiblyAFunctionType;
11830   if (const PointerType *ToTypePtr =
11831     PossiblyAFunctionType->getAs<PointerType>())
11832     Ret = ToTypePtr->getPointeeType();
11833   else if (const ReferenceType *ToTypeRef =
11834     PossiblyAFunctionType->getAs<ReferenceType>())
11835     Ret = ToTypeRef->getPointeeType();
11836   else if (const MemberPointerType *MemTypePtr =
11837     PossiblyAFunctionType->getAs<MemberPointerType>())
11838     Ret = MemTypePtr->getPointeeType();
11839   Ret =
11840     Context.getCanonicalType(Ret).getUnqualifiedType();
11841   return Ret;
11842 }
11843 
11844 static bool completeFunctionType(Sema &S, FunctionDecl *FD, SourceLocation Loc,
11845                                  bool Complain = true) {
11846   if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus14 && FD->getReturnType()->isUndeducedType() &&
11847       S.DeduceReturnType(FD, Loc, Complain))
11848     return true;
11849 
11850   auto *FPT = FD->getType()->castAs<FunctionProtoType>();
11851   if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus17 &&
11852       isUnresolvedExceptionSpec(FPT->getExceptionSpecType()) &&
11853       !S.ResolveExceptionSpec(Loc, FPT))
11854     return true;
11855 
11856   return false;
11857 }
11858 
11859 namespace {
11860 // A helper class to help with address of function resolution
11861 // - allows us to avoid passing around all those ugly parameters
11862 class AddressOfFunctionResolver {
11863   Sema& S;
11864   Expr* SourceExpr;
11865   const QualType& TargetType;
11866   QualType TargetFunctionType; // Extracted function type from target type
11867 
11868   bool Complain;
11869   //DeclAccessPair& ResultFunctionAccessPair;
11870   ASTContext& Context;
11871 
11872   bool TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction;
11873   bool FoundNonTemplateFunction;
11874   bool StaticMemberFunctionFromBoundPointer;
11875   bool HasComplained;
11876 
11877   OverloadExpr::FindResult OvlExprInfo;
11878   OverloadExpr *OvlExpr;
11879   TemplateArgumentListInfo OvlExplicitTemplateArgs;
11880   SmallVector<std::pair<DeclAccessPair, FunctionDecl*>, 4> Matches;
11881   TemplateSpecCandidateSet FailedCandidates;
11882 
11883 public:
11884   AddressOfFunctionResolver(Sema &S, Expr *SourceExpr,
11885                             const QualType &TargetType, bool Complain)
11886       : S(S), SourceExpr(SourceExpr), TargetType(TargetType),
11887         Complain(Complain), Context(S.getASTContext()),
11888         TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction(
11889             !!TargetType->getAs<MemberPointerType>()),
11890         FoundNonTemplateFunction(false),
11891         StaticMemberFunctionFromBoundPointer(false),
11892         HasComplained(false),
11893         OvlExprInfo(OverloadExpr::find(SourceExpr)),
11894         OvlExpr(OvlExprInfo.Expression),
11895         FailedCandidates(OvlExpr->getNameLoc(), /*ForTakingAddress=*/true) {
11896     ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionTypeFromTargetType();
11897 
11898     if (TargetFunctionType->isFunctionType()) {
11899       if (UnresolvedMemberExpr *UME = dyn_cast<UnresolvedMemberExpr>(OvlExpr))
11900         if (!UME->isImplicitAccess() &&
11901             !S.ResolveSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization(UME))
11902           StaticMemberFunctionFromBoundPointer = true;
11903     } else if (OvlExpr->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) {
11904       DeclAccessPair dap;
11905       if (FunctionDecl *Fn = S.ResolveSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization(
11906               OvlExpr, false, &dap)) {
11907         if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn))
11908           if (!Method->isStatic()) {
11909             // If the target type is a non-function type and the function found
11910             // is a non-static member function, pretend as if that was the
11911             // target, it's the only possible type to end up with.
11912             TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction = true;
11913 
11914             // And skip adding the function if its not in the proper form.
11915             // We'll diagnose this due to an empty set of functions.
11916             if (!OvlExprInfo.HasFormOfMemberPointer)
11917               return;
11918           }
11919 
11920         Matches.push_back(std::make_pair(dap, Fn));
11921       }
11922       return;
11923     }
11924 
11925     if (OvlExpr->hasExplicitTemplateArgs())
11926       OvlExpr->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(OvlExplicitTemplateArgs);
11927 
11928     if (FindAllFunctionsThatMatchTargetTypeExactly()) {
11929       // C++ [over.over]p4:
11930       //   If more than one function is selected, [...]
11931       if (Matches.size() > 1 && !eliminiateSuboptimalOverloadCandidates()) {
11932         if (FoundNonTemplateFunction)
11933           EliminateAllTemplateMatches();
11934         else
11935           EliminateAllExceptMostSpecializedTemplate();
11936       }
11937     }
11938 
11939     if (S.getLangOpts().CUDA && Matches.size() > 1)
11940       EliminateSuboptimalCudaMatches();
11941   }
11942 
11943   bool hasComplained() const { return HasComplained; }
11944 
11945 private:
11946   bool candidateHasExactlyCorrectType(const FunctionDecl *FD) {
11947     QualType Discard;
11948     return Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(TargetFunctionType, FD->getType()) ||
11949            S.IsFunctionConversion(FD->getType(), TargetFunctionType, Discard);
11950   }
11951 
11952   /// \return true if A is considered a better overload candidate for the
11953   /// desired type than B.
11954   bool isBetterCandidate(const FunctionDecl *A, const FunctionDecl *B) {
11955     // If A doesn't have exactly the correct type, we don't want to classify it
11956     // as "better" than anything else. This way, the user is required to
11957     // disambiguate for us if there are multiple candidates and no exact match.
11958     return candidateHasExactlyCorrectType(A) &&
11959            (!candidateHasExactlyCorrectType(B) ||
11960             compareEnableIfAttrs(S, A, B) == Comparison::Better);
11961   }
11962 
11963   /// \return true if we were able to eliminate all but one overload candidate,
11964   /// false otherwise.
11965   bool eliminiateSuboptimalOverloadCandidates() {
11966     // Same algorithm as overload resolution -- one pass to pick the "best",
11967     // another pass to be sure that nothing is better than the best.
11968     auto Best = Matches.begin();
11969     for (auto I = Matches.begin()+1, E = Matches.end(); I != E; ++I)
11970       if (isBetterCandidate(I->second, Best->second))
11971         Best = I;
11972 
11973     const FunctionDecl *BestFn = Best->second;
11974     auto IsBestOrInferiorToBest = [this, BestFn](
11975         const std::pair<DeclAccessPair, FunctionDecl *> &Pair) {
11976       return BestFn == Pair.second || isBetterCandidate(BestFn, Pair.second);
11977     };
11978 
11979     // Note: We explicitly leave Matches unmodified if there isn't a clear best
11980     // option, so we can potentially give the user a better error
11981     if (!llvm::all_of(Matches, IsBestOrInferiorToBest))
11982       return false;
11983     Matches[0] = *Best;
11984     Matches.resize(1);
11985     return true;
11986   }
11987 
11988   bool isTargetTypeAFunction() const {
11989     return TargetFunctionType->isFunctionType();
11990   }
11991 
11992   // [ToType]     [Return]
11993 
11994   // R (*)(A) --> R (A), IsNonStaticMemberFunction = false
11995   // R (&)(A) --> R (A), IsNonStaticMemberFunction = false
11996   // R (S::*)(A) --> R (A), IsNonStaticMemberFunction = true
11997   void inline ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionTypeFromTargetType() {
11998     TargetFunctionType = S.ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionType(TargetType);
11999   }
12000 
12001   // return true if any matching specializations were found
12002   bool AddMatchingTemplateFunction(FunctionTemplateDecl* FunctionTemplate,
12003                                    const DeclAccessPair& CurAccessFunPair) {
12004     if (CXXMethodDecl *Method
12005               = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl())) {
12006       // Skip non-static function templates when converting to pointer, and
12007       // static when converting to member pointer.
12008       if (Method->isStatic() == TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction)
12009         return false;
12010     }
12011     else if (TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction)
12012       return false;
12013 
12014     // C++ [over.over]p2:
12015     //   If the name is a function template, template argument deduction is
12016     //   done (14.8.2.2), and if the argument deduction succeeds, the
12017     //   resulting template argument list is used to generate a single
12018     //   function template specialization, which is added to the set of
12019     //   overloaded functions considered.
12020     FunctionDecl *Specialization = nullptr;
12021     TemplateDeductionInfo Info(FailedCandidates.getLocation());
12022     if (Sema::TemplateDeductionResult Result
12023           = S.DeduceTemplateArguments(FunctionTemplate,
12024                                       &OvlExplicitTemplateArgs,
12025                                       TargetFunctionType, Specialization,
12026                                       Info, /*IsAddressOfFunction*/true)) {
12027       // Make a note of the failed deduction for diagnostics.
12028       FailedCandidates.addCandidate()
12029           .set(CurAccessFunPair, FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl(),
12030                MakeDeductionFailureInfo(Context, Result, Info));
12031       return false;
12032     }
12033 
12034     // Template argument deduction ensures that we have an exact match or
12035     // compatible pointer-to-function arguments that would be adjusted by ICS.
12036     // This function template specicalization works.
12037     assert(S.isSameOrCompatibleFunctionType(
12038               Context.getCanonicalType(Specialization->getType()),
12039               Context.getCanonicalType(TargetFunctionType)));
12040 
12041     if (!S.checkAddressOfFunctionIsAvailable(Specialization))
12042       return false;
12043 
12044     Matches.push_back(std::make_pair(CurAccessFunPair, Specialization));
12045     return true;
12046   }
12047 
12048   bool AddMatchingNonTemplateFunction(NamedDecl* Fn,
12049                                       const DeclAccessPair& CurAccessFunPair) {
12050     if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)) {
12051       // Skip non-static functions when converting to pointer, and static
12052       // when converting to member pointer.
12053       if (Method->isStatic() == TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction)
12054         return false;
12055     }
12056     else if (TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction)
12057       return false;
12058 
12059     if (FunctionDecl *FunDecl = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(Fn)) {
12060       if (S.getLangOpts().CUDA)
12061         if (FunctionDecl *Caller = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(S.CurContext))
12062           if (!Caller->isImplicit() && !S.IsAllowedCUDACall(Caller, FunDecl))
12063             return false;
12064       if (FunDecl->isMultiVersion()) {
12065         const auto *TA = FunDecl->getAttr<TargetAttr>();
12066         if (TA && !TA->isDefaultVersion())
12067           return false;
12068       }
12069 
12070       // If any candidate has a placeholder return type, trigger its deduction
12071       // now.
12072       if (completeFunctionType(S, FunDecl, SourceExpr->getBeginLoc(),
12073                                Complain)) {
12074         HasComplained |= Complain;
12075         return false;
12076       }
12077 
12078       if (!S.checkAddressOfFunctionIsAvailable(FunDecl))
12079         return false;
12080 
12081       // If we're in C, we need to support types that aren't exactly identical.
12082       if (!S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus ||
12083           candidateHasExactlyCorrectType(FunDecl)) {
12084         Matches.push_back(std::make_pair(
12085             CurAccessFunPair, cast<FunctionDecl>(FunDecl->getCanonicalDecl())));
12086         FoundNonTemplateFunction = true;
12087         return true;
12088       }
12089     }
12090 
12091     return false;
12092   }
12093 
12094   bool FindAllFunctionsThatMatchTargetTypeExactly() {
12095     bool Ret = false;
12096 
12097     // If the overload expression doesn't have the form of a pointer to
12098     // member, don't try to convert it to a pointer-to-member type.
12099     if (IsInvalidFormOfPointerToMemberFunction())
12100       return false;
12101 
12102     for (UnresolvedSetIterator I = OvlExpr->decls_begin(),
12103                                E = OvlExpr->decls_end();
12104          I != E; ++I) {
12105       // Look through any using declarations to find the underlying function.
12106       NamedDecl *Fn = (*I)->getUnderlyingDecl();
12107 
12108       // C++ [over.over]p3:
12109       //   Non-member functions and static member functions match
12110       //   targets of type "pointer-to-function" or "reference-to-function."
12111       //   Nonstatic member functions match targets of
12112       //   type "pointer-to-member-function."
12113       // Note that according to DR 247, the containing class does not matter.
12114       if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FunctionTemplate
12115                                         = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(Fn)) {
12116         if (AddMatchingTemplateFunction(FunctionTemplate, I.getPair()))
12117           Ret = true;
12118       }
12119       // If we have explicit template arguments supplied, skip non-templates.
12120       else if (!OvlExpr->hasExplicitTemplateArgs() &&
12121                AddMatchingNonTemplateFunction(Fn, I.getPair()))
12122         Ret = true;
12123     }
12124     assert(Ret || Matches.empty());
12125     return Ret;
12126   }
12127 
12128   void EliminateAllExceptMostSpecializedTemplate() {
12129     //   [...] and any given function template specialization F1 is
12130     //   eliminated if the set contains a second function template
12131     //   specialization whose function template is more specialized
12132     //   than the function template of F1 according to the partial
12133     //   ordering rules of 14.5.5.2.
12134 
12135     // The algorithm specified above is quadratic. We instead use a
12136     // two-pass algorithm (similar to the one used to identify the
12137     // best viable function in an overload set) that identifies the
12138     // best function template (if it exists).
12139 
12140     UnresolvedSet<4> MatchesCopy; // TODO: avoid!
12141     for (unsigned I = 0, E = Matches.size(); I != E; ++I)
12142       MatchesCopy.addDecl(Matches[I].second, Matches[I].first.getAccess());
12143 
12144     // TODO: It looks like FailedCandidates does not serve much purpose
12145     // here, since the no_viable diagnostic has index 0.
12146     UnresolvedSetIterator Result = S.getMostSpecialized(
12147         MatchesCopy.begin(), MatchesCopy.end(), FailedCandidates,
12148         SourceExpr->getBeginLoc(), S.PDiag(),
12149         S.PDiag(diag::err_addr_ovl_ambiguous)
12150             << Matches[0].second->getDeclName(),
12151         S.PDiag(diag::note_ovl_candidate)
12152             << (unsigned)oc_function << (unsigned)ocs_described_template,
12153         Complain, TargetFunctionType);
12154 
12155     if (Result != MatchesCopy.end()) {
12156       // Make it the first and only element
12157       Matches[0].first = Matches[Result - MatchesCopy.begin()].first;
12158       Matches[0].second = cast<FunctionDecl>(*Result);
12159       Matches.resize(1);
12160     } else
12161       HasComplained |= Complain;
12162   }
12163 
12164   void EliminateAllTemplateMatches() {
12165     //   [...] any function template specializations in the set are
12166     //   eliminated if the set also contains a non-template function, [...]
12167     for (unsigned I = 0, N = Matches.size(); I != N; ) {
12168       if (Matches[I].second->getPrimaryTemplate() == nullptr)
12169         ++I;
12170       else {
12171         Matches[I] = Matches[--N];
12172         Matches.resize(N);
12173       }
12174     }
12175   }
12176 
12177   void EliminateSuboptimalCudaMatches() {
12178     S.EraseUnwantedCUDAMatches(dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(S.CurContext), Matches);
12179   }
12180 
12181 public:
12182   void ComplainNoMatchesFound() const {
12183     assert(Matches.empty());
12184     S.Diag(OvlExpr->getBeginLoc(), diag::err_addr_ovl_no_viable)
12185         << OvlExpr->getName() << TargetFunctionType
12186         << OvlExpr->getSourceRange();
12187     if (FailedCandidates.empty())
12188       S.NoteAllOverloadCandidates(OvlExpr, TargetFunctionType,
12189                                   /*TakingAddress=*/true);
12190     else {
12191       // We have some deduction failure messages. Use them to diagnose
12192       // the function templates, and diagnose the non-template candidates
12193       // normally.
12194       for (UnresolvedSetIterator I = OvlExpr->decls_begin(),
12195                                  IEnd = OvlExpr->decls_end();
12196            I != IEnd; ++I)
12197         if (FunctionDecl *Fun =
12198                 dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>((*I)->getUnderlyingDecl()))
12199           if (!functionHasPassObjectSizeParams(Fun))
12200             S.NoteOverloadCandidate(*I, Fun, CRK_None, TargetFunctionType,
12201                                     /*TakingAddress=*/true);
12202       FailedCandidates.NoteCandidates(S, OvlExpr->getBeginLoc());
12203     }
12204   }
12205 
12206   bool IsInvalidFormOfPointerToMemberFunction() const {
12207     return TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction &&
12208       !OvlExprInfo.HasFormOfMemberPointer;
12209   }
12210 
12211   void ComplainIsInvalidFormOfPointerToMemberFunction() const {
12212       // TODO: Should we condition this on whether any functions might
12213       // have matched, or is it more appropriate to do that in callers?
12214       // TODO: a fixit wouldn't hurt.
12215       S.Diag(OvlExpr->getNameLoc(), diag::err_addr_ovl_no_qualifier)
12216         << TargetType << OvlExpr->getSourceRange();
12217   }
12218 
12219   bool IsStaticMemberFunctionFromBoundPointer() const {
12220     return StaticMemberFunctionFromBoundPointer;
12221   }
12222 
12223   void ComplainIsStaticMemberFunctionFromBoundPointer() const {
12224     S.Diag(OvlExpr->getBeginLoc(),
12225            diag::err_invalid_form_pointer_member_function)
12226         << OvlExpr->getSourceRange();
12227   }
12228 
12229   void ComplainOfInvalidConversion() const {
12230     S.Diag(OvlExpr->getBeginLoc(), diag::err_addr_ovl_not_func_ptrref)
12231         << OvlExpr->getName() << TargetType;
12232   }
12233 
12234   void ComplainMultipleMatchesFound() const {
12235     assert(Matches.size() > 1);
12236     S.Diag(OvlExpr->getBeginLoc(), diag::err_addr_ovl_ambiguous)
12237         << OvlExpr->getName() << OvlExpr->getSourceRange();
12238     S.NoteAllOverloadCandidates(OvlExpr, TargetFunctionType,
12239                                 /*TakingAddress=*/true);
12240   }
12241 
12242   bool hadMultipleCandidates() const { return (OvlExpr->getNumDecls() > 1); }
12243 
12244   int getNumMatches() const { return Matches.size(); }
12245 
12246   FunctionDecl* getMatchingFunctionDecl() const {
12247     if (Matches.size() != 1) return nullptr;
12248     return Matches[0].second;
12249   }
12250 
12251   const DeclAccessPair* getMatchingFunctionAccessPair() const {
12252     if (Matches.size() != 1) return nullptr;
12253     return &Matches[0].first;
12254   }
12255 };
12256 }
12257 
12258 /// ResolveAddressOfOverloadedFunction - Try to resolve the address of
12259 /// an overloaded function (C++ [over.over]), where @p From is an
12260 /// expression with overloaded function type and @p ToType is the type
12261 /// we're trying to resolve to. For example:
12262 ///
12263 /// @code
12264 /// int f(double);
12265 /// int f(int);
12266 ///
12267 /// int (*pfd)(double) = f; // selects f(double)
12268 /// @endcode
12269 ///
12270 /// This routine returns the resulting FunctionDecl if it could be
12271 /// resolved, and NULL otherwise. When @p Complain is true, this
12272 /// routine will emit diagnostics if there is an error.
12273 FunctionDecl *
12274 Sema::ResolveAddressOfOverloadedFunction(Expr *AddressOfExpr,
12275                                          QualType TargetType,
12276                                          bool Complain,
12277                                          DeclAccessPair &FoundResult,
12278                                          bool *pHadMultipleCandidates) {
12279   assert(AddressOfExpr->getType() == Context.OverloadTy);
12280 
12281   AddressOfFunctionResolver Resolver(*this, AddressOfExpr, TargetType,
12282                                      Complain);
12283   int NumMatches = Resolver.getNumMatches();
12284   FunctionDecl *Fn = nullptr;
12285   bool ShouldComplain = Complain && !Resolver.hasComplained();
12286   if (NumMatches == 0 && ShouldComplain) {
12287     if (Resolver.IsInvalidFormOfPointerToMemberFunction())
12288       Resolver.ComplainIsInvalidFormOfPointerToMemberFunction();
12289     else
12290       Resolver.ComplainNoMatchesFound();
12291   }
12292   else if (NumMatches > 1 && ShouldComplain)
12293     Resolver.ComplainMultipleMatchesFound();
12294   else if (NumMatches == 1) {
12295     Fn = Resolver.getMatchingFunctionDecl();
12296     assert(Fn);
12297     if (auto *FPT = Fn->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>())
12298       ResolveExceptionSpec(AddressOfExpr->getExprLoc(), FPT);
12299     FoundResult = *Resolver.getMatchingFunctionAccessPair();
12300     if (Complain) {
12301       if (Resolver.IsStaticMemberFunctionFromBoundPointer())
12302         Resolver.ComplainIsStaticMemberFunctionFromBoundPointer();
12303       else
12304         CheckAddressOfMemberAccess(AddressOfExpr, FoundResult);
12305     }
12306   }
12307 
12308   if (pHadMultipleCandidates)
12309     *pHadMultipleCandidates = Resolver.hadMultipleCandidates();
12310   return Fn;
12311 }
12312 
12313 /// Given an expression that refers to an overloaded function, try to
12314 /// resolve that function to a single function that can have its address taken.
12315 /// This will modify `Pair` iff it returns non-null.
12316 ///
12317 /// This routine can only succeed if from all of the candidates in the overload
12318 /// set for SrcExpr that can have their addresses taken, there is one candidate
12319 /// that is more constrained than the rest.
12320 FunctionDecl *
12321 Sema::resolveAddressOfSingleOverloadCandidate(Expr *E, DeclAccessPair &Pair) {
12322   OverloadExpr::FindResult R = OverloadExpr::find(E);
12323   OverloadExpr *Ovl = R.Expression;
12324   bool IsResultAmbiguous = false;
12325   FunctionDecl *Result = nullptr;
12326   DeclAccessPair DAP;
12327   SmallVector<FunctionDecl *, 2> AmbiguousDecls;
12328 
12329   auto CheckMoreConstrained =
12330       [&] (FunctionDecl *FD1, FunctionDecl *FD2) -> Optional<bool> {
12331         SmallVector<const Expr *, 1> AC1, AC2;
12332         FD1->getAssociatedConstraints(AC1);
12333         FD2->getAssociatedConstraints(AC2);
12334         bool AtLeastAsConstrained1, AtLeastAsConstrained2;
12335         if (IsAtLeastAsConstrained(FD1, AC1, FD2, AC2, AtLeastAsConstrained1))
12336           return None;
12337         if (IsAtLeastAsConstrained(FD2, AC2, FD1, AC1, AtLeastAsConstrained2))
12338           return None;
12339         if (AtLeastAsConstrained1 == AtLeastAsConstrained2)
12340           return None;
12341         return AtLeastAsConstrained1;
12342       };
12343 
12344   // Don't use the AddressOfResolver because we're specifically looking for
12345   // cases where we have one overload candidate that lacks
12346   // enable_if/pass_object_size/...
12347   for (auto I = Ovl->decls_begin(), E = Ovl->decls_end(); I != E; ++I) {
12348     auto *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(I->getUnderlyingDecl());
12349     if (!FD)
12350       return nullptr;
12351 
12352     if (!checkAddressOfFunctionIsAvailable(FD))
12353       continue;
12354 
12355     // We have more than one result - see if it is more constrained than the
12356     // previous one.
12357     if (Result) {
12358       Optional<bool> MoreConstrainedThanPrevious = CheckMoreConstrained(FD,
12359                                                                         Result);
12360       if (!MoreConstrainedThanPrevious) {
12361         IsResultAmbiguous = true;
12362         AmbiguousDecls.push_back(FD);
12363         continue;
12364       }
12365       if (!*MoreConstrainedThanPrevious)
12366         continue;
12367       // FD is more constrained - replace Result with it.
12368     }
12369     IsResultAmbiguous = false;
12370     DAP = I.getPair();
12371     Result = FD;
12372   }
12373 
12374   if (IsResultAmbiguous)
12375     return nullptr;
12376 
12377   if (Result) {
12378     SmallVector<const Expr *, 1> ResultAC;
12379     // We skipped over some ambiguous declarations which might be ambiguous with
12380     // the selected result.
12381     for (FunctionDecl *Skipped : AmbiguousDecls)
12382       if (!CheckMoreConstrained(Skipped, Result).hasValue())
12383         return nullptr;
12384     Pair = DAP;
12385   }
12386   return Result;
12387 }
12388 
12389 /// Given an overloaded function, tries to turn it into a non-overloaded
12390 /// function reference using resolveAddressOfSingleOverloadCandidate. This
12391 /// will perform access checks, diagnose the use of the resultant decl, and, if
12392 /// requested, potentially perform a function-to-pointer decay.
12393 ///
12394 /// Returns false if resolveAddressOfSingleOverloadCandidate fails.
12395 /// Otherwise, returns true. This may emit diagnostics and return true.
12396 bool Sema::resolveAndFixAddressOfSingleOverloadCandidate(
12397     ExprResult &SrcExpr, bool DoFunctionPointerConverion) {
12398   Expr *E = SrcExpr.get();
12399   assert(E->getType() == Context.OverloadTy && "SrcExpr must be an overload");
12400 
12401   DeclAccessPair DAP;
12402   FunctionDecl *Found = resolveAddressOfSingleOverloadCandidate(E, DAP);
12403   if (!Found || Found->isCPUDispatchMultiVersion() ||
12404       Found->isCPUSpecificMultiVersion())
12405     return false;
12406 
12407   // Emitting multiple diagnostics for a function that is both inaccessible and
12408   // unavailable is consistent with our behavior elsewhere. So, always check
12409   // for both.
12410   DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Found, E->getExprLoc());
12411   CheckAddressOfMemberAccess(E, DAP);
12412   Expr *Fixed = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(E, DAP, Found);
12413   if (DoFunctionPointerConverion && Fixed->getType()->isFunctionType())
12414     SrcExpr = DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(Fixed, /*Diagnose=*/false);
12415   else
12416     SrcExpr = Fixed;
12417   return true;
12418 }
12419 
12420 /// Given an expression that refers to an overloaded function, try to
12421 /// resolve that overloaded function expression down to a single function.
12422 ///
12423 /// This routine can only resolve template-ids that refer to a single function
12424 /// template, where that template-id refers to a single template whose template
12425 /// arguments are either provided by the template-id or have defaults,
12426 /// as described in C++0x [temp.arg.explicit]p3.
12427 ///
12428 /// If no template-ids are found, no diagnostics are emitted and NULL is
12429 /// returned.
12430 FunctionDecl *
12431 Sema::ResolveSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization(OverloadExpr *ovl,
12432                                                   bool Complain,
12433                                                   DeclAccessPair *FoundResult) {
12434   // C++ [over.over]p1:
12435   //   [...] [Note: any redundant set of parentheses surrounding the
12436   //   overloaded function name is ignored (5.1). ]
12437   // C++ [over.over]p1:
12438   //   [...] The overloaded function name can be preceded by the &
12439   //   operator.
12440 
12441   // If we didn't actually find any template-ids, we're done.
12442   if (!ovl->hasExplicitTemplateArgs())
12443     return nullptr;
12444 
12445   TemplateArgumentListInfo ExplicitTemplateArgs;
12446   ovl->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(ExplicitTemplateArgs);
12447   TemplateSpecCandidateSet FailedCandidates(ovl->getNameLoc());
12448 
12449   // Look through all of the overloaded functions, searching for one
12450   // whose type matches exactly.
12451   FunctionDecl *Matched = nullptr;
12452   for (UnresolvedSetIterator I = ovl->decls_begin(),
12453          E = ovl->decls_end(); I != E; ++I) {
12454     // C++0x [temp.arg.explicit]p3:
12455     //   [...] In contexts where deduction is done and fails, or in contexts
12456     //   where deduction is not done, if a template argument list is
12457     //   specified and it, along with any default template arguments,
12458     //   identifies a single function template specialization, then the
12459     //   template-id is an lvalue for the function template specialization.
12460     FunctionTemplateDecl *FunctionTemplate
12461       = cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>((*I)->getUnderlyingDecl());
12462 
12463     // C++ [over.over]p2:
12464     //   If the name is a function template, template argument deduction is
12465     //   done (14.8.2.2), and if the argument deduction succeeds, the
12466     //   resulting template argument list is used to generate a single
12467     //   function template specialization, which is added to the set of
12468     //   overloaded functions considered.
12469     FunctionDecl *Specialization = nullptr;
12470     TemplateDeductionInfo Info(FailedCandidates.getLocation());
12471     if (TemplateDeductionResult Result
12472           = DeduceTemplateArguments(FunctionTemplate, &ExplicitTemplateArgs,
12473                                     Specialization, Info,
12474                                     /*IsAddressOfFunction*/true)) {
12475       // Make a note of the failed deduction for diagnostics.
12476       // TODO: Actually use the failed-deduction info?
12477       FailedCandidates.addCandidate()
12478           .set(I.getPair(), FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl(),
12479                MakeDeductionFailureInfo(Context, Result, Info));
12480       continue;
12481     }
12482 
12483     assert(Specialization && "no specialization and no error?");
12484 
12485     // Multiple matches; we can't resolve to a single declaration.
12486     if (Matched) {
12487       if (Complain) {
12488         Diag(ovl->getExprLoc(), diag::err_addr_ovl_ambiguous)
12489           << ovl->getName();
12490         NoteAllOverloadCandidates(ovl);
12491       }
12492       return nullptr;
12493     }
12494 
12495     Matched = Specialization;
12496     if (FoundResult) *FoundResult = I.getPair();
12497   }
12498 
12499   if (Matched &&
12500       completeFunctionType(*this, Matched, ovl->getExprLoc(), Complain))
12501     return nullptr;
12502 
12503   return Matched;
12504 }
12505 
12506 // Resolve and fix an overloaded expression that can be resolved
12507 // because it identifies a single function template specialization.
12508 //
12509 // Last three arguments should only be supplied if Complain = true
12510 //
12511 // Return true if it was logically possible to so resolve the
12512 // expression, regardless of whether or not it succeeded.  Always
12513 // returns true if 'complain' is set.
12514 bool Sema::ResolveAndFixSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization(
12515                       ExprResult &SrcExpr, bool doFunctionPointerConverion,
12516                       bool complain, SourceRange OpRangeForComplaining,
12517                                            QualType DestTypeForComplaining,
12518                                             unsigned DiagIDForComplaining) {
12519   assert(SrcExpr.get()->getType() == Context.OverloadTy);
12520 
12521   OverloadExpr::FindResult ovl = OverloadExpr::find(SrcExpr.get());
12522 
12523   DeclAccessPair found;
12524   ExprResult SingleFunctionExpression;
12525   if (FunctionDecl *fn = ResolveSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization(
12526                            ovl.Expression, /*complain*/ false, &found)) {
12527     if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(fn, SrcExpr.get()->getBeginLoc())) {
12528       SrcExpr = ExprError();
12529       return true;
12530     }
12531 
12532     // It is only correct to resolve to an instance method if we're
12533     // resolving a form that's permitted to be a pointer to member.
12534     // Otherwise we'll end up making a bound member expression, which
12535     // is illegal in all the contexts we resolve like this.
12536     if (!ovl.HasFormOfMemberPointer &&
12537         isa<CXXMethodDecl>(fn) &&
12538         cast<CXXMethodDecl>(fn)->isInstance()) {
12539       if (!complain) return false;
12540 
12541       Diag(ovl.Expression->getExprLoc(),
12542            diag::err_bound_member_function)
12543         << 0 << ovl.Expression->getSourceRange();
12544 
12545       // TODO: I believe we only end up here if there's a mix of
12546       // static and non-static candidates (otherwise the expression
12547       // would have 'bound member' type, not 'overload' type).
12548       // Ideally we would note which candidate was chosen and why
12549       // the static candidates were rejected.
12550       SrcExpr = ExprError();
12551       return true;
12552     }
12553 
12554     // Fix the expression to refer to 'fn'.
12555     SingleFunctionExpression =
12556         FixOverloadedFunctionReference(SrcExpr.get(), found, fn);
12557 
12558     // If desired, do function-to-pointer decay.
12559     if (doFunctionPointerConverion) {
12560       SingleFunctionExpression =
12561         DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(SingleFunctionExpression.get());
12562       if (SingleFunctionExpression.isInvalid()) {
12563         SrcExpr = ExprError();
12564         return true;
12565       }
12566     }
12567   }
12568 
12569   if (!SingleFunctionExpression.isUsable()) {
12570     if (complain) {
12571       Diag(OpRangeForComplaining.getBegin(), DiagIDForComplaining)
12572         << ovl.Expression->getName()
12573         << DestTypeForComplaining
12574         << OpRangeForComplaining
12575         << ovl.Expression->getQualifierLoc().getSourceRange();
12576       NoteAllOverloadCandidates(SrcExpr.get());
12577 
12578       SrcExpr = ExprError();
12579       return true;
12580     }
12581 
12582     return false;
12583   }
12584 
12585   SrcExpr = SingleFunctionExpression;
12586   return true;
12587 }
12588 
12589 /// Add a single candidate to the overload set.
12590 static void AddOverloadedCallCandidate(Sema &S,
12591                                        DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
12592                                  TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs,
12593                                        ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
12594                                        OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet,
12595                                        bool PartialOverloading,
12596                                        bool KnownValid) {
12597   NamedDecl *Callee = FoundDecl.getDecl();
12598   if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(Callee))
12599     Callee = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(Callee)->getTargetDecl();
12600 
12601   if (FunctionDecl *Func = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(Callee)) {
12602     if (ExplicitTemplateArgs) {
12603       assert(!KnownValid && "Explicit template arguments?");
12604       return;
12605     }
12606     // Prevent ill-formed function decls to be added as overload candidates.
12607     if (!dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(Func->getType()->getAs<FunctionType>()))
12608       return;
12609 
12610     S.AddOverloadCandidate(Func, FoundDecl, Args, CandidateSet,
12611                            /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false,
12612                            PartialOverloading);
12613     return;
12614   }
12615 
12616   if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FuncTemplate
12617       = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(Callee)) {
12618     S.AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(FuncTemplate, FoundDecl,
12619                                    ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args, CandidateSet,
12620                                    /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false,
12621                                    PartialOverloading);
12622     return;
12623   }
12624 
12625   assert(!KnownValid && "unhandled case in overloaded call candidate");
12626 }
12627 
12628 /// Add the overload candidates named by callee and/or found by argument
12629 /// dependent lookup to the given overload set.
12630 void Sema::AddOverloadedCallCandidates(UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE,
12631                                        ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
12632                                        OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet,
12633                                        bool PartialOverloading) {
12634 
12635 #ifndef NDEBUG
12636   // Verify that ArgumentDependentLookup is consistent with the rules
12637   // in C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3:
12638   //
12639   //   Let X be the lookup set produced by unqualified lookup (3.4.1)
12640   //   and let Y be the lookup set produced by argument dependent
12641   //   lookup (defined as follows). If X contains
12642   //
12643   //     -- a declaration of a class member, or
12644   //
12645   //     -- a block-scope function declaration that is not a
12646   //        using-declaration, or
12647   //
12648   //     -- a declaration that is neither a function or a function
12649   //        template
12650   //
12651   //   then Y is empty.
12652 
12653   if (ULE->requiresADL()) {
12654     for (UnresolvedLookupExpr::decls_iterator I = ULE->decls_begin(),
12655            E = ULE->decls_end(); I != E; ++I) {
12656       assert(!(*I)->getDeclContext()->isRecord());
12657       assert(isa<UsingShadowDecl>(*I) ||
12658              !(*I)->getDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod());
12659       assert((*I)->getUnderlyingDecl()->isFunctionOrFunctionTemplate());
12660     }
12661   }
12662 #endif
12663 
12664   // It would be nice to avoid this copy.
12665   TemplateArgumentListInfo TABuffer;
12666   TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs = nullptr;
12667   if (ULE->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) {
12668     ULE->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TABuffer);
12669     ExplicitTemplateArgs = &TABuffer;
12670   }
12671 
12672   for (UnresolvedLookupExpr::decls_iterator I = ULE->decls_begin(),
12673          E = ULE->decls_end(); I != E; ++I)
12674     AddOverloadedCallCandidate(*this, I.getPair(), ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args,
12675                                CandidateSet, PartialOverloading,
12676                                /*KnownValid*/ true);
12677 
12678   if (ULE->requiresADL())
12679     AddArgumentDependentLookupCandidates(ULE->getName(), ULE->getExprLoc(),
12680                                          Args, ExplicitTemplateArgs,
12681                                          CandidateSet, PartialOverloading);
12682 }
12683 
12684 /// Add the call candidates from the given set of lookup results to the given
12685 /// overload set. Non-function lookup results are ignored.
12686 void Sema::AddOverloadedCallCandidates(
12687     LookupResult &R, TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs,
12688     ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet) {
12689   for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I)
12690     AddOverloadedCallCandidate(*this, I.getPair(), ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args,
12691                                CandidateSet, false, /*KnownValid*/ false);
12692 }
12693 
12694 /// Determine whether a declaration with the specified name could be moved into
12695 /// a different namespace.
12696 static bool canBeDeclaredInNamespace(const DeclarationName &Name) {
12697   switch (Name.getCXXOverloadedOperator()) {
12698   case OO_New: case OO_Array_New:
12699   case OO_Delete: case OO_Array_Delete:
12700     return false;
12701 
12702   default:
12703     return true;
12704   }
12705 }
12706 
12707 /// Attempt to recover from an ill-formed use of a non-dependent name in a
12708 /// template, where the non-dependent name was declared after the template
12709 /// was defined. This is common in code written for a compilers which do not
12710 /// correctly implement two-stage name lookup.
12711 ///
12712 /// Returns true if a viable candidate was found and a diagnostic was issued.
12713 static bool DiagnoseTwoPhaseLookup(
12714     Sema &SemaRef, SourceLocation FnLoc, const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
12715     LookupResult &R, OverloadCandidateSet::CandidateSetKind CSK,
12716     TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs, ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
12717     CXXRecordDecl **FoundInClass = nullptr) {
12718   if (!SemaRef.inTemplateInstantiation() || !SS.isEmpty())
12719     return false;
12720 
12721   for (DeclContext *DC = SemaRef.CurContext; DC; DC = DC->getParent()) {
12722     if (DC->isTransparentContext())
12723       continue;
12724 
12725     SemaRef.LookupQualifiedName(R, DC);
12726 
12727     if (!R.empty()) {
12728       R.suppressDiagnostics();
12729 
12730       OverloadCandidateSet Candidates(FnLoc, CSK);
12731       SemaRef.AddOverloadedCallCandidates(R, ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args,
12732                                           Candidates);
12733 
12734       OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
12735       OverloadingResult OR =
12736           Candidates.BestViableFunction(SemaRef, FnLoc, Best);
12737 
12738       if (auto *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DC)) {
12739         // We either found non-function declarations or a best viable function
12740         // at class scope. A class-scope lookup result disables ADL. Don't
12741         // look past this, but let the caller know that we found something that
12742         // either is, or might be, usable in this class.
12743         if (FoundInClass) {
12744           *FoundInClass = RD;
12745           if (OR == OR_Success) {
12746             R.clear();
12747             R.addDecl(Best->FoundDecl.getDecl(), Best->FoundDecl.getAccess());
12748             R.resolveKind();
12749           }
12750         }
12751         return false;
12752       }
12753 
12754       if (OR != OR_Success) {
12755         // There wasn't a unique best function or function template.
12756         return false;
12757       }
12758 
12759       // Find the namespaces where ADL would have looked, and suggest
12760       // declaring the function there instead.
12761       Sema::AssociatedNamespaceSet AssociatedNamespaces;
12762       Sema::AssociatedClassSet AssociatedClasses;
12763       SemaRef.FindAssociatedClassesAndNamespaces(FnLoc, Args,
12764                                                  AssociatedNamespaces,
12765                                                  AssociatedClasses);
12766       Sema::AssociatedNamespaceSet SuggestedNamespaces;
12767       if (canBeDeclaredInNamespace(R.getLookupName())) {
12768         DeclContext *Std = SemaRef.getStdNamespace();
12769         for (Sema::AssociatedNamespaceSet::iterator
12770                it = AssociatedNamespaces.begin(),
12771                end = AssociatedNamespaces.end(); it != end; ++it) {
12772           // Never suggest declaring a function within namespace 'std'.
12773           if (Std && Std->Encloses(*it))
12774             continue;
12775 
12776           // Never suggest declaring a function within a namespace with a
12777           // reserved name, like __gnu_cxx.
12778           NamespaceDecl *NS = dyn_cast<NamespaceDecl>(*it);
12779           if (NS &&
12780               NS->getQualifiedNameAsString().find("__") != std::string::npos)
12781             continue;
12782 
12783           SuggestedNamespaces.insert(*it);
12784         }
12785       }
12786 
12787       SemaRef.Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_not_found_by_two_phase_lookup)
12788         << R.getLookupName();
12789       if (SuggestedNamespaces.empty()) {
12790         SemaRef.Diag(Best->Function->getLocation(),
12791                      diag::note_not_found_by_two_phase_lookup)
12792           << R.getLookupName() << 0;
12793       } else if (SuggestedNamespaces.size() == 1) {
12794         SemaRef.Diag(Best->Function->getLocation(),
12795                      diag::note_not_found_by_two_phase_lookup)
12796           << R.getLookupName() << 1 << *SuggestedNamespaces.begin();
12797       } else {
12798         // FIXME: It would be useful to list the associated namespaces here,
12799         // but the diagnostics infrastructure doesn't provide a way to produce
12800         // a localized representation of a list of items.
12801         SemaRef.Diag(Best->Function->getLocation(),
12802                      diag::note_not_found_by_two_phase_lookup)
12803           << R.getLookupName() << 2;
12804       }
12805 
12806       // Try to recover by calling this function.
12807       return true;
12808     }
12809 
12810     R.clear();
12811   }
12812 
12813   return false;
12814 }
12815 
12816 /// Attempt to recover from ill-formed use of a non-dependent operator in a
12817 /// template, where the non-dependent operator was declared after the template
12818 /// was defined.
12819 ///
12820 /// Returns true if a viable candidate was found and a diagnostic was issued.
12821 static bool
12822 DiagnoseTwoPhaseOperatorLookup(Sema &SemaRef, OverloadedOperatorKind Op,
12823                                SourceLocation OpLoc,
12824                                ArrayRef<Expr *> Args) {
12825   DeclarationName OpName =
12826     SemaRef.Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(Op);
12827   LookupResult R(SemaRef, OpName, OpLoc, Sema::LookupOperatorName);
12828   return DiagnoseTwoPhaseLookup(SemaRef, OpLoc, CXXScopeSpec(), R,
12829                                 OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Operator,
12830                                 /*ExplicitTemplateArgs=*/nullptr, Args);
12831 }
12832 
12833 namespace {
12834 class BuildRecoveryCallExprRAII {
12835   Sema &SemaRef;
12836 public:
12837   BuildRecoveryCallExprRAII(Sema &S) : SemaRef(S) {
12838     assert(SemaRef.IsBuildingRecoveryCallExpr == false);
12839     SemaRef.IsBuildingRecoveryCallExpr = true;
12840   }
12841 
12842   ~BuildRecoveryCallExprRAII() {
12843     SemaRef.IsBuildingRecoveryCallExpr = false;
12844   }
12845 };
12846 
12847 }
12848 
12849 /// Attempts to recover from a call where no functions were found.
12850 ///
12851 /// This function will do one of three things:
12852 ///  * Diagnose, recover, and return a recovery expression.
12853 ///  * Diagnose, fail to recover, and return ExprError().
12854 ///  * Do not diagnose, do not recover, and return ExprResult(). The caller is
12855 ///    expected to diagnose as appropriate.
12856 static ExprResult
12857 BuildRecoveryCallExpr(Sema &SemaRef, Scope *S, Expr *Fn,
12858                       UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE,
12859                       SourceLocation LParenLoc,
12860                       MutableArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
12861                       SourceLocation RParenLoc,
12862                       bool EmptyLookup, bool AllowTypoCorrection) {
12863   // Do not try to recover if it is already building a recovery call.
12864   // This stops infinite loops for template instantiations like
12865   //
12866   // template <typename T> auto foo(T t) -> decltype(foo(t)) {}
12867   // template <typename T> auto foo(T t) -> decltype(foo(&t)) {}
12868   if (SemaRef.IsBuildingRecoveryCallExpr)
12869     return ExprResult();
12870   BuildRecoveryCallExprRAII RCE(SemaRef);
12871 
12872   CXXScopeSpec SS;
12873   SS.Adopt(ULE->getQualifierLoc());
12874   SourceLocation TemplateKWLoc = ULE->getTemplateKeywordLoc();
12875 
12876   TemplateArgumentListInfo TABuffer;
12877   TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs = nullptr;
12878   if (ULE->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) {
12879     ULE->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TABuffer);
12880     ExplicitTemplateArgs = &TABuffer;
12881   }
12882 
12883   LookupResult R(SemaRef, ULE->getName(), ULE->getNameLoc(),
12884                  Sema::LookupOrdinaryName);
12885   CXXRecordDecl *FoundInClass = nullptr;
12886   if (DiagnoseTwoPhaseLookup(SemaRef, Fn->getExprLoc(), SS, R,
12887                              OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Normal,
12888                              ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args, &FoundInClass)) {
12889     // OK, diagnosed a two-phase lookup issue.
12890   } else if (EmptyLookup) {
12891     // Try to recover from an empty lookup with typo correction.
12892     R.clear();
12893     NoTypoCorrectionCCC NoTypoValidator{};
12894     FunctionCallFilterCCC FunctionCallValidator(SemaRef, Args.size(),
12895                                                 ExplicitTemplateArgs != nullptr,
12896                                                 dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(Fn));
12897     CorrectionCandidateCallback &Validator =
12898         AllowTypoCorrection
12899             ? static_cast<CorrectionCandidateCallback &>(FunctionCallValidator)
12900             : static_cast<CorrectionCandidateCallback &>(NoTypoValidator);
12901     if (SemaRef.DiagnoseEmptyLookup(S, SS, R, Validator, ExplicitTemplateArgs,
12902                                     Args))
12903       return ExprError();
12904   } else if (FoundInClass && SemaRef.getLangOpts().MSVCCompat) {
12905     // We found a usable declaration of the name in a dependent base of some
12906     // enclosing class.
12907     // FIXME: We should also explain why the candidates found by name lookup
12908     // were not viable.
12909     if (SemaRef.DiagnoseDependentMemberLookup(R))
12910       return ExprError();
12911   } else {
12912     // We had viable candidates and couldn't recover; let the caller diagnose
12913     // this.
12914     return ExprResult();
12915   }
12916 
12917   // If we get here, we should have issued a diagnostic and formed a recovery
12918   // lookup result.
12919   assert(!R.empty() && "lookup results empty despite recovery");
12920 
12921   // If recovery created an ambiguity, just bail out.
12922   if (R.isAmbiguous()) {
12923     R.suppressDiagnostics();
12924     return ExprError();
12925   }
12926 
12927   // Build an implicit member call if appropriate.  Just drop the
12928   // casts and such from the call, we don't really care.
12929   ExprResult NewFn = ExprError();
12930   if ((*R.begin())->isCXXClassMember())
12931     NewFn = SemaRef.BuildPossibleImplicitMemberExpr(SS, TemplateKWLoc, R,
12932                                                     ExplicitTemplateArgs, S);
12933   else if (ExplicitTemplateArgs || TemplateKWLoc.isValid())
12934     NewFn = SemaRef.BuildTemplateIdExpr(SS, TemplateKWLoc, R, false,
12935                                         ExplicitTemplateArgs);
12936   else
12937     NewFn = SemaRef.BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R, false);
12938 
12939   if (NewFn.isInvalid())
12940     return ExprError();
12941 
12942   // This shouldn't cause an infinite loop because we're giving it
12943   // an expression with viable lookup results, which should never
12944   // end up here.
12945   return SemaRef.BuildCallExpr(/*Scope*/ nullptr, NewFn.get(), LParenLoc,
12946                                MultiExprArg(Args.data(), Args.size()),
12947                                RParenLoc);
12948 }
12949 
12950 /// Constructs and populates an OverloadedCandidateSet from
12951 /// the given function.
12952 /// \returns true when an the ExprResult output parameter has been set.
12953 bool Sema::buildOverloadedCallSet(Scope *S, Expr *Fn,
12954                                   UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE,
12955                                   MultiExprArg Args,
12956                                   SourceLocation RParenLoc,
12957                                   OverloadCandidateSet *CandidateSet,
12958                                   ExprResult *Result) {
12959 #ifndef NDEBUG
12960   if (ULE->requiresADL()) {
12961     // To do ADL, we must have found an unqualified name.
12962     assert(!ULE->getQualifier() && "qualified name with ADL");
12963 
12964     // We don't perform ADL for implicit declarations of builtins.
12965     // Verify that this was correctly set up.
12966     FunctionDecl *F;
12967     if (ULE->decls_begin() != ULE->decls_end() &&
12968         ULE->decls_begin() + 1 == ULE->decls_end() &&
12969         (F = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(*ULE->decls_begin())) &&
12970         F->getBuiltinID() && F->isImplicit())
12971       llvm_unreachable("performing ADL for builtin");
12972 
12973     // We don't perform ADL in C.
12974     assert(getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && "ADL enabled in C");
12975   }
12976 #endif
12977 
12978   UnbridgedCastsSet UnbridgedCasts;
12979   if (checkArgPlaceholdersForOverload(*this, Args, UnbridgedCasts)) {
12980     *Result = ExprError();
12981     return true;
12982   }
12983 
12984   // Add the functions denoted by the callee to the set of candidate
12985   // functions, including those from argument-dependent lookup.
12986   AddOverloadedCallCandidates(ULE, Args, *CandidateSet);
12987 
12988   if (getLangOpts().MSVCCompat &&
12989       CurContext->isDependentContext() && !isSFINAEContext() &&
12990       (isa<FunctionDecl>(CurContext) || isa<CXXRecordDecl>(CurContext))) {
12991 
12992     OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
12993     if (CandidateSet->empty() ||
12994         CandidateSet->BestViableFunction(*this, Fn->getBeginLoc(), Best) ==
12995             OR_No_Viable_Function) {
12996       // In Microsoft mode, if we are inside a template class member function
12997       // then create a type dependent CallExpr. The goal is to postpone name
12998       // lookup to instantiation time to be able to search into type dependent
12999       // base classes.
13000       CallExpr *CE =
13001           CallExpr::Create(Context, Fn, Args, Context.DependentTy, VK_RValue,
13002                            RParenLoc, CurFPFeatureOverrides());
13003       CE->markDependentForPostponedNameLookup();
13004       *Result = CE;
13005       return true;
13006     }
13007   }
13008 
13009   if (CandidateSet->empty())
13010     return false;
13011 
13012   UnbridgedCasts.restore();
13013   return false;
13014 }
13015 
13016 // Guess at what the return type for an unresolvable overload should be.
13017 static QualType chooseRecoveryType(OverloadCandidateSet &CS,
13018                                    OverloadCandidateSet::iterator *Best) {
13019   llvm::Optional<QualType> Result;
13020   // Adjust Type after seeing a candidate.
13021   auto ConsiderCandidate = [&](const OverloadCandidate &Candidate) {
13022     if (!Candidate.Function)
13023       return;
13024     if (Candidate.Function->isInvalidDecl())
13025       return;
13026     QualType T = Candidate.Function->getReturnType();
13027     if (T.isNull())
13028       return;
13029     if (!Result)
13030       Result = T;
13031     else if (Result != T)
13032       Result = QualType();
13033   };
13034 
13035   // Look for an unambiguous type from a progressively larger subset.
13036   // e.g. if types disagree, but all *viable* overloads return int, choose int.
13037   //
13038   // First, consider only the best candidate.
13039   if (Best && *Best != CS.end())
13040     ConsiderCandidate(**Best);
13041   // Next, consider only viable candidates.
13042   if (!Result)
13043     for (const auto &C : CS)
13044       if (C.Viable)
13045         ConsiderCandidate(C);
13046   // Finally, consider all candidates.
13047   if (!Result)
13048     for (const auto &C : CS)
13049       ConsiderCandidate(C);
13050 
13051   if (!Result)
13052     return QualType();
13053   auto Value = Result.getValue();
13054   if (Value.isNull() || Value->isUndeducedType())
13055     return QualType();
13056   return Value;
13057 }
13058 
13059 /// FinishOverloadedCallExpr - given an OverloadCandidateSet, builds and returns
13060 /// the completed call expression. If overload resolution fails, emits
13061 /// diagnostics and returns ExprError()
13062 static ExprResult FinishOverloadedCallExpr(Sema &SemaRef, Scope *S, Expr *Fn,
13063                                            UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE,
13064                                            SourceLocation LParenLoc,
13065                                            MultiExprArg Args,
13066                                            SourceLocation RParenLoc,
13067                                            Expr *ExecConfig,
13068                                            OverloadCandidateSet *CandidateSet,
13069                                            OverloadCandidateSet::iterator *Best,
13070                                            OverloadingResult OverloadResult,
13071                                            bool AllowTypoCorrection) {
13072   switch (OverloadResult) {
13073   case OR_Success: {
13074     FunctionDecl *FDecl = (*Best)->Function;
13075     SemaRef.CheckUnresolvedLookupAccess(ULE, (*Best)->FoundDecl);
13076     if (SemaRef.DiagnoseUseOfDecl(FDecl, ULE->getNameLoc()))
13077       return ExprError();
13078     Fn = SemaRef.FixOverloadedFunctionReference(Fn, (*Best)->FoundDecl, FDecl);
13079     return SemaRef.BuildResolvedCallExpr(Fn, FDecl, LParenLoc, Args, RParenLoc,
13080                                          ExecConfig, /*IsExecConfig=*/false,
13081                                          (*Best)->IsADLCandidate);
13082   }
13083 
13084   case OR_No_Viable_Function: {
13085     // Try to recover by looking for viable functions which the user might
13086     // have meant to call.
13087     ExprResult Recovery = BuildRecoveryCallExpr(SemaRef, S, Fn, ULE, LParenLoc,
13088                                                 Args, RParenLoc,
13089                                                 CandidateSet->empty(),
13090                                                 AllowTypoCorrection);
13091     if (Recovery.isInvalid() || Recovery.isUsable())
13092       return Recovery;
13093 
13094     // If the user passes in a function that we can't take the address of, we
13095     // generally end up emitting really bad error messages. Here, we attempt to
13096     // emit better ones.
13097     for (const Expr *Arg : Args) {
13098       if (!Arg->getType()->isFunctionType())
13099         continue;
13100       if (auto *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(Arg->IgnoreParenImpCasts())) {
13101         auto *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(DRE->getDecl());
13102         if (FD &&
13103             !SemaRef.checkAddressOfFunctionIsAvailable(FD, /*Complain=*/true,
13104                                                        Arg->getExprLoc()))
13105           return ExprError();
13106       }
13107     }
13108 
13109     CandidateSet->NoteCandidates(
13110         PartialDiagnosticAt(
13111             Fn->getBeginLoc(),
13112             SemaRef.PDiag(diag::err_ovl_no_viable_function_in_call)
13113                 << ULE->getName() << Fn->getSourceRange()),
13114         SemaRef, OCD_AllCandidates, Args);
13115     break;
13116   }
13117 
13118   case OR_Ambiguous:
13119     CandidateSet->NoteCandidates(
13120         PartialDiagnosticAt(Fn->getBeginLoc(),
13121                             SemaRef.PDiag(diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_call)
13122                                 << ULE->getName() << Fn->getSourceRange()),
13123         SemaRef, OCD_AmbiguousCandidates, Args);
13124     break;
13125 
13126   case OR_Deleted: {
13127     CandidateSet->NoteCandidates(
13128         PartialDiagnosticAt(Fn->getBeginLoc(),
13129                             SemaRef.PDiag(diag::err_ovl_deleted_call)
13130                                 << ULE->getName() << Fn->getSourceRange()),
13131         SemaRef, OCD_AllCandidates, Args);
13132 
13133     // We emitted an error for the unavailable/deleted function call but keep
13134     // the call in the AST.
13135     FunctionDecl *FDecl = (*Best)->Function;
13136     Fn = SemaRef.FixOverloadedFunctionReference(Fn, (*Best)->FoundDecl, FDecl);
13137     return SemaRef.BuildResolvedCallExpr(Fn, FDecl, LParenLoc, Args, RParenLoc,
13138                                          ExecConfig, /*IsExecConfig=*/false,
13139                                          (*Best)->IsADLCandidate);
13140   }
13141   }
13142 
13143   // Overload resolution failed, try to recover.
13144   SmallVector<Expr *, 8> SubExprs = {Fn};
13145   SubExprs.append(Args.begin(), Args.end());
13146   return SemaRef.CreateRecoveryExpr(Fn->getBeginLoc(), RParenLoc, SubExprs,
13147                                     chooseRecoveryType(*CandidateSet, Best));
13148 }
13149 
13150 static void markUnaddressableCandidatesUnviable(Sema &S,
13151                                                 OverloadCandidateSet &CS) {
13152   for (auto I = CS.begin(), E = CS.end(); I != E; ++I) {
13153     if (I->Viable &&
13154         !S.checkAddressOfFunctionIsAvailable(I->Function, /*Complain=*/false)) {
13155       I->Viable = false;
13156       I->FailureKind = ovl_fail_addr_not_available;
13157     }
13158   }
13159 }
13160 
13161 /// BuildOverloadedCallExpr - Given the call expression that calls Fn
13162 /// (which eventually refers to the declaration Func) and the call
13163 /// arguments Args/NumArgs, attempt to resolve the function call down
13164 /// to a specific function. If overload resolution succeeds, returns
13165 /// the call expression produced by overload resolution.
13166 /// Otherwise, emits diagnostics and returns ExprError.
13167 ExprResult Sema::BuildOverloadedCallExpr(Scope *S, Expr *Fn,
13168                                          UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE,
13169                                          SourceLocation LParenLoc,
13170                                          MultiExprArg Args,
13171                                          SourceLocation RParenLoc,
13172                                          Expr *ExecConfig,
13173                                          bool AllowTypoCorrection,
13174                                          bool CalleesAddressIsTaken) {
13175   OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(Fn->getExprLoc(),
13176                                     OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Normal);
13177   ExprResult result;
13178 
13179   if (buildOverloadedCallSet(S, Fn, ULE, Args, LParenLoc, &CandidateSet,
13180                              &result))
13181     return result;
13182 
13183   // If the user handed us something like `(&Foo)(Bar)`, we need to ensure that
13184   // functions that aren't addressible are considered unviable.
13185   if (CalleesAddressIsTaken)
13186     markUnaddressableCandidatesUnviable(*this, CandidateSet);
13187 
13188   OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
13189   OverloadingResult OverloadResult =
13190       CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, Fn->getBeginLoc(), Best);
13191 
13192   return FinishOverloadedCallExpr(*this, S, Fn, ULE, LParenLoc, Args, RParenLoc,
13193                                   ExecConfig, &CandidateSet, &Best,
13194                                   OverloadResult, AllowTypoCorrection);
13195 }
13196 
13197 static bool IsOverloaded(const UnresolvedSetImpl &Functions) {
13198   return Functions.size() > 1 ||
13199          (Functions.size() == 1 &&
13200           isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>((*Functions.begin())->getUnderlyingDecl()));
13201 }
13202 
13203 ExprResult Sema::CreateUnresolvedLookupExpr(CXXRecordDecl *NamingClass,
13204                                             NestedNameSpecifierLoc NNSLoc,
13205                                             DeclarationNameInfo DNI,
13206                                             const UnresolvedSetImpl &Fns,
13207                                             bool PerformADL) {
13208   return UnresolvedLookupExpr::Create(Context, NamingClass, NNSLoc, DNI,
13209                                       PerformADL, IsOverloaded(Fns),
13210                                       Fns.begin(), Fns.end());
13211 }
13212 
13213 /// Create a unary operation that may resolve to an overloaded
13214 /// operator.
13215 ///
13216 /// \param OpLoc The location of the operator itself (e.g., '*').
13217 ///
13218 /// \param Opc The UnaryOperatorKind that describes this operator.
13219 ///
13220 /// \param Fns The set of non-member functions that will be
13221 /// considered by overload resolution. The caller needs to build this
13222 /// set based on the context using, e.g.,
13223 /// LookupOverloadedOperatorName() and ArgumentDependentLookup(). This
13224 /// set should not contain any member functions; those will be added
13225 /// by CreateOverloadedUnaryOp().
13226 ///
13227 /// \param Input The input argument.
13228 ExprResult
13229 Sema::CreateOverloadedUnaryOp(SourceLocation OpLoc, UnaryOperatorKind Opc,
13230                               const UnresolvedSetImpl &Fns,
13231                               Expr *Input, bool PerformADL) {
13232   OverloadedOperatorKind Op = UnaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc);
13233   assert(Op != OO_None && "Invalid opcode for overloaded unary operator");
13234   DeclarationName OpName = Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(Op);
13235   // TODO: provide better source location info.
13236   DeclarationNameInfo OpNameInfo(OpName, OpLoc);
13237 
13238   if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, Input))
13239     return ExprError();
13240 
13241   Expr *Args[2] = { Input, nullptr };
13242   unsigned NumArgs = 1;
13243 
13244   // For post-increment and post-decrement, add the implicit '0' as
13245   // the second argument, so that we know this is a post-increment or
13246   // post-decrement.
13247   if (Opc == UO_PostInc || Opc == UO_PostDec) {
13248     llvm::APSInt Zero(Context.getTypeSize(Context.IntTy), false);
13249     Args[1] = IntegerLiteral::Create(Context, Zero, Context.IntTy,
13250                                      SourceLocation());
13251     NumArgs = 2;
13252   }
13253 
13254   ArrayRef<Expr *> ArgsArray(Args, NumArgs);
13255 
13256   if (Input->isTypeDependent()) {
13257     if (Fns.empty())
13258       return UnaryOperator::Create(Context, Input, Opc, Context.DependentTy,
13259                                    VK_RValue, OK_Ordinary, OpLoc, false,
13260                                    CurFPFeatureOverrides());
13261 
13262     CXXRecordDecl *NamingClass = nullptr; // lookup ignores member operators
13263     ExprResult Fn = CreateUnresolvedLookupExpr(
13264         NamingClass, NestedNameSpecifierLoc(), OpNameInfo, Fns);
13265     if (Fn.isInvalid())
13266       return ExprError();
13267     return CXXOperatorCallExpr::Create(Context, Op, Fn.get(), ArgsArray,
13268                                        Context.DependentTy, VK_RValue, OpLoc,
13269                                        CurFPFeatureOverrides());
13270   }
13271 
13272   // Build an empty overload set.
13273   OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(OpLoc, OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Operator);
13274 
13275   // Add the candidates from the given function set.
13276   AddNonMemberOperatorCandidates(Fns, ArgsArray, CandidateSet);
13277 
13278   // Add operator candidates that are member functions.
13279   AddMemberOperatorCandidates(Op, OpLoc, ArgsArray, CandidateSet);
13280 
13281   // Add candidates from ADL.
13282   if (PerformADL) {
13283     AddArgumentDependentLookupCandidates(OpName, OpLoc, ArgsArray,
13284                                          /*ExplicitTemplateArgs*/nullptr,
13285                                          CandidateSet);
13286   }
13287 
13288   // Add builtin operator candidates.
13289   AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates(Op, OpLoc, ArgsArray, CandidateSet);
13290 
13291   bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1);
13292 
13293   // Perform overload resolution.
13294   OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
13295   switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, OpLoc, Best)) {
13296   case OR_Success: {
13297     // We found a built-in operator or an overloaded operator.
13298     FunctionDecl *FnDecl = Best->Function;
13299 
13300     if (FnDecl) {
13301       Expr *Base = nullptr;
13302       // We matched an overloaded operator. Build a call to that
13303       // operator.
13304 
13305       // Convert the arguments.
13306       if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FnDecl)) {
13307         CheckMemberOperatorAccess(OpLoc, Args[0], nullptr, Best->FoundDecl);
13308 
13309         ExprResult InputRes =
13310           PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Input, /*Qualifier=*/nullptr,
13311                                               Best->FoundDecl, Method);
13312         if (InputRes.isInvalid())
13313           return ExprError();
13314         Base = Input = InputRes.get();
13315       } else {
13316         // Convert the arguments.
13317         ExprResult InputInit
13318           = PerformCopyInitialization(InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(
13319                                                       Context,
13320                                                       FnDecl->getParamDecl(0)),
13321                                       SourceLocation(),
13322                                       Input);
13323         if (InputInit.isInvalid())
13324           return ExprError();
13325         Input = InputInit.get();
13326       }
13327 
13328       // Build the actual expression node.
13329       ExprResult FnExpr = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, FnDecl, Best->FoundDecl,
13330                                                 Base, HadMultipleCandidates,
13331                                                 OpLoc);
13332       if (FnExpr.isInvalid())
13333         return ExprError();
13334 
13335       // Determine the result type.
13336       QualType ResultTy = FnDecl->getReturnType();
13337       ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy);
13338       ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
13339 
13340       Args[0] = Input;
13341       CallExpr *TheCall = CXXOperatorCallExpr::Create(
13342           Context, Op, FnExpr.get(), ArgsArray, ResultTy, VK, OpLoc,
13343           CurFPFeatureOverrides(), Best->IsADLCandidate);
13344 
13345       if (CheckCallReturnType(FnDecl->getReturnType(), OpLoc, TheCall, FnDecl))
13346         return ExprError();
13347 
13348       if (CheckFunctionCall(FnDecl, TheCall,
13349                             FnDecl->getType()->castAs<FunctionProtoType>()))
13350         return ExprError();
13351       return CheckForImmediateInvocation(MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall), FnDecl);
13352     } else {
13353       // We matched a built-in operator. Convert the arguments, then
13354       // break out so that we will build the appropriate built-in
13355       // operator node.
13356       ExprResult InputRes = PerformImplicitConversion(
13357           Input, Best->BuiltinParamTypes[0], Best->Conversions[0], AA_Passing,
13358           CCK_ForBuiltinOverloadedOp);
13359       if (InputRes.isInvalid())
13360         return ExprError();
13361       Input = InputRes.get();
13362       break;
13363     }
13364   }
13365 
13366   case OR_No_Viable_Function:
13367     // This is an erroneous use of an operator which can be overloaded by
13368     // a non-member function. Check for non-member operators which were
13369     // defined too late to be candidates.
13370     if (DiagnoseTwoPhaseOperatorLookup(*this, Op, OpLoc, ArgsArray))
13371       // FIXME: Recover by calling the found function.
13372       return ExprError();
13373 
13374     // No viable function; fall through to handling this as a
13375     // built-in operator, which will produce an error message for us.
13376     break;
13377 
13378   case OR_Ambiguous:
13379     CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(
13380         PartialDiagnosticAt(OpLoc,
13381                             PDiag(diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_oper_unary)
13382                                 << UnaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc)
13383                                 << Input->getType() << Input->getSourceRange()),
13384         *this, OCD_AmbiguousCandidates, ArgsArray,
13385         UnaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc), OpLoc);
13386     return ExprError();
13387 
13388   case OR_Deleted:
13389     CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(
13390         PartialDiagnosticAt(OpLoc, PDiag(diag::err_ovl_deleted_oper)
13391                                        << UnaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc)
13392                                        << Input->getSourceRange()),
13393         *this, OCD_AllCandidates, ArgsArray, UnaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc),
13394         OpLoc);
13395     return ExprError();
13396   }
13397 
13398   // Either we found no viable overloaded operator or we matched a
13399   // built-in operator. In either case, fall through to trying to
13400   // build a built-in operation.
13401   return CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(OpLoc, Opc, Input);
13402 }
13403 
13404 /// Perform lookup for an overloaded binary operator.
13405 void Sema::LookupOverloadedBinOp(OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet,
13406                                  OverloadedOperatorKind Op,
13407                                  const UnresolvedSetImpl &Fns,
13408                                  ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, bool PerformADL) {
13409   SourceLocation OpLoc = CandidateSet.getLocation();
13410 
13411   OverloadedOperatorKind ExtraOp =
13412       CandidateSet.getRewriteInfo().AllowRewrittenCandidates
13413           ? getRewrittenOverloadedOperator(Op)
13414           : OO_None;
13415 
13416   // Add the candidates from the given function set. This also adds the
13417   // rewritten candidates using these functions if necessary.
13418   AddNonMemberOperatorCandidates(Fns, Args, CandidateSet);
13419 
13420   // Add operator candidates that are member functions.
13421   AddMemberOperatorCandidates(Op, OpLoc, Args, CandidateSet);
13422   if (CandidateSet.getRewriteInfo().shouldAddReversed(Op))
13423     AddMemberOperatorCandidates(Op, OpLoc, {Args[1], Args[0]}, CandidateSet,
13424                                 OverloadCandidateParamOrder::Reversed);
13425 
13426   // In C++20, also add any rewritten member candidates.
13427   if (ExtraOp) {
13428     AddMemberOperatorCandidates(ExtraOp, OpLoc, Args, CandidateSet);
13429     if (CandidateSet.getRewriteInfo().shouldAddReversed(ExtraOp))
13430       AddMemberOperatorCandidates(ExtraOp, OpLoc, {Args[1], Args[0]},
13431                                   CandidateSet,
13432                                   OverloadCandidateParamOrder::Reversed);
13433   }
13434 
13435   // Add candidates from ADL. Per [over.match.oper]p2, this lookup is not
13436   // performed for an assignment operator (nor for operator[] nor operator->,
13437   // which don't get here).
13438   if (Op != OO_Equal && PerformADL) {
13439     DeclarationName OpName = Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(Op);
13440     AddArgumentDependentLookupCandidates(OpName, OpLoc, Args,
13441                                          /*ExplicitTemplateArgs*/ nullptr,
13442                                          CandidateSet);
13443     if (ExtraOp) {
13444       DeclarationName ExtraOpName =
13445           Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(ExtraOp);
13446       AddArgumentDependentLookupCandidates(ExtraOpName, OpLoc, Args,
13447                                            /*ExplicitTemplateArgs*/ nullptr,
13448                                            CandidateSet);
13449     }
13450   }
13451 
13452   // Add builtin operator candidates.
13453   //
13454   // FIXME: We don't add any rewritten candidates here. This is strictly
13455   // incorrect; a builtin candidate could be hidden by a non-viable candidate,
13456   // resulting in our selecting a rewritten builtin candidate. For example:
13457   //
13458   //   enum class E { e };
13459   //   bool operator!=(E, E) requires false;
13460   //   bool k = E::e != E::e;
13461   //
13462   // ... should select the rewritten builtin candidate 'operator==(E, E)'. But
13463   // it seems unreasonable to consider rewritten builtin candidates. A core
13464   // issue has been filed proposing to removed this requirement.
13465   AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates(Op, OpLoc, Args, CandidateSet);
13466 }
13467 
13468 /// Create a binary operation that may resolve to an overloaded
13469 /// operator.
13470 ///
13471 /// \param OpLoc The location of the operator itself (e.g., '+').
13472 ///
13473 /// \param Opc The BinaryOperatorKind that describes this operator.
13474 ///
13475 /// \param Fns The set of non-member functions that will be
13476 /// considered by overload resolution. The caller needs to build this
13477 /// set based on the context using, e.g.,
13478 /// LookupOverloadedOperatorName() and ArgumentDependentLookup(). This
13479 /// set should not contain any member functions; those will be added
13480 /// by CreateOverloadedBinOp().
13481 ///
13482 /// \param LHS Left-hand argument.
13483 /// \param RHS Right-hand argument.
13484 /// \param PerformADL Whether to consider operator candidates found by ADL.
13485 /// \param AllowRewrittenCandidates Whether to consider candidates found by
13486 ///        C++20 operator rewrites.
13487 /// \param DefaultedFn If we are synthesizing a defaulted operator function,
13488 ///        the function in question. Such a function is never a candidate in
13489 ///        our overload resolution. This also enables synthesizing a three-way
13490 ///        comparison from < and == as described in C++20 [class.spaceship]p1.
13491 ExprResult Sema::CreateOverloadedBinOp(SourceLocation OpLoc,
13492                                        BinaryOperatorKind Opc,
13493                                        const UnresolvedSetImpl &Fns, Expr *LHS,
13494                                        Expr *RHS, bool PerformADL,
13495                                        bool AllowRewrittenCandidates,
13496                                        FunctionDecl *DefaultedFn) {
13497   Expr *Args[2] = { LHS, RHS };
13498   LHS=RHS=nullptr; // Please use only Args instead of LHS/RHS couple
13499 
13500   if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus20)
13501     AllowRewrittenCandidates = false;
13502 
13503   OverloadedOperatorKind Op = BinaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc);
13504 
13505   // If either side is type-dependent, create an appropriate dependent
13506   // expression.
13507   if (Args[0]->isTypeDependent() || Args[1]->isTypeDependent()) {
13508     if (Fns.empty()) {
13509       // If there are no functions to store, just build a dependent
13510       // BinaryOperator or CompoundAssignment.
13511       if (BinaryOperator::isCompoundAssignmentOp(Opc))
13512         return CompoundAssignOperator::Create(
13513             Context, Args[0], Args[1], Opc, Context.DependentTy, VK_LValue,
13514             OK_Ordinary, OpLoc, CurFPFeatureOverrides(), Context.DependentTy,
13515             Context.DependentTy);
13516       return BinaryOperator::Create(Context, Args[0], Args[1], Opc,
13517                                     Context.DependentTy, VK_RValue, OK_Ordinary,
13518                                     OpLoc, CurFPFeatureOverrides());
13519     }
13520 
13521     // FIXME: save results of ADL from here?
13522     CXXRecordDecl *NamingClass = nullptr; // lookup ignores member operators
13523     // TODO: provide better source location info in DNLoc component.
13524     DeclarationName OpName = Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(Op);
13525     DeclarationNameInfo OpNameInfo(OpName, OpLoc);
13526     ExprResult Fn = CreateUnresolvedLookupExpr(
13527         NamingClass, NestedNameSpecifierLoc(), OpNameInfo, Fns, PerformADL);
13528     if (Fn.isInvalid())
13529       return ExprError();
13530     return CXXOperatorCallExpr::Create(Context, Op, Fn.get(), Args,
13531                                        Context.DependentTy, VK_RValue, OpLoc,
13532                                        CurFPFeatureOverrides());
13533   }
13534 
13535   // Always do placeholder-like conversions on the RHS.
13536   if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, Args[1]))
13537     return ExprError();
13538 
13539   // Do placeholder-like conversion on the LHS; note that we should
13540   // not get here with a PseudoObject LHS.
13541   assert(Args[0]->getObjectKind() != OK_ObjCProperty);
13542   if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, Args[0]))
13543     return ExprError();
13544 
13545   // If this is the assignment operator, we only perform overload resolution
13546   // if the left-hand side is a class or enumeration type. This is actually
13547   // a hack. The standard requires that we do overload resolution between the
13548   // various built-in candidates, but as DR507 points out, this can lead to
13549   // problems. So we do it this way, which pretty much follows what GCC does.
13550   // Note that we go the traditional code path for compound assignment forms.
13551   if (Opc == BO_Assign && !Args[0]->getType()->isOverloadableType())
13552     return CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Args[0], Args[1]);
13553 
13554   // If this is the .* operator, which is not overloadable, just
13555   // create a built-in binary operator.
13556   if (Opc == BO_PtrMemD)
13557     return CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Args[0], Args[1]);
13558 
13559   // Build the overload set.
13560   OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(
13561       OpLoc, OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Operator,
13562       OverloadCandidateSet::OperatorRewriteInfo(Op, AllowRewrittenCandidates));
13563   if (DefaultedFn)
13564     CandidateSet.exclude(DefaultedFn);
13565   LookupOverloadedBinOp(CandidateSet, Op, Fns, Args, PerformADL);
13566 
13567   bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1);
13568 
13569   // Perform overload resolution.
13570   OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
13571   switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, OpLoc, Best)) {
13572     case OR_Success: {
13573       // We found a built-in operator or an overloaded operator.
13574       FunctionDecl *FnDecl = Best->Function;
13575 
13576       bool IsReversed = Best->isReversed();
13577       if (IsReversed)
13578         std::swap(Args[0], Args[1]);
13579 
13580       if (FnDecl) {
13581         Expr *Base = nullptr;
13582         // We matched an overloaded operator. Build a call to that
13583         // operator.
13584 
13585         OverloadedOperatorKind ChosenOp =
13586             FnDecl->getDeclName().getCXXOverloadedOperator();
13587 
13588         // C++2a [over.match.oper]p9:
13589         //   If a rewritten operator== candidate is selected by overload
13590         //   resolution for an operator@, its return type shall be cv bool
13591         if (Best->RewriteKind && ChosenOp == OO_EqualEqual &&
13592             !FnDecl->getReturnType()->isBooleanType()) {
13593           bool IsExtension =
13594               FnDecl->getReturnType()->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType();
13595           Diag(OpLoc, IsExtension ? diag::ext_ovl_rewrite_equalequal_not_bool
13596                                   : diag::err_ovl_rewrite_equalequal_not_bool)
13597               << FnDecl->getReturnType() << BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc)
13598               << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange();
13599           Diag(FnDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_at);
13600           if (!IsExtension)
13601             return ExprError();
13602         }
13603 
13604         if (AllowRewrittenCandidates && !IsReversed &&
13605             CandidateSet.getRewriteInfo().isReversible()) {
13606           // We could have reversed this operator, but didn't. Check if some
13607           // reversed form was a viable candidate, and if so, if it had a
13608           // better conversion for either parameter. If so, this call is
13609           // formally ambiguous, and allowing it is an extension.
13610           llvm::SmallVector<FunctionDecl*, 4> AmbiguousWith;
13611           for (OverloadCandidate &Cand : CandidateSet) {
13612             if (Cand.Viable && Cand.Function && Cand.isReversed() &&
13613                 haveSameParameterTypes(Context, Cand.Function, FnDecl, 2)) {
13614               for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < 2; ++ArgIdx) {
13615                 if (CompareImplicitConversionSequences(
13616                         *this, OpLoc, Cand.Conversions[ArgIdx],
13617                         Best->Conversions[ArgIdx]) ==
13618                     ImplicitConversionSequence::Better) {
13619                   AmbiguousWith.push_back(Cand.Function);
13620                   break;
13621                 }
13622               }
13623             }
13624           }
13625 
13626           if (!AmbiguousWith.empty()) {
13627             bool AmbiguousWithSelf =
13628                 AmbiguousWith.size() == 1 &&
13629                 declaresSameEntity(AmbiguousWith.front(), FnDecl);
13630             Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_ovl_ambiguous_oper_binary_reversed)
13631                 << BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc)
13632                 << Args[0]->getType() << Args[1]->getType() << AmbiguousWithSelf
13633                 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange();
13634             if (AmbiguousWithSelf) {
13635               Diag(FnDecl->getLocation(),
13636                    diag::note_ovl_ambiguous_oper_binary_reversed_self);
13637             } else {
13638               Diag(FnDecl->getLocation(),
13639                    diag::note_ovl_ambiguous_oper_binary_selected_candidate);
13640               for (auto *F : AmbiguousWith)
13641                 Diag(F->getLocation(),
13642                      diag::note_ovl_ambiguous_oper_binary_reversed_candidate);
13643             }
13644           }
13645         }
13646 
13647         // Convert the arguments.
13648         if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FnDecl)) {
13649           // Best->Access is only meaningful for class members.
13650           CheckMemberOperatorAccess(OpLoc, Args[0], Args[1], Best->FoundDecl);
13651 
13652           ExprResult Arg1 =
13653             PerformCopyInitialization(
13654               InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context,
13655                                                      FnDecl->getParamDecl(0)),
13656               SourceLocation(), Args[1]);
13657           if (Arg1.isInvalid())
13658             return ExprError();
13659 
13660           ExprResult Arg0 =
13661             PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Args[0], /*Qualifier=*/nullptr,
13662                                                 Best->FoundDecl, Method);
13663           if (Arg0.isInvalid())
13664             return ExprError();
13665           Base = Args[0] = Arg0.getAs<Expr>();
13666           Args[1] = RHS = Arg1.getAs<Expr>();
13667         } else {
13668           // Convert the arguments.
13669           ExprResult Arg0 = PerformCopyInitialization(
13670             InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context,
13671                                                    FnDecl->getParamDecl(0)),
13672             SourceLocation(), Args[0]);
13673           if (Arg0.isInvalid())
13674             return ExprError();
13675 
13676           ExprResult Arg1 =
13677             PerformCopyInitialization(
13678               InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context,
13679                                                      FnDecl->getParamDecl(1)),
13680               SourceLocation(), Args[1]);
13681           if (Arg1.isInvalid())
13682             return ExprError();
13683           Args[0] = LHS = Arg0.getAs<Expr>();
13684           Args[1] = RHS = Arg1.getAs<Expr>();
13685         }
13686 
13687         // Build the actual expression node.
13688         ExprResult FnExpr = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, FnDecl,
13689                                                   Best->FoundDecl, Base,
13690                                                   HadMultipleCandidates, OpLoc);
13691         if (FnExpr.isInvalid())
13692           return ExprError();
13693 
13694         // Determine the result type.
13695         QualType ResultTy = FnDecl->getReturnType();
13696         ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy);
13697         ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
13698 
13699         CXXOperatorCallExpr *TheCall = CXXOperatorCallExpr::Create(
13700             Context, ChosenOp, FnExpr.get(), Args, ResultTy, VK, OpLoc,
13701             CurFPFeatureOverrides(), Best->IsADLCandidate);
13702 
13703         if (CheckCallReturnType(FnDecl->getReturnType(), OpLoc, TheCall,
13704                                 FnDecl))
13705           return ExprError();
13706 
13707         ArrayRef<const Expr *> ArgsArray(Args, 2);
13708         const Expr *ImplicitThis = nullptr;
13709         // Cut off the implicit 'this'.
13710         if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(FnDecl)) {
13711           ImplicitThis = ArgsArray[0];
13712           ArgsArray = ArgsArray.slice(1);
13713         }
13714 
13715         // Check for a self move.
13716         if (Op == OO_Equal)
13717           DiagnoseSelfMove(Args[0], Args[1], OpLoc);
13718 
13719         checkCall(FnDecl, nullptr, ImplicitThis, ArgsArray,
13720                   isa<CXXMethodDecl>(FnDecl), OpLoc, TheCall->getSourceRange(),
13721                   VariadicDoesNotApply);
13722 
13723         ExprResult R = MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall);
13724         if (R.isInvalid())
13725           return ExprError();
13726 
13727         R = CheckForImmediateInvocation(R, FnDecl);
13728         if (R.isInvalid())
13729           return ExprError();
13730 
13731         // For a rewritten candidate, we've already reversed the arguments
13732         // if needed. Perform the rest of the rewrite now.
13733         if ((Best->RewriteKind & CRK_DifferentOperator) ||
13734             (Op == OO_Spaceship && IsReversed)) {
13735           if (Op == OO_ExclaimEqual) {
13736             assert(ChosenOp == OO_EqualEqual && "unexpected operator name");
13737             R = CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(OpLoc, UO_LNot, R.get());
13738           } else {
13739             assert(ChosenOp == OO_Spaceship && "unexpected operator name");
13740             llvm::APSInt Zero(Context.getTypeSize(Context.IntTy), false);
13741             Expr *ZeroLiteral =
13742                 IntegerLiteral::Create(Context, Zero, Context.IntTy, OpLoc);
13743 
13744             Sema::CodeSynthesisContext Ctx;
13745             Ctx.Kind = Sema::CodeSynthesisContext::RewritingOperatorAsSpaceship;
13746             Ctx.Entity = FnDecl;
13747             pushCodeSynthesisContext(Ctx);
13748 
13749             R = CreateOverloadedBinOp(
13750                 OpLoc, Opc, Fns, IsReversed ? ZeroLiteral : R.get(),
13751                 IsReversed ? R.get() : ZeroLiteral, PerformADL,
13752                 /*AllowRewrittenCandidates=*/false);
13753 
13754             popCodeSynthesisContext();
13755           }
13756           if (R.isInvalid())
13757             return ExprError();
13758         } else {
13759           assert(ChosenOp == Op && "unexpected operator name");
13760         }
13761 
13762         // Make a note in the AST if we did any rewriting.
13763         if (Best->RewriteKind != CRK_None)
13764           R = new (Context) CXXRewrittenBinaryOperator(R.get(), IsReversed);
13765 
13766         return R;
13767       } else {
13768         // We matched a built-in operator. Convert the arguments, then
13769         // break out so that we will build the appropriate built-in
13770         // operator node.
13771         ExprResult ArgsRes0 = PerformImplicitConversion(
13772             Args[0], Best->BuiltinParamTypes[0], Best->Conversions[0],
13773             AA_Passing, CCK_ForBuiltinOverloadedOp);
13774         if (ArgsRes0.isInvalid())
13775           return ExprError();
13776         Args[0] = ArgsRes0.get();
13777 
13778         ExprResult ArgsRes1 = PerformImplicitConversion(
13779             Args[1], Best->BuiltinParamTypes[1], Best->Conversions[1],
13780             AA_Passing, CCK_ForBuiltinOverloadedOp);
13781         if (ArgsRes1.isInvalid())
13782           return ExprError();
13783         Args[1] = ArgsRes1.get();
13784         break;
13785       }
13786     }
13787 
13788     case OR_No_Viable_Function: {
13789       // C++ [over.match.oper]p9:
13790       //   If the operator is the operator , [...] and there are no
13791       //   viable functions, then the operator is assumed to be the
13792       //   built-in operator and interpreted according to clause 5.
13793       if (Opc == BO_Comma)
13794         break;
13795 
13796       // When defaulting an 'operator<=>', we can try to synthesize a three-way
13797       // compare result using '==' and '<'.
13798       if (DefaultedFn && Opc == BO_Cmp) {
13799         ExprResult E = BuildSynthesizedThreeWayComparison(OpLoc, Fns, Args[0],
13800                                                           Args[1], DefaultedFn);
13801         if (E.isInvalid() || E.isUsable())
13802           return E;
13803       }
13804 
13805       // For class as left operand for assignment or compound assignment
13806       // operator do not fall through to handling in built-in, but report that
13807       // no overloaded assignment operator found
13808       ExprResult Result = ExprError();
13809       StringRef OpcStr = BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc);
13810       auto Cands = CandidateSet.CompleteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates,
13811                                                    Args, OpLoc);
13812       if (Args[0]->getType()->isRecordType() &&
13813           Opc >= BO_Assign && Opc <= BO_OrAssign) {
13814         Diag(OpLoc,  diag::err_ovl_no_viable_oper)
13815              << BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc)
13816              << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange();
13817         if (Args[0]->getType()->isIncompleteType()) {
13818           Diag(OpLoc, diag::note_assign_lhs_incomplete)
13819             << Args[0]->getType()
13820             << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange();
13821         }
13822       } else {
13823         // This is an erroneous use of an operator which can be overloaded by
13824         // a non-member function. Check for non-member operators which were
13825         // defined too late to be candidates.
13826         if (DiagnoseTwoPhaseOperatorLookup(*this, Op, OpLoc, Args))
13827           // FIXME: Recover by calling the found function.
13828           return ExprError();
13829 
13830         // No viable function; try to create a built-in operation, which will
13831         // produce an error. Then, show the non-viable candidates.
13832         Result = CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Args[0], Args[1]);
13833       }
13834       assert(Result.isInvalid() &&
13835              "C++ binary operator overloading is missing candidates!");
13836       CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, Args, Cands, OpcStr, OpLoc);
13837       return Result;
13838     }
13839 
13840     case OR_Ambiguous:
13841       CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(
13842           PartialDiagnosticAt(OpLoc, PDiag(diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_oper_binary)
13843                                          << BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc)
13844                                          << Args[0]->getType()
13845                                          << Args[1]->getType()
13846                                          << Args[0]->getSourceRange()
13847                                          << Args[1]->getSourceRange()),
13848           *this, OCD_AmbiguousCandidates, Args, BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc),
13849           OpLoc);
13850       return ExprError();
13851 
13852     case OR_Deleted:
13853       if (isImplicitlyDeleted(Best->Function)) {
13854         FunctionDecl *DeletedFD = Best->Function;
13855         DefaultedFunctionKind DFK = getDefaultedFunctionKind(DeletedFD);
13856         if (DFK.isSpecialMember()) {
13857           Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_deleted_special_oper)
13858             << Args[0]->getType() << DFK.asSpecialMember();
13859         } else {
13860           assert(DFK.isComparison());
13861           Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_deleted_comparison)
13862             << Args[0]->getType() << DeletedFD;
13863         }
13864 
13865         // The user probably meant to call this special member. Just
13866         // explain why it's deleted.
13867         NoteDeletedFunction(DeletedFD);
13868         return ExprError();
13869       }
13870       CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(
13871           PartialDiagnosticAt(
13872               OpLoc, PDiag(diag::err_ovl_deleted_oper)
13873                          << getOperatorSpelling(Best->Function->getDeclName()
13874                                                     .getCXXOverloadedOperator())
13875                          << Args[0]->getSourceRange()
13876                          << Args[1]->getSourceRange()),
13877           *this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args, BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc),
13878           OpLoc);
13879       return ExprError();
13880   }
13881 
13882   // We matched a built-in operator; build it.
13883   return CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Args[0], Args[1]);
13884 }
13885 
13886 ExprResult Sema::BuildSynthesizedThreeWayComparison(
13887     SourceLocation OpLoc, const UnresolvedSetImpl &Fns, Expr *LHS, Expr *RHS,
13888     FunctionDecl *DefaultedFn) {
13889   const ComparisonCategoryInfo *Info =
13890       Context.CompCategories.lookupInfoForType(DefaultedFn->getReturnType());
13891   // If we're not producing a known comparison category type, we can't
13892   // synthesize a three-way comparison. Let the caller diagnose this.
13893   if (!Info)
13894     return ExprResult((Expr*)nullptr);
13895 
13896   // If we ever want to perform this synthesis more generally, we will need to
13897   // apply the temporary materialization conversion to the operands.
13898   assert(LHS->isGLValue() && RHS->isGLValue() &&
13899          "cannot use prvalue expressions more than once");
13900   Expr *OrigLHS = LHS;
13901   Expr *OrigRHS = RHS;
13902 
13903   // Replace the LHS and RHS with OpaqueValueExprs; we're going to refer to
13904   // each of them multiple times below.
13905   LHS = new (Context)
13906       OpaqueValueExpr(LHS->getExprLoc(), LHS->getType(), LHS->getValueKind(),
13907                       LHS->getObjectKind(), LHS);
13908   RHS = new (Context)
13909       OpaqueValueExpr(RHS->getExprLoc(), RHS->getType(), RHS->getValueKind(),
13910                       RHS->getObjectKind(), RHS);
13911 
13912   ExprResult Eq = CreateOverloadedBinOp(OpLoc, BO_EQ, Fns, LHS, RHS, true, true,
13913                                         DefaultedFn);
13914   if (Eq.isInvalid())
13915     return ExprError();
13916 
13917   ExprResult Less = CreateOverloadedBinOp(OpLoc, BO_LT, Fns, LHS, RHS, true,
13918                                           true, DefaultedFn);
13919   if (Less.isInvalid())
13920     return ExprError();
13921 
13922   ExprResult Greater;
13923   if (Info->isPartial()) {
13924     Greater = CreateOverloadedBinOp(OpLoc, BO_LT, Fns, RHS, LHS, true, true,
13925                                     DefaultedFn);
13926     if (Greater.isInvalid())
13927       return ExprError();
13928   }
13929 
13930   // Form the list of comparisons we're going to perform.
13931   struct Comparison {
13932     ExprResult Cmp;
13933     ComparisonCategoryResult Result;
13934   } Comparisons[4] =
13935   { {Eq, Info->isStrong() ? ComparisonCategoryResult::Equal
13936                           : ComparisonCategoryResult::Equivalent},
13937     {Less, ComparisonCategoryResult::Less},
13938     {Greater, ComparisonCategoryResult::Greater},
13939     {ExprResult(), ComparisonCategoryResult::Unordered},
13940   };
13941 
13942   int I = Info->isPartial() ? 3 : 2;
13943 
13944   // Combine the comparisons with suitable conditional expressions.
13945   ExprResult Result;
13946   for (; I >= 0; --I) {
13947     // Build a reference to the comparison category constant.
13948     auto *VI = Info->lookupValueInfo(Comparisons[I].Result);
13949     // FIXME: Missing a constant for a comparison category. Diagnose this?
13950     if (!VI)
13951       return ExprResult((Expr*)nullptr);
13952     ExprResult ThisResult =
13953         BuildDeclarationNameExpr(CXXScopeSpec(), DeclarationNameInfo(), VI->VD);
13954     if (ThisResult.isInvalid())
13955       return ExprError();
13956 
13957     // Build a conditional unless this is the final case.
13958     if (Result.get()) {
13959       Result = ActOnConditionalOp(OpLoc, OpLoc, Comparisons[I].Cmp.get(),
13960                                   ThisResult.get(), Result.get());
13961       if (Result.isInvalid())
13962         return ExprError();
13963     } else {
13964       Result = ThisResult;
13965     }
13966   }
13967 
13968   // Build a PseudoObjectExpr to model the rewriting of an <=> operator, and to
13969   // bind the OpaqueValueExprs before they're (repeatedly) used.
13970   Expr *SyntacticForm = BinaryOperator::Create(
13971       Context, OrigLHS, OrigRHS, BO_Cmp, Result.get()->getType(),
13972       Result.get()->getValueKind(), Result.get()->getObjectKind(), OpLoc,
13973       CurFPFeatureOverrides());
13974   Expr *SemanticForm[] = {LHS, RHS, Result.get()};
13975   return PseudoObjectExpr::Create(Context, SyntacticForm, SemanticForm, 2);
13976 }
13977 
13978 ExprResult
13979 Sema::CreateOverloadedArraySubscriptExpr(SourceLocation LLoc,
13980                                          SourceLocation RLoc,
13981                                          Expr *Base, Expr *Idx) {
13982   Expr *Args[2] = { Base, Idx };
13983   DeclarationName OpName =
13984       Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(OO_Subscript);
13985 
13986   // If either side is type-dependent, create an appropriate dependent
13987   // expression.
13988   if (Args[0]->isTypeDependent() || Args[1]->isTypeDependent()) {
13989 
13990     CXXRecordDecl *NamingClass = nullptr; // lookup ignores member operators
13991     // CHECKME: no 'operator' keyword?
13992     DeclarationNameInfo OpNameInfo(OpName, LLoc);
13993     OpNameInfo.setCXXOperatorNameRange(SourceRange(LLoc, RLoc));
13994     ExprResult Fn = CreateUnresolvedLookupExpr(
13995         NamingClass, NestedNameSpecifierLoc(), OpNameInfo, UnresolvedSet<0>());
13996     if (Fn.isInvalid())
13997       return ExprError();
13998     // Can't add any actual overloads yet
13999 
14000     return CXXOperatorCallExpr::Create(Context, OO_Subscript, Fn.get(), Args,
14001                                        Context.DependentTy, VK_RValue, RLoc,
14002                                        CurFPFeatureOverrides());
14003   }
14004 
14005   // Handle placeholders on both operands.
14006   if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, Args[0]))
14007     return ExprError();
14008   if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, Args[1]))
14009     return ExprError();
14010 
14011   // Build an empty overload set.
14012   OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(LLoc, OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Operator);
14013 
14014   // Subscript can only be overloaded as a member function.
14015 
14016   // Add operator candidates that are member functions.
14017   AddMemberOperatorCandidates(OO_Subscript, LLoc, Args, CandidateSet);
14018 
14019   // Add builtin operator candidates.
14020   AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates(OO_Subscript, LLoc, Args, CandidateSet);
14021 
14022   bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1);
14023 
14024   // Perform overload resolution.
14025   OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
14026   switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, LLoc, Best)) {
14027     case OR_Success: {
14028       // We found a built-in operator or an overloaded operator.
14029       FunctionDecl *FnDecl = Best->Function;
14030 
14031       if (FnDecl) {
14032         // We matched an overloaded operator. Build a call to that
14033         // operator.
14034 
14035         CheckMemberOperatorAccess(LLoc, Args[0], Args[1], Best->FoundDecl);
14036 
14037         // Convert the arguments.
14038         CXXMethodDecl *Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FnDecl);
14039         ExprResult Arg0 =
14040           PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Args[0], /*Qualifier=*/nullptr,
14041                                               Best->FoundDecl, Method);
14042         if (Arg0.isInvalid())
14043           return ExprError();
14044         Args[0] = Arg0.get();
14045 
14046         // Convert the arguments.
14047         ExprResult InputInit
14048           = PerformCopyInitialization(InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(
14049                                                       Context,
14050                                                       FnDecl->getParamDecl(0)),
14051                                       SourceLocation(),
14052                                       Args[1]);
14053         if (InputInit.isInvalid())
14054           return ExprError();
14055 
14056         Args[1] = InputInit.getAs<Expr>();
14057 
14058         // Build the actual expression node.
14059         DeclarationNameInfo OpLocInfo(OpName, LLoc);
14060         OpLocInfo.setCXXOperatorNameRange(SourceRange(LLoc, RLoc));
14061         ExprResult FnExpr = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, FnDecl,
14062                                                   Best->FoundDecl,
14063                                                   Base,
14064                                                   HadMultipleCandidates,
14065                                                   OpLocInfo.getLoc(),
14066                                                   OpLocInfo.getInfo());
14067         if (FnExpr.isInvalid())
14068           return ExprError();
14069 
14070         // Determine the result type
14071         QualType ResultTy = FnDecl->getReturnType();
14072         ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy);
14073         ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
14074 
14075         CXXOperatorCallExpr *TheCall = CXXOperatorCallExpr::Create(
14076             Context, OO_Subscript, FnExpr.get(), Args, ResultTy, VK, RLoc,
14077             CurFPFeatureOverrides());
14078         if (CheckCallReturnType(FnDecl->getReturnType(), LLoc, TheCall, FnDecl))
14079           return ExprError();
14080 
14081         if (CheckFunctionCall(Method, TheCall,
14082                               Method->getType()->castAs<FunctionProtoType>()))
14083           return ExprError();
14084 
14085         return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall);
14086       } else {
14087         // We matched a built-in operator. Convert the arguments, then
14088         // break out so that we will build the appropriate built-in
14089         // operator node.
14090         ExprResult ArgsRes0 = PerformImplicitConversion(
14091             Args[0], Best->BuiltinParamTypes[0], Best->Conversions[0],
14092             AA_Passing, CCK_ForBuiltinOverloadedOp);
14093         if (ArgsRes0.isInvalid())
14094           return ExprError();
14095         Args[0] = ArgsRes0.get();
14096 
14097         ExprResult ArgsRes1 = PerformImplicitConversion(
14098             Args[1], Best->BuiltinParamTypes[1], Best->Conversions[1],
14099             AA_Passing, CCK_ForBuiltinOverloadedOp);
14100         if (ArgsRes1.isInvalid())
14101           return ExprError();
14102         Args[1] = ArgsRes1.get();
14103 
14104         break;
14105       }
14106     }
14107 
14108     case OR_No_Viable_Function: {
14109       PartialDiagnostic PD = CandidateSet.empty()
14110           ? (PDiag(diag::err_ovl_no_oper)
14111              << Args[0]->getType() << /*subscript*/ 0
14112              << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange())
14113           : (PDiag(diag::err_ovl_no_viable_subscript)
14114              << Args[0]->getType() << Args[0]->getSourceRange()
14115              << Args[1]->getSourceRange());
14116       CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(PartialDiagnosticAt(LLoc, PD), *this,
14117                                   OCD_AllCandidates, Args, "[]", LLoc);
14118       return ExprError();
14119     }
14120 
14121     case OR_Ambiguous:
14122       CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(
14123           PartialDiagnosticAt(LLoc, PDiag(diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_oper_binary)
14124                                         << "[]" << Args[0]->getType()
14125                                         << Args[1]->getType()
14126                                         << Args[0]->getSourceRange()
14127                                         << Args[1]->getSourceRange()),
14128           *this, OCD_AmbiguousCandidates, Args, "[]", LLoc);
14129       return ExprError();
14130 
14131     case OR_Deleted:
14132       CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(
14133           PartialDiagnosticAt(LLoc, PDiag(diag::err_ovl_deleted_oper)
14134                                         << "[]" << Args[0]->getSourceRange()
14135                                         << Args[1]->getSourceRange()),
14136           *this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args, "[]", LLoc);
14137       return ExprError();
14138     }
14139 
14140   // We matched a built-in operator; build it.
14141   return CreateBuiltinArraySubscriptExpr(Args[0], LLoc, Args[1], RLoc);
14142 }
14143 
14144 /// BuildCallToMemberFunction - Build a call to a member
14145 /// function. MemExpr is the expression that refers to the member
14146 /// function (and includes the object parameter), Args/NumArgs are the
14147 /// arguments to the function call (not including the object
14148 /// parameter). The caller needs to validate that the member
14149 /// expression refers to a non-static member function or an overloaded
14150 /// member function.
14151 ExprResult Sema::BuildCallToMemberFunction(Scope *S, Expr *MemExprE,
14152                                            SourceLocation LParenLoc,
14153                                            MultiExprArg Args,
14154                                            SourceLocation RParenLoc,
14155                                            bool AllowRecovery) {
14156   assert(MemExprE->getType() == Context.BoundMemberTy ||
14157          MemExprE->getType() == Context.OverloadTy);
14158 
14159   // Dig out the member expression. This holds both the object
14160   // argument and the member function we're referring to.
14161   Expr *NakedMemExpr = MemExprE->IgnoreParens();
14162 
14163   // Determine whether this is a call to a pointer-to-member function.
14164   if (BinaryOperator *op = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(NakedMemExpr)) {
14165     assert(op->getType() == Context.BoundMemberTy);
14166     assert(op->getOpcode() == BO_PtrMemD || op->getOpcode() == BO_PtrMemI);
14167 
14168     QualType fnType =
14169       op->getRHS()->getType()->castAs<MemberPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
14170 
14171     const FunctionProtoType *proto = fnType->castAs<FunctionProtoType>();
14172     QualType resultType = proto->getCallResultType(Context);
14173     ExprValueKind valueKind = Expr::getValueKindForType(proto->getReturnType());
14174 
14175     // Check that the object type isn't more qualified than the
14176     // member function we're calling.
14177     Qualifiers funcQuals = proto->getMethodQuals();
14178 
14179     QualType objectType = op->getLHS()->getType();
14180     if (op->getOpcode() == BO_PtrMemI)
14181       objectType = objectType->castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
14182     Qualifiers objectQuals = objectType.getQualifiers();
14183 
14184     Qualifiers difference = objectQuals - funcQuals;
14185     difference.removeObjCGCAttr();
14186     difference.removeAddressSpace();
14187     if (difference) {
14188       std::string qualsString = difference.getAsString();
14189       Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_pointer_to_member_call_drops_quals)
14190         << fnType.getUnqualifiedType()
14191         << qualsString
14192         << (qualsString.find(' ') == std::string::npos ? 1 : 2);
14193     }
14194 
14195     CXXMemberCallExpr *call = CXXMemberCallExpr::Create(
14196         Context, MemExprE, Args, resultType, valueKind, RParenLoc,
14197         CurFPFeatureOverrides(), proto->getNumParams());
14198 
14199     if (CheckCallReturnType(proto->getReturnType(), op->getRHS()->getBeginLoc(),
14200                             call, nullptr))
14201       return ExprError();
14202 
14203     if (ConvertArgumentsForCall(call, op, nullptr, proto, Args, RParenLoc))
14204       return ExprError();
14205 
14206     if (CheckOtherCall(call, proto))
14207       return ExprError();
14208 
14209     return MaybeBindToTemporary(call);
14210   }
14211 
14212   // We only try to build a recovery expr at this level if we can preserve
14213   // the return type, otherwise we return ExprError() and let the caller
14214   // recover.
14215   auto BuildRecoveryExpr = [&](QualType Type) {
14216     if (!AllowRecovery)
14217       return ExprError();
14218     std::vector<Expr *> SubExprs = {MemExprE};
14219     llvm::for_each(Args, [&SubExprs](Expr *E) { SubExprs.push_back(E); });
14220     return CreateRecoveryExpr(MemExprE->getBeginLoc(), RParenLoc, SubExprs,
14221                               Type);
14222   };
14223   if (isa<CXXPseudoDestructorExpr>(NakedMemExpr))
14224     return CallExpr::Create(Context, MemExprE, Args, Context.VoidTy, VK_RValue,
14225                             RParenLoc, CurFPFeatureOverrides());
14226 
14227   UnbridgedCastsSet UnbridgedCasts;
14228   if (checkArgPlaceholdersForOverload(*this, Args, UnbridgedCasts))
14229     return ExprError();
14230 
14231   MemberExpr *MemExpr;
14232   CXXMethodDecl *Method = nullptr;
14233   DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = DeclAccessPair::make(nullptr, AS_public);
14234   NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier = nullptr;
14235   if (isa<MemberExpr>(NakedMemExpr)) {
14236     MemExpr = cast<MemberExpr>(NakedMemExpr);
14237     Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(MemExpr->getMemberDecl());
14238     FoundDecl = MemExpr->getFoundDecl();
14239     Qualifier = MemExpr->getQualifier();
14240     UnbridgedCasts.restore();
14241   } else {
14242     UnresolvedMemberExpr *UnresExpr = cast<UnresolvedMemberExpr>(NakedMemExpr);
14243     Qualifier = UnresExpr->getQualifier();
14244 
14245     QualType ObjectType = UnresExpr->getBaseType();
14246     Expr::Classification ObjectClassification
14247       = UnresExpr->isArrow()? Expr::Classification::makeSimpleLValue()
14248                             : UnresExpr->getBase()->Classify(Context);
14249 
14250     // Add overload candidates
14251     OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(UnresExpr->getMemberLoc(),
14252                                       OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Normal);
14253 
14254     // FIXME: avoid copy.
14255     TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer, *TemplateArgs = nullptr;
14256     if (UnresExpr->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) {
14257       UnresExpr->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TemplateArgsBuffer);
14258       TemplateArgs = &TemplateArgsBuffer;
14259     }
14260 
14261     for (UnresolvedMemberExpr::decls_iterator I = UnresExpr->decls_begin(),
14262            E = UnresExpr->decls_end(); I != E; ++I) {
14263 
14264       NamedDecl *Func = *I;
14265       CXXRecordDecl *ActingDC = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Func->getDeclContext());
14266       if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(Func))
14267         Func = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(Func)->getTargetDecl();
14268 
14269 
14270       // Microsoft supports direct constructor calls.
14271       if (getLangOpts().MicrosoftExt && isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Func)) {
14272         AddOverloadCandidate(cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Func), I.getPair(), Args,
14273                              CandidateSet,
14274                              /*SuppressUserConversions*/ false);
14275       } else if ((Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Func))) {
14276         // If explicit template arguments were provided, we can't call a
14277         // non-template member function.
14278         if (TemplateArgs)
14279           continue;
14280 
14281         AddMethodCandidate(Method, I.getPair(), ActingDC, ObjectType,
14282                            ObjectClassification, Args, CandidateSet,
14283                            /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false);
14284       } else {
14285         AddMethodTemplateCandidate(
14286             cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(Func), I.getPair(), ActingDC,
14287             TemplateArgs, ObjectType, ObjectClassification, Args, CandidateSet,
14288             /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false);
14289       }
14290     }
14291 
14292     DeclarationName DeclName = UnresExpr->getMemberName();
14293 
14294     UnbridgedCasts.restore();
14295 
14296     OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
14297     bool Succeeded = false;
14298     switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, UnresExpr->getBeginLoc(),
14299                                             Best)) {
14300     case OR_Success:
14301       Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Best->Function);
14302       FoundDecl = Best->FoundDecl;
14303       CheckUnresolvedMemberAccess(UnresExpr, Best->FoundDecl);
14304       if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Best->FoundDecl, UnresExpr->getNameLoc()))
14305         break;
14306       // If FoundDecl is different from Method (such as if one is a template
14307       // and the other a specialization), make sure DiagnoseUseOfDecl is
14308       // called on both.
14309       // FIXME: This would be more comprehensively addressed by modifying
14310       // DiagnoseUseOfDecl to accept both the FoundDecl and the decl
14311       // being used.
14312       if (Method != FoundDecl.getDecl() &&
14313                       DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Method, UnresExpr->getNameLoc()))
14314         break;
14315       Succeeded = true;
14316       break;
14317 
14318     case OR_No_Viable_Function:
14319       CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(
14320           PartialDiagnosticAt(
14321               UnresExpr->getMemberLoc(),
14322               PDiag(diag::err_ovl_no_viable_member_function_in_call)
14323                   << DeclName << MemExprE->getSourceRange()),
14324           *this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args);
14325       break;
14326     case OR_Ambiguous:
14327       CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(
14328           PartialDiagnosticAt(UnresExpr->getMemberLoc(),
14329                               PDiag(diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_member_call)
14330                                   << DeclName << MemExprE->getSourceRange()),
14331           *this, OCD_AmbiguousCandidates, Args);
14332       break;
14333     case OR_Deleted:
14334       CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(
14335           PartialDiagnosticAt(UnresExpr->getMemberLoc(),
14336                               PDiag(diag::err_ovl_deleted_member_call)
14337                                   << DeclName << MemExprE->getSourceRange()),
14338           *this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args);
14339       break;
14340     }
14341     // Overload resolution fails, try to recover.
14342     if (!Succeeded)
14343       return BuildRecoveryExpr(chooseRecoveryType(CandidateSet, &Best));
14344 
14345     MemExprE = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(MemExprE, FoundDecl, Method);
14346 
14347     // If overload resolution picked a static member, build a
14348     // non-member call based on that function.
14349     if (Method->isStatic()) {
14350       return BuildResolvedCallExpr(MemExprE, Method, LParenLoc, Args,
14351                                    RParenLoc);
14352     }
14353 
14354     MemExpr = cast<MemberExpr>(MemExprE->IgnoreParens());
14355   }
14356 
14357   QualType ResultType = Method->getReturnType();
14358   ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultType);
14359   ResultType = ResultType.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
14360 
14361   assert(Method && "Member call to something that isn't a method?");
14362   const auto *Proto = Method->getType()->castAs<FunctionProtoType>();
14363   CXXMemberCallExpr *TheCall = CXXMemberCallExpr::Create(
14364       Context, MemExprE, Args, ResultType, VK, RParenLoc,
14365       CurFPFeatureOverrides(), Proto->getNumParams());
14366 
14367   // Check for a valid return type.
14368   if (CheckCallReturnType(Method->getReturnType(), MemExpr->getMemberLoc(),
14369                           TheCall, Method))
14370     return BuildRecoveryExpr(ResultType);
14371 
14372   // Convert the object argument (for a non-static member function call).
14373   // We only need to do this if there was actually an overload; otherwise
14374   // it was done at lookup.
14375   if (!Method->isStatic()) {
14376     ExprResult ObjectArg =
14377       PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(MemExpr->getBase(), Qualifier,
14378                                           FoundDecl, Method);
14379     if (ObjectArg.isInvalid())
14380       return ExprError();
14381     MemExpr->setBase(ObjectArg.get());
14382   }
14383 
14384   // Convert the rest of the arguments
14385   if (ConvertArgumentsForCall(TheCall, MemExpr, Method, Proto, Args,
14386                               RParenLoc))
14387     return BuildRecoveryExpr(ResultType);
14388 
14389   DiagnoseSentinelCalls(Method, LParenLoc, Args);
14390 
14391   if (CheckFunctionCall(Method, TheCall, Proto))
14392     return ExprError();
14393 
14394   // In the case the method to call was not selected by the overloading
14395   // resolution process, we still need to handle the enable_if attribute. Do
14396   // that here, so it will not hide previous -- and more relevant -- errors.
14397   if (auto *MemE = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(NakedMemExpr)) {
14398     if (const EnableIfAttr *Attr =
14399             CheckEnableIf(Method, LParenLoc, Args, true)) {
14400       Diag(MemE->getMemberLoc(),
14401            diag::err_ovl_no_viable_member_function_in_call)
14402           << Method << Method->getSourceRange();
14403       Diag(Method->getLocation(),
14404            diag::note_ovl_candidate_disabled_by_function_cond_attr)
14405           << Attr->getCond()->getSourceRange() << Attr->getMessage();
14406       return ExprError();
14407     }
14408   }
14409 
14410   if ((isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(CurContext) ||
14411        isa<CXXDestructorDecl>(CurContext)) &&
14412       TheCall->getMethodDecl()->isPure()) {
14413     const CXXMethodDecl *MD = TheCall->getMethodDecl();
14414 
14415     if (isa<CXXThisExpr>(MemExpr->getBase()->IgnoreParenCasts()) &&
14416         MemExpr->performsVirtualDispatch(getLangOpts())) {
14417       Diag(MemExpr->getBeginLoc(),
14418            diag::warn_call_to_pure_virtual_member_function_from_ctor_dtor)
14419           << MD->getDeclName() << isa<CXXDestructorDecl>(CurContext)
14420           << MD->getParent();
14421 
14422       Diag(MD->getBeginLoc(), diag::note_previous_decl) << MD->getDeclName();
14423       if (getLangOpts().AppleKext)
14424         Diag(MemExpr->getBeginLoc(), diag::note_pure_qualified_call_kext)
14425             << MD->getParent() << MD->getDeclName();
14426     }
14427   }
14428 
14429   if (CXXDestructorDecl *DD =
14430           dyn_cast<CXXDestructorDecl>(TheCall->getMethodDecl())) {
14431     // a->A::f() doesn't go through the vtable, except in AppleKext mode.
14432     bool CallCanBeVirtual = !MemExpr->hasQualifier() || getLangOpts().AppleKext;
14433     CheckVirtualDtorCall(DD, MemExpr->getBeginLoc(), /*IsDelete=*/false,
14434                          CallCanBeVirtual, /*WarnOnNonAbstractTypes=*/true,
14435                          MemExpr->getMemberLoc());
14436   }
14437 
14438   return CheckForImmediateInvocation(MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall),
14439                                      TheCall->getMethodDecl());
14440 }
14441 
14442 /// BuildCallToObjectOfClassType - Build a call to an object of class
14443 /// type (C++ [over.call.object]), which can end up invoking an
14444 /// overloaded function call operator (@c operator()) or performing a
14445 /// user-defined conversion on the object argument.
14446 ExprResult
14447 Sema::BuildCallToObjectOfClassType(Scope *S, Expr *Obj,
14448                                    SourceLocation LParenLoc,
14449                                    MultiExprArg Args,
14450                                    SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
14451   if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, Obj))
14452     return ExprError();
14453   ExprResult Object = Obj;
14454 
14455   UnbridgedCastsSet UnbridgedCasts;
14456   if (checkArgPlaceholdersForOverload(*this, Args, UnbridgedCasts))
14457     return ExprError();
14458 
14459   assert(Object.get()->getType()->isRecordType() &&
14460          "Requires object type argument");
14461 
14462   // C++ [over.call.object]p1:
14463   //  If the primary-expression E in the function call syntax
14464   //  evaluates to a class object of type "cv T", then the set of
14465   //  candidate functions includes at least the function call
14466   //  operators of T. The function call operators of T are obtained by
14467   //  ordinary lookup of the name operator() in the context of
14468   //  (E).operator().
14469   OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(LParenLoc,
14470                                     OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Operator);
14471   DeclarationName OpName = Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(OO_Call);
14472 
14473   if (RequireCompleteType(LParenLoc, Object.get()->getType(),
14474                           diag::err_incomplete_object_call, Object.get()))
14475     return true;
14476 
14477   const auto *Record = Object.get()->getType()->castAs<RecordType>();
14478   LookupResult R(*this, OpName, LParenLoc, LookupOrdinaryName);
14479   LookupQualifiedName(R, Record->getDecl());
14480   R.suppressDiagnostics();
14481 
14482   for (LookupResult::iterator Oper = R.begin(), OperEnd = R.end();
14483        Oper != OperEnd; ++Oper) {
14484     AddMethodCandidate(Oper.getPair(), Object.get()->getType(),
14485                        Object.get()->Classify(Context), Args, CandidateSet,
14486                        /*SuppressUserConversion=*/false);
14487   }
14488 
14489   // C++ [over.call.object]p2:
14490   //   In addition, for each (non-explicit in C++0x) conversion function
14491   //   declared in T of the form
14492   //
14493   //        operator conversion-type-id () cv-qualifier;
14494   //
14495   //   where cv-qualifier is the same cv-qualification as, or a
14496   //   greater cv-qualification than, cv, and where conversion-type-id
14497   //   denotes the type "pointer to function of (P1,...,Pn) returning
14498   //   R", or the type "reference to pointer to function of
14499   //   (P1,...,Pn) returning R", or the type "reference to function
14500   //   of (P1,...,Pn) returning R", a surrogate call function [...]
14501   //   is also considered as a candidate function. Similarly,
14502   //   surrogate call functions are added to the set of candidate
14503   //   functions for each conversion function declared in an
14504   //   accessible base class provided the function is not hidden
14505   //   within T by another intervening declaration.
14506   const auto &Conversions =
14507       cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Record->getDecl())->getVisibleConversionFunctions();
14508   for (auto I = Conversions.begin(), E = Conversions.end(); I != E; ++I) {
14509     NamedDecl *D = *I;
14510     CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D->getDeclContext());
14511     if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D))
14512       D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl();
14513 
14514     // Skip over templated conversion functions; they aren't
14515     // surrogates.
14516     if (isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D))
14517       continue;
14518 
14519     CXXConversionDecl *Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D);
14520     if (!Conv->isExplicit()) {
14521       // Strip the reference type (if any) and then the pointer type (if
14522       // any) to get down to what might be a function type.
14523       QualType ConvType = Conv->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType();
14524       if (const PointerType *ConvPtrType = ConvType->getAs<PointerType>())
14525         ConvType = ConvPtrType->getPointeeType();
14526 
14527       if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto = ConvType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>())
14528       {
14529         AddSurrogateCandidate(Conv, I.getPair(), ActingContext, Proto,
14530                               Object.get(), Args, CandidateSet);
14531       }
14532     }
14533   }
14534 
14535   bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1);
14536 
14537   // Perform overload resolution.
14538   OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
14539   switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, Object.get()->getBeginLoc(),
14540                                           Best)) {
14541   case OR_Success:
14542     // Overload resolution succeeded; we'll build the appropriate call
14543     // below.
14544     break;
14545 
14546   case OR_No_Viable_Function: {
14547     PartialDiagnostic PD =
14548         CandidateSet.empty()
14549             ? (PDiag(diag::err_ovl_no_oper)
14550                << Object.get()->getType() << /*call*/ 1
14551                << Object.get()->getSourceRange())
14552             : (PDiag(diag::err_ovl_no_viable_object_call)
14553                << Object.get()->getType() << Object.get()->getSourceRange());
14554     CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(
14555         PartialDiagnosticAt(Object.get()->getBeginLoc(), PD), *this,
14556         OCD_AllCandidates, Args);
14557     break;
14558   }
14559   case OR_Ambiguous:
14560     CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(
14561         PartialDiagnosticAt(Object.get()->getBeginLoc(),
14562                             PDiag(diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_object_call)
14563                                 << Object.get()->getType()
14564                                 << Object.get()->getSourceRange()),
14565         *this, OCD_AmbiguousCandidates, Args);
14566     break;
14567 
14568   case OR_Deleted:
14569     CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(
14570         PartialDiagnosticAt(Object.get()->getBeginLoc(),
14571                             PDiag(diag::err_ovl_deleted_object_call)
14572                                 << Object.get()->getType()
14573                                 << Object.get()->getSourceRange()),
14574         *this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args);
14575     break;
14576   }
14577 
14578   if (Best == CandidateSet.end())
14579     return true;
14580 
14581   UnbridgedCasts.restore();
14582 
14583   if (Best->Function == nullptr) {
14584     // Since there is no function declaration, this is one of the
14585     // surrogate candidates. Dig out the conversion function.
14586     CXXConversionDecl *Conv
14587       = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(
14588                          Best->Conversions[0].UserDefined.ConversionFunction);
14589 
14590     CheckMemberOperatorAccess(LParenLoc, Object.get(), nullptr,
14591                               Best->FoundDecl);
14592     if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Best->FoundDecl, LParenLoc))
14593       return ExprError();
14594     assert(Conv == Best->FoundDecl.getDecl() &&
14595              "Found Decl & conversion-to-functionptr should be same, right?!");
14596     // We selected one of the surrogate functions that converts the
14597     // object parameter to a function pointer. Perform the conversion
14598     // on the object argument, then let BuildCallExpr finish the job.
14599 
14600     // Create an implicit member expr to refer to the conversion operator.
14601     // and then call it.
14602     ExprResult Call = BuildCXXMemberCallExpr(Object.get(), Best->FoundDecl,
14603                                              Conv, HadMultipleCandidates);
14604     if (Call.isInvalid())
14605       return ExprError();
14606     // Record usage of conversion in an implicit cast.
14607     Call = ImplicitCastExpr::Create(
14608         Context, Call.get()->getType(), CK_UserDefinedConversion, Call.get(),
14609         nullptr, VK_RValue, CurFPFeatureOverrides());
14610 
14611     return BuildCallExpr(S, Call.get(), LParenLoc, Args, RParenLoc);
14612   }
14613 
14614   CheckMemberOperatorAccess(LParenLoc, Object.get(), nullptr, Best->FoundDecl);
14615 
14616   // We found an overloaded operator(). Build a CXXOperatorCallExpr
14617   // that calls this method, using Object for the implicit object
14618   // parameter and passing along the remaining arguments.
14619   CXXMethodDecl *Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Best->Function);
14620 
14621   // An error diagnostic has already been printed when parsing the declaration.
14622   if (Method->isInvalidDecl())
14623     return ExprError();
14624 
14625   const auto *Proto = Method->getType()->castAs<FunctionProtoType>();
14626   unsigned NumParams = Proto->getNumParams();
14627 
14628   DeclarationNameInfo OpLocInfo(
14629                Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(OO_Call), LParenLoc);
14630   OpLocInfo.setCXXOperatorNameRange(SourceRange(LParenLoc, RParenLoc));
14631   ExprResult NewFn = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, Method, Best->FoundDecl,
14632                                            Obj, HadMultipleCandidates,
14633                                            OpLocInfo.getLoc(),
14634                                            OpLocInfo.getInfo());
14635   if (NewFn.isInvalid())
14636     return true;
14637 
14638   // The number of argument slots to allocate in the call. If we have default
14639   // arguments we need to allocate space for them as well. We additionally
14640   // need one more slot for the object parameter.
14641   unsigned NumArgsSlots = 1 + std::max<unsigned>(Args.size(), NumParams);
14642 
14643   // Build the full argument list for the method call (the implicit object
14644   // parameter is placed at the beginning of the list).
14645   SmallVector<Expr *, 8> MethodArgs(NumArgsSlots);
14646 
14647   bool IsError = false;
14648 
14649   // Initialize the implicit object parameter.
14650   ExprResult ObjRes =
14651     PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Object.get(), /*Qualifier=*/nullptr,
14652                                         Best->FoundDecl, Method);
14653   if (ObjRes.isInvalid())
14654     IsError = true;
14655   else
14656     Object = ObjRes;
14657   MethodArgs[0] = Object.get();
14658 
14659   // Check the argument types.
14660   for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumParams; i++) {
14661     Expr *Arg;
14662     if (i < Args.size()) {
14663       Arg = Args[i];
14664 
14665       // Pass the argument.
14666 
14667       ExprResult InputInit
14668         = PerformCopyInitialization(InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(
14669                                                     Context,
14670                                                     Method->getParamDecl(i)),
14671                                     SourceLocation(), Arg);
14672 
14673       IsError |= InputInit.isInvalid();
14674       Arg = InputInit.getAs<Expr>();
14675     } else {
14676       ExprResult DefArg
14677         = BuildCXXDefaultArgExpr(LParenLoc, Method, Method->getParamDecl(i));
14678       if (DefArg.isInvalid()) {
14679         IsError = true;
14680         break;
14681       }
14682 
14683       Arg = DefArg.getAs<Expr>();
14684     }
14685 
14686     MethodArgs[i + 1] = Arg;
14687   }
14688 
14689   // If this is a variadic call, handle args passed through "...".
14690   if (Proto->isVariadic()) {
14691     // Promote the arguments (C99 6.5.2.2p7).
14692     for (unsigned i = NumParams, e = Args.size(); i < e; i++) {
14693       ExprResult Arg = DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion(Args[i], VariadicMethod,
14694                                                         nullptr);
14695       IsError |= Arg.isInvalid();
14696       MethodArgs[i + 1] = Arg.get();
14697     }
14698   }
14699 
14700   if (IsError)
14701     return true;
14702 
14703   DiagnoseSentinelCalls(Method, LParenLoc, Args);
14704 
14705   // Once we've built TheCall, all of the expressions are properly owned.
14706   QualType ResultTy = Method->getReturnType();
14707   ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy);
14708   ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
14709 
14710   CXXOperatorCallExpr *TheCall = CXXOperatorCallExpr::Create(
14711       Context, OO_Call, NewFn.get(), MethodArgs, ResultTy, VK, RParenLoc,
14712       CurFPFeatureOverrides());
14713 
14714   if (CheckCallReturnType(Method->getReturnType(), LParenLoc, TheCall, Method))
14715     return true;
14716 
14717   if (CheckFunctionCall(Method, TheCall, Proto))
14718     return true;
14719 
14720   return CheckForImmediateInvocation(MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall), Method);
14721 }
14722 
14723 /// BuildOverloadedArrowExpr - Build a call to an overloaded @c operator->
14724 ///  (if one exists), where @c Base is an expression of class type and
14725 /// @c Member is the name of the member we're trying to find.
14726 ExprResult
14727 Sema::BuildOverloadedArrowExpr(Scope *S, Expr *Base, SourceLocation OpLoc,
14728                                bool *NoArrowOperatorFound) {
14729   assert(Base->getType()->isRecordType() &&
14730          "left-hand side must have class type");
14731 
14732   if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, Base))
14733     return ExprError();
14734 
14735   SourceLocation Loc = Base->getExprLoc();
14736 
14737   // C++ [over.ref]p1:
14738   //
14739   //   [...] An expression x->m is interpreted as (x.operator->())->m
14740   //   for a class object x of type T if T::operator->() exists and if
14741   //   the operator is selected as the best match function by the
14742   //   overload resolution mechanism (13.3).
14743   DeclarationName OpName =
14744     Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(OO_Arrow);
14745   OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(Loc, OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Operator);
14746 
14747   if (RequireCompleteType(Loc, Base->getType(),
14748                           diag::err_typecheck_incomplete_tag, Base))
14749     return ExprError();
14750 
14751   LookupResult R(*this, OpName, OpLoc, LookupOrdinaryName);
14752   LookupQualifiedName(R, Base->getType()->castAs<RecordType>()->getDecl());
14753   R.suppressDiagnostics();
14754 
14755   for (LookupResult::iterator Oper = R.begin(), OperEnd = R.end();
14756        Oper != OperEnd; ++Oper) {
14757     AddMethodCandidate(Oper.getPair(), Base->getType(), Base->Classify(Context),
14758                        None, CandidateSet, /*SuppressUserConversion=*/false);
14759   }
14760 
14761   bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1);
14762 
14763   // Perform overload resolution.
14764   OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
14765   switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, OpLoc, Best)) {
14766   case OR_Success:
14767     // Overload resolution succeeded; we'll build the call below.
14768     break;
14769 
14770   case OR_No_Viable_Function: {
14771     auto Cands = CandidateSet.CompleteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Base);
14772     if (CandidateSet.empty()) {
14773       QualType BaseType = Base->getType();
14774       if (NoArrowOperatorFound) {
14775         // Report this specific error to the caller instead of emitting a
14776         // diagnostic, as requested.
14777         *NoArrowOperatorFound = true;
14778         return ExprError();
14779       }
14780       Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_arrow)
14781         << BaseType << Base->getSourceRange();
14782       if (BaseType->isRecordType() && !BaseType->isPointerType()) {
14783         Diag(OpLoc, diag::note_typecheck_member_reference_suggestion)
14784           << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(OpLoc, ".");
14785       }
14786     } else
14787       Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_no_viable_oper)
14788         << "operator->" << Base->getSourceRange();
14789     CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, Base, Cands);
14790     return ExprError();
14791   }
14792   case OR_Ambiguous:
14793     CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(
14794         PartialDiagnosticAt(OpLoc, PDiag(diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_oper_unary)
14795                                        << "->" << Base->getType()
14796                                        << Base->getSourceRange()),
14797         *this, OCD_AmbiguousCandidates, Base);
14798     return ExprError();
14799 
14800   case OR_Deleted:
14801     CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(
14802         PartialDiagnosticAt(OpLoc, PDiag(diag::err_ovl_deleted_oper)
14803                                        << "->" << Base->getSourceRange()),
14804         *this, OCD_AllCandidates, Base);
14805     return ExprError();
14806   }
14807 
14808   CheckMemberOperatorAccess(OpLoc, Base, nullptr, Best->FoundDecl);
14809 
14810   // Convert the object parameter.
14811   CXXMethodDecl *Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Best->Function);
14812   ExprResult BaseResult =
14813     PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Base, /*Qualifier=*/nullptr,
14814                                         Best->FoundDecl, Method);
14815   if (BaseResult.isInvalid())
14816     return ExprError();
14817   Base = BaseResult.get();
14818 
14819   // Build the operator call.
14820   ExprResult FnExpr = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, Method, Best->FoundDecl,
14821                                             Base, HadMultipleCandidates, OpLoc);
14822   if (FnExpr.isInvalid())
14823     return ExprError();
14824 
14825   QualType ResultTy = Method->getReturnType();
14826   ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy);
14827   ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
14828   CXXOperatorCallExpr *TheCall =
14829       CXXOperatorCallExpr::Create(Context, OO_Arrow, FnExpr.get(), Base,
14830                                   ResultTy, VK, OpLoc, CurFPFeatureOverrides());
14831 
14832   if (CheckCallReturnType(Method->getReturnType(), OpLoc, TheCall, Method))
14833     return ExprError();
14834 
14835   if (CheckFunctionCall(Method, TheCall,
14836                         Method->getType()->castAs<FunctionProtoType>()))
14837     return ExprError();
14838 
14839   return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall);
14840 }
14841 
14842 /// BuildLiteralOperatorCall - Build a UserDefinedLiteral by creating a call to
14843 /// a literal operator described by the provided lookup results.
14844 ExprResult Sema::BuildLiteralOperatorCall(LookupResult &R,
14845                                           DeclarationNameInfo &SuffixInfo,
14846                                           ArrayRef<Expr*> Args,
14847                                           SourceLocation LitEndLoc,
14848                                        TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs) {
14849   SourceLocation UDSuffixLoc = SuffixInfo.getCXXLiteralOperatorNameLoc();
14850 
14851   OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(UDSuffixLoc,
14852                                     OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Normal);
14853   AddNonMemberOperatorCandidates(R.asUnresolvedSet(), Args, CandidateSet,
14854                                  TemplateArgs);
14855 
14856   bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1);
14857 
14858   // Perform overload resolution. This will usually be trivial, but might need
14859   // to perform substitutions for a literal operator template.
14860   OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
14861   switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, UDSuffixLoc, Best)) {
14862   case OR_Success:
14863   case OR_Deleted:
14864     break;
14865 
14866   case OR_No_Viable_Function:
14867     CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(
14868         PartialDiagnosticAt(UDSuffixLoc,
14869                             PDiag(diag::err_ovl_no_viable_function_in_call)
14870                                 << R.getLookupName()),
14871         *this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args);
14872     return ExprError();
14873 
14874   case OR_Ambiguous:
14875     CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(
14876         PartialDiagnosticAt(R.getNameLoc(), PDiag(diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_call)
14877                                                 << R.getLookupName()),
14878         *this, OCD_AmbiguousCandidates, Args);
14879     return ExprError();
14880   }
14881 
14882   FunctionDecl *FD = Best->Function;
14883   ExprResult Fn = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, FD, Best->FoundDecl,
14884                                         nullptr, HadMultipleCandidates,
14885                                         SuffixInfo.getLoc(),
14886                                         SuffixInfo.getInfo());
14887   if (Fn.isInvalid())
14888     return true;
14889 
14890   // Check the argument types. This should almost always be a no-op, except
14891   // that array-to-pointer decay is applied to string literals.
14892   Expr *ConvArgs[2];
14893   for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, N = Args.size(); ArgIdx != N; ++ArgIdx) {
14894     ExprResult InputInit = PerformCopyInitialization(
14895       InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context, FD->getParamDecl(ArgIdx)),
14896       SourceLocation(), Args[ArgIdx]);
14897     if (InputInit.isInvalid())
14898       return true;
14899     ConvArgs[ArgIdx] = InputInit.get();
14900   }
14901 
14902   QualType ResultTy = FD->getReturnType();
14903   ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy);
14904   ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
14905 
14906   UserDefinedLiteral *UDL = UserDefinedLiteral::Create(
14907       Context, Fn.get(), llvm::makeArrayRef(ConvArgs, Args.size()), ResultTy,
14908       VK, LitEndLoc, UDSuffixLoc, CurFPFeatureOverrides());
14909 
14910   if (CheckCallReturnType(FD->getReturnType(), UDSuffixLoc, UDL, FD))
14911     return ExprError();
14912 
14913   if (CheckFunctionCall(FD, UDL, nullptr))
14914     return ExprError();
14915 
14916   return CheckForImmediateInvocation(MaybeBindToTemporary(UDL), FD);
14917 }
14918 
14919 /// Build a call to 'begin' or 'end' for a C++11 for-range statement. If the
14920 /// given LookupResult is non-empty, it is assumed to describe a member which
14921 /// will be invoked. Otherwise, the function will be found via argument
14922 /// dependent lookup.
14923 /// CallExpr is set to a valid expression and FRS_Success returned on success,
14924 /// otherwise CallExpr is set to ExprError() and some non-success value
14925 /// is returned.
14926 Sema::ForRangeStatus
14927 Sema::BuildForRangeBeginEndCall(SourceLocation Loc,
14928                                 SourceLocation RangeLoc,
14929                                 const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo,
14930                                 LookupResult &MemberLookup,
14931                                 OverloadCandidateSet *CandidateSet,
14932                                 Expr *Range, ExprResult *CallExpr) {
14933   Scope *S = nullptr;
14934 
14935   CandidateSet->clear(OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Normal);
14936   if (!MemberLookup.empty()) {
14937     ExprResult MemberRef =
14938         BuildMemberReferenceExpr(Range, Range->getType(), Loc,
14939                                  /*IsPtr=*/false, CXXScopeSpec(),
14940                                  /*TemplateKWLoc=*/SourceLocation(),
14941                                  /*FirstQualifierInScope=*/nullptr,
14942                                  MemberLookup,
14943                                  /*TemplateArgs=*/nullptr, S);
14944     if (MemberRef.isInvalid()) {
14945       *CallExpr = ExprError();
14946       return FRS_DiagnosticIssued;
14947     }
14948     *CallExpr = BuildCallExpr(S, MemberRef.get(), Loc, None, Loc, nullptr);
14949     if (CallExpr->isInvalid()) {
14950       *CallExpr = ExprError();
14951       return FRS_DiagnosticIssued;
14952     }
14953   } else {
14954     ExprResult FnR = CreateUnresolvedLookupExpr(/*NamingClass=*/nullptr,
14955                                                 NestedNameSpecifierLoc(),
14956                                                 NameInfo, UnresolvedSet<0>());
14957     if (FnR.isInvalid())
14958       return FRS_DiagnosticIssued;
14959     UnresolvedLookupExpr *Fn = cast<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(FnR.get());
14960 
14961     bool CandidateSetError = buildOverloadedCallSet(S, Fn, Fn, Range, Loc,
14962                                                     CandidateSet, CallExpr);
14963     if (CandidateSet->empty() || CandidateSetError) {
14964       *CallExpr = ExprError();
14965       return FRS_NoViableFunction;
14966     }
14967     OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
14968     OverloadingResult OverloadResult =
14969         CandidateSet->BestViableFunction(*this, Fn->getBeginLoc(), Best);
14970 
14971     if (OverloadResult == OR_No_Viable_Function) {
14972       *CallExpr = ExprError();
14973       return FRS_NoViableFunction;
14974     }
14975     *CallExpr = FinishOverloadedCallExpr(*this, S, Fn, Fn, Loc, Range,
14976                                          Loc, nullptr, CandidateSet, &Best,
14977                                          OverloadResult,
14978                                          /*AllowTypoCorrection=*/false);
14979     if (CallExpr->isInvalid() || OverloadResult != OR_Success) {
14980       *CallExpr = ExprError();
14981       return FRS_DiagnosticIssued;
14982     }
14983   }
14984   return FRS_Success;
14985 }
14986 
14987 
14988 /// FixOverloadedFunctionReference - E is an expression that refers to
14989 /// a C++ overloaded function (possibly with some parentheses and
14990 /// perhaps a '&' around it). We have resolved the overloaded function
14991 /// to the function declaration Fn, so patch up the expression E to
14992 /// refer (possibly indirectly) to Fn. Returns the new expr.
14993 Expr *Sema::FixOverloadedFunctionReference(Expr *E, DeclAccessPair Found,
14994                                            FunctionDecl *Fn) {
14995   if (ParenExpr *PE = dyn_cast<ParenExpr>(E)) {
14996     Expr *SubExpr = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(PE->getSubExpr(),
14997                                                    Found, Fn);
14998     if (SubExpr == PE->getSubExpr())
14999       return PE;
15000 
15001     return new (Context) ParenExpr(PE->getLParen(), PE->getRParen(), SubExpr);
15002   }
15003 
15004   if (ImplicitCastExpr *ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(E)) {
15005     Expr *SubExpr = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(ICE->getSubExpr(),
15006                                                    Found, Fn);
15007     assert(Context.hasSameType(ICE->getSubExpr()->getType(),
15008                                SubExpr->getType()) &&
15009            "Implicit cast type cannot be determined from overload");
15010     assert(ICE->path_empty() && "fixing up hierarchy conversion?");
15011     if (SubExpr == ICE->getSubExpr())
15012       return ICE;
15013 
15014     return ImplicitCastExpr::Create(Context, ICE->getType(), ICE->getCastKind(),
15015                                     SubExpr, nullptr, ICE->getValueKind(),
15016                                     CurFPFeatureOverrides());
15017   }
15018 
15019   if (auto *GSE = dyn_cast<GenericSelectionExpr>(E)) {
15020     if (!GSE->isResultDependent()) {
15021       Expr *SubExpr =
15022           FixOverloadedFunctionReference(GSE->getResultExpr(), Found, Fn);
15023       if (SubExpr == GSE->getResultExpr())
15024         return GSE;
15025 
15026       // Replace the resulting type information before rebuilding the generic
15027       // selection expression.
15028       ArrayRef<Expr *> A = GSE->getAssocExprs();
15029       SmallVector<Expr *, 4> AssocExprs(A.begin(), A.end());
15030       unsigned ResultIdx = GSE->getResultIndex();
15031       AssocExprs[ResultIdx] = SubExpr;
15032 
15033       return GenericSelectionExpr::Create(
15034           Context, GSE->getGenericLoc(), GSE->getControllingExpr(),
15035           GSE->getAssocTypeSourceInfos(), AssocExprs, GSE->getDefaultLoc(),
15036           GSE->getRParenLoc(), GSE->containsUnexpandedParameterPack(),
15037           ResultIdx);
15038     }
15039     // Rather than fall through to the unreachable, return the original generic
15040     // selection expression.
15041     return GSE;
15042   }
15043 
15044   if (UnaryOperator *UnOp = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(E)) {
15045     assert(UnOp->getOpcode() == UO_AddrOf &&
15046            "Can only take the address of an overloaded function");
15047     if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)) {
15048       if (Method->isStatic()) {
15049         // Do nothing: static member functions aren't any different
15050         // from non-member functions.
15051       } else {
15052         // Fix the subexpression, which really has to be an
15053         // UnresolvedLookupExpr holding an overloaded member function
15054         // or template.
15055         Expr *SubExpr = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(UnOp->getSubExpr(),
15056                                                        Found, Fn);
15057         if (SubExpr == UnOp->getSubExpr())
15058           return UnOp;
15059 
15060         assert(isa<DeclRefExpr>(SubExpr)
15061                && "fixed to something other than a decl ref");
15062         assert(cast<DeclRefExpr>(SubExpr)->getQualifier()
15063                && "fixed to a member ref with no nested name qualifier");
15064 
15065         // We have taken the address of a pointer to member
15066         // function. Perform the computation here so that we get the
15067         // appropriate pointer to member type.
15068         QualType ClassType
15069           = Context.getTypeDeclType(cast<RecordDecl>(Method->getDeclContext()));
15070         QualType MemPtrType
15071           = Context.getMemberPointerType(Fn->getType(), ClassType.getTypePtr());
15072         // Under the MS ABI, lock down the inheritance model now.
15073         if (Context.getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().isMicrosoft())
15074           (void)isCompleteType(UnOp->getOperatorLoc(), MemPtrType);
15075 
15076         return UnaryOperator::Create(
15077             Context, SubExpr, UO_AddrOf, MemPtrType, VK_RValue, OK_Ordinary,
15078             UnOp->getOperatorLoc(), false, CurFPFeatureOverrides());
15079       }
15080     }
15081     Expr *SubExpr = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(UnOp->getSubExpr(),
15082                                                    Found, Fn);
15083     if (SubExpr == UnOp->getSubExpr())
15084       return UnOp;
15085 
15086     return UnaryOperator::Create(Context, SubExpr, UO_AddrOf,
15087                                  Context.getPointerType(SubExpr->getType()),
15088                                  VK_RValue, OK_Ordinary, UnOp->getOperatorLoc(),
15089                                  false, CurFPFeatureOverrides());
15090   }
15091 
15092   if (UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE = dyn_cast<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(E)) {
15093     // FIXME: avoid copy.
15094     TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer, *TemplateArgs = nullptr;
15095     if (ULE->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) {
15096       ULE->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TemplateArgsBuffer);
15097       TemplateArgs = &TemplateArgsBuffer;
15098     }
15099 
15100     DeclRefExpr *DRE =
15101         BuildDeclRefExpr(Fn, Fn->getType(), VK_LValue, ULE->getNameInfo(),
15102                          ULE->getQualifierLoc(), Found.getDecl(),
15103                          ULE->getTemplateKeywordLoc(), TemplateArgs);
15104     DRE->setHadMultipleCandidates(ULE->getNumDecls() > 1);
15105     return DRE;
15106   }
15107 
15108   if (UnresolvedMemberExpr *MemExpr = dyn_cast<UnresolvedMemberExpr>(E)) {
15109     // FIXME: avoid copy.
15110     TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer, *TemplateArgs = nullptr;
15111     if (MemExpr->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) {
15112       MemExpr->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TemplateArgsBuffer);
15113       TemplateArgs = &TemplateArgsBuffer;
15114     }
15115 
15116     Expr *Base;
15117 
15118     // If we're filling in a static method where we used to have an
15119     // implicit member access, rewrite to a simple decl ref.
15120     if (MemExpr->isImplicitAccess()) {
15121       if (cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)->isStatic()) {
15122         DeclRefExpr *DRE = BuildDeclRefExpr(
15123             Fn, Fn->getType(), VK_LValue, MemExpr->getNameInfo(),
15124             MemExpr->getQualifierLoc(), Found.getDecl(),
15125             MemExpr->getTemplateKeywordLoc(), TemplateArgs);
15126         DRE->setHadMultipleCandidates(MemExpr->getNumDecls() > 1);
15127         return DRE;
15128       } else {
15129         SourceLocation Loc = MemExpr->getMemberLoc();
15130         if (MemExpr->getQualifier())
15131           Loc = MemExpr->getQualifierLoc().getBeginLoc();
15132         Base =
15133             BuildCXXThisExpr(Loc, MemExpr->getBaseType(), /*IsImplicit=*/true);
15134       }
15135     } else
15136       Base = MemExpr->getBase();
15137 
15138     ExprValueKind valueKind;
15139     QualType type;
15140     if (cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)->isStatic()) {
15141       valueKind = VK_LValue;
15142       type = Fn->getType();
15143     } else {
15144       valueKind = VK_RValue;
15145       type = Context.BoundMemberTy;
15146     }
15147 
15148     return BuildMemberExpr(
15149         Base, MemExpr->isArrow(), MemExpr->getOperatorLoc(),
15150         MemExpr->getQualifierLoc(), MemExpr->getTemplateKeywordLoc(), Fn, Found,
15151         /*HadMultipleCandidates=*/true, MemExpr->getMemberNameInfo(),
15152         type, valueKind, OK_Ordinary, TemplateArgs);
15153   }
15154 
15155   llvm_unreachable("Invalid reference to overloaded function");
15156 }
15157 
15158 ExprResult Sema::FixOverloadedFunctionReference(ExprResult E,
15159                                                 DeclAccessPair Found,
15160                                                 FunctionDecl *Fn) {
15161   return FixOverloadedFunctionReference(E.get(), Found, Fn);
15162 }
15163